Remove --xdb
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 @node Sample Session
545 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
546
547 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
548 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
549 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
550
551 @iftex
552 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
553 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
554 @end iftex
555
556 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
557 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
558
559 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
560 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
561 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
562 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
563 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
564 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
565 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
566 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
567 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
568
569 @smallexample
570 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
571 $ @b{./m4}
572 @b{define(foo,0000)}
573
574 @b{foo}
575 0000
576 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
577
578 @b{bar}
579 0000
580 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
581
582 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
583 @b{baz}
584 @b{Ctrl-d}
585 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
586 @end smallexample
587
588 @noindent
589 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
590
591 @smallexample
592 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
593 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
594 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
595 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
596 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
597 the conditions.
598 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
599 for details.
600
601 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
602 (@value{GDBP})
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
607 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
608 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
609 that examples fit in this manual.
610
611 @smallexample
612 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
617 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
618 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
619 @code{break} command.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
623 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
628 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
629 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
633 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
634 @b{define(foo,0000)}
635
636 @b{foo}
637 0000
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
642 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
643 context where it stops.
644
645 @smallexample
646 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
647
648 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
649 at builtin.c:879
650 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
651 @end smallexample
652
653 @noindent
654 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
655 the next line of the current function.
656
657 @smallexample
658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
659 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
660 : nil,
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
665 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
666 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
667 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
668
669 @smallexample
670 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
671 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
672 at input.c:530
673 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
674 @end smallexample
675
676 @noindent
677 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
678 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
679 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
680 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
681 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
682 stack frame for each active subroutine.
683
684 @smallexample
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
686 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
687 at input.c:530
688 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
689 at builtin.c:882
690 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
691 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
692 at macro.c:71
693 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
694 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
695 @end smallexample
696
697 @noindent
698 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
699 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
700 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
704 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
706 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
707 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
708 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
709 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
710 : xstrdup(rq);
711 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
712 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
713 @end smallexample
714
715 @noindent
716 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
717 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
718 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
719 (@code{print}) to see their values.
720
721 @smallexample
722 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
723 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
725 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
726 @end smallexample
727
728 @noindent
729 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
730 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
731 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
732
733 @smallexample
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
735 533 xfree(rquote);
736 534
737 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
738 : xstrdup (lq);
739 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
740 : xstrdup (rq);
741 537
742 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
743 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
744 540 @}
745 541
746 542 void
747 @end smallexample
748
749 @noindent
750 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
751 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
752
753 @smallexample
754 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
755 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
757 540 @}
758 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
759 $3 = 9
760 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
761 $4 = 7
762 @end smallexample
763
764 @noindent
765 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
766 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
767 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
768 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
769 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
770 assignments.
771
772 @smallexample
773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
774 $5 = 7
775 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
776 $6 = 9
777 @end smallexample
778
779 @noindent
780 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
781 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
782 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
783 example that caused trouble initially:
784
785 @smallexample
786 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
787 Continuing.
788
789 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
790
791 baz
792 0000
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
797 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
798 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
799
800 @smallexample
801 @b{Ctrl-d}
802 Program exited normally.
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
807 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
808 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
809
810 @smallexample
811 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
812 @end smallexample
813
814 @node Invocation
815 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
816
817 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
818 The essentials are:
819 @itemize @bullet
820 @item
821 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
822 @item
823 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
824 @end itemize
825
826 @menu
827 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
828 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
829 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
830 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
831 @end menu
832
833 @node Invoking GDB
834 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
835
836 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
837 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
838
839 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
840 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
841
842 The command-line options described here are designed
843 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
844 options may effectively be unavailable.
845
846 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
847 specifying an executable program:
848
849 @smallexample
850 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
851 @end smallexample
852
853 @noindent
854 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
855 specified:
856
857 @smallexample
858 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
859 @end smallexample
860
861 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
862 to debug a running process:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
866 @end smallexample
867
868 @noindent
869 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
870 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
871
872 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
873 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
874 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
875 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
876 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
877
878 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
879 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
880 option processing.
881 @smallexample
882 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
883 @end smallexample
884 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
885 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
886
887 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
888 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
889 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
890
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --silent
893 @end smallexample
894
895 @noindent
896 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
897 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
898
899 @noindent
900 Type
901
902 @smallexample
903 @value{GDBP} -help
904 @end smallexample
905
906 @noindent
907 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
908 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
909
910 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
911 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
912 @samp{-x} option is used.
913
914
915 @menu
916 * File Options:: Choosing files
917 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
918 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
919 @end menu
920
921 @node File Options
922 @subsection Choosing Files
923
924 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
925 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
926 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
927 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
928 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
929 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
930 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
931 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
932 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
933 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
934 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
935 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
936 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
937
938 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
939 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
940 argument and ignore it.
941
942 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
943 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
944 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
945 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
946 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
947
948 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
949 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
950 @c it.
951
952 @table @code
953 @item -symbols @var{file}
954 @itemx -s @var{file}
955 @cindex @code{--symbols}
956 @cindex @code{-s}
957 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
958
959 @item -exec @var{file}
960 @itemx -e @var{file}
961 @cindex @code{--exec}
962 @cindex @code{-e}
963 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
964 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
965
966 @item -se @var{file}
967 @cindex @code{--se}
968 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
969 file.
970
971 @item -core @var{file}
972 @itemx -c @var{file}
973 @cindex @code{--core}
974 @cindex @code{-c}
975 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
976
977 @item -pid @var{number}
978 @itemx -p @var{number}
979 @cindex @code{--pid}
980 @cindex @code{-p}
981 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
982
983 @item -command @var{file}
984 @itemx -x @var{file}
985 @cindex @code{--command}
986 @cindex @code{-x}
987 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
988 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
989 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
990
991 @item -eval-command @var{command}
992 @itemx -ex @var{command}
993 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
994 @cindex @code{-ex}
995 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
996
997 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
998 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
999
1000 @smallexample
1001 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1002 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @item -init-command @var{file}
1006 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1007 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1008 @cindex @code{-ix}
1009 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1010 after loading gdbinit files).
1011 @xref{Startup}.
1012
1013 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1014 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1015 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1016 @cindex @code{-iex}
1017 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1018 after loading gdbinit files).
1019 @xref{Startup}.
1020
1021 @item -directory @var{directory}
1022 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1023 @cindex @code{--directory}
1024 @cindex @code{-d}
1025 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1026
1027 @item -r
1028 @itemx -readnow
1029 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1030 @cindex @code{-r}
1031 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1032 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1033 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1034
1035 @end table
1036
1037 @node Mode Options
1038 @subsection Choosing Modes
1039
1040 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1041 batch mode or quiet mode.
1042
1043 @table @code
1044 @anchor{-nx}
1045 @item -nx
1046 @itemx -n
1047 @cindex @code{--nx}
1048 @cindex @code{-n}
1049 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1050 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1051
1052 @table @code
1053 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1054 This is the system-wide init file.
1055 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1056 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1057 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1058 have been processed.
1059 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1060 This is the init file in your home directory.
1061 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1062 command options have been processed.
1063 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1064 This is the init file in the current directory.
1065 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1066 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1067 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1068 @end table
1069
1070 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1071 For documentation on how to write command files,
1072 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1073
1074 @anchor{-nh}
1075 @item -nh
1076 @cindex @code{--nh}
1077 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1078 in your home directory.
1079 @xref{Startup}.
1080
1081 @item -quiet
1082 @itemx -silent
1083 @itemx -q
1084 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1085 @cindex @code{--silent}
1086 @cindex @code{-q}
1087 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1088 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1089
1090 @item -batch
1091 @cindex @code{--batch}
1092 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1093 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1094 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1095 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1096 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1097 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1098 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1099
1100 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1101 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1102 make this more useful, the message
1103
1104 @smallexample
1105 Program exited normally.
1106 @end smallexample
1107
1108 @noindent
1109 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1110 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1111 mode.
1112
1113 @item -batch-silent
1114 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1115 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1116 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1117 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1118 for an interactive session.
1119
1120 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1121 messages, for example.
1122
1123 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1124 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1125
1126 @item -return-child-result
1127 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1128 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1129 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1130
1131 @itemize @bullet
1132 @item
1133 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1134 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1135 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1136 @item
1137 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1138 @item
1139 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1140 the exit code will be -1.
1141 @end itemize
1142
1143 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1144 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1145 interface.
1146
1147 @item -nowindows
1148 @itemx -nw
1149 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1150 @cindex @code{-nw}
1151 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1152 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1153 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1154
1155 @item -windows
1156 @itemx -w
1157 @cindex @code{--windows}
1158 @cindex @code{-w}
1159 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1160 used if possible.
1161
1162 @item -cd @var{directory}
1163 @cindex @code{--cd}
1164 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1165 instead of the current directory.
1166
1167 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1168 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1169 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1170 @cindex @code{-D}
1171 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1172 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1173 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1174
1175 @item -fullname
1176 @itemx -f
1177 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1178 @cindex @code{-f}
1179 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1180 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1181 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1182 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1183 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1184 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1185 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1186 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1187 frame.
1188
1189 @item -annotate @var{level}
1190 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1191 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1192 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1193 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1194 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1195 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1196 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1197 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1198 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1199
1200 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1201 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1202
1203 @item --args
1204 @cindex @code{--args}
1205 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1206 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1207 This option stops option processing.
1208
1209 @item -baud @var{bps}
1210 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1211 @cindex @code{--baud}
1212 @cindex @code{-b}
1213 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1214 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1215
1216 @item -l @var{timeout}
1217 @cindex @code{-l}
1218 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1219 for remote debugging.
1220
1221 @item -tty @var{device}
1222 @itemx -t @var{device}
1223 @cindex @code{--tty}
1224 @cindex @code{-t}
1225 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1226 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1227
1228 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1229 @item -tui
1230 @cindex @code{--tui}
1231 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1232 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1233 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1234 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1235 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1236 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1237
1238 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1239 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1240 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1241 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1242 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1243 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1244
1245 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1246 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1247 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1248 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1249 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1250 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1251
1252 @item -write
1253 @cindex @code{--write}
1254 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1255 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1256 (@pxref{Patching}).
1257
1258 @item -statistics
1259 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1260 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1261 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1262
1263 @item -version
1264 @cindex @code{--version}
1265 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1266 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1267
1268 @item -configuration
1269 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1270 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1271 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1272 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1273
1274 @end table
1275
1276 @node Startup
1277 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1278 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1279
1280 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1281
1282 @enumerate
1283 @item
1284 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1285 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1286
1287 @item
1288 @cindex init file
1289 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1290 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1291 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1292 that file.
1293
1294 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1295 @item
1296 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1297 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1298 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1299 that file.
1300
1301 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1302 @item
1303 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1304 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1305 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1306 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1307 gets loaded.
1308
1309 @item
1310 Processes command line options and operands.
1311
1312 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1313 @item
1314 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1315 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1316 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1317 This is only done if the current directory is
1318 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1319 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1320 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1321 @value{GDBN}.
1322
1323 @item
1324 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1325 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1326 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1327 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1328
1329 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1330 you must do something like the following:
1331
1332 @smallexample
1333 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1334 @end smallexample
1335
1336 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1337 off too late.
1338
1339 @item
1340 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1341 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1342 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1343
1344 @item
1345 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1346 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1347 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1348 @end enumerate
1349
1350 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1351 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1352 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1353 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1354 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1355 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1356
1357 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1358 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1359
1360 @cindex init file name
1361 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1362 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1363 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1364 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1365 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1366 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1367 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1368 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1369
1370
1371 @node Quitting GDB
1372 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1373 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1374 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1375
1376 @table @code
1377 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1378 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1379 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1380 @itemx q
1381 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1382 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1383 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1384 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1385 error code.
1386 @end table
1387
1388 @cindex interrupt
1389 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1390 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1391 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1392 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1393 until a time when it is safe.
1394
1395 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1396 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1397 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1398
1399 @node Shell Commands
1400 @section Shell Commands
1401
1402 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1403 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1404 just use the @code{shell} command.
1405
1406 @table @code
1407 @kindex shell
1408 @kindex !
1409 @cindex shell escape
1410 @item shell @var{command-string}
1411 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1412 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1413 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1414 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1415 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1416 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1417 @end table
1418
1419 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1420 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1421 @value{GDBN}:
1422
1423 @table @code
1424 @kindex make
1425 @cindex calling make
1426 @item make @var{make-args}
1427 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1428 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1429 @end table
1430
1431 @node Logging Output
1432 @section Logging Output
1433 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1434 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1435
1436 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1437 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1438
1439 @table @code
1440 @kindex set logging
1441 @item set logging on
1442 Enable logging.
1443 @item set logging off
1444 Disable logging.
1445 @cindex logging file name
1446 @item set logging file @var{file}
1447 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1448 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1449 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1450 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1451 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1452 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1453 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1454 @kindex show logging
1455 @item show logging
1456 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1457 @end table
1458
1459 @node Commands
1460 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1461
1462 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1463 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1464 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1465 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1466 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1467
1468 @menu
1469 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1470 * Completion:: Command completion
1471 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1472 @end menu
1473
1474 @node Command Syntax
1475 @section Command Syntax
1476
1477 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1478 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1479 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1480 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1481 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1482 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1483
1484 @cindex abbreviation
1485 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1486 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1487 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1488 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1489 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1490 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1491 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1492
1493 @cindex repeating commands
1494 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1495 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1496 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1497 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1498 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1499 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1500 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1501
1502 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1503 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1504 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1505
1506 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1507 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1508 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1509 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1510 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1511
1512 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1513 @cindex comment
1514 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1515 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1516 Files,,Command Files}).
1517
1518 @cindex repeating command sequences
1519 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1520 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1521 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1522 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1523 for editing.
1524
1525 @node Completion
1526 @section Command Completion
1527
1528 @cindex completion
1529 @cindex word completion
1530 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1531 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1532 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1533 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1534
1535 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1536 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1537 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1538 enter it). For example, if you type
1539
1540 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1541 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1542 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1543 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1544 @smallexample
1545 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1546 @end smallexample
1547
1548 @noindent
1549 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1550 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1551
1552 @smallexample
1553 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1554 @end smallexample
1555
1556 @noindent
1557 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1558 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1559 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1560 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1561 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1562 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1563
1564 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1565 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1566 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1567 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1568 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1569 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1570 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1571 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1572 example:
1573
1574 @smallexample
1575 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1576 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1577 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1578 make_abs_section make_function_type
1579 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1580 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1581 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1582 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1583 @end smallexample
1584
1585 @noindent
1586 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1587 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1588 command.
1589
1590 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1591 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1592 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1593 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1594 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1595
1596 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1597 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1598 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1599
1600 @smallexample
1601 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1602 main
1603 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1604 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1605 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1606 @end smallexample
1607
1608 @noindent
1609 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1610
1611 @table @code
1612 @kindex set max-completions
1613 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1614 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1615 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1616 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1617 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1618 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1619 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1620 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1621 completion slow.
1622 @kindex show max-completions
1623 @item show max-completions
1624 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1625 during completion.
1626 @end table
1627
1628 @cindex quotes in commands
1629 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1630 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1631 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1632 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1633 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1634 @value{GDBN} commands.
1635
1636 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1637 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1638 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1639 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1640 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1641 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1642 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1643 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1644 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1645 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1646 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1647
1648 @smallexample
1649 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1650 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1651 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1652 @end smallexample
1653
1654 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1655 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1656 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1657 place:
1658
1659 @smallexample
1660 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1661 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1662 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1663 @end smallexample
1664
1665 @noindent
1666 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1667 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1668 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1669
1670 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1671 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1672 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1673 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1674
1675 @cindex completion of structure field names
1676 @cindex structure field name completion
1677 @cindex completion of union field names
1678 @cindex union field name completion
1679 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1680 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1681 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1682 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1683 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1684 left-hand-side:
1685
1686 @smallexample
1687 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1688 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1689 to_data to_isatty to_write
1690 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1691 to_flush to_read
1692 @end smallexample
1693
1694 @noindent
1695 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1696 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1697 follows:
1698
1699 @smallexample
1700 struct ui_file
1701 @{
1702 int *magic;
1703 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1704 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1705 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1706 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1707 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1708 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1709 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1710 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1711 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1712 void *to_data;
1713 @}
1714 @end smallexample
1715
1716
1717 @node Help
1718 @section Getting Help
1719 @cindex online documentation
1720 @kindex help
1721
1722 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1723 using the command @code{help}.
1724
1725 @table @code
1726 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1727 @item help
1728 @itemx h
1729 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1730 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1731
1732 @smallexample
1733 (@value{GDBP}) help
1734 List of classes of commands:
1735
1736 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1737 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1738 data -- Examining data
1739 files -- Specifying and examining files
1740 internals -- Maintenance commands
1741 obscure -- Obscure features
1742 running -- Running the program
1743 stack -- Examining the stack
1744 status -- Status inquiries
1745 support -- Support facilities
1746 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1747 stopping the program
1748 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1749
1750 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1751 commands in that class.
1752 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1753 documentation.
1754 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1755 (@value{GDBP})
1756 @end smallexample
1757 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1758
1759 @item help @var{class}
1760 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1761 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1762 help display for the class @code{status}:
1763
1764 @smallexample
1765 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1766 Status inquiries.
1767
1768 List of commands:
1769
1770 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1771 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1772 info -- Generic command for showing things
1773 about the program being debugged
1774 show -- Generic command for showing things
1775 about the debugger
1776
1777 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1778 documentation.
1779 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1780 (@value{GDBP})
1781 @end smallexample
1782
1783 @item help @var{command}
1784 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1785 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1786
1787 @kindex apropos
1788 @item apropos @var{args}
1789 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1790 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1791 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1792
1793 @smallexample
1794 apropos alias
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 results in:
1799
1800 @smallexample
1801 @c @group
1802 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1803 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1804 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1805 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1806 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1807 @c @end group
1808 @end smallexample
1809
1810 @kindex complete
1811 @item complete @var{args}
1812 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1813 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1814 command you want completed. For example:
1815
1816 @smallexample
1817 complete i
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @noindent results in:
1821
1822 @smallexample
1823 @group
1824 if
1825 ignore
1826 info
1827 inspect
1828 @end group
1829 @end smallexample
1830
1831 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1832 @end table
1833
1834 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1835 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1836 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1837 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1838 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1839 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1840 Index}.
1841
1842 @c @group
1843 @table @code
1844 @kindex info
1845 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1846 @item info
1847 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1848 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1849 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1850 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1851 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1852 @w{@code{help info}}.
1853
1854 @kindex set
1855 @item set
1856 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1857 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1858 @code{set prompt $}.
1859
1860 @kindex show
1861 @item show
1862 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1863 @value{GDBN} itself.
1864 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1865 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1866 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1867 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1868
1869 @kindex info set
1870 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1871 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1872 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1873 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1874 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1875 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1876 @end table
1877 @c @end group
1878
1879 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1880 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1881
1882 @table @code
1883 @kindex show version
1884 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1885 @item show version
1886 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1887 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1888 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1889 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1890 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1891 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1892 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1893 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1894 @value{GDBN}.
1895
1896 @kindex show copying
1897 @kindex info copying
1898 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1899 @item show copying
1900 @itemx info copying
1901 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1902
1903 @kindex show warranty
1904 @kindex info warranty
1905 @item show warranty
1906 @itemx info warranty
1907 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1908 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1909
1910 @kindex show configuration
1911 @item show configuration
1912 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1913 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1914 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1915 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1916 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1917 your report.
1918
1919 @end table
1920
1921 @node Running
1922 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1923
1924 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1925 debugging information when you compile it.
1926
1927 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1928 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1929 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1930 kill a child process.
1931
1932 @menu
1933 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1934 * Starting:: Starting your program
1935 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1936 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1937
1938 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1939 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1940 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1941 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1942
1943 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1944 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1945 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1946 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1947 @end menu
1948
1949 @node Compilation
1950 @section Compiling for Debugging
1951
1952 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1953 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1954 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1955 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1956 and addresses in the executable code.
1957
1958 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1959 the compiler.
1960
1961 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1962 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
1963 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
1964 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1965 executables containing debugging information.
1966
1967 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1968 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1969 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1970 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1971 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
1972
1973 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1974 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1975 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1976
1977 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
1978 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
1979 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
1980 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
1981 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
1982 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
1983
1984 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
1985 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
1986 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
1987
1988 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
1989 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
1990 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
1991 format in @value{GDBN}.
1992
1993 @need 2000
1994 @node Starting
1995 @section Starting your Program
1996 @cindex starting
1997 @cindex running
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex run
2001 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2002 @item run
2003 @itemx r
2004 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2005 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2006 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2007 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2008 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2009
2010 @end table
2011
2012 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2013 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2014 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2015 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2016 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2017 message like this one:
2018
2019 @smallexample
2020 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2021 Try "help target" or "continue".
2022 @end smallexample
2023
2024 @noindent
2025 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2026 first (@pxref{load}).
2027
2028 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2029 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2030 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2031 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2032 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2033 divided into four categories:
2034
2035 @table @asis
2036 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2037 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2038 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2039 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2040 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2041 the arguments.
2042 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2043 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2044 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2045 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2046 below for details).
2047
2048 @item The @emph{environment.}
2049 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2050 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2051 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2052 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2053
2054 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2055 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
2056 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
2057 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working Directory}.
2058
2059 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2060 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2061 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2062 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2063 set a different device for your program.
2064 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2065
2066 @cindex pipes
2067 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2068 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2069 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2070 wrong program.
2071 @end table
2072
2073 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2074 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2075 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2076 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2077 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2078
2079 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2080 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2081 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2082 your current breakpoints.
2083
2084 @table @code
2085 @kindex start
2086 @item start
2087 @cindex run to main procedure
2088 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2089 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2090 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2091 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2092 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2093 procedure, depending on the language used.
2094
2095 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2096 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2097 the @samp{run} command.
2098
2099 @cindex elaboration phase
2100 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2101 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2102 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2103 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2104 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2105 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2106 will remain to halt execution.
2107
2108 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2109 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2110 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2111 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2112 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2113
2114 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2115 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution of
2116 your program too late, as the program would have already completed the
2117 elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, insert breakpoints in your
2118 elaboration code before running your program.
2119
2120 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2121 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2122 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2123 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2124 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2125 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2126 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2127 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2128 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2129 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2130 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2131 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2132
2133 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2134 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2135 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2136 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2137
2138 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2139 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2140 environment:
2141
2142 @smallexample
2143 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2144 (@value{GDBP}) run
2145 @end smallexample
2146
2147 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2148 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2149
2150 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2151 @item set startup-with-shell
2152 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2153 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2154 @itemx show set startup-with-shell
2155 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2156 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2157 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2158 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2159 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2160 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2161 startup failures such as:
2162
2163 @smallexample
2164 (@value{GDBP}) run
2165 Starting program: ./a.out
2166 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2167 @end smallexample
2168
2169 @noindent
2170 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2171 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2172 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2173 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2174 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2175 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2176
2177 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2178 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2179 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2180 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2181 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2182 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2183
2184 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2185 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2186 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2187 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2188 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2189 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2190
2191 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2192 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2193 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2194
2195 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2196 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 (@value{GDBP}) run
2200 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2201 @end smallexample
2202
2203 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2204 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2205
2206 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2207 @code{target native} command. For example,
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2211 (@value{GDBP}) run
2212 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2213 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2214 (@value{GDBP}) run
2215 Starting program: ./a.out
2216 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2220 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2221 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2222 disconnect.
2223
2224 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2225 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2226 proc}, @code{info os}.
2227
2228 @kindex set disable-randomization
2229 @item set disable-randomization
2230 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2231 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2232 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2233 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2234 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2235
2236 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2237 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2238
2239 @smallexample
2240 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2241 @end smallexample
2242
2243 @item set disable-randomization off
2244 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2245 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2246 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2247 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2248 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2249 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2250
2251 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2252 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2253 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2254 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2255 a code at its expected addresses.
2256
2257 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2258 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2259 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2260 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2261 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2262 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2263 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2264 a randomly chosen address.
2265
2266 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2267 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2268 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2269 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2270 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2271
2272 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2273 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2274
2275 @item show disable-randomization
2276 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2277 the virtual address space of the started program.
2278
2279 @end table
2280
2281 @node Arguments
2282 @section Your Program's Arguments
2283
2284 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2285 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2286 @code{run} command.
2287 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2288 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2289 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2290 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2291 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2292
2293 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2294 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2295 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2296 the program, not by the shell.
2297
2298 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2299 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set args
2303 @item set args
2304 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2305 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2306 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2307 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2308 it again without arguments.
2309
2310 @kindex show args
2311 @item show args
2312 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2313 @end table
2314
2315 @node Environment
2316 @section Your Program's Environment
2317
2318 @cindex environment (of your program)
2319 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2320 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2321 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2322 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2323 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2324 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2325 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex path
2329 @item path @var{directory}
2330 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2331 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2332 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2333 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2334 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2335 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2336 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2337
2338 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2339 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2340 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2341 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2342 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2343 @var{directory} to the search path.
2344 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2345 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2346
2347 @kindex show paths
2348 @item show paths
2349 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2350 environment variable).
2351
2352 @kindex show environment
2353 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2354 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2355 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2356 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2357 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2358
2359 @kindex set environment
2360 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2361 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2362 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2363 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2364 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2365 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2366 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2367 null value.
2368 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2369 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2370
2371 For example, this command:
2372
2373 @smallexample
2374 set env USER = foo
2375 @end smallexample
2376
2377 @noindent
2378 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2379 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2380 are not actually required.)
2381
2382 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2383 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2384 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2385 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2386 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2387
2388 @kindex unset environment
2389 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2390 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2391 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2392 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2393 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2394 @end table
2395
2396 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2397 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2398 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2399 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2400 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2401 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2402 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2403 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2404 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2405 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2406
2407 @node Working Directory
2408 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2409
2410 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2411 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
2412 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
2413 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
2414 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
2415 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
2416
2417 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
2418 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2419 Specify Files}.
2420
2421 @table @code
2422 @kindex cd
2423 @cindex change working directory
2424 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2425 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2426 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2427
2428 @kindex pwd
2429 @item pwd
2430 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2431 @end table
2432
2433 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2434 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2435 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} is
2436 configured with the @file{/proc} support, you can use the @code{info
2437 proc} command (@pxref{SVR4 Process Information}) to find out the
2438 current working directory of the debuggee.
2439
2440 @node Input/Output
2441 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2442
2443 @cindex redirection
2444 @cindex i/o
2445 @cindex terminal
2446 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2447 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2448 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2449 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2450 running your program.
2451
2452 @table @code
2453 @kindex info terminal
2454 @item info terminal
2455 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2456 program is using.
2457 @end table
2458
2459 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2460 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2461
2462 @smallexample
2463 run > outfile
2464 @end smallexample
2465
2466 @noindent
2467 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2468
2469 @kindex tty
2470 @cindex controlling terminal
2471 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2472 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2473 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2474 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2475 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2476
2477 @smallexample
2478 tty /dev/ttyb
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2483 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2484 that as their controlling terminal.
2485
2486 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2487 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2488 terminal.
2489
2490 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2491 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2492 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2493 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2494
2495 @cindex inferior tty
2496 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2497 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2498 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2499 program.
2500
2501 @table @code
2502 @item set inferior-tty /dev/ttyb
2503 @kindex set inferior-tty
2504 Set the tty for the program being debugged to /dev/ttyb.
2505
2506 @item show inferior-tty
2507 @kindex show inferior-tty
2508 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2509 @end table
2510
2511 @node Attach
2512 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2513 @kindex attach
2514 @cindex attach
2515
2516 @table @code
2517 @item attach @var{process-id}
2518 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2519 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2520 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2521 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2522 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2523
2524 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2525 executing the command.
2526 @end table
2527
2528 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2529 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2530 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2531 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2532
2533 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2534 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2535 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2536 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2537 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2538 Specify Files}.
2539
2540 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2541 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2542 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2543 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2544 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2545 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2546 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2547
2548 @table @code
2549 @kindex detach
2550 @item detach
2551 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2552 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2553 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2554 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2555 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2556 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2557 executing the command.
2558 @end table
2559
2560 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2561 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2562 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2563 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2564 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2565 Messages}).
2566
2567 @node Kill Process
2568 @section Killing the Child Process
2569
2570 @table @code
2571 @kindex kill
2572 @item kill
2573 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2577 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2578 is running.
2579
2580 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2581 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2582 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2583 outside the debugger.
2584
2585 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2586 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2587 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2588 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2589 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2590 breakpoint settings).
2591
2592 @node Inferiors and Programs
2593 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2594
2595 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2596 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2597 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2598 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2599 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2600 from multiple executables.
2601
2602 @cindex inferior
2603 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2604 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2605 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2606 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2607 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2608 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2609 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2610 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2611 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2612 threads running in it.
2613
2614 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2615 inferiors}}:
2616
2617 @table @code
2618 @kindex info inferiors
2619 @item info inferiors
2620 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2621
2622 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2623
2624 @enumerate
2625 @item
2626 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2627
2628 @item
2629 the target system's inferior identifier
2630
2631 @item
2632 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2633
2634 @end enumerate
2635
2636 @noindent
2637 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2638 indicates the current inferior.
2639
2640 For example,
2641 @end table
2642 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2643
2644 @smallexample
2645 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2646 Num Description Executable
2647 2 process 2307 hello
2648 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2649 @end smallexample
2650
2651 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2652
2653 @table @code
2654 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2655 @item inferior @var{infno}
2656 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2657 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2658 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2659 @end table
2660
2661
2662 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2663 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2664 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2665 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2666 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2667 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2668
2669 @table @code
2670 @kindex add-inferior
2671 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2672 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2673 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2674 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2675 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2676 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2677
2678 @kindex clone-inferior
2679 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2680 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2681 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2682 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2683 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2684
2685 @smallexample
2686 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2687 Num Description Executable
2688 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2689 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2690 Added inferior 2.
2691 1 inferiors added.
2692 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2693 Num Description Executable
2694 2 <null> helloworld
2695 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2696 @end smallexample
2697
2698 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2699
2700 @kindex remove-inferiors
2701 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2702 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2703 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2704 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2705
2706 @end table
2707
2708 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2709 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2710 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2711 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2712
2713 @table @code
2714 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2715 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2716 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2717 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2718 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2719 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2720
2721 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2722 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2723 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2724 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2725 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2726 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2727 @end table
2728
2729 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2730 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2731 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2732 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2733
2734
2735 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2736 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2737
2738 @table @code
2739 @kindex set print inferior-events
2740 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2741 @item set print inferior-events
2742 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2743 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2744 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2745 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2746 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2747 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2748
2749 @kindex show print inferior-events
2750 @item show print inferior-events
2751 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2752 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2753 @end table
2754
2755 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2756 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2757 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2758
2759
2760 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2761 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2762 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2763 info program-spaces}} command.
2764
2765 @table @code
2766 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2767 @item maint info program-spaces
2768 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2769 @value{GDBN}.
2770
2771 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2772
2773 @enumerate
2774 @item
2775 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2776
2777 @item
2778 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2779 the @code{file} command.
2780
2781 @end enumerate
2782
2783 @noindent
2784 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2785 indicates the current program space.
2786
2787 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2788 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2789 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2790
2791 @smallexample
2792 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2793 Id Executable
2794 2 goodbye
2795 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2796 * 1 hello
2797 @end smallexample
2798
2799 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2800 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2801 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2802 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2803 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2804
2805 @smallexample
2806 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2807 Id Executable
2808 * 1 vfork-test
2809 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2810 @end smallexample
2811
2812 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2813 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2814 @end table
2815
2816 @node Threads
2817 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2818
2819 @cindex threads of execution
2820 @cindex multiple threads
2821 @cindex switching threads
2822 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2823 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2824 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2825 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2826 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2827 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2828 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2829
2830 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2831 programs:
2832
2833 @itemize @bullet
2834 @item automatic notification of new threads
2835 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2836 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2837 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2838 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2839 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2840 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2841 messages on thread start and exit.
2842 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2843 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2844 isn't compatible with the program.
2845 @end itemize
2846
2847 @quotation
2848 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2849 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2850 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2851 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2852 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2853 like this:
2854
2855 @smallexample
2856 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2857 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2858 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2859 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2860 @end smallexample
2861 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2862 @c doesn't support threads"?
2863 @end quotation
2864
2865 @cindex focus of debugging
2866 @cindex current thread
2867 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2868 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2869 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2870 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2871 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2872
2873 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2874 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2875 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2876 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2877 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2878 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2879 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2880 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2881 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2882 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2883
2884 @smallexample
2885 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2886 @end smallexample
2887
2888 @noindent
2889 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2890 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2891 further qualifier.
2892
2893 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2894 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2895 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2896 @c program?
2897 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2898 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2899 @c threads ab initio?
2900
2901 @cindex thread number
2902 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2903 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2904 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2905
2906 @table @code
2907 @kindex info threads
2908 @item info threads @r{[}@var{id}@dots{}@r{]}
2909 Display a summary of all threads currently in your program. Optional
2910 argument @var{id}@dots{} is one or more thread ids separated by spaces, and
2911 means to print information only about the specified thread or threads.
2912 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2913
2914 @enumerate
2915 @item
2916 the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2917
2918 @item
2919 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2920
2921 @item
2922 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
2923 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
2924 program itself.
2925
2926 @item
2927 the current stack frame summary for that thread
2928 @end enumerate
2929
2930 @noindent
2931 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2932 indicates the current thread.
2933
2934 For example,
2935 @end table
2936 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2937
2938 @smallexample
2939 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2940 Id Target Id Frame
2941 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2942 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2943 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2944 at threadtest.c:68
2945 @end smallexample
2946
2947 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
2948 Solaris-specific command:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item maint info sol-threads
2952 @kindex maint info sol-threads
2953 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
2954 Display info on Solaris user threads.
2955 @end table
2956
2957 @table @code
2958 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2959 @item thread @var{threadno}
2960 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2961 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2962 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2963 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2964 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2965
2966 @smallexample
2967 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2968 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
2969 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
2970 8 printf ("hello\n");
2971 @end smallexample
2972
2973 @noindent
2974 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2975 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2976 threads.
2977
2978 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
2979 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_thread} contains the number
2980 of the current thread. You may find this useful in writing breakpoint
2981 conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth. See
2982 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2983 information on convenience variables.
2984
2985 @kindex thread apply
2986 @cindex apply command to several threads
2987 @item thread apply [@var{threadno} | all [-ascending]] @var{command}
2988 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
2989 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the numbers of the
2990 threads that you want affected with the command argument
2991 @var{threadno}. It can be a single thread number, one of the numbers
2992 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display; or it
2993 could be a range of thread numbers, as in @code{2-4}. To apply
2994 a command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
2995 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
2996 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
2997
2998
2999 @kindex thread name
3000 @cindex name a thread
3001 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3002 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3003 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3004 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3005
3006 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3007 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3008 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3009 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3010 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3011
3012 @kindex thread find
3013 @cindex search for a thread
3014 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3015 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3016 matches the supplied regular expression.
3017
3018 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3019 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3020 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3021 is the LWP id.
3022
3023 @smallexample
3024 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3025 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3026 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3027 Id Target Id Frame
3028 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3029 @end smallexample
3030
3031 @kindex set print thread-events
3032 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3033 @item set print thread-events
3034 @itemx set print thread-events on
3035 @itemx set print thread-events off
3036 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3037 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3038 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3039 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3040 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3041
3042 @kindex show print thread-events
3043 @item show print thread-events
3044 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3045 have started and exited.
3046 @end table
3047
3048 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3049 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3050 programs with multiple threads.
3051
3052 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3053 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3054
3055 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3056 @table @code
3057 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3058 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3059 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3060 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3061 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3062 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3063 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3064 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3065 macro.
3066
3067 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3068 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3069 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3070 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3071 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3072 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3073
3074 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3075 refers to the default system directories that are
3076 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3077 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3078 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3079
3080 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3081 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3082 was loaded in the inferior process.
3083
3084 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3085 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3086 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3087 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3088 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3089 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3090 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3091
3092 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3093 only on some platforms.
3094
3095 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3096 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3097 Display current libthread_db search path.
3098
3099 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3100 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3101 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3102 @item set debug libthread-db
3103 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3104 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3105 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3106 @end table
3107
3108 @node Forks
3109 @section Debugging Forks
3110
3111 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3112 @cindex multiple processes
3113 @cindex processes, multiple
3114 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3115 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3116 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3117 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3118 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3119 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3120 will cause it to terminate.
3121
3122 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3123 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3124 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3125 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3126 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3127 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3128 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3129 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3130 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3131 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3132
3133 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs that
3134 create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork} functions.
3135 Currently, the only platforms with this feature are HP-UX (11.x and later
3136 only?) and @sc{gnu}/Linux (kernel version 2.5.60 and later).
3137
3138 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3139 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3140
3141 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3142 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3146 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3147 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3148 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3149 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @item parent
3153 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3154 unimpeded. This is the default.
3155
3156 @item child
3157 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3158 unimpeded.
3159
3160 @end table
3161
3162 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3163 @item show follow-fork-mode
3164 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3165 @end table
3166
3167 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3168 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3169 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3170
3171 @table @code
3172 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3173 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3174 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3175 retain debugger control over them both.
3176
3177 @table @code
3178 @item on
3179 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3180 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3181 independently. This is the default.
3182
3183 @item off
3184 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3185 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3186 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3187 is held suspended.
3188
3189 @end table
3190
3191 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3192 @item show detach-on-fork
3193 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3194 @end table
3195
3196 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3197 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3198 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3199 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3200 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3201 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3202
3203 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3204 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3205 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3206 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3207 and Programs}.
3208
3209 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3210 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3211 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3212 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3213 the child process's @code{main}.
3214
3215 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3216 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3217
3218 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3219 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3220 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3221 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3222 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3223 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3224 command.
3225
3226 @table @code
3227 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3228 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3229
3230 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3231 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3232
3233 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3234
3235 @table @code
3236 @item new
3237 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3238 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3239 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3240 original inferior.
3241
3242 For example:
3243
3244 @smallexample
3245 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3246 (gdb) info inferior
3247 Id Description Executable
3248 * 1 <null> prog1
3249 (@value{GDBP}) run
3250 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3251 Program exited normally.
3252 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3253 Id Description Executable
3254 * 2 <null> prog2
3255 1 <null> prog1
3256 @end smallexample
3257
3258 @item same
3259 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3260 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3261 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3262 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3263 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3264
3265 For example:
3266
3267 @smallexample
3268 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3269 Id Description Executable
3270 * 1 <null> prog1
3271 (@value{GDBP}) run
3272 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3273 Program exited normally.
3274 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3275 Id Description Executable
3276 * 1 <null> prog2
3277 @end smallexample
3278
3279 @end table
3280 @end table
3281
3282 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3283 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3284 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3285
3286 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3287 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3288
3289 @cindex checkpoint
3290 @cindex restart
3291 @cindex bookmark
3292 @cindex snapshot of a process
3293 @cindex rewind program state
3294
3295 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3296 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3297 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3298 later.
3299
3300 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3301 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3302 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3303 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3304 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3305
3306 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3307 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3308 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3309 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3310 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3311 start again from there.
3312
3313 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3314 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3315
3316 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3317
3318 @table @code
3319 @kindex checkpoint
3320 @item checkpoint
3321 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3322 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3323 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3324
3325 @kindex info checkpoints
3326 @item info checkpoints
3327 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3328 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3329 listed:
3330
3331 @table @code
3332 @item Checkpoint ID
3333 @item Process ID
3334 @item Code Address
3335 @item Source line, or label
3336 @end table
3337
3338 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3339 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3340 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3341 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3342 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3343 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3344 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3345
3346 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3347 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3348 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3349 the debugger.
3350
3351 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3352 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3353 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3354
3355 @end table
3356
3357 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3358 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3359 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3360 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3361 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3362 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3363 previously read data can be read again.
3364
3365 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3366 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3367 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3368 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3369 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3370 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3371
3372 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3373 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3374 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3375 different execution path this time.
3376
3377 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3378 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3379 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3380 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3381 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3382 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3383 potentially pose a problem.
3384
3385 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3386
3387 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3388 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3389 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3390 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3391 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3392 next.
3393
3394 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3395 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3396 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3397 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3398 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3399
3400 @node Stopping
3401 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3402
3403 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3404 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3405 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3406
3407 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3408 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3409 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3410 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3411 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3412 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3413 explicitly request this information at any time.
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @kindex info program
3417 @item info program
3418 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3419 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3420 @end table
3421
3422 @menu
3423 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3424 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3425 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3426 Skipping over functions and files
3427 * Signals:: Signals
3428 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3429 @end menu
3430
3431 @node Breakpoints
3432 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3433
3434 @cindex breakpoints
3435 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3436 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3437 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3438 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3439 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3440 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3441 program.
3442
3443 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3444 the executable is run. There is a minor limitation on HP-UX systems:
3445 you must wait until the executable is run in order to set breakpoints
3446 in shared library routines that are not called directly by the program
3447 (for example, routines that are arguments in a @code{pthread_create}
3448 call).
3449
3450 @cindex watchpoints
3451 @cindex data breakpoints
3452 @cindex memory tracing
3453 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3454 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3455 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3456 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3457 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3458 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3459 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3460 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3461 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3462 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3463 same commands.
3464
3465 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3466 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3467 Automatic Display}.
3468
3469 @cindex catchpoints
3470 @cindex breakpoint on events
3471 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3472 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3473 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3474 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3475 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3476 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3477 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3478
3479 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3480 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3481 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3482 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3483 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3484 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3485 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3486 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3487 enable it again.
3488
3489 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3490 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3491 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
3492 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
3493 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
3494 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
3495 all breakpoints in that range are operated on.
3496
3497 @menu
3498 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3499 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3500 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3501 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3502 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3503 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3504 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3505 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3506 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3507 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3508 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3509 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3510 @end menu
3511
3512 @node Set Breaks
3513 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3514
3515 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3516 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3517 @c
3518 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3519
3520 @kindex break
3521 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3522 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3523 @cindex latest breakpoint
3524 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3525 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3526 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3527 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3528 convenience variables.
3529
3530 @table @code
3531 @item break @var{location}
3532 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3533 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3534 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3535 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3536 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3537
3538 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3539 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3540 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3541 that situation.
3542
3543 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3544 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3545 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3546
3547 @item break
3548 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3549 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3550 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3551 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3552 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3553 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3554 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3555 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3556 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3557 inside loops.
3558
3559 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3560 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3561 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3562 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3563 existed when your program stopped.
3564
3565 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3566 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3567 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3568 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3569 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3570 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3571 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3572
3573 @kindex tbreak
3574 @item tbreak @var{args}
3575 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3576 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3577 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3578 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3579
3580 @kindex hbreak
3581 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3582 @item hbreak @var{args}
3583 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3584 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3585 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3586 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3587 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3588 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3589 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3590 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3591 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3592 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3593 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3594 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3595 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3596 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3597 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3598 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3599 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3600 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3601
3602 @kindex thbreak
3603 @item thbreak @var{args}
3604 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3605 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3606 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3607 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3608 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3609 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3610 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3611 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3612
3613 @kindex rbreak
3614 @cindex regular expression
3615 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3616 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3617 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3618 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3619 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3620 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3621 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3622 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3623 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3624
3625 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3626 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3627 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3628 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3629 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3630 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3631
3632 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3633 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3634 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3635 classes.
3636
3637 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3638 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3639 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3640
3641 @smallexample
3642 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3643 @end smallexample
3644
3645 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3646 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3647 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3648 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3649 every function in a given file:
3650
3651 @smallexample
3652 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3653 @end smallexample
3654
3655 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3656 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3657
3658 @kindex info breakpoints
3659 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3660 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3661 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
3662 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3663 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3664 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3665 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3666
3667 @table @emph
3668 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3669 @item Type
3670 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3671 @item Disposition
3672 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3673 @item Enabled or Disabled
3674 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3675 that are not enabled.
3676 @item Address
3677 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3678 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3679 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3680 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3681 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3682 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3683 @item What
3684 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3685 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3686 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3687 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3688 @end table
3689
3690 @noindent
3691 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3692 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3693 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3694 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3695 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3696 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3697
3698 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3699 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3700 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3701 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3702
3703 @noindent
3704 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3705 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3706 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3707 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3708 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3709
3710 @noindent
3711 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3712 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3713 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3714 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3715 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3716 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3717
3718 @noindent
3719 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3720 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3721
3722 @end table
3723
3724 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3725 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3726 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3727 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3728
3729 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3730 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3731 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3732 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3733
3734 @itemize @bullet
3735 @item
3736 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3737
3738 @item
3739 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3740 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3741
3742 @item
3743 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3744 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3745
3746 @item
3747 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3748 several places where that function is inlined.
3749 @end itemize
3750
3751 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3752 the relevant locations.
3753
3754 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
3755 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
3756 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
3757 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
3758 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
3759 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
3760 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
3761
3762 For example:
3763
3764 @smallexample
3765 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
3766 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
3767 stop only if i==1
3768 breakpoint already hit 1 time
3769 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
3770 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
3771 @end smallexample
3772
3773 Each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
3774 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
3775 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. Note that you cannot
3776 delete the individual locations from the list, you can only delete the
3777 entire list of locations that belong to their parent breakpoint (with
3778 the @kbd{delete @var{num}} command, where @var{num} is the number of
3779 the parent breakpoint, 1 in the above example). Disabling or enabling
3780 the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects all of the locations
3781 that belong to that breakpoint.
3782
3783 @cindex pending breakpoints
3784 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
3785 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
3786 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
3787 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
3788 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
3789 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
3790 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
3791 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
3792 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
3793 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
3794 is not yet resolved.
3795
3796 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
3797 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
3798 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
3799 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
3800 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
3801 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
3802
3803 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
3804 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
3805 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
3806 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
3807
3808 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
3809 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
3810 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
3811
3812 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
3813 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
3814 address specification to an address:
3815
3816 @kindex set breakpoint pending
3817 @kindex show breakpoint pending
3818 @table @code
3819 @item set breakpoint pending auto
3820 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
3821 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
3822
3823 @item set breakpoint pending on
3824 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
3825 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
3826
3827 @item set breakpoint pending off
3828 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
3829 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
3830 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
3831
3832 @item show breakpoint pending
3833 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
3834 @end table
3835
3836 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
3837 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
3838 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
3839
3840 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
3841 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
3842 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
3843 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
3844 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
3845 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
3846 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
3847 breakpoints.
3848
3849 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands::
3850
3851 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
3852 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
3853 @table @code
3854 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
3855 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
3856 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
3857 breakpoint must be used.
3858
3859 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
3860 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
3861 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
3862 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
3863 @end table
3864
3865 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
3866 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
3867 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
3868 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
3869 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
3870 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
3871 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
3872 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
3873 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
3874
3875 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
3876 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
3877 @table @code
3878 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
3879 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
3880 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
3881 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
3882
3883 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
3884 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
3885 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
3886 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
3887 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
3888 @end table
3889
3890 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
3891 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
3892 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
3893
3894 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
3895 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
3896
3897 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
3898
3899 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
3900 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
3901 @table @code
3902 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
3903 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
3904 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
3905 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
3906 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
3907
3908 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
3909 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
3910 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
3911 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
3912 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
3913 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
3914 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
3915 that is only known to the host. Examples include
3916 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
3917 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
3918 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
3919 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
3920 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
3921
3922 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
3923 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
3924 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
3925 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
3926 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
3927 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
3928 @end table
3929
3930
3931 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
3932 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
3933 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
3934 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
3935 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
3936 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
3937 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
3938 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
3939
3940
3941 @node Set Watchpoints
3942 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
3943
3944 @cindex setting watchpoints
3945 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
3946 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
3947 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
3948 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
3949 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
3950
3951 @itemize @bullet
3952 @item
3953 A reference to the value of a single variable.
3954
3955 @item
3956 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
3957 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
3958 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
3959
3960 @item
3961 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
3962 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
3963 language (@pxref{Languages}).
3964 @end itemize
3965
3966 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
3967 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
3968 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
3969 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
3970 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
3971 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
3972 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
3973 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
3974 the expression changes.
3975
3976 @cindex software watchpoints
3977 @cindex hardware watchpoints
3978 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
3979 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
3980 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
3981 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
3982 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
3983 culprit.)
3984
3985 On some systems, such as HP-UX, PowerPC, @sc{gnu}/Linux and most other
3986 x86-based targets, @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware
3987 watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your program.
3988
3989 @table @code
3990 @kindex watch
3991 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
3992 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
3993 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
3994 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
3995 to watch the value of a single variable:
3996
3997 @smallexample
3998 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
3999 @end smallexample
4000
4001 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]}}
4002 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4003 @var{threadnum} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4004 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4005 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4006 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4007
4008 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4009 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4010 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4011 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4012 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4013 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4014 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4015 error.
4016
4017 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4018 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4019 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4020 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4021 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4022 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4023 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4024 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4025 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4026 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4027 Examples:
4028
4029 @smallexample
4030 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4031 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4032 @end smallexample
4033
4034 @kindex rwatch
4035 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4036 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4037 by the program.
4038
4039 @kindex awatch
4040 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{threadnum}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4041 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4042 or written into by the program.
4043
4044 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4045 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
4046 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4047 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4048 @end table
4049
4050 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4051 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4052 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4053 a never-changing value:
4054
4055 @smallexample
4056 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4057 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4058 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4059 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4060 @end smallexample
4061
4062 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4063 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4064 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4065 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4066 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4067 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4068
4069 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4070 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4071 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4072 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4073 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4074 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4075 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4076 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4077
4078 @table @code
4079 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4080 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4081 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4082
4083 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4084 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4085 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4086 @end table
4087
4088 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4089 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4090 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4091
4092 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4093
4094 @smallexample
4095 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4096 @end smallexample
4097
4098 @noindent
4099 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4100
4101 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4102 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4103 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4104 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4105 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4106 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4107 will print a message like this:
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4111 @end smallexample
4112
4113 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4114 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4115 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4116 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4117 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4118 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4119 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4120 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4121
4122 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4123 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4124 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4125 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4126 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4127 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4128
4129 @smallexample
4130 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4131 @end smallexample
4132
4133 @noindent
4134 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4135
4136 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4137 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4138 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4139 expression with separately allocated resources.
4140
4141 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4142 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4143 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4144
4145 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4146 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4147 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4148 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4149 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4150 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4151 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4152 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4153 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4154
4155 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4156 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4157 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4158 watched expression from every thread.
4159
4160 @quotation
4161 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4162 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4163 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4164 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4165 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4166 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4167 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4168 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4169 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4170 @end quotation
4171
4172 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4173
4174 @node Set Catchpoints
4175 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4176 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4177 @cindex exception handlers
4178 @cindex event handling
4179
4180 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4181 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4182 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4183
4184 @table @code
4185 @kindex catch
4186 @item catch @var{event}
4187 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4188
4189 @table @code
4190 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4191 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4192 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4193 @kindex catch throw
4194 @kindex catch rethrow
4195 @kindex catch catch
4196 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4197 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4198
4199 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4200 regular expression will be caught.
4201
4202 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4203 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4204 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4205 exception being thrown.
4206
4207 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4208 @value{GDBN}:
4209
4210 @itemize @bullet
4211 @item
4212 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4213 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4214 supported.
4215
4216 @item
4217 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4218 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4219 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4220 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4221 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4222 built.
4223
4224 @item
4225 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4226 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4227
4228 @item
4229 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4230 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4231 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4232 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4233
4234 @item
4235 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4236 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4237 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4238 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4239 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4240 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4241 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4242 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4243 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4244
4245 @item
4246 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4247
4248 @item
4249 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4250 @end itemize
4251
4252 @item exception
4253 @kindex catch exception
4254 @cindex Ada exception catching
4255 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4256 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4257 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4258 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4259 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4260
4261 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4262 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4263 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4264 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4265 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4266 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4267 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4268 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4269
4270 @item exception unhandled
4271 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4272 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4273
4274 @item assert
4275 @kindex catch assert
4276 A failed Ada assertion.
4277
4278 @item exec
4279 @kindex catch exec
4280 @cindex break on fork/exec
4281 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4282 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4283
4284 @item syscall
4285 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number}@r{]} @dots{}
4286 @kindex catch syscall
4287 @cindex break on a system call.
4288 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4289 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4290 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4291 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4292 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4293 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4294 will be caught.
4295
4296 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4297 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4298 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4299 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4300
4301 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4302 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4303 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4304 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4305
4306 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4307 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4308 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4309 available choices.
4310
4311 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4312 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4313 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4314 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4315 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4316 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4317 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4318 behind the OS upgrades).
4319
4320 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4321 arguments to it:
4322
4323 @smallexample
4324 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4325 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4326 (@value{GDBP}) r
4327 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4328
4329 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4330 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4331 (@value{GDBP}) c
4332 Continuing.
4333
4334 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4335 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4336 (@value{GDBP})
4337 @end smallexample
4338
4339 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4343 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4344 (@value{GDBP}) r
4345 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4346
4347 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4348 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4349 (@value{GDBP}) c
4350 Continuing.
4351
4352 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4353 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4354 (@value{GDBP})
4355 @end smallexample
4356
4357 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4358 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4359 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4360
4361 @smallexample
4362 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4363 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4364 (@value{GDBP}) r
4365 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4366
4367 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4368 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4369 (@value{GDBP}) c
4370 Continuing.
4371
4372 Program exited normally.
4373 (@value{GDBP})
4374 @end smallexample
4375
4376 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4377 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4378 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4379 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4380
4381 @smallexample
4382 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4383 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4384 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4385 (@value{GDBP})
4386 @end smallexample
4387
4388 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4389 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4390 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4391 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4392 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4393 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4394
4395 @smallexample
4396 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4397 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4398 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4399 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4400 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4401 (@value{GDBP})
4402 @end smallexample
4403
4404 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4405
4406 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4407 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4408
4409 @smallexample
4410 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4411 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4412 @end smallexample
4413
4414 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4415
4416 @item fork
4417 @kindex catch fork
4418 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4419 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4420
4421 @item vfork
4422 @kindex catch vfork
4423 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX
4424 and @sc{gnu}/Linux.
4425
4426 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4427 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4428 @kindex catch load
4429 @kindex catch unload
4430 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4431 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4432 matches one of the affected libraries.
4433
4434 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4435 @kindex catch signal
4436 The delivery of a signal.
4437
4438 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4439 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4440 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4441
4442 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4443 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4444 signal names.
4445
4446 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4447 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4448 will be caught.
4449
4450 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4451 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4452 catchpoint.
4453
4454 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4455 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4456 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4457 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4458 commands.
4459
4460 @end table
4461
4462 @item tcatch @var{event}
4463 @kindex tcatch
4464 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4465 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4466
4467 @end table
4468
4469 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4470
4471
4472 @node Delete Breaks
4473 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4474
4475 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4476 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4477 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4478 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4479 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4480 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4481
4482 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4483 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4484 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4485 their breakpoint numbers.
4486
4487 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4488 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4489 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4490
4491 @table @code
4492 @kindex clear
4493 @item clear
4494 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4495 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4496 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4497 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4498
4499 @item clear @var{location}
4500 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4501 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4502 most useful ones are listed below:
4503
4504 @table @code
4505 @item clear @var{function}
4506 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4507 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4508
4509 @item clear @var{linenum}
4510 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4511 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4512 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4513 @end table
4514
4515 @cindex delete breakpoints
4516 @kindex delete
4517 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4518 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4519 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4520 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
4521 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4522 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4523 @end table
4524
4525 @node Disabling
4526 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4527
4528 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4529 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4530 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4531 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4532 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4533
4534 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4535 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4536 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4537 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4538 do not know which numbers to use.
4539
4540 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4541 affects all of its locations.
4542
4543 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4544 different states of enablement:
4545
4546 @itemize @bullet
4547 @item
4548 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4549 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4550 @item
4551 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4552 @item
4553 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4554 disabled.
4555 @item
4556 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4557 N times, then becomes disabled.
4558 @item
4559 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4560 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4561 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4562 @end itemize
4563
4564 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4565 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4566
4567 @table @code
4568 @kindex disable
4569 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4570 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4571 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4572 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4573 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4574 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4575 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4576
4577 @kindex enable
4578 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4579 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4580 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4581
4582 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
4583 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4584 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4585
4586 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{range}@dots{}
4587 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4588 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4589 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4590 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4591 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4592 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4593
4594 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
4595 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4596 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4597 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4598 @end table
4599
4600 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4601 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4602 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4603 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4604 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4605 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4606 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4607 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4608 Stepping}.)
4609
4610 @node Conditions
4611 @subsection Break Conditions
4612 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4613 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4614
4615 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4616 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4617 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4618 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4619 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4620 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4621 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4622 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4623
4624 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4625 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4626 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4627 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4628 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4629
4630 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4631 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4632 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4633 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4634 one.
4635
4636 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4637 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4638 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4639 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4640 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4641 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4642 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4643 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4644 conditions for the
4645 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4646 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4647
4648 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4649 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4650 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4651 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4652 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4653 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4654
4655 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4656 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4657 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4658 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4659 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4660
4661 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4662 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4663 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4664 with the @code{condition} command.
4665
4666 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4667 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4668 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4669 catchpoint.
4670
4671 @table @code
4672 @kindex condition
4673 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4674 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4675 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4676 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4677 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4678 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4679 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4680 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4681 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4682 prints an error message:
4683
4684 @smallexample
4685 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4686 @end smallexample
4687
4688 @noindent
4689 @value{GDBN} does
4690 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4691 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4692 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4693
4694 @item condition @var{bnum}
4695 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4696 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4697 @end table
4698
4699 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4700 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4701 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4702 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4703 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4704 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4705 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4706 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4707 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4708 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4709 your program reaches it.
4710
4711 @table @code
4712 @kindex ignore
4713 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
4714 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
4715 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
4716 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
4717 takes no action.
4718
4719 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
4720 a count of zero.
4721
4722 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
4723 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
4724 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
4725 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
4726
4727 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
4728 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
4729 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
4730
4731 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
4732 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
4733 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4734 Variables}.
4735 @end table
4736
4737 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
4738
4739
4740 @node Break Commands
4741 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
4742
4743 @cindex breakpoint commands
4744 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
4745 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
4746 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
4747 enable other breakpoints.
4748
4749 @table @code
4750 @kindex commands
4751 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
4752 @item commands @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
4753 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
4754 @itemx end
4755 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
4756 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
4757 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
4758
4759 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
4760 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
4761
4762 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
4763 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
4764 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
4765 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
4766 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
4767 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
4768 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
4769 Expressions}).
4770 @end table
4771
4772 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
4773 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
4774
4775 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
4776 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
4777 that resumes execution.
4778
4779 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
4780 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
4781 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
4782 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
4783 ambiguities about which list to execute.
4784
4785 @kindex silent
4786 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
4787 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
4788 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
4789 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
4790 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
4791 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
4792
4793 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
4794 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
4795 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
4796
4797 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
4798 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
4799
4800 @smallexample
4801 break foo if x>0
4802 commands
4803 silent
4804 printf "x is %d\n",x
4805 cont
4806 end
4807 @end smallexample
4808
4809 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
4810 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
4811 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
4812 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
4813 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
4814 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
4815 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
4816
4817 @smallexample
4818 break 403
4819 commands
4820 silent
4821 set x = y + 4
4822 cont
4823 end
4824 @end smallexample
4825
4826 @node Dynamic Printf
4827 @subsection Dynamic Printf
4828
4829 @cindex dynamic printf
4830 @cindex dprintf
4831 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
4832 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
4833 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
4834 having to recompile it.
4835
4836 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
4837 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
4838 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
4839 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
4840 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
4841 redirects to files and so forth.
4842
4843 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
4844 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
4845 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
4846 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
4847 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
4848 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
4849 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
4850
4851 @table @code
4852 @kindex dprintf
4853 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
4854 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
4855 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
4856 To print several values, separate them with commas.
4857
4858 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
4859 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
4860 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
4861 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
4862 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
4863 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
4864
4865 @item gdb
4866 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
4867 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
4868
4869 @item call
4870 @kindex dprintf-style call
4871 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
4872 @code{printf}).
4873
4874 @item agent
4875 @kindex dprintf-style agent
4876 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
4877 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
4878 support running commands on the target.
4879
4880 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
4881 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
4882 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
4883 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
4884 command.
4885
4886 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
4887 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
4888 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
4889 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
4890 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
4891 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
4892
4893 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
4894 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
4895 you could do the following:
4896
4897 @example
4898 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
4899 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
4900 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
4901 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
4902 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
4903 (gdb) info break
4904 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
4905 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
4906 continue
4907 (gdb)
4908 @end example
4909
4910 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
4911 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
4912 the variable settings.
4913
4914 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
4915 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
4916 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
4917 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
4918 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
4919 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
4920
4921 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
4922 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
4923 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
4924
4925 @end table
4926
4927 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
4928 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
4929 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
4930 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
4931 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
4932 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
4933
4934 @node Save Breakpoints
4935 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
4936
4937 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
4938 breakpoints}} command.
4939
4940 @table @code
4941 @kindex save breakpoints
4942 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
4943 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
4944 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
4945 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
4946 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
4947 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
4948 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
4949 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
4950 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
4951 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
4952 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
4953 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
4954 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
4955 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
4956 that can no longer be recreated.
4957 @end table
4958
4959 @node Static Probe Points
4960 @subsection Static Probe Points
4961
4962 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
4963 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
4964 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
4965 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
4966 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
4967
4968 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
4969 ELF-compatible systems:
4970
4971 @itemize @bullet
4972
4973 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
4974 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
4975 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
4976 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
4977 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
4978 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
4979 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
4980 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
4981
4982 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
4983 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
4984 C@t{++} languages.
4985 @end itemize
4986
4987 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
4988 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
4989 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
4990 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
4991 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
4992 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
4993 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
4994 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
4995 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
4996
4997 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
4998 probes}, with optional arguments:
4999
5000 @table @code
5001 @kindex info probes
5002 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5003 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5004 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5005 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5006
5007 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5008 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5009 probes from all providers are listed.
5010
5011 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5012 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5013 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5014
5015 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5016 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5017 given, all object files are considered.
5018
5019 @item info probes all
5020 List the available static probes, from all types.
5021 @end table
5022
5023 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5024 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5025 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5026 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5027 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5028
5029 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5030 commands, with optional arguments:
5031
5032 @table @code
5033 @kindex enable probes
5034 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5035 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5036 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5037 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5038
5039 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5040 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5041 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5042
5043 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5044 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5045 given, all object files are considered.
5046
5047 @kindex disable probes
5048 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5049 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5050 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5051 @end table
5052
5053 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5054 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5055 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5056 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5057 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5058 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5059 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5060 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5061 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5062 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5063 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5064 at the current probe point.
5065
5066 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5067 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5068 an error message.
5069
5070
5071 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5072 @node Error in Breakpoints
5073 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5074
5075 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5076 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5077
5078 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5079 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5080 @smallexample
5081 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5082 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5083 @end smallexample
5084
5085 @noindent
5086 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5087 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5088 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5089
5090 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5091 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5092
5093 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5094 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5095 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5096
5097 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5098 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5099 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5100 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5101
5102 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5103 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5104 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5105 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5106 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5107 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5108 first in the bundle.
5109
5110 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5111 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5112 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5113 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5114 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5115 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5116 is hit.
5117
5118 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5119 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5120
5121 @smallexample
5122 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5123 @end smallexample
5124
5125 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5126 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5127 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5128 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5129 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5130 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5131 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5132 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5133
5134 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5135 adjusted breakpoints:
5136
5137 @smallexample
5138 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5139 to 0x00010410.
5140 @end smallexample
5141
5142 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5143 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5144 frequently than expected.
5145
5146 @node Continuing and Stepping
5147 @section Continuing and Stepping
5148
5149 @cindex stepping
5150 @cindex continuing
5151 @cindex resuming execution
5152 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5153 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5154 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5155 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5156 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5157 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5158 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5159 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5160 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5161 handlers}).)
5162
5163 @table @code
5164 @kindex continue
5165 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5166 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5167 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5168 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5169 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5170 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5171 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5172 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5173 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5174 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5175
5176 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5177 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5178 @code{continue} is ignored.
5179
5180 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5181 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5182 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5183 @code{continue}.
5184 @end table
5185
5186 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5187 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5188 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5189 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5190
5191 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5192 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5193 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5194 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5195 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5196 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5197
5198 @table @code
5199 @kindex step
5200 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5201 @item step
5202 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5203 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5204 abbreviated @code{s}.
5205
5206 @quotation
5207 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5208 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5209 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5210 @c distinction here.
5211 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5212 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5213 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5214 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5215 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5216 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5217 below.
5218 @end quotation
5219
5220 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5221 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5222 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5223 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5224 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5225 called within the line.
5226
5227 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5228 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5229 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5230 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5231 was any debugging information about the routine.
5232
5233 @item step @var{count}
5234 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5235 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5236 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5237
5238 @kindex next
5239 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5240 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5241 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5242 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5243 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5244 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5245 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5246 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5247
5248 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5249
5250
5251 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5252 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5253 @c
5254 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5255 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5256 @c function are executed without stopping.
5257
5258 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5259 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5260 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5261
5262 @kindex set step-mode
5263 @item set step-mode
5264 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5265 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5266 @itemx set step-mode on
5267 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5268 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5269 information rather than stepping over it.
5270
5271 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5272 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5273 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5274
5275 @item set step-mode off
5276 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5277 debug information. This is the default.
5278
5279 @item show step-mode
5280 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5281 source line debug information.
5282
5283 @kindex finish
5284 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5285 @item finish
5286 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5287 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5288 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5289
5290 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5291 ,Returning from a Function}).
5292
5293 @kindex until
5294 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5295 @cindex run until specified location
5296 @item until
5297 @itemx u
5298 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5299 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5300 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5301 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5302 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5303 than the address of the jump.
5304
5305 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5306 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5307 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5308 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5309 through the next iteration.
5310
5311 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5312 stack frame.
5313
5314 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5315 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5316 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5317 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5318 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5319
5320 @smallexample
5321 (@value{GDBP}) f
5322 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5323 206 expand_input();
5324 (@value{GDBP}) until
5325 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5326 @end smallexample
5327
5328 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5329 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5330 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5331 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5332 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5333 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5334 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5335
5336 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5337 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5338 argument.
5339
5340 @item until @var{location}
5341 @itemx u @var{location}
5342 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5343 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5344 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5345 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5346 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5347 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5348 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5349 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5350 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5351 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5352 invocations have returned.
5353
5354 @smallexample
5355 94 int factorial (int value)
5356 95 @{
5357 96 if (value > 1) @{
5358 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5359 98 @}
5360 99 return (value);
5361 100 @}
5362 @end smallexample
5363
5364
5365 @kindex advance @var{location}
5366 @item advance @var{location}
5367 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5368 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5369 @ref{Specify Location}.
5370 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5371 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5372 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5373 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5374
5375
5376 @kindex stepi
5377 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5378 @item stepi
5379 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5380 @itemx si
5381 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5382
5383 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5384 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5385 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5386 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5387
5388 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5389
5390 @need 750
5391 @kindex nexti
5392 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5393 @item nexti
5394 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5395 @itemx ni
5396 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5397 proceed until the function returns.
5398
5399 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5400
5401 @end table
5402
5403 @anchor{range stepping}
5404 @cindex range stepping
5405 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5406 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5407 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5408 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5409 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5410 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5411 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5412 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5413 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5414 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5415 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5416 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5417 if necessary:
5418
5419 @table @code
5420 @kindex set range-stepping
5421 @kindex show range-stepping
5422 @item set range-stepping
5423 @itemx show range-stepping
5424 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5425
5426 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5427 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5428 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5429 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5430 default is @code{on}.
5431
5432 @end table
5433
5434 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5435 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5436 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5437
5438 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5439 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} comand lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5440 skip a function or all functions in a file when stepping.
5441
5442 For example, consider the following C function:
5443
5444 @smallexample
5445 101 int func()
5446 102 @{
5447 103 foo(boring());
5448 104 bar(boring());
5449 105 @}
5450 @end smallexample
5451
5452 @noindent
5453 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5454 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5455 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5456 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5457
5458 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5459 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5460 is called from many places.
5461
5462 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5463 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5464 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5465 @code{foo}.
5466
5467 You can also instruct @value{GDBN} to skip all functions in a file, with, for
5468 example, @code{skip file boring.c}.
5469
5470 @table @code
5471 @kindex skip function
5472 @item skip @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5473 @itemx skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5474 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5475 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5476 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5477
5478 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5479 will be skipped.
5480
5481 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5482 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5483
5484 @kindex skip file
5485 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5486 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5487 will be skipped over when stepping.
5488
5489 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5490 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5491 @end table
5492
5493 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5494 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5495
5496 @table @code
5497 @kindex info skip
5498 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5499 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5500 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5501 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5502
5503 @table @emph
5504 @item Identifier
5505 A number identifying this skip.
5506 @item Type
5507 The type of this skip, either @samp{function} or @samp{file}.
5508 @item Enabled or Disabled
5509 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}. Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5510 @item Address
5511 For function skips, this column indicates the address in memory of the function
5512 being skipped. If you've set a function skip on a function which has not yet
5513 been loaded, this field will contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Once a shared library
5514 which has the function is loaded, @code{info skip} will show the function's
5515 address here.
5516 @item What
5517 For file skips, this field contains the filename being skipped. For functions
5518 skips, this field contains the function name and its line number in the file
5519 where it is defined.
5520 @end table
5521
5522 @kindex skip delete
5523 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5524 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5525 skips.
5526
5527 @kindex skip enable
5528 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5529 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5530 skips.
5531
5532 @kindex skip disable
5533 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5534 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5535 skips.
5536
5537 @end table
5538
5539 @node Signals
5540 @section Signals
5541 @cindex signals
5542
5543 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5544 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5545 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5546 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5547 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5548 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5549 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5550 requested an alarm).
5551
5552 @cindex fatal signals
5553 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5554 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5555 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5556 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5557 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5558 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5559
5560 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5561 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5562 signal.
5563
5564 @cindex handling signals
5565 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5566 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5567 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5568 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5569 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5570
5571 @table @code
5572 @kindex info signals
5573 @kindex info handle
5574 @item info signals
5575 @itemx info handle
5576 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5577 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5578 the defined types of signals.
5579
5580 @item info signals @var{sig}
5581 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5582
5583 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5584
5585 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5586 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5587 for details about this command.
5588
5589 @kindex handle
5590 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5591 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5592 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5593 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5594 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5595 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5596 say what change to make.
5597 @end table
5598
5599 @c @group
5600 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5601 Their full names are:
5602
5603 @table @code
5604 @item nostop
5605 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5606 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5607
5608 @item stop
5609 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5610 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5611
5612 @item print
5613 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5614
5615 @item noprint
5616 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5617 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5618
5619 @item pass
5620 @itemx noignore
5621 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5622 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5623 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5624
5625 @item nopass
5626 @itemx ignore
5627 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5628 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5629 @end table
5630 @c @end group
5631
5632 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5633 program until you
5634 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5635 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5636 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5637 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5638 program sees that signal when you continue.
5639
5640 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
5641 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
5642 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
5643 erroneous signals.
5644
5645 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
5646 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
5647 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
5648 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
5649 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
5650 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
5651 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
5652 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5653 Program a Signal}.
5654
5655 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
5656 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
5657
5658 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
5659 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
5660 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
5661 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
5662 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
5663 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
5664 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
5665 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
5666 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
5667 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
5668 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
5669 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
5670 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
5671
5672 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
5673
5674 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
5675 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
5676 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
5677 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
5678
5679 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
5680 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
5681 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
5682 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
5683
5684 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
5685 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
5686
5687 @smallexample
5688 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
5689 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
5690 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
5691 (@value{GDBP}) c
5692 Continuing.
5693
5694 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
5695 main () sigusr1.c:28
5696 28 p = 0;
5697 (@value{GDBP}) si
5698 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5699 9 @{
5700 @end smallexample
5701
5702 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
5703 program to receive the signal first:
5704
5705 @smallexample
5706 (@value{GDBP}) n
5707 28 p = 0;
5708 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
5709 (@value{GDBP}) si
5710 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
5711 9 @{
5712 (@value{GDBP})
5713 @end smallexample
5714
5715 @cindex extra signal information
5716 @anchor{extra signal information}
5717
5718 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
5719 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
5720 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
5721 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
5722 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
5723 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
5724 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
5725 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
5726 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
5727 system header.
5728
5729 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
5730 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
5731
5732 @smallexample
5733 @group
5734 (@value{GDBP}) continue
5735 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
5736 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
5737 69 *(int *)p = 0;
5738 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
5739 type = struct @{
5740 int si_signo;
5741 int si_errno;
5742 int si_code;
5743 union @{
5744 int _pad[28];
5745 struct @{...@} _kill;
5746 struct @{...@} _timer;
5747 struct @{...@} _rt;
5748 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
5749 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
5750 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
5751 @} _sifields;
5752 @}
5753 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
5754 type = struct @{
5755 void *si_addr;
5756 @}
5757 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
5758 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
5759 @end group
5760 @end smallexample
5761
5762 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
5763
5764 @node Thread Stops
5765 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
5766
5767 @cindex stopped threads
5768 @cindex threads, stopped
5769
5770 @cindex continuing threads
5771 @cindex threads, continuing
5772
5773 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
5774 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
5775 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
5776 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
5777 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
5778 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
5779 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
5780 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
5781 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
5782
5783 @menu
5784 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
5785 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
5786 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
5787 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
5788 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
5789 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
5790 @end menu
5791
5792 @node All-Stop Mode
5793 @subsection All-Stop Mode
5794
5795 @cindex all-stop mode
5796
5797 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
5798 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
5799 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
5800 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
5801 underfoot.
5802
5803 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
5804 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5805 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
5806
5807 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
5808 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
5809 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
5810 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
5811 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
5812 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
5813 stops.
5814
5815 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
5816 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
5817 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
5818 first thread completes whatever you requested.
5819
5820 @cindex automatic thread selection
5821 @cindex switching threads automatically
5822 @cindex threads, automatic switching
5823 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
5824 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
5825 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
5826 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
5827 thread.
5828
5829 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
5830 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
5831
5832 @table @code
5833 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
5834 @cindex scheduler locking mode
5835 @cindex lock scheduler
5836 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
5837 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
5838 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
5839 mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other threads
5840 from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so that
5841 the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly.
5842 Other threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
5843 completely free to run when you use commands
5844 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
5845 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change
5846 the current thread away from the thread that you are debugging.
5847
5848 @item show scheduler-locking
5849 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
5850 @end table
5851
5852 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
5853 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
5854 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
5855 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
5856 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
5857 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
5858 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
5859 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
5860 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
5861 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
5862 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
5863 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
5864 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
5865 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
5866
5867 @table @code
5868 @kindex set schedule-multiple
5869 @item set schedule-multiple
5870 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
5871 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
5872 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
5873 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
5874 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
5875 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
5876
5877 @item show schedule-multiple
5878 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
5879 multiple processes.
5880 @end table
5881
5882 @node Non-Stop Mode
5883 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
5884
5885 @cindex non-stop mode
5886
5887 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
5888 @c with more details.
5889
5890 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
5891 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
5892 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
5893 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
5894 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
5895 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
5896
5897 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
5898 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
5899 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
5900 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
5901 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
5902 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
5903 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
5904 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
5905 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
5906 independently and simultaneously.
5907
5908 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
5909 or attach to your program:
5910
5911 @smallexample
5912 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
5913 set pagination off
5914
5915 # Finally, turn it on!
5916 set non-stop on
5917 @end smallexample
5918
5919 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
5920
5921 @table @code
5922 @kindex set non-stop
5923 @item set non-stop on
5924 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
5925 @item set non-stop off
5926 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
5927 @kindex show non-stop
5928 @item show non-stop
5929 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
5930 @end table
5931
5932 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
5933 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
5934 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
5935 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
5936 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
5937 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
5938 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
5939 default.
5940
5941 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
5942 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
5943 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
5944
5945 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
5946 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
5947 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
5948 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
5949 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
5950
5951 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
5952 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
5953 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
5954 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
5955 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
5956
5957 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
5958
5959 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
5960 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
5961 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
5962 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
5963 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
5964 previously current thread.
5965
5966 @node Background Execution
5967 @subsection Background Execution
5968
5969 @cindex foreground execution
5970 @cindex background execution
5971 @cindex asynchronous execution
5972 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
5973
5974 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
5975 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
5976 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
5977 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
5978 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
5979 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
5980
5981 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
5982 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
5983
5984 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
5985 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
5986 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
5987 are:
5988
5989 @table @code
5990 @kindex run&
5991 @item run
5992 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
5993
5994 @item attach
5995 @kindex attach&
5996 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
5997
5998 @item step
5999 @kindex step&
6000 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6001
6002 @item stepi
6003 @kindex stepi&
6004 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6005
6006 @item next
6007 @kindex next&
6008 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6009
6010 @item nexti
6011 @kindex nexti&
6012 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6013
6014 @item continue
6015 @kindex continue&
6016 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6017
6018 @item finish
6019 @kindex finish&
6020 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6021
6022 @item until
6023 @kindex until&
6024 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6025
6026 @end table
6027
6028 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6029 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6030 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6031 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6032 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6033 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6034
6035 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6036 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6037
6038 @table @code
6039 @kindex interrupt
6040 @item interrupt
6041 @itemx interrupt -a
6042
6043 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6044 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6045 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6046 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6047 @end table
6048
6049 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6050 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6051
6052 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6053 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6054 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6055
6056 @table @code
6057 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6058 @cindex thread breakpoints
6059 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
6060 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
6061 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
6062 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6063 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6064 specify some source line.
6065
6066 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
6067 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6068 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{threadno} specifier
6069 is one of the numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6070 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6071
6072 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
6073 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6074 program.
6075
6076 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6077 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before or
6078 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6079
6080 @smallexample
6081 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6082 @end smallexample
6083
6084 @end table
6085
6086 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6087 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6088 thread list. For example:
6089
6090 @smallexample
6091 (@value{GDBP}) c
6092 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6093 @end smallexample
6094
6095 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6096 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6097 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6098 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6099 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6100 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6101 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6102 command.
6103
6104 @node Interrupted System Calls
6105 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6106
6107 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6108 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6109 @cindex premature return from system calls
6110 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6111 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6112 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6113 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6114 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6115 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6116 stop execution.
6117
6118 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6119 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6120 style anyways.
6121
6122 For example, do not write code like this:
6123
6124 @smallexample
6125 sleep (10);
6126 @end smallexample
6127
6128 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6129 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6130
6131 Instead, write this:
6132
6133 @smallexample
6134 int unslept = 10;
6135 while (unslept > 0)
6136 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6137 @end smallexample
6138
6139 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6140 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6141 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6142 @value{GDBN}.
6143
6144 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6145 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6146 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6147 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6148
6149 @node Observer Mode
6150 @subsection Observer Mode
6151
6152 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6153 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6154 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6155 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6156 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6157
6158 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6159 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6160 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6161 mode.
6162
6163 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6164 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6165 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6166 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6167 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6168
6169 @table @code
6170
6171 @kindex observer
6172 @item set observer on
6173 @itemx set observer off
6174 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6175 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6176 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6177 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6178
6179 @item show observer
6180 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6181
6182 @kindex may-write-registers
6183 @item set may-write-registers on
6184 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6185 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6186 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6187 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6188
6189 @item show may-write-registers
6190 Show the current permission to write registers.
6191
6192 @kindex may-write-memory
6193 @item set may-write-memory on
6194 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6195 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6196 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6197 defaults to @code{on}.
6198
6199 @item show may-write-memory
6200 Show the current permission to write memory.
6201
6202 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6203 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6204 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6205 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6206 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6207 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6208
6209 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6210 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6211
6212 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6213 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6214 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6215 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6216 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6217 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6218 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6219
6220 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6221 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6222
6223 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6224 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6225 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6226 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6227 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6228 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6229 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6230
6231 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6232 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6233
6234 @kindex may-interrupt
6235 @item set may-interrupt on
6236 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6237 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6238 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6239 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6240 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6241
6242 @item show may-interrupt
6243 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6244
6245 @end table
6246
6247 @node Reverse Execution
6248 @chapter Running programs backward
6249 @cindex reverse execution
6250 @cindex running programs backward
6251
6252 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6253 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6254 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6255 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6256
6257 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6258 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6259 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6260 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6261 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6262 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6263
6264 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6265 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6266 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6267 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6268 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6269 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6270 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6271 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6272 prior values@footnote{
6273 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6274 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6275 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6276
6277 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6278 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6279 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6280 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6281 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6282 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6283 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6284 }.
6285
6286 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6287 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6288
6289 @table @code
6290 @kindex reverse-continue
6291 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6292 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6293 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6294 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6295 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6296 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6297 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6298
6299 @kindex reverse-step
6300 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6301 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6302 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6303 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6304
6305 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6306 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6307 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6308 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6309 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6310 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6311
6312 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6313 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6314
6315 @kindex reverse-stepi
6316 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6317 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6318 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6319 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6320 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6321 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6322 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6323
6324 @kindex reverse-next
6325 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6326 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6327 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6328 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6329 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6330 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6331 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6332 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6333 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6334 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6335
6336 @kindex reverse-nexti
6337 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6338 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6339 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6340 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6341 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6342 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6343 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6344 frame) is reached.
6345
6346 @kindex reverse-finish
6347 @item reverse-finish
6348 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6349 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6350 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6351 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6352
6353 @kindex set exec-direction
6354 @item set exec-direction
6355 Set the direction of target execution.
6356 @item set exec-direction reverse
6357 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6358 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6359 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6360 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6361 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6362 @item set exec-direction forward
6363 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6364 This is the default.
6365 @end table
6366
6367
6368 @node Process Record and Replay
6369 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6370 @cindex process record and replay
6371 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6372
6373 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6374 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6375 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6376
6377 @cindex replay mode
6378 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6379 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6380 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6381 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6382 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6383 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6384 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6385 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6386 execution log.
6387
6388 @cindex record mode
6389 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6390 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6391 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6392 for future replay.
6393
6394 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6395 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6396 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6397 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6398 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6399 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6400
6401 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6402 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6403 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6404 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6405
6406 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6407 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6408
6409 @table @code
6410 @kindex target record
6411 @kindex target record-full
6412 @kindex target record-btrace
6413 @kindex record
6414 @kindex record full
6415 @kindex record btrace
6416 @kindex record btrace bts
6417 @kindex record bts
6418 @kindex rec
6419 @kindex rec full
6420 @kindex rec btrace
6421 @kindex rec btrace bts
6422 @kindex rec bts
6423 @item record @var{method}
6424 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6425 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6426 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6427 recording methods are available:
6428
6429 @table @code
6430 @item full
6431 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6432 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6433 execution.
6434
6435 @item btrace @var{format}
6436 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6437 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6438 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited replay and
6439 reverse execution.
6440
6441 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6442 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6443 formats are available:
6444
6445 @table @code
6446 @item bts
6447 @cindex branch trace store
6448 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6449 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6450 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6451 @end table
6452
6453 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6454 @end table
6455
6456 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6457 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6458 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6459 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6460
6461 Both @code{record @var{method}} and @code{rec @var{method}} are
6462 aliases of @code{target record-@var{method}}.
6463
6464 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6465 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6466 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6467 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6468 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6469
6470 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6471 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6472 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6473 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6474 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6475 does not support these two modes.
6476
6477 @kindex record stop
6478 @kindex rec s
6479 @item record stop
6480 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6481 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6482 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6483
6484 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6485 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6486 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6487 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6488 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6489
6490 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6491 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6492 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6493 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6494 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6495
6496 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6497 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6498
6499 @kindex record goto
6500 @item record goto
6501 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6502 ways to specify the location to go to:
6503
6504 @table @code
6505 @item record goto begin
6506 @itemx record goto start
6507 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6508
6509 @item record goto end
6510 Go to the end of the execution log.
6511
6512 @item record goto @var{n}
6513 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6514 @end table
6515
6516 @kindex record save
6517 @item record save @var{filename}
6518 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6519 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6520 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6521
6522 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6523
6524 @kindex record restore
6525 @item record restore @var{filename}
6526 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6527 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6528
6529 @kindex set record full
6530 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6531 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6532 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6533 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6534
6535 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6536 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6537 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6538 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6539 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6540 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6541 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6542 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6543
6544 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6545 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6546 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6547
6548 @kindex show record full
6549 @item show record full insn-number-max
6550 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6551 recording method.
6552
6553 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6554 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6555 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6556 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6557 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6558 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6559 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6560 oldest one to be deleted.
6561
6562 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6563 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6564
6565 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6566 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6567
6568 @item set record full memory-query
6569 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6570 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6571 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6572 case.
6573
6574 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6575 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6576 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6577 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6578 results.
6579
6580 @item show record full memory-query
6581 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6582
6583 @kindex set record btrace
6584 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6585 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6586 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6587 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6588 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
6589 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
6590 You can use the following command for that:
6591
6592 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
6593 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
6594 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
6595 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
6596 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
6597 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
6598 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
6599 position.
6600
6601 @kindex show record btrace
6602 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
6603 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
6604
6605 @kindex set record btrace bts
6606 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6607 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
6608 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
6609 format. Default is 64KB.
6610
6611 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
6612 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
6613 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
6614 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
6615 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
6616 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
6617 the @acronym{BTS} format.
6618
6619 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
6620 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
6621
6622 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
6623 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
6624
6625 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
6626 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
6627 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
6628
6629 @kindex info record
6630 @item info record
6631 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
6632 method:
6633
6634 @table @code
6635 @item full
6636 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
6637 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
6638
6639 @itemize @bullet
6640 @item
6641 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6642 @item
6643 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
6644 @item
6645 Highest recorded instruction number.
6646 @item
6647 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
6648 @item
6649 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
6650 @item
6651 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
6652 @end itemize
6653
6654 @item btrace
6655 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
6656
6657 @itemize @bullet
6658 @item
6659 Recording format.
6660 @item
6661 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
6662 @item
6663 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
6664 instructions.
6665 @item
6666 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
6667 @end itemize
6668
6669 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
6670 @itemize @bullet
6671 @item
6672 Size of the perf ring buffer.
6673 @end itemize
6674 @end table
6675
6676 @kindex record delete
6677 @kindex rec del
6678 @item record delete
6679 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
6680 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
6681 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
6682 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
6683
6684 @kindex record instruction-history
6685 @kindex rec instruction-history
6686 @item record instruction-history
6687 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
6688 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
6689 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
6690 are printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify
6691 what part of the execution log to disassemble:
6692
6693 @table @code
6694 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
6695 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
6696 @var{insn}.
6697
6698 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
6699 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
6700 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
6701 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
6702 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
6703 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
6704
6705 @item record instruction-history
6706 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
6707
6708 @item record instruction-history -
6709 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
6710
6711 @item record instruction-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6712 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
6713 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
6714 number @var{end} is included.
6715 @end table
6716
6717 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6718
6719 @kindex set record
6720 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
6721 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
6722 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6723 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
6724 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
6725
6726 @kindex show record
6727 @item show record instruction-history-size
6728 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
6729 instruction-history} command.
6730
6731 @kindex record function-call-history
6732 @kindex rec function-call-history
6733 @item record function-call-history
6734 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
6735 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
6736 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
6737 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
6738 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
6739 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
6740 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
6741 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
6742 given together.
6743
6744 @smallexample
6745 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
6746 1 void foo (void)
6747 2 @{
6748 3 @}
6749 4
6750 5 void bar (void)
6751 6 @{
6752 7 ...
6753 8 foo ();
6754 9 ...
6755 10 @}
6756 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
6757 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
6758 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
6759 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
6760 @end smallexample
6761
6762 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
6763 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
6764 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
6765 to print:
6766
6767 @table @code
6768 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
6769 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
6770
6771 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
6772 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
6773 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
6774 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
6775 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
6776
6777 @item record function-call-history
6778 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
6779
6780 @item record function-call-history -
6781 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
6782
6783 @item record function-call-history @var{begin} @var{end}
6784 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
6785 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
6786 @end table
6787
6788 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6789
6790 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
6791 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
6792 Define how many lines to print in the
6793 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
6794 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
6795
6796 @item show record function-call-history-size
6797 Show how many lines to print in the
6798 @code{record function-call-history} command.
6799 @end table
6800
6801
6802 @node Stack
6803 @chapter Examining the Stack
6804
6805 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
6806 stopped and how it got there.
6807
6808 @cindex call stack
6809 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
6810 is generated.
6811 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
6812 the arguments of the call,
6813 and the local variables of the function being called.
6814 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
6815 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
6816 stack}.
6817
6818 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
6819 stack allow you to see all of this information.
6820
6821 @cindex selected frame
6822 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
6823 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
6824 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
6825 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
6826 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
6827 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
6828
6829 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
6830 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
6831 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
6832
6833 @menu
6834 * Frames:: Stack frames
6835 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
6836 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
6837 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
6838 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
6839
6840 @end menu
6841
6842 @node Frames
6843 @section Stack Frames
6844
6845 @cindex frame, definition
6846 @cindex stack frame
6847 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
6848 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
6849 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
6850 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
6851 which the function is executing.
6852
6853 @cindex initial frame
6854 @cindex outermost frame
6855 @cindex innermost frame
6856 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
6857 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
6858 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
6859 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
6860 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
6861 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
6862 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
6863 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
6864
6865 @cindex frame pointer
6866 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
6867 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
6868 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
6869 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
6870 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
6871 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
6872
6873 @cindex frame number
6874 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
6875 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
6876 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
6877 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
6878 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
6879
6880 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
6881 @c underflow problems.
6882 @cindex frameless execution
6883 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6884 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
6885 @smallexample
6886 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
6887 @end smallexample
6888 generates functions without a frame.)
6889 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
6890 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
6891 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
6892 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
6893 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
6894 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
6895 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
6896
6897 @table @code
6898 @kindex frame@r{, command}
6899 @cindex current stack frame
6900 @item frame @r{[}@var{framespec}@r{]}
6901 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
6902 and to print the stack frame you select. The @var{framespec} may be either the
6903 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
6904 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
6905
6906 @kindex select-frame
6907 @cindex selecting frame silently
6908 @item select-frame
6909 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
6910 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
6911 @code{frame}.
6912 @end table
6913
6914 @node Backtrace
6915 @section Backtraces
6916
6917 @cindex traceback
6918 @cindex call stack traces
6919 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
6920 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
6921 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
6922 stack.
6923
6924 @anchor{backtrace-command}
6925 @table @code
6926 @kindex backtrace
6927 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
6928 @item backtrace
6929 @itemx bt
6930 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
6931 frames in the stack.
6932
6933 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
6934 character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
6935
6936 @item backtrace @var{n}
6937 @itemx bt @var{n}
6938 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
6939
6940 @item backtrace -@var{n}
6941 @itemx bt -@var{n}
6942 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
6943
6944 @item backtrace full
6945 @itemx bt full
6946 @itemx bt full @var{n}
6947 @itemx bt full -@var{n}
6948 Print the values of the local variables also. As described above,
6949 @var{n} specifies the number of frames to print.
6950
6951 @item backtrace no-filters
6952 @itemx bt no-filters
6953 @itemx bt no-filters @var{n}
6954 @itemx bt no-filters -@var{n}
6955 @itemx bt no-filters full
6956 @itemx bt no-filters full @var{n}
6957 @itemx bt no-filters full -@var{n}
6958 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
6959 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
6960 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
6961 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
6962 support.
6963 @end table
6964
6965 @kindex where
6966 @kindex info stack
6967 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
6968 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
6969
6970 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
6971 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
6972 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
6973 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
6974 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
6975 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
6976 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
6977 multi-threaded program.
6978
6979 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
6980 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
6981 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
6982 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
6983 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
6984 line number.
6985
6986 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
6987 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
6988
6989 @smallexample
6990 @group
6991 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
6992 at builtin.c:993
6993 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
6994 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
6995 at macro.c:71
6996 (More stack frames follow...)
6997 @end group
6998 @end smallexample
6999
7000 @noindent
7001 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7002 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7003 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7004
7005 @noindent
7006 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7007 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7008 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7009 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7010 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7011
7012 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7013 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7014 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7015 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7016 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7017 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7018 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7019 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7020 such a backtrace might look like:
7021
7022 @smallexample
7023 @group
7024 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7025 at builtin.c:993
7026 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7027 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7028 at macro.c:71
7029 (More stack frames follow...)
7030 @end group
7031 @end smallexample
7032
7033 @noindent
7034 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7035 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7036
7037 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7038 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7039 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7040
7041 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7042 @cindex program entry point
7043 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7044 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7045 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7046 @code{main}@footnote{
7047 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7048 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7049 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7050 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7051 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7052 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7053
7054 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7055 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7056
7057 @table @code
7058 @item set backtrace past-main
7059 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7060 @kindex set backtrace
7061 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7062
7063 @item set backtrace past-main off
7064 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7065 default.
7066
7067 @item show backtrace past-main
7068 @kindex show backtrace
7069 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7070
7071 @item set backtrace past-entry
7072 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7073 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7074 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7075 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7076
7077 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7078 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7079 application. This is the default.
7080
7081 @item show backtrace past-entry
7082 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7083
7084 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7085 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7086 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7087 @cindex backtrace limit
7088 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7089 or zero means unlimited levels.
7090
7091 @item show backtrace limit
7092 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7093 @end table
7094
7095 You can control how file names are displayed.
7096
7097 @table @code
7098 @item set filename-display
7099 @itemx set filename-display relative
7100 @cindex filename-display
7101 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7102
7103 @item set filename-display basename
7104 Display only basename of a filename.
7105
7106 @item set filename-display absolute
7107 Display an absolute filename.
7108
7109 @item show filename-display
7110 Show the current way to display filenames.
7111 @end table
7112
7113 @node Frame Filter Management
7114 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7115 @cindex managing frame filters
7116
7117 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7118 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7119
7120 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7121 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7122
7123 @table @code
7124 @kindex info frame-filter
7125 @item info frame-filter
7126 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7127 their name, priority and enabled status.
7128
7129 @kindex disable frame-filter
7130 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7131 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7132 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7133 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7134 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7135 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7136 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7137 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7138 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7139 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7140 may be enabled again later.
7141
7142 @kindex enable frame-filter
7143 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7144 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7145 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7146 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7147 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7148 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7149 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7150 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7151 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7152
7153 Example:
7154
7155 @smallexample
7156 (gdb) info frame-filter
7157
7158 global frame-filters:
7159 Priority Enabled Name
7160 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7161 100 Yes Reverse
7162
7163 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7164 Priority Enabled Name
7165 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7166
7167 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7168 Priority Enabled Name
7169 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7170
7171 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7172 (gdb) info frame-filter
7173
7174 global frame-filters:
7175 Priority Enabled Name
7176 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7177 100 Yes Reverse
7178
7179 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7180 Priority Enabled Name
7181 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7182
7183 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7184 Priority Enabled Name
7185 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7186
7187 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7188 (gdb) info frame-filter
7189
7190 global frame-filters:
7191 Priority Enabled Name
7192 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7193 100 Yes Reverse
7194
7195 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7196 Priority Enabled Name
7197 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7198
7199 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7200 Priority Enabled Name
7201 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7202 @end smallexample
7203
7204 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7205 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7206 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7207 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7208 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7209 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7210 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
7211
7212 @kindex show frame-filter priority
7213 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7214 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7215 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7216 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7217 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7218 dictionary resides.
7219
7220 Example:
7221
7222 @smallexample
7223 (gdb) info frame-filter
7224
7225 global frame-filters:
7226 Priority Enabled Name
7227 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7228 100 Yes Reverse
7229
7230 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7231 Priority Enabled Name
7232 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7233
7234 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7235 Priority Enabled Name
7236 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7237
7238 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
7239 (gdb) info frame-filter
7240
7241 global frame-filters:
7242 Priority Enabled Name
7243 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7244 50 Yes Reverse
7245
7246 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7247 Priority Enabled Name
7248 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7249
7250 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7251 Priority Enabled Name
7252 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7253 @end smallexample
7254 @end table
7255
7256 @node Selection
7257 @section Selecting a Frame
7258
7259 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7260 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7261 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7262 of the stack frame just selected.
7263
7264 @table @code
7265 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7266 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7267 @item frame @var{n}
7268 @itemx f @var{n}
7269 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7270 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7271 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7272 @code{main}.
7273
7274 @item frame @var{addr}
7275 @itemx f @var{addr}
7276 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7277 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7278 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7279 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7280 switches between them.
7281
7282 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
7283 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
7284
7285 On the @acronym{MIPS} and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
7286 pointer and a program counter.
7287
7288 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
7289 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
7290
7291 @kindex up
7292 @item up @var{n}
7293 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7294 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7295 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7296
7297 @kindex down
7298 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7299 @item down @var{n}
7300 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7301 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7302 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7303 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7304 @end table
7305
7306 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7307 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7308 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7309 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7310
7311 @need 1000
7312 For example:
7313
7314 @smallexample
7315 @group
7316 (@value{GDBP}) up
7317 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7318 at env.c:10
7319 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7320 @end group
7321 @end smallexample
7322
7323 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7324 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7325 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7326 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7327 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7328 for details.
7329
7330 @table @code
7331 @kindex down-silently
7332 @kindex up-silently
7333 @item up-silently @var{n}
7334 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7335 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7336 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7337 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7338 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7339 distracting.
7340 @end table
7341
7342 @node Frame Info
7343 @section Information About a Frame
7344
7345 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7346 stack frame.
7347
7348 @table @code
7349 @item frame
7350 @itemx f
7351 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7352 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7353 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7354 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7355 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7356
7357 @kindex info frame
7358 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7359 @item info frame
7360 @itemx info f
7361 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7362 including:
7363
7364 @itemize @bullet
7365 @item
7366 the address of the frame
7367 @item
7368 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7369 @item
7370 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7371 @item
7372 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7373 @item
7374 the address of the frame's arguments
7375 @item
7376 the address of the frame's local variables
7377 @item
7378 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7379 @item
7380 which registers were saved in the frame
7381 @end itemize
7382
7383 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7384 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7385 the usual conventions.
7386
7387 @item info frame @var{addr}
7388 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7389 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7390 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7391 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7392 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7393 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7394
7395 @kindex info args
7396 @item info args
7397 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7398
7399 @item info locals
7400 @kindex info locals
7401 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7402 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7403 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7404
7405 @end table
7406
7407
7408 @node Source
7409 @chapter Examining Source Files
7410
7411 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
7412 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
7413 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
7414 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
7415 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
7416 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
7417 source files by explicit command.
7418
7419 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
7420 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7421 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
7422
7423 @menu
7424 * List:: Printing source lines
7425 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
7426 * Edit:: Editing source files
7427 * Search:: Searching source files
7428 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
7429 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
7430 @end menu
7431
7432 @node List
7433 @section Printing Source Lines
7434
7435 @kindex list
7436 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
7437 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
7438 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
7439 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
7440 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
7441
7442 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
7443
7444 @table @code
7445 @item list @var{linenum}
7446 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
7447 current source file.
7448
7449 @item list @var{function}
7450 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
7451 @var{function}.
7452
7453 @item list
7454 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
7455 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
7456 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
7457 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
7458 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
7459
7460 @item list -
7461 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7462 @end table
7463
7464 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
7465 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
7466 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
7467
7468 @table @code
7469 @kindex set listsize
7470 @item set listsize @var{count}
7471 @itemx set listsize unlimited
7472 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
7473 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
7474 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
7475
7476 @kindex show listsize
7477 @item show listsize
7478 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
7479 @end table
7480
7481 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
7482 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
7483 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
7484 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
7485 each repetition moves up in the source file.
7486
7487 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
7488 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
7489 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
7490 to specify some source line.
7491
7492 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
7493
7494 @table @code
7495 @item list @var{linespec}
7496 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
7497
7498 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
7499 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
7500 linespecs. When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, and the
7501 source file of the second linespec is omitted, this refers to
7502 the same source file as the first linespec.
7503
7504 @item list ,@var{last}
7505 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
7506
7507 @item list @var{first},
7508 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
7509
7510 @item list +
7511 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
7512
7513 @item list -
7514 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
7515
7516 @item list
7517 As described in the preceding table.
7518 @end table
7519
7520 @node Specify Location
7521 @section Specifying a Location
7522 @cindex specifying location
7523 @cindex linespec
7524
7525 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
7526 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
7527 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code;
7528 for that reason, locations are also known as @dfn{linespecs}.
7529
7530 Here are all the different ways of specifying a code location that
7531 @value{GDBN} understands:
7532
7533 @table @code
7534 @item @var{linenum}
7535 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
7536
7537 @item -@var{offset}
7538 @itemx +@var{offset}
7539 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
7540 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
7541 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
7542 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
7543 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
7544 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
7545 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
7546 linespec.
7547
7548 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
7549 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
7550 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
7551 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
7552 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
7553 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
7554 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
7555
7556 @item @var{function}
7557 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
7558 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
7559
7560 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
7561 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
7562
7563 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
7564 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
7565 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
7566 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
7567 functions in different source files.
7568
7569 @item @var{label}
7570 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears.
7571 @value{GDBN} searches for the label in the function corresponding to
7572 the currently selected stack frame. If there is no current selected
7573 stack frame (for instance, if the inferior is not running), then
7574 @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
7575
7576 @item *@var{address}
7577 Specifies the program address @var{address}. For line-oriented
7578 commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this specifies a source
7579 line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and other
7580 breakpoint oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
7581 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
7582 source files.
7583
7584 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
7585 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
7586 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
7587 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover the situations
7588 that frequently happen during debugging. Here are the various forms
7589 of @var{address}:
7590
7591 @table @code
7592 @item @var{expression}
7593 Any expression valid in the current working language.
7594
7595 @item @var{funcaddr}
7596 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
7597 C@t{++}, Java, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
7598 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
7599 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
7600 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
7601 (although the Pascal form also works).
7602
7603 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
7604 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
7605
7606 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
7607 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
7608 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
7609 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
7610 functions with identical names in different source files.
7611 @end table
7612
7613 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
7614 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
7615 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
7616 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
7617 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
7618 specifies the location of such a static probe.
7619
7620 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
7621 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
7622 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
7623 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
7624 each one of those probes.
7625
7626 @end table
7627
7628
7629 @node Edit
7630 @section Editing Source Files
7631 @cindex editing source files
7632
7633 @kindex edit
7634 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
7635 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
7636 The editing program of your choice
7637 is invoked with the current line set to
7638 the active line in the program.
7639 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
7640 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
7641
7642 @table @code
7643 @item edit @var{location}
7644 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
7645 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
7646 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
7647 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
7648 command most commonly used:
7649
7650 @table @code
7651 @item edit @var{number}
7652 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
7653
7654 @item edit @var{function}
7655 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
7656 @end table
7657
7658 @end table
7659
7660 @subsection Choosing your Editor
7661 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
7662 @footnote{
7663 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
7664 following command-line syntax:
7665 @smallexample
7666 ex +@var{number} file
7667 @end smallexample
7668 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
7669 the file where to start editing.}.
7670 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
7671 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
7672 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
7673 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
7674 @smallexample
7675 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
7676 export EDITOR
7677 gdb @dots{}
7678 @end smallexample
7679 or in the @code{csh} shell,
7680 @smallexample
7681 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
7682 gdb @dots{}
7683 @end smallexample
7684
7685 @node Search
7686 @section Searching Source Files
7687 @cindex searching source files
7688
7689 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
7690 regular expression.
7691
7692 @table @code
7693 @kindex search
7694 @kindex forward-search
7695 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
7696 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
7697 @itemx search @var{regexp}
7698 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
7699 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
7700 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
7701 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
7702 @code{fo}.
7703
7704 @kindex reverse-search
7705 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
7706 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
7707 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
7708 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
7709 this command as @code{rev}.
7710 @end table
7711
7712 @node Source Path
7713 @section Specifying Source Directories
7714
7715 @cindex source path
7716 @cindex directories for source files
7717 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
7718 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
7719 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
7720 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
7721 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
7722 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
7723 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
7724
7725 For example, suppose an executable references the file
7726 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
7727 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
7728 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
7729 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
7730 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
7731 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
7732 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
7733 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
7734 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
7735 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
7736
7737 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
7738 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
7739 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
7740 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
7741 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
7742 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
7743
7744 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
7745 source files.
7746
7747 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
7748 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
7749 each line is in the file.
7750
7751 @kindex directory
7752 @kindex dir
7753 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
7754 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
7755 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
7756
7757 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
7758 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
7759
7760 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
7761 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
7762 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
7763 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
7764 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
7765 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
7766 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
7767 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
7768 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
7769 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
7770 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
7771 name to look up the sources.
7772
7773 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
7774 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
7775 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
7776 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
7777 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
7778 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
7779 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
7780 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
7781
7782 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
7783 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
7784 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
7785 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
7786 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
7787 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
7788 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
7789
7790 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
7791 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
7792 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
7793 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
7794 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
7795 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
7796 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
7797 command.
7798
7799 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
7800 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
7801 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
7802 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
7803 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
7804 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
7805 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
7806
7807 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
7808 @cindex default source path substitution
7809 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
7810 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
7811 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
7812 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
7813 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
7814 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
7815 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
7816 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
7817 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
7818 together.
7819
7820 @table @code
7821 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
7822 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
7823 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
7824 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
7825 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
7826 part of absolute file names) or
7827 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
7828 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
7829
7830 @kindex cdir
7831 @kindex cwd
7832 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
7833 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
7834 @cindex compilation directory
7835 @cindex current directory
7836 @cindex working directory
7837 @cindex directory, current
7838 @cindex directory, compilation
7839 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
7840 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
7841 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
7842 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
7843 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
7844 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
7845
7846 @item directory
7847 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
7848
7849 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
7850 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
7851
7852 @item set directories @var{path-list}
7853 @kindex set directories
7854 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
7855 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
7856
7857 @item show directories
7858 @kindex show directories
7859 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
7860
7861 @anchor{set substitute-path}
7862 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
7863 @kindex set substitute-path
7864 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
7865 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
7866 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
7867
7868 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
7869 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
7870
7871 @smallexample
7872 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/cross
7873 @end smallexample
7874
7875 @noindent
7876 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/usr/src} with
7877 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
7878 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
7879
7880 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
7881 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
7882 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
7883 the substitution.
7884
7885 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
7886
7887 @smallexample
7888 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
7889 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
7890 @end smallexample
7891
7892 @noindent
7893 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
7894 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
7895 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
7896 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
7897
7898
7899 @item unset substitute-path [path]
7900 @kindex unset substitute-path
7901 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
7902 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
7903 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
7904
7905 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
7906
7907 @item show substitute-path [path]
7908 @kindex show substitute-path
7909 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
7910 which would rewrite that path, if any.
7911
7912 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
7913 rules.
7914
7915 @end table
7916
7917 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
7918 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
7919 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
7920
7921 @enumerate
7922 @item
7923 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
7924
7925 @item
7926 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
7927 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
7928 directories in one command.
7929 @end enumerate
7930
7931 @node Machine Code
7932 @section Source and Machine Code
7933 @cindex source line and its code address
7934
7935 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
7936 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
7937 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
7938 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
7939 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
7940 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
7941 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
7942 well as hex.
7943
7944 @table @code
7945 @kindex info line
7946 @item info line @var{linespec}
7947 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
7948 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
7949 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}.
7950 @end table
7951
7952 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
7953 the object code for the first line of function
7954 @code{m4_changequote}:
7955
7956 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
7957 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
7958 @smallexample
7959 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
7960 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
7961 @end smallexample
7962
7963 @noindent
7964 @cindex code address and its source line
7965 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
7966 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
7967 @smallexample
7968 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
7969 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
7970 @end smallexample
7971
7972 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
7973 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
7974 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
7975 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
7976 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
7977 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
7978 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
7979 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
7980 Variables}).
7981
7982 @table @code
7983 @kindex disassemble
7984 @cindex assembly instructions
7985 @cindex instructions, assembly
7986 @cindex machine instructions
7987 @cindex listing machine instructions
7988 @item disassemble
7989 @itemx disassemble /m
7990 @itemx disassemble /r
7991 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
7992 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
7993 the @code{/m} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex as well as
7994 in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r}.
7995 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
7996 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
7997 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
7998 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
7999 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8000 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8001
8002 @table @code
8003 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8004 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8005 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8006 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8007 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8008 @end table
8009
8010 @noindent
8011 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8012 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8013
8014 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8015 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8016
8017 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8018 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8019 @end table
8020
8021 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8022 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8023
8024 @smallexample
8025 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8026 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8027 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8028 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8029 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8030 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8031 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8032 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8033 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8034 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8035 End of assembler dump.
8036 @end smallexample
8037
8038 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86, when the
8039 program is stopped just after function prologue:
8040
8041 @smallexample
8042 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8043 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8044 5 @{
8045 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8046 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8047 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8048 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8049 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8050
8051 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8052 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8053 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8054
8055 7 return 0;
8056 8 @}
8057 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8058 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8059 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8060
8061 End of assembler dump.
8062 @end smallexample
8063
8064 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8065
8066 @smallexample
8067 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8068 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8069 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8070 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8071 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8072 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8073 End of assembler dump.
8074 @end smallexample
8075
8076 Addresses cannot be specified as a linespec (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8077 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8078 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8079 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8080
8081 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8082 mnemonics or other syntax.
8083
8084 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8085 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8086 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8087 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8088 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8089
8090 @table @code
8091 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8092 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8093 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8094 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8095 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8096 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8097
8098 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8099 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8100 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8101 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8102
8103 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8104 @item show disassembly-flavor
8105 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8106 @end table
8107
8108 @table @code
8109 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8110 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8111 @item set disassemble-next-line
8112 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8113 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8114 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8115 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8116 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8117 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8118 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8119 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8120 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8121 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8122 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8123 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8124 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8125 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8126 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8127 instruction.
8128 @end table
8129
8130
8131 @node Data
8132 @chapter Examining Data
8133
8134 @cindex printing data
8135 @cindex examining data
8136 @kindex print
8137 @kindex inspect
8138 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
8139 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
8140 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
8141 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
8142 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
8143 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
8144
8145 @table @code
8146 @item print @var{expr}
8147 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
8148 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
8149 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
8150 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
8151 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
8152 Formats}.
8153
8154 @item print
8155 @itemx print /@var{f}
8156 @cindex reprint the last value
8157 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
8158 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
8159 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
8160 @end table
8161
8162 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
8163 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
8164 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
8165
8166 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
8167 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
8168 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
8169 Table}.
8170
8171 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
8172 @kindex explore
8173 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
8174 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
8175 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
8176 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
8177 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
8178 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
8179 embedded in the higher level data types.
8180
8181 @table @code
8182 @item explore @var{arg}
8183 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
8184 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
8185 @end table
8186
8187 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
8188 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
8189 C program as
8190
8191 @smallexample
8192 struct SimpleStruct
8193 @{
8194 int i;
8195 double d;
8196 @};
8197
8198 struct ComplexStruct
8199 @{
8200 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
8201 int arr[10];
8202 @};
8203 @end smallexample
8204
8205 @noindent
8206 followed by variable declarations as
8207
8208 @smallexample
8209 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
8210 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
8211 @end smallexample
8212
8213 @noindent
8214 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
8215 @code{explore} command as follows.
8216
8217 @smallexample
8218 (gdb) explore cs
8219 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
8220 the following fields:
8221
8222 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
8223 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
8224
8225 Enter the field number of choice:
8226 @end smallexample
8227
8228 @noindent
8229 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
8230 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
8231 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
8232 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
8233 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
8234 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
8235 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
8236 field will be explored as if it were an array.
8237
8238 @smallexample
8239 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
8240 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
8241 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
8242 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
8243
8244 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
8245 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
8246
8247 Press enter to return to parent value:
8248 @end smallexample
8249
8250 @noindent
8251 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
8252 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
8253 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
8254 to explore.
8255
8256 @smallexample
8257 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
8258 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
8259
8260 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
8261
8262 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
8263
8264 Press enter to return to parent value:
8265 @end smallexample
8266
8267 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
8268 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
8269 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
8270 level data structure).
8271
8272 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
8273 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
8274 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
8275 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
8276 same example as above, your can explore the type
8277 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
8278 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
8279
8280 @smallexample
8281 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
8282 @end smallexample
8283
8284 @noindent
8285 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
8286 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
8287 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
8288 example.
8289
8290 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
8291 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
8292 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
8293 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
8294 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
8295
8296 @table @code
8297 @item explore value @var{expr}
8298 @cindex explore value
8299 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
8300 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
8301 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
8302 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
8303 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
8304
8305 @item explore type @var{arg}
8306 @cindex explore type
8307 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
8308 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
8309 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
8310 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
8311 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
8312 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
8313 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
8314 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
8315 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
8316 @end table
8317
8318 @menu
8319 * Expressions:: Expressions
8320 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
8321 * Variables:: Program variables
8322 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
8323 * Output Formats:: Output formats
8324 * Memory:: Examining memory
8325 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
8326 * Print Settings:: Print settings
8327 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
8328 * Value History:: Value history
8329 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
8330 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
8331 * Registers:: Registers
8332 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
8333 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
8334 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
8335 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
8336 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
8337 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
8338 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
8339 character set than GDB does
8340 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
8341 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
8342 @end menu
8343
8344 @node Expressions
8345 @section Expressions
8346
8347 @cindex expressions
8348 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
8349 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
8350 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
8351 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
8352 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
8353 you compiled your program to include this information; see
8354 @ref{Compilation}.
8355
8356 @cindex arrays in expressions
8357 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
8358 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
8359 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
8360 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
8361 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
8362 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
8363
8364 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
8365 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
8366 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
8367 languages.
8368
8369 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
8370 expressions regardless of your programming language.
8371
8372 @cindex casts, in expressions
8373 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
8374 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
8375 at that address in memory.
8376 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
8377
8378 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
8379 to programming languages:
8380
8381 @table @code
8382 @item @@
8383 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
8384 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
8385
8386 @item ::
8387 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
8388 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
8389
8390 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
8391 @cindex type casting memory
8392 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
8393 @cindex casts, to view memory
8394 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
8395 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
8396 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
8397 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
8398 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
8399 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
8400 @end table
8401
8402 @node Ambiguous Expressions
8403 @section Ambiguous Expressions
8404 @cindex ambiguous expressions
8405
8406 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
8407 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
8408 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
8409 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
8410 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
8411 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
8412 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
8413
8414 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
8415 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
8416 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
8417 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
8418 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
8419 as well.
8420
8421 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
8422 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
8423 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
8424 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
8425 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
8426 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
8427 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
8428 choices.
8429
8430 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
8431 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
8432 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
8433
8434 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
8435 @smallexample
8436 @group
8437 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
8438 [0] cancel
8439 [1] all
8440 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
8441 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
8442 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
8443 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
8444 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
8445 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
8446 > 2 4 6
8447 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
8448 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
8449 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
8450 Multiple breakpoints were set.
8451 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
8452 breakpoints.
8453 (@value{GDBP})
8454 @end group
8455 @end smallexample
8456
8457 @table @code
8458 @kindex set multiple-symbols
8459 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
8460 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
8461
8462 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
8463 is ambiguous.
8464
8465 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
8466 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
8467 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
8468 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
8469 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
8470 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
8471 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
8472 in the use of the menu.
8473
8474 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
8475 when an ambiguity is detected.
8476
8477 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
8478 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
8479
8480 @kindex show multiple-symbols
8481 @item show multiple-symbols
8482 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
8483 @end table
8484
8485 @node Variables
8486 @section Program Variables
8487
8488 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
8489 in your program.
8490
8491 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
8492 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
8493
8494 @itemize @bullet
8495 @item
8496 global (or file-static)
8497 @end itemize
8498
8499 @noindent or
8500
8501 @itemize @bullet
8502 @item
8503 visible according to the scope rules of the
8504 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
8505 @end itemize
8506
8507 @noindent This means that in the function
8508
8509 @smallexample
8510 foo (a)
8511 int a;
8512 @{
8513 bar (a);
8514 @{
8515 int b = test ();
8516 bar (b);
8517 @}
8518 @}
8519 @end smallexample
8520
8521 @noindent
8522 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
8523 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
8524 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
8525 the block where @code{b} is declared.
8526
8527 @cindex variable name conflict
8528 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
8529 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
8530 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
8531 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
8532 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
8533 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
8534 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
8535
8536 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
8537 @ifnotinfo
8538 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
8539 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
8540 @end ifnotinfo
8541 @smallexample
8542 @var{file}::@var{variable}
8543 @var{function}::@var{variable}
8544 @end smallexample
8545
8546 @noindent
8547 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
8548 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
8549 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
8550 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
8551
8552 @smallexample
8553 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
8554 @end smallexample
8555
8556 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
8557 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
8558 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
8559 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
8560 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
8561
8562 @smallexample
8563 void
8564 foo (int a)
8565 @{
8566 if (a < 10)
8567 bar (a);
8568 else
8569 process (a); /* Stop here */
8570 @}
8571
8572 int
8573 bar (int a)
8574 @{
8575 foo (a + 5);
8576 @}
8577 @end smallexample
8578
8579 @noindent
8580 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
8581 here is what you might see
8582 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
8583
8584 @smallexample
8585 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8586 $1 = 10
8587 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8588 $2 = 5
8589 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
8590 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
8591 (@value{GDBP}) p a
8592 $3 = 5
8593 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
8594 $4 = 0
8595 @end smallexample
8596
8597 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
8598 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
8599 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
8600 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
8601 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
8602
8603 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
8604 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
8605 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
8606 @code{some_global}.
8607
8608 @smallexample
8609 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
8610 $1 = 23
8611 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
8612 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
8613 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
8614 $2 = 27
8615 @end smallexample
8616
8617 @cindex wrong values
8618 @cindex variable values, wrong
8619 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
8620 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
8621 @quotation
8622 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
8623 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
8624 scope, and just before exit.
8625 @end quotation
8626 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
8627 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
8628 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
8629 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
8630 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
8631 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
8632 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
8633 variable definitions may be gone.
8634
8635 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
8636 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
8637 when compiling.
8638
8639 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
8640 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
8641 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
8642 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
8643 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
8644 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
8645 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
8646
8647 @smallexample
8648 No symbol "foo" in current context.
8649 @end smallexample
8650
8651 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
8652 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
8653 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
8654 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
8655 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
8656
8657 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
8658 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
8659 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
8660 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
8661
8662 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
8663 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
8664 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
8665 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
8666 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
8667
8668 @smallexample
8669 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
8670 29 i++;
8671 (gdb) next
8672 30 e (i);
8673 (gdb) print i
8674 $1 = 31
8675 (gdb) print i@@entry
8676 $2 = 30
8677 @end smallexample
8678
8679 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
8680 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
8681 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
8682 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
8683 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
8684 For program code
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 char var0[] = "A";
8688 signed char var1[] = "A";
8689 @end smallexample
8690
8691 You get during debugging
8692 @smallexample
8693 (gdb) print var0
8694 $1 = "A"
8695 (gdb) print var1
8696 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
8697 @end smallexample
8698
8699 @node Arrays
8700 @section Artificial Arrays
8701
8702 @cindex artificial array
8703 @cindex arrays
8704 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
8705 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
8706 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
8707 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
8708 program.
8709
8710 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
8711 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
8712 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
8713 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
8714 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
8715 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
8716 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
8717 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
8718 example. If a program says
8719
8720 @smallexample
8721 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
8722 @end smallexample
8723
8724 @noindent
8725 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
8726
8727 @smallexample
8728 p *array@@len
8729 @end smallexample
8730
8731 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
8732 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
8733 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
8734 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
8735 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
8736
8737 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
8738 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
8739 The value need not be in memory:
8740 @smallexample
8741 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
8742 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8743 @end smallexample
8744
8745 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
8746 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
8747 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
8748 @smallexample
8749 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
8750 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
8751 @end smallexample
8752
8753 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
8754 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
8755 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
8756 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
8757 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8758 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
8759 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
8760 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
8761 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
8762 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
8763
8764 @smallexample
8765 set $i = 0
8766 p dtab[$i++]->fv
8767 @key{RET}
8768 @key{RET}
8769 @dots{}
8770 @end smallexample
8771
8772 @node Output Formats
8773 @section Output Formats
8774
8775 @cindex formatted output
8776 @cindex output formats
8777 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
8778 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
8779 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
8780 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
8781 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
8782
8783 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
8784 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
8785 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
8786 letters supported are:
8787
8788 @table @code
8789 @item x
8790 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
8791 hexadecimal.
8792
8793 @item d
8794 Print as integer in signed decimal.
8795
8796 @item u
8797 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
8798
8799 @item o
8800 Print as integer in octal.
8801
8802 @item t
8803 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
8804 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
8805 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
8806 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
8807
8808 @item a
8809 @cindex unknown address, locating
8810 @cindex locate address
8811 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
8812 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
8813 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
8814
8815 @smallexample
8816 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
8817 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
8818 @end smallexample
8819
8820 @noindent
8821 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
8822 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
8823
8824 @item c
8825 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
8826 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
8827 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
8828 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
8829
8830 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
8831 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
8832 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
8833 data.
8834
8835 @item f
8836 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
8837 using typical floating point syntax.
8838
8839 @item s
8840 @cindex printing strings
8841 @cindex printing byte arrays
8842 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
8843 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
8844 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
8845 natural types.
8846
8847 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
8848 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
8849 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
8850 array.
8851
8852 @item z
8853 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
8854 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
8855 to the size of the integer type.
8856
8857 @item r
8858 @cindex raw printing
8859 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
8860 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
8861 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
8862 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
8863 pretty-printer which might exist.
8864 @end table
8865
8866 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
8867
8868 @smallexample
8869 p/x $pc
8870 @end smallexample
8871
8872 @noindent
8873 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
8874 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
8875
8876 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
8877 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
8878 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
8879
8880 @node Memory
8881 @section Examining Memory
8882
8883 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
8884 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
8885
8886 @cindex examining memory
8887 @table @code
8888 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
8889 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
8890 @itemx x @var{addr}
8891 @itemx x
8892 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
8893 @end table
8894
8895 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
8896 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
8897 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
8898 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
8899 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
8900
8901 @table @r
8902 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
8903 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
8904 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
8905 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
8906 @c 4.1.2.
8907
8908 @item @var{f}, the display format
8909 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
8910 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
8911 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
8912 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
8913 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
8914
8915 @item @var{u}, the unit size
8916 The unit size is any of
8917
8918 @table @code
8919 @item b
8920 Bytes.
8921 @item h
8922 Halfwords (two bytes).
8923 @item w
8924 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
8925 @item g
8926 Giant words (eight bytes).
8927 @end table
8928
8929 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
8930 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
8931 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
8932 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
8933 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
8934 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
8935 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
8936 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
8937 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
8938 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
8939 be altered.
8940
8941 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
8942 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
8943 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
8944 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
8945 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
8946 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
8947 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
8948 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
8949 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
8950 a value from memory).
8951 @end table
8952
8953 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
8954 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
8955 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
8956 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
8957 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
8958
8959 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
8960 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
8961 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
8962 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
8963 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
8964
8965 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
8966 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
8967 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
8968 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
8969 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
8970 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
8971 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
8972 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
8973 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
8974
8975 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
8976 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
8977 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
8978 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
8979 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
8980 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
8981 for successive uses of @code{x}.
8982
8983 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
8984 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
8985
8986 @smallexample
8987 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
8988 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
8989 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
8990 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
8991 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
8992 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
8993 @end smallexample
8994
8995 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
8996 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
8997 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
8998 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
8999 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9000 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9001 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9002 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9003 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9004
9005 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9006 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9007 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9008
9009 @cindex remote memory comparison
9010 @cindex target memory comparison
9011 @cindex verify remote memory image
9012 @cindex verify target memory image
9013 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9014 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9015 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9016 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9017 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9018 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9019
9020 @table @code
9021 @kindex compare-sections
9022 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9023 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9024 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9025 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9026 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9027 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9028
9029 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9030 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9031 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9032 @end table
9033
9034 @node Auto Display
9035 @section Automatic Display
9036 @cindex automatic display
9037 @cindex display of expressions
9038
9039 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9040 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9041 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9042 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9043 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9044 The automatic display looks like this:
9045
9046 @smallexample
9047 2: foo = 38
9048 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9049 @end smallexample
9050
9051 @noindent
9052 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9053 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9054 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9055 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9056 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9057 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9058
9059 @table @code
9060 @kindex display
9061 @item display @var{expr}
9062 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9063 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9064
9065 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9066
9067 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9068 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9069 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9070 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9071 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9072
9073 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9074 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9075 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9076 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9077 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9078 @end table
9079
9080 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9081 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9082 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9083
9084 @table @code
9085 @kindex delete display
9086 @kindex undisplay
9087 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9088 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9089 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9090 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9091 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9092 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9093 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9094
9095 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9096 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
9097
9098 @kindex disable display
9099 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9100 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
9101 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
9102 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
9103 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
9104 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
9105 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
9106 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9107
9108 @kindex enable display
9109 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9110 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
9111 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
9112 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
9113 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
9114 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
9115 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9116
9117 @item display
9118 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
9119 done when your program stops.
9120
9121 @kindex info display
9122 @item info display
9123 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
9124 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
9125 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
9126 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
9127 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
9128 @end table
9129
9130 @cindex display disabled out of scope
9131 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
9132 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
9133 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
9134 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
9135 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
9136 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
9137 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
9138 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
9139 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
9140 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
9141
9142 @node Print Settings
9143 @section Print Settings
9144
9145 @cindex format options
9146 @cindex print settings
9147 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
9148 and symbols are printed.
9149
9150 @noindent
9151 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
9152
9153 @table @code
9154 @kindex set print
9155 @item set print address
9156 @itemx set print address on
9157 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
9158 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
9159 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
9160 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
9161 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
9162 @code{set print address on}:
9163
9164 @smallexample
9165 @group
9166 (@value{GDBP}) f
9167 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
9168 at input.c:530
9169 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9170 @end group
9171 @end smallexample
9172
9173 @item set print address off
9174 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
9175 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
9176
9177 @smallexample
9178 @group
9179 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
9180 (@value{GDBP}) f
9181 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
9182 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
9183 @end group
9184 @end smallexample
9185
9186 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
9187 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
9188 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
9189 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
9190
9191 @kindex show print
9192 @item show print address
9193 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
9194 @end table
9195
9196 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
9197 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
9198 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
9199 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
9200 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
9201 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
9202 it prints a symbolic address:
9203
9204 @table @code
9205 @item set print symbol-filename on
9206 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
9207 @cindex symbol, source file and line
9208 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
9209 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9210
9211 @item set print symbol-filename off
9212 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
9213 default.
9214
9215 @item show print symbol-filename
9216 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
9217 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
9218 @end table
9219
9220 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
9221 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
9222 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
9223
9224 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
9225 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
9226
9227 @table @code
9228 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
9229 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
9230 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
9231 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
9232 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
9233 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
9234 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
9235 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
9236
9237 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
9238 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
9239 symbolic address.
9240 @end table
9241
9242 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
9243 @cindex pointer, finding referent
9244 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
9245 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
9246 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
9247 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
9248 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
9249 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
9250
9251 @smallexample
9252 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
9253 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
9254 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
9255 @end smallexample
9256
9257 @quotation
9258 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
9259 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
9260 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
9261 @end quotation
9262
9263 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
9264 @samp{set print symbol on}:
9265
9266 @table @code
9267 @item set print symbol on
9268 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
9269 one exists.
9270
9271 @item set print symbol off
9272 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
9273 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
9274 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
9275
9276 @item show print symbol
9277 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
9278 address.
9279 @end table
9280
9281 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
9282
9283 @table @code
9284 @item set print array
9285 @itemx set print array on
9286 @cindex pretty print arrays
9287 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
9288 but uses more space. The default is off.
9289
9290 @item set print array off
9291 Return to compressed format for arrays.
9292
9293 @item show print array
9294 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
9295 arrays.
9296
9297 @cindex print array indexes
9298 @item set print array-indexes
9299 @itemx set print array-indexes on
9300 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
9301 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
9302 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
9303
9304 @item set print array-indexes off
9305 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
9306
9307 @item show print array-indexes
9308 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
9309 arrays.
9310
9311 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
9312 @itemx set print elements unlimited
9313 @cindex number of array elements to print
9314 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
9315 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
9316 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
9317 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
9318 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
9319 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
9320 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
9321 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
9322
9323 @item show print elements
9324 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
9325 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
9326
9327 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
9328 @kindex set print frame-arguments
9329 @cindex printing frame argument values
9330 @cindex print all frame argument values
9331 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
9332 @cindex do not print frame argument values
9333 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
9334 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
9335 values are:
9336
9337 @table @code
9338 @item all
9339 The values of all arguments are printed.
9340
9341 @item scalars
9342 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
9343 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
9344 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
9345 only scalar arguments are shown:
9346
9347 @smallexample
9348 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
9349 at frame-args.c:23
9350 @end smallexample
9351
9352 @item none
9353 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
9354 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
9355
9356 @smallexample
9357 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
9358 at frame-args.c:23
9359 @end smallexample
9360 @end table
9361
9362 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
9363 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
9364 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
9365 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
9366 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
9367 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
9368 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
9369 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
9370 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
9371 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
9372
9373 @item show print frame-arguments
9374 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
9375
9376 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
9377 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
9378
9379 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
9380 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
9381 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
9382 otherwise print the value in raw form.
9383 This is the default.
9384
9385 @item show print raw frame-arguments
9386 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
9387
9388 @anchor{set print entry-values}
9389 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
9390 @kindex set print entry-values
9391 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
9392 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
9393 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
9394 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
9395 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
9396
9397 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
9398 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
9399 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
9400 @code{no} setting.
9401
9402 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
9403 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
9404 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
9405 this information.
9406
9407 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
9408
9409 @table @code
9410 @item no
9411 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
9412 point.
9413 @smallexample
9414 #0 equal (val=5)
9415 #0 different (val=6)
9416 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
9417 #0 born (val=10)
9418 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9419 @end smallexample
9420
9421 @item only
9422 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
9423 values are never printed.
9424 @smallexample
9425 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9426 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9427 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9428 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9429 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9430 @end smallexample
9431
9432 @item preferred
9433 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
9434 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
9435 value for such parameter.
9436 @smallexample
9437 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
9438 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
9439 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9440 #0 born (val=10)
9441 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9442 @end smallexample
9443
9444 @item if-needed
9445 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
9446 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
9447 parameter.
9448 @smallexample
9449 #0 equal (val=5)
9450 #0 different (val=6)
9451 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9452 #0 born (val=10)
9453 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9454 @end smallexample
9455
9456 @item both
9457 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
9458 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
9459 optimizations.
9460 @smallexample
9461 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
9462 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9463 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9464 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9465 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
9466 @end smallexample
9467
9468 @item compact
9469 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
9470 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
9471 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
9472 values are known and identical, print the shortened
9473 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9474 @smallexample
9475 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9476 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9477 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
9478 #0 born (val=10)
9479 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9480 @end smallexample
9481
9482 @item default
9483 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
9484 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
9485 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
9486 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
9487 @smallexample
9488 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
9489 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
9490 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
9491 #0 born (val=10)
9492 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
9493 @end smallexample
9494 @end table
9495
9496 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
9497 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
9498
9499 @item show print entry-values
9500 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
9501 entry.
9502
9503 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
9504 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
9505 @cindex repeated array elements
9506 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
9507 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
9508 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
9509 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
9510 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
9511 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
9512 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
9513 is 10.
9514
9515 @item show print repeats
9516 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
9517 elements.
9518
9519 @item set print null-stop
9520 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
9521 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
9522 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
9523 contain only short strings.
9524 The default is off.
9525
9526 @item show print null-stop
9527 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
9528 @sc{null} character.
9529
9530 @item set print pretty on
9531 @cindex print structures in indented form
9532 @cindex indentation in structure display
9533 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
9534 per line, like this:
9535
9536 @smallexample
9537 @group
9538 $1 = @{
9539 next = 0x0,
9540 flags = @{
9541 sweet = 1,
9542 sour = 1
9543 @},
9544 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9545 @}
9546 @end group
9547 @end smallexample
9548
9549 @item set print pretty off
9550 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
9551
9552 @smallexample
9553 @group
9554 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
9555 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
9556 @end group
9557 @end smallexample
9558
9559 @noindent
9560 This is the default format.
9561
9562 @item show print pretty
9563 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
9564
9565 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
9566 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
9567 @cindex octal escapes in strings
9568 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
9569 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
9570 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
9571 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
9572 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
9573
9574 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
9575 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
9576 international character sets, and is the default.
9577
9578 @item show print sevenbit-strings
9579 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
9580
9581 @item set print union on
9582 @cindex unions in structures, printing
9583 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
9584 and other unions. This is the default setting.
9585
9586 @item set print union off
9587 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
9588 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
9589 instead.
9590
9591 @item show print union
9592 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
9593 structures and other unions.
9594
9595 For example, given the declarations
9596
9597 @smallexample
9598 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
9599 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
9600 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
9601 Bug_forms;
9602
9603 struct thing @{
9604 Species it;
9605 union @{
9606 Tree_forms tree;
9607 Bug_forms bug;
9608 @} form;
9609 @};
9610
9611 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
9612 @end smallexample
9613
9614 @noindent
9615 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
9616
9617 @smallexample
9618 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
9619 @end smallexample
9620
9621 @noindent
9622 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
9623
9624 @smallexample
9625 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
9626 @end smallexample
9627
9628 @noindent
9629 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
9630 and in Pascal.
9631 @end table
9632
9633 @need 1000
9634 @noindent
9635 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
9636
9637 @table @code
9638 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
9639 @item set print demangle
9640 @itemx set print demangle on
9641 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
9642 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
9643 linkage. The default is on.
9644
9645 @item show print demangle
9646 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
9647
9648 @item set print asm-demangle
9649 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
9650 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
9651 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
9652 The default is off.
9653
9654 @item show print asm-demangle
9655 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
9656 or demangled form.
9657
9658 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
9659 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
9660 @kindex set demangle-style
9661 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
9662 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
9663 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
9664
9665 @table @code
9666 @item auto
9667 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
9668 This is the default.
9669
9670 @item gnu
9671 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
9672
9673 @item hp
9674 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
9675
9676 @item lucid
9677 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
9678
9679 @item arm
9680 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
9681 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
9682 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
9683 require further enhancement to permit that.
9684
9685 @end table
9686 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
9687
9688 @item show demangle-style
9689 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
9690
9691 @item set print object
9692 @itemx set print object on
9693 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
9694 @cindex display derived types
9695 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
9696 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
9697 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
9698 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
9699 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
9700 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
9701 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
9702
9703 @item set print object off
9704 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
9705 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
9706
9707 @item show print object
9708 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
9709
9710 @item set print static-members
9711 @itemx set print static-members on
9712 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
9713 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
9714
9715 @item set print static-members off
9716 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
9717
9718 @item show print static-members
9719 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
9720
9721 @item set print pascal_static-members
9722 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
9723 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
9724 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
9725 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
9726
9727 @item set print pascal_static-members off
9728 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
9729
9730 @item show print pascal_static-members
9731 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
9732
9733 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
9734 @item set print vtbl
9735 @itemx set print vtbl on
9736 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
9737 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
9738 @cindex VTBL display
9739 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
9740 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
9741 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
9742
9743 @item set print vtbl off
9744 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
9745
9746 @item show print vtbl
9747 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
9748 @end table
9749
9750 @node Pretty Printing
9751 @section Pretty Printing
9752
9753 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
9754 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
9755 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
9756
9757 @menu
9758 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
9759 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
9760 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
9761 @end menu
9762
9763 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
9764 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
9765
9766 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
9767 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
9768 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
9769
9770 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
9771 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
9772 pretty-printers with their names.
9773 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
9774 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
9775 Each such subprinter has its own name.
9776 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
9777
9778 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
9779 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
9780 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
9781 do anything special.
9782
9783 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
9784
9785 @itemize @bullet
9786 @item
9787 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
9788 all inferiors.
9789
9790 @item
9791 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
9792 when debugging that program.
9793 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
9794
9795 @item
9796 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
9797 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
9798 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
9799 @end itemize
9800
9801 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
9802 pretty-printers are selected,
9803
9804 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
9805 for new types.
9806
9807 @node Pretty-Printer Example
9808 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
9809
9810 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
9811
9812 @smallexample
9813 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9814 $1 = @{
9815 static npos = 4294967295,
9816 _M_dataplus = @{
9817 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
9818 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
9819 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
9820 @},
9821 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
9822 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
9823 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
9824 @}
9825 @}
9826 @end smallexample
9827
9828 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
9829
9830 @smallexample
9831 (@value{GDBP}) print s
9832 $2 = "abcd"
9833 @end smallexample
9834
9835 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
9836 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
9837 @cindex pretty-printer commands
9838
9839 @table @code
9840 @kindex info pretty-printer
9841 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9842 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
9843 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
9844
9845 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
9846 whose pretty-printers to list.
9847 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
9848 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
9849 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
9850 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
9851 looks up a printer from these three objects.
9852
9853 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
9854 to list.
9855
9856 @kindex disable pretty-printer
9857 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9858 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9859 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
9860
9861 @kindex enable pretty-printer
9862 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
9863 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
9864 @end table
9865
9866 Example:
9867
9868 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
9869 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
9870 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
9871 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
9872
9873 @smallexample
9874 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9875 library1.so:
9876 foo
9877 library2.so:
9878 bar
9879 bar1
9880 bar2
9881 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9882 library2.so:
9883 bar
9884 bar1
9885 bar2
9886 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
9887 1 printer disabled
9888 2 of 3 printers enabled
9889 (gdb) info pretty-printer
9890 library1.so:
9891 foo [disabled]
9892 library2.so:
9893 bar
9894 bar1
9895 bar2
9896 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
9897 1 printer disabled
9898 1 of 3 printers enabled
9899 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9900 library1.so:
9901 foo [disabled]
9902 library2.so:
9903 bar
9904 bar1 [disabled]
9905 bar2
9906 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
9907 1 printer disabled
9908 0 of 3 printers enabled
9909 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
9910 library1.so:
9911 foo [disabled]
9912 library2.so:
9913 bar [disabled]
9914 bar1 [disabled]
9915 bar2
9916 @end smallexample
9917
9918 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
9919 as can each individual subprinter.
9920
9921 @node Value History
9922 @section Value History
9923
9924 @cindex value history
9925 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
9926 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
9927 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
9928 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
9929 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
9930 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
9931 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
9932 symbol table.
9933
9934 @cindex @code{$}
9935 @cindex @code{$$}
9936 @cindex history number
9937 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
9938 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
9939 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
9940 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
9941 history number.
9942
9943 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
9944 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
9945 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
9946 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
9947 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
9948 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
9949 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
9950
9951 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
9952 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
9953
9954 @smallexample
9955 p *$
9956 @end smallexample
9957
9958 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
9959 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
9960
9961 @smallexample
9962 p *$.next
9963 @end smallexample
9964
9965 @noindent
9966 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
9967 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
9968
9969 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
9970 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
9971
9972 @smallexample
9973 print x
9974 set x=5
9975 @end smallexample
9976
9977 @noindent
9978 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
9979 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
9980
9981 @table @code
9982 @kindex show values
9983 @item show values
9984 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
9985 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
9986 values} does not change the history.
9987
9988 @item show values @var{n}
9989 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
9990
9991 @item show values +
9992 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
9993 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
9994 @end table
9995
9996 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
9997 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
9998
9999 @node Convenience Vars
10000 @section Convenience Variables
10001
10002 @cindex convenience variables
10003 @cindex user-defined variables
10004 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10005 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10006 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10007 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10008 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10009
10010 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10011 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10012 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10013 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10014 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10015
10016 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10017 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10018 For example:
10019
10020 @smallexample
10021 set $foo = *object_ptr
10022 @end smallexample
10023
10024 @noindent
10025 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10026 @code{object_ptr}.
10027
10028 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10029 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10030 value with another assignment at any time.
10031
10032 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10033 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10034 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10035 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10036
10037 @table @code
10038 @kindex show convenience
10039 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10040 @item show convenience
10041 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10042 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10043 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10044
10045 @kindex init-if-undefined
10046 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10047 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10048 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10049 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10050 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10051 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10052 override default values used in a command script.
10053
10054 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10055 any side-effects do not occur.
10056 @end table
10057
10058 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10059 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10060 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10061
10062 @smallexample
10063 set $i = 0
10064 print bar[$i++]->contents
10065 @end smallexample
10066
10067 @noindent
10068 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10069
10070 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10071 values likely to be useful.
10072
10073 @table @code
10074 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10075 @item $_
10076 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10077 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10078 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10079 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10080 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10081 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10082 to the type of @code{$__}.
10083
10084 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10085 @item $__
10086 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10087 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10088 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10089
10090 @item $_exitcode
10091 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10092 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10093 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10094 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
10095
10096 @item $_exitsignal
10097 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
10098 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
10099 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
10100 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
10101
10102 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
10103 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
10104 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
10105 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
10106 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
10107
10108 @smallexample
10109 #include <signal.h>
10110
10111 int
10112 main (int argc, char *argv[])
10113 @{
10114 raise (SIGALRM);
10115 return 0;
10116 @}
10117 @end smallexample
10118
10119 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
10120 or signalled would be:
10121
10122 @smallexample
10123 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
10124 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
10125 End with a line saying just ``end''.
10126 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
10127 >echo The program has exited\n
10128 >else
10129 >echo The program has signalled\n
10130 >end
10131 >end
10132 (@value{GDBP}) run
10133 Starting program:
10134
10135 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
10136 The program no longer exists.
10137 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10138 The program has signalled
10139 @end smallexample
10140
10141 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
10142 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
10143 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
10144 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
10145
10146 @smallexample
10147 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
10148 The program has exited
10149 @end smallexample
10150
10151 @item $_exception
10152 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
10153 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
10154
10155 @item $_probe_argc
10156 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
10157 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
10158
10159 @item $_sdata
10160 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
10161 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
10162 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
10163 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
10164 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
10165
10166 @item $_siginfo
10167 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
10168 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
10169 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
10170 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
10171 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
10172
10173 @item $_tlb
10174 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
10175 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
10176 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
10177 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
10178 @xref{General Query Packets}.
10179 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
10180
10181 @end table
10182
10183 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10184 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10185 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10186
10187 @node Convenience Funs
10188 @section Convenience Functions
10189
10190 @cindex convenience functions
10191 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
10192 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
10193 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
10194 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
10195 @value{GDBN}.
10196
10197 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10198 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
10199
10200 @table @code
10201
10202 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
10203 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
10204 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
10205 returns zero.
10206
10207 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
10208 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
10209 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
10210 it is @code{void}:
10211
10212 @smallexample
10213 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10214 $1 = void
10215 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10216 $2 = 1
10217 (@value{GDBP}) run
10218 Starting program: ./a.out
10219 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
10220 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
10221 $3 = 0
10222 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
10223 $4 = 0
10224 @end smallexample
10225
10226 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
10227 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
10228 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
10229 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
10230 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
10231 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
10232 anymore.
10233
10234 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
10235 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
10236
10237 @smallexample
10238 void
10239 foo (void)
10240 @{
10241 @}
10242 @end smallexample
10243
10244 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
10245
10246 @smallexample
10247 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
10248 $1 = void
10249 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
10250 $2 = 1
10251 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
10252 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
10253 $3 = void
10254 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
10255 $4 = 1
10256 @end smallexample
10257
10258 @end table
10259
10260 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
10261 @code{Python} support.
10262
10263 @table @code
10264
10265 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
10266 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
10267 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
10268 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
10269 Otherwise it returns zero.
10270
10271 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
10272 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
10273 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
10274 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10275 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
10276 regular expression support.
10277
10278 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
10279 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
10280 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
10281 Otherwise it returns zero.
10282
10283 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
10284 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
10285 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
10286
10287 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10288 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10289 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10290 Otherwise it returns zero.
10291
10292 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10293 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10294 The default is 1.
10295
10296 Example:
10297
10298 @smallexample
10299 (gdb) backtrace
10300 #0 bottom_func ()
10301 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
10302 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
10303 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
10304 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
10305 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
10306 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
10307 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
10308 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
10309 $1 = 1
10310 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
10311 $1 = 1
10312 @end smallexample
10313
10314 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10315 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10316 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
10317 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10318
10319 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10320 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10321 The default is 1.
10322
10323 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10324 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
10325 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
10326 Otherwise it returns zero.
10327
10328 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10329 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10330 The default is 1.
10331
10332 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
10333 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10334 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
10335 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10336
10337 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
10338 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
10339 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
10340 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
10341
10342 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
10343 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
10344 The default is 1.
10345
10346 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
10347 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
10348 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
10349 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
10350
10351 @end table
10352
10353 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
10354 convenience functions.
10355
10356 @table @code
10357 @item help function
10358 @kindex help function
10359 @cindex show all convenience functions
10360 Print a list of all convenience functions.
10361 @end table
10362
10363 @node Registers
10364 @section Registers
10365
10366 @cindex registers
10367 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
10368 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
10369 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
10370 your machine.
10371
10372 @table @code
10373 @kindex info registers
10374 @item info registers
10375 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
10376 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10377
10378 @kindex info all-registers
10379 @cindex floating point registers
10380 @item info all-registers
10381 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
10382 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
10383
10384 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
10385 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
10386 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
10387 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
10388 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
10389 @end table
10390
10391 @anchor{standard registers}
10392 @cindex stack pointer register
10393 @cindex program counter register
10394 @cindex process status register
10395 @cindex frame pointer register
10396 @cindex standard registers
10397 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
10398 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
10399 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
10400 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
10401 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
10402 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
10403 register that contains the processor status. For example,
10404 you could print the program counter in hex with
10405
10406 @smallexample
10407 p/x $pc
10408 @end smallexample
10409
10410 @noindent
10411 or print the instruction to be executed next with
10412
10413 @smallexample
10414 x/i $pc
10415 @end smallexample
10416
10417 @noindent
10418 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
10419 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
10420 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
10421 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
10422 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
10423 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
10424 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
10425
10426 @smallexample
10427 set $sp += 4
10428 @end smallexample
10429
10430 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
10431 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
10432 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
10433 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
10434 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
10435 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
10436 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
10437
10438 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
10439 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
10440 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
10441 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
10442 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
10443 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
10444 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
10445
10446 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
10447 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
10448 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
10449 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
10450 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
10451 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
10452 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
10453 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
10454 prints the data in both formats.
10455
10456 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
10457 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
10458 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
10459 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
10460 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
10461 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
10462 registers in @code{struct} notation:
10463
10464 @smallexample
10465 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
10466 $1 = @{
10467 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
10468 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
10469 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
10470 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
10471 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
10472 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
10473 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
10474 @}
10475 @end smallexample
10476
10477 @noindent
10478 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
10479 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
10480 value to a @code{struct} member:
10481
10482 @smallexample
10483 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
10484 @end smallexample
10485
10486 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
10487 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
10488 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
10489 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
10490 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
10491 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
10492
10493 @cindex caller-saved registers
10494 @cindex call-clobbered registers
10495 @cindex volatile registers
10496 @cindex <not saved> values
10497 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
10498 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
10499 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
10500 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
10501 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
10502 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
10503 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
10504 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
10505 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
10506 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
10507 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
10508 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
10509 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
10510 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
10511 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
10512 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
10513 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
10514 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
10515 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
10516 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
10517 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
10518 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
10519 represent the value the register had just before the call.
10520
10521 @node Floating Point Hardware
10522 @section Floating Point Hardware
10523 @cindex floating point
10524
10525 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
10526 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
10527
10528 @table @code
10529 @kindex info float
10530 @item info float
10531 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
10532 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
10533 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
10534 the ARM and x86 machines.
10535 @end table
10536
10537 @node Vector Unit
10538 @section Vector Unit
10539 @cindex vector unit
10540
10541 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
10542 more information about the status of the vector unit.
10543
10544 @table @code
10545 @kindex info vector
10546 @item info vector
10547 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
10548 layout vary depending on the hardware.
10549 @end table
10550
10551 @node OS Information
10552 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
10553 @cindex OS information
10554
10555 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
10556 you debug your program.
10557
10558 @cindex auxiliary vector
10559 @cindex vector, auxiliary
10560 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
10561 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
10562 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
10563 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
10564 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
10565 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
10566 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
10567 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
10568 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
10569 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
10570 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
10571
10572 @table @code
10573 @kindex info auxv
10574 @item info auxv
10575 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
10576 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
10577 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
10578 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
10579 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
10580 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
10581 an unrecognized tag.
10582 @end table
10583
10584 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
10585 information and show it to you. The types of information available
10586 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
10587 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
10588 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
10589 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
10590 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
10591
10592 @table @code
10593 @kindex info os
10594 @item info os @var{infotype}
10595
10596 Display OS information of the requested type.
10597
10598 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
10599
10600 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
10601 @table @code
10602 @kindex info os cpus
10603 @item cpus
10604 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
10605 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
10606 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
10607 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
10608 kernel initialization.
10609
10610 @kindex info os files
10611 @item files
10612 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
10613 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
10614 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
10615 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
10616
10617 @kindex info os modules
10618 @item modules
10619 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
10620 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
10621 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
10622 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
10623 in memory.
10624
10625 @kindex info os msg
10626 @item msg
10627 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
10628 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
10629 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
10630 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
10631 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
10632 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
10633 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
10634 the message queue was last changed.
10635
10636 @kindex info os processes
10637 @item processes
10638 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
10639 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
10640 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
10641 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
10642 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
10643 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
10644
10645 @kindex info os procgroups
10646 @item procgroups
10647 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
10648 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
10649 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
10650 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
10651 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
10652 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
10653 and the process group leader is listed first.
10654
10655 @kindex info os semaphores
10656 @item semaphores
10657 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
10658 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
10659 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
10660 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
10661 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
10662
10663 @kindex info os shm
10664 @item shm
10665 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
10666 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
10667 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
10668 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
10669 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
10670 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
10671 attached to, detach from, and changed.
10672
10673 @kindex info os sockets
10674 @item sockets
10675 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
10676 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
10677 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
10678 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
10679 connection.
10680
10681 @kindex info os threads
10682 @item threads
10683 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
10684 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
10685 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
10686 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
10687 process is not listed.
10688 @end table
10689
10690 @item info os
10691 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
10692 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
10693 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
10694 types, this command will report an error.
10695 @end table
10696
10697 @node Memory Region Attributes
10698 @section Memory Region Attributes
10699 @cindex memory region attributes
10700
10701 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
10702 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
10703 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
10704 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
10705 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
10706 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
10707 user can override the fetched regions.
10708
10709 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
10710 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
10711 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
10712 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
10713 all memory.
10714
10715 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
10716 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
10717
10718 @table @code
10719 @kindex mem
10720 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
10721 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
10722 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
10723 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
10724 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
10725 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
10726
10727 @item mem auto
10728 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
10729 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
10730
10731 @kindex delete mem
10732 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10733 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
10734 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
10735
10736 @kindex disable mem
10737 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10738 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10739 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
10740 It may be enabled again later.
10741
10742 @kindex enable mem
10743 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
10744 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
10745
10746 @kindex info mem
10747 @item info mem
10748 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
10749 for each region:
10750
10751 @table @emph
10752 @item Memory Region Number
10753 @item Enabled or Disabled.
10754 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
10755 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
10756
10757 @item Lo Address
10758 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
10759
10760 @item Hi Address
10761 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
10762
10763 @item Attributes
10764 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
10765 @end table
10766 @end table
10767
10768
10769 @subsection Attributes
10770
10771 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
10772 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
10773 write accesses to a memory region.
10774
10775 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
10776 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
10777 etc.@: from accessing memory.
10778
10779 @table @code
10780 @item ro
10781 Memory is read only.
10782 @item wo
10783 Memory is write only.
10784 @item rw
10785 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
10786 @end table
10787
10788 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
10789 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
10790 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
10791 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
10792 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
10793
10794 @table @code
10795 @item 8
10796 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
10797 @item 16
10798 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
10799 @item 32
10800 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
10801 @item 64
10802 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
10803 @end table
10804
10805 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
10806 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10807 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
10808 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
10809 @c
10810 @c @table @code
10811 @c @item hwbreak
10812 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
10813 @c @item swbreak (default)
10814 @c @end table
10815
10816 @subsubsection Data Cache
10817 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
10818 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
10819 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
10820 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
10821 registers.
10822
10823 @table @code
10824 @item cache
10825 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
10826 @item nocache
10827 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
10828 @end table
10829
10830 @subsection Memory Access Checking
10831 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
10832 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
10833 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
10834 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
10835
10836 @table @code
10837 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
10838 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
10839 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
10840 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
10841 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
10842 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
10843 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
10844 The default value is @code{on}.
10845 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
10846 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
10847 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
10848 @end table
10849
10850
10851 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
10852 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
10853 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
10854 @c
10855 @c @table @code
10856 @c @item verify
10857 @c @item noverify (default)
10858 @c @end table
10859
10860 @node Dump/Restore Files
10861 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
10862 @cindex dump/restore files
10863 @cindex append data to a file
10864 @cindex dump data to a file
10865 @cindex restore data from a file
10866
10867 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
10868 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
10869 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
10870 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
10871 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
10872 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
10873 files.
10874
10875 @table @code
10876
10877 @kindex dump
10878 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10879 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10880 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10881 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
10882
10883 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
10884 @table @code
10885 @item binary
10886 Raw binary form.
10887 @item ihex
10888 Intel hex format.
10889 @item srec
10890 Motorola S-record format.
10891 @item tekhex
10892 Tektronix Hex format.
10893 @end table
10894
10895 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
10896 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
10897 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
10898 form.
10899
10900 @kindex append
10901 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
10902 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
10903 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
10904 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
10905 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
10906
10907 @kindex restore
10908 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
10909 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
10910 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
10911 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
10912 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
10913
10914 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
10915 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
10916 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
10917 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
10918 from that location.
10919
10920 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
10921 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
10922 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
10923 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
10924
10925 @end table
10926
10927 @node Core File Generation
10928 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
10929 @cindex dump core from inferior
10930
10931 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
10932 image of a running process and its process status (register values
10933 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
10934 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
10935 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
10936 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
10937 the post-mortem debugging mode.
10938
10939 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
10940 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
10941 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
10942
10943 @table @code
10944 @kindex gcore
10945 @kindex generate-core-file
10946 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
10947 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
10948 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
10949 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
10950 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
10951 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
10952
10953 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
10954 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
10955
10956 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
10957 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
10958 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}).
10959
10960 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
10961 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
10962 @item set use-coredump-filter on
10963 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
10964 Enable or disable the use of the file
10965 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
10966 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
10967 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
10968 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
10969
10970 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
10971 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
10972 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
10973 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
10974 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
10975 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
10976 about the bits that can be set in the
10977 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
10978 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
10979
10980 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
10981 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
10982 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
10983 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
10984 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
10985 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
10986 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
10987 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
10988 @end table
10989
10990 @node Character Sets
10991 @section Character Sets
10992 @cindex character sets
10993 @cindex charset
10994 @cindex translating between character sets
10995 @cindex host character set
10996 @cindex target character set
10997
10998 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
10999 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11000 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11001 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11002 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11003 @dfn{target character set}.
11004
11005 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11006 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11007 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11008 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11009 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11010 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11011 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11012 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11013 character and string literals in expressions.
11014
11015 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11016 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11017 target-charset} command, described below.
11018
11019 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11020 support:
11021
11022 @table @code
11023 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11024 @kindex set target-charset
11025 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11026 list of supported target character sets, type
11027 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11028
11029 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11030 @kindex set host-charset
11031 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11032
11033 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11034 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11035 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11036 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11037 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11038
11039 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11040 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11041 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11042
11043 @item set charset @var{charset}
11044 @kindex set charset
11045 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11046 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11047 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11048 for both host and target.
11049
11050 @item show charset
11051 @kindex show charset
11052 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11053
11054 @item show host-charset
11055 @kindex show host-charset
11056 Show the name of the current host character set.
11057
11058 @item show target-charset
11059 @kindex show target-charset
11060 Show the name of the current target character set.
11061
11062 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
11063 @kindex set target-wide-charset
11064 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
11065 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
11066 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
11067 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11068
11069 @item show target-wide-charset
11070 @kindex show target-wide-charset
11071 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
11072 @end table
11073
11074 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
11075 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
11076 @file{charset-test.c}:
11077
11078 @smallexample
11079 #include <stdio.h>
11080
11081 char ascii_hello[]
11082 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
11083 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
11084 char ibm1047_hello[]
11085 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
11086 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
11087
11088 main ()
11089 @{
11090 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11091 @}
11092 @end smallexample
11093
11094 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
11095 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
11096 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
11097
11098 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
11099
11100 @smallexample
11101 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
11102 $ gdb -nw charset-test
11103 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
11104 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11105 @dots{}
11106 (@value{GDBP})
11107 @end smallexample
11108
11109 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
11110 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
11111 strings:
11112
11113 @smallexample
11114 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11115 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
11116 (@value{GDBP})
11117 @end smallexample
11118
11119 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
11120 initial character set:
11121 @smallexample
11122 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
11123 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11124 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
11125 (@value{GDBP})
11126 @end smallexample
11127
11128 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
11129 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
11130 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
11131 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
11132 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
11133
11134 @smallexample
11135 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11136 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
11137 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11138 $2 = 72 'H'
11139 (@value{GDBP})
11140 @end smallexample
11141
11142 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
11143 literals you use in expressions:
11144
11145 @smallexample
11146 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11147 $3 = 43 '+'
11148 (@value{GDBP})
11149 @end smallexample
11150
11151 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
11152 character.
11153
11154 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
11155 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
11156 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
11157
11158 @smallexample
11159 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11160 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
11161 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11162 $5 = 200 '\310'
11163 (@value{GDBP})
11164 @end smallexample
11165
11166 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
11167 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
11168
11169 @smallexample
11170 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11171 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
11172 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
11173 @end smallexample
11174
11175 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
11176 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
11177 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
11178 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
11179 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
11180
11181 @smallexample
11182 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
11183 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
11184 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
11185 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
11186 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
11187 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
11188 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
11189 $7 = 72 '\110'
11190 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
11191 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
11192 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
11193 $9 = 200 'H'
11194 (@value{GDBP})
11195 @end smallexample
11196
11197 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
11198 string literals you use in expressions:
11199
11200 @smallexample
11201 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
11202 $10 = 78 '+'
11203 (@value{GDBP})
11204 @end smallexample
11205
11206 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
11207 character.
11208
11209 @node Caching Target Data
11210 @section Caching Data of Targets
11211 @cindex caching data of targets
11212
11213 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
11214 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
11215 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
11216 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
11217 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
11218 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
11219 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
11220 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
11221 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
11222 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
11223 is executing.
11224 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
11225 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
11226 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
11227 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
11228 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
11229 in the code segment.
11230 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
11231 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
11232
11233 @table @code
11234 @kindex set remotecache
11235 @item set remotecache on
11236 @itemx set remotecache off
11237 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
11238 with old scripts.
11239
11240 @kindex show remotecache
11241 @item show remotecache
11242 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
11243
11244 @kindex set stack-cache
11245 @item set stack-cache on
11246 @itemx set stack-cache off
11247 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
11248 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
11249
11250 @kindex show stack-cache
11251 @item show stack-cache
11252 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
11253
11254 @kindex set code-cache
11255 @item set code-cache on
11256 @itemx set code-cache off
11257 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
11258 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
11259 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
11260
11261 @kindex show code-cache
11262 @item show code-cache
11263 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
11264 accesses.
11265
11266 @kindex info dcache
11267 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
11268 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
11269 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
11270 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
11271 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
11272 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
11273
11274 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
11275 printed in hex.
11276
11277 @item set dcache size @var{size}
11278 @cindex dcache size
11279 @kindex set dcache size
11280 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
11281
11282 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
11283 @cindex dcache line-size
11284 @kindex set dcache line-size
11285 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
11286 Must be a power of 2.
11287
11288 @item show dcache size
11289 @kindex show dcache size
11290 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
11291
11292 @item show dcache line-size
11293 @kindex show dcache line-size
11294 Show default size of dcache lines.
11295
11296 @end table
11297
11298 @node Searching Memory
11299 @section Search Memory
11300 @cindex searching memory
11301
11302 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
11303 @code{find} command.
11304
11305 @table @code
11306 @kindex find
11307 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11308 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
11309 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
11310 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
11311 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
11312 @end table
11313
11314 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
11315 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
11316
11317 @table @r
11318 @item @var{s}, search query size
11319 The size of each search query value.
11320
11321 @table @code
11322 @item b
11323 bytes
11324 @item h
11325 halfwords (two bytes)
11326 @item w
11327 words (four bytes)
11328 @item g
11329 giant words (eight bytes)
11330 @end table
11331
11332 All values are interpreted in the current language.
11333 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
11334 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
11335
11336 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
11337 value's type in the current language.
11338 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
11339 pattern as a mixture of types.
11340 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
11341 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
11342 which is typically four bytes.
11343
11344 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
11345 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
11346 @end table
11347
11348 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
11349 (@code{"}).
11350 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
11351 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
11352
11353 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
11354 number of matches found.
11355
11356 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
11357 @samp{$_}.
11358 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
11359
11360 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
11361
11362 @smallexample
11363 void
11364 hello ()
11365 @{
11366 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
11367 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
11368 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
11369 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
11370 printf ("%s\n", hello);
11371 @}
11372 @end smallexample
11373
11374 @noindent
11375 you get during debugging:
11376
11377 @smallexample
11378 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
11379 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11380 1 pattern found
11381 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
11382 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11383 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
11384 2 patterns found
11385 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
11386 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
11387 1 pattern found
11388 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
11389 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
11390 1 pattern found
11391 (gdb) print $numfound
11392 $1 = 1
11393 (gdb) print $_
11394 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
11395 @end smallexample
11396
11397 @node Optimized Code
11398 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
11399 @cindex optimized code, debugging
11400 @cindex debugging optimized code
11401
11402 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
11403 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
11404 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
11405 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
11406 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
11407 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
11408 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
11409
11410 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
11411 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
11412 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
11413 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
11414
11415 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
11416 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
11417 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
11418 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
11419 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
11420 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
11421
11422 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
11423 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
11424 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
11425 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
11426 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
11427
11428 @menu
11429 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
11430 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
11431 @end menu
11432
11433 @node Inline Functions
11434 @section Inline Functions
11435 @cindex inline functions, debugging
11436
11437 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
11438 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
11439 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
11440 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
11441 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
11442 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
11443 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
11444 @code{info frame} command.
11445
11446 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
11447 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
11448 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
11449 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
11450 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
11451 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
11452 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
11453 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
11454 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
11455 local variables in the caller.
11456
11457 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
11458 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
11459 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
11460 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
11461 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
11462 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
11463 instructions are executed.
11464
11465 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
11466 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
11467 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
11468 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
11469
11470 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
11471 function calls are the same as normal calls:
11472
11473 @itemize @bullet
11474 @item
11475 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
11476 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
11477 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
11478 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
11479 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
11480 or inside the inlined function instead.
11481
11482 @item
11483 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
11484 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
11485 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
11486 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
11487
11488 @end itemize
11489
11490 @node Tail Call Frames
11491 @section Tail Call Frames
11492 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
11493
11494 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
11495 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
11496 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
11497 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
11498 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
11499
11500 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
11501 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
11502 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
11503 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
11504 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
11505 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
11506 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
11507
11508 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
11509 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_GNU_call_site} tags. With
11510 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
11511 this information.
11512
11513 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
11514 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
11515
11516 @smallexample
11517 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
11518 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
11519 (gdb) info frame
11520 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
11521 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
11522 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
11523 source language c++.
11524 Arglist at unknown address.
11525 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
11526 @end smallexample
11527
11528 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
11529 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
11530 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
11531 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
11532 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
11533 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
11534
11535 @table @code
11536 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
11537 @item set debug entry-values
11538 @kindex set debug entry-values
11539 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
11540 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
11541 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
11542 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
11543 result.
11544
11545 @item show debug entry-values
11546 @kindex show debug entry-values
11547 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
11548 values at function entry and tail calls.
11549 @end table
11550
11551 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
11552 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
11553 reference by variable @code{x}):
11554
11555 @smallexample
11556 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
11557 void (*x) (void) = c;
11558 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11559 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
11560 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
11561
11562 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving cannot find
11563 DW_TAG_GNU_call_site 0x40039a in main
11564 a () at t.c:3
11565 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
11566 (gdb) bt
11567 #0 a () at t.c:3
11568 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
11569 @end smallexample
11570
11571 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
11572
11573 @smallexample
11574 int i;
11575 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
11576 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
11577 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
11578 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
11579 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
11580 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
11581 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
11582 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
11583
11584 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
11585 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
11586 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
11587 (gdb) bt
11588 #0 f () at t.c:2
11589 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
11590 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
11591 @end smallexample
11592
11593 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
11594 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
11595
11596 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
11597 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11598 @set ARROW @click{}
11599 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
11600 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
11601 @end ifset
11602 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
11603 @set ARROW ->
11604 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
11605 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
11606 @end ifclear
11607
11608 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
11609 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
11610 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
11611
11612 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
11613 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
11614 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
11615 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
11616 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
11617 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
11618
11619 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
11620 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
11621 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
11622 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
11623 omitted.
11624
11625 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
11626 entry may fail:
11627
11628 @smallexample
11629 int v;
11630 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
11631 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
11632 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
11633 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
11634 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
11635 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
11636
11637 (gdb) bt
11638 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
11639 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value resolving has found
11640 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
11641 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
11642 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
11643 @end smallexample
11644
11645 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
11646 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
11647 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
11648 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
11649 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
11650
11651 @node Macros
11652 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
11653
11654 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
11655 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
11656 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
11657 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
11658 where it was defined.
11659
11660 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
11661 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
11662 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
11663 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
11664
11665 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
11666 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
11667 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
11668 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
11669 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
11670 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
11671 see @ref{List}.
11672
11673 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
11674 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
11675 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
11676
11677 @table @code
11678
11679 @kindex macro expand
11680 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
11681 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
11682 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
11683 @item macro expand @var{expression}
11684 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
11685 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
11686 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
11687 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
11688 it can be any string of tokens.
11689
11690 @kindex macro exp1
11691 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
11692 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
11693 @cindex expand macro once
11694 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
11695 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
11696 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
11697 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
11698 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
11699 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
11700 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
11701 can be any string of tokens.
11702
11703 @kindex info macro
11704 @cindex macro definition, showing
11705 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
11706 @cindex macros, from debug info
11707 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
11708 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
11709 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
11710 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
11711 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
11712 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
11713
11714 @kindex info macros
11715 @item info macros @var{linespec}
11716 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
11717 by @var{linespec}, and describe the source location or compiler
11718 command-line where those definitions were established.
11719
11720 @kindex macro define
11721 @cindex user-defined macros
11722 @cindex defining macros interactively
11723 @cindex macros, user-defined
11724 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
11725 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
11726 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
11727 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
11728 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
11729 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
11730 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
11731 @var{arglist}.
11732
11733 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
11734 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
11735 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
11736 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
11737 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
11738
11739 @kindex macro undef
11740 @item macro undef @var{macro}
11741 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
11742 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
11743 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
11744 in the program being debugged.
11745
11746 @kindex macro list
11747 @item macro list
11748 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
11749 @end table
11750
11751 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
11752 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
11753 show our source files:
11754
11755 @smallexample
11756 $ cat sample.c
11757 #include <stdio.h>
11758 #include "sample.h"
11759
11760 #define M 42
11761 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11762
11763 main ()
11764 @{
11765 #define N 28
11766 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11767 #undef N
11768 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11769 #define N 1729
11770 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11771 @}
11772 $ cat sample.h
11773 #define Q <
11774 $
11775 @end smallexample
11776
11777 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
11778 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
11779 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
11780 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
11781 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
11782 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
11783 information.
11784
11785 @smallexample
11786 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
11787 $
11788 @end smallexample
11789
11790 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
11791
11792 @smallexample
11793 $ gdb -nw sample
11794 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
11795 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11796 GDB is free software, @dots{}
11797 (@value{GDBP})
11798 @end smallexample
11799
11800 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
11801 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
11802 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
11803
11804 @smallexample
11805 (@value{GDBP}) list main
11806 3
11807 4 #define M 42
11808 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11809 6
11810 7 main ()
11811 8 @{
11812 9 #define N 28
11813 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11814 11 #undef N
11815 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11816 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
11817 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
11818 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
11819 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
11820 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
11821 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
11822 #define Q <
11823 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
11824 expands to: (42 + 1)
11825 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
11826 expands to: once (M + 1)
11827 (@value{GDBP})
11828 @end smallexample
11829
11830 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
11831 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
11832 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
11833 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
11834
11835 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
11836 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
11837
11838 @smallexample
11839 (@value{GDBP}) break main
11840 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
11841 (@value{GDBP}) run
11842 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
11843
11844 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
11845 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
11846 (@value{GDBP})
11847 @end smallexample
11848
11849 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
11850
11851 @smallexample
11852 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11853 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
11854 #define N 28
11855 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11856 expands to: 28 < 42
11857 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11858 $1 = 1
11859 (@value{GDBP})
11860 @end smallexample
11861
11862 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
11863 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
11864 thereof) in force at each point:
11865
11866 @smallexample
11867 (@value{GDBP}) next
11868 Hello, world!
11869 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
11870 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11871 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
11872 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
11873 (@value{GDBP}) next
11874 We're so creative.
11875 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
11876 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
11877 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
11878 #define N 1729
11879 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
11880 expands to: 1729 < 42
11881 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
11882 $2 = 0
11883 (@value{GDBP})
11884 @end smallexample
11885
11886 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
11887 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
11888 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
11889 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
11890
11891 @smallexample
11892 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
11893 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
11894 -D__STDC__=1
11895 (@value{GDBP})
11896 @end smallexample
11897
11898
11899 @node Tracepoints
11900 @chapter Tracepoints
11901 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
11902 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
11903
11904 @cindex tracepoints
11905 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
11906 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
11907 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
11908 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
11909 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
11910 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
11911 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
11912
11913 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
11914 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
11915 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
11916 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
11917 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
11918 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
11919 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
11920 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
11921 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
11922 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
11923 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
11924
11925 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
11926 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
11927 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
11928 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
11929 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
11930 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
11931 Packets}.
11932
11933 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
11934 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
11935 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
11936
11937 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
11938
11939 @menu
11940 * Set Tracepoints::
11941 * Analyze Collected Data::
11942 * Tracepoint Variables::
11943 * Trace Files::
11944 @end menu
11945
11946 @node Set Tracepoints
11947 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
11948
11949 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
11950 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
11951 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
11952 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
11953 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
11954 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
11955 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
11956
11957 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
11958 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
11959 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
11960 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
11961 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
11962 tracepoint was hit.
11963
11964 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
11965 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
11966 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
11967 either.
11968
11969 @cindex fast tracepoints
11970 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
11971 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
11972 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
11973
11974 @cindex static tracepoints
11975 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
11976 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
11977 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
11978 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
11979 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
11980 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
11981 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
11982 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
11983 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
11984 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
11985 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
11986 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
11987 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
11988 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
11989 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
11990 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
11991 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
11992 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
11993 static tracepoint marker.
11994
11995 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
11996 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
11997
11998 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
11999 conditions and actions.
12000
12001 @menu
12002 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12003 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12004 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12005 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12006 * Trace State Variables::
12007 * Tracepoint Actions::
12008 * Listing Tracepoints::
12009 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
12010 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
12011 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
12012 @end menu
12013
12014 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
12015 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
12016
12017 @table @code
12018 @cindex set tracepoint
12019 @kindex trace
12020 @item trace @var{location}
12021 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
12022 Its argument @var{location} can be a source line, a function name, or
12023 an address in the target program. @xref{Specify Location}. The
12024 @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the
12025 target program where the debugger will briefly stop, collect some
12026 data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or
12027 changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
12028 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
12029 in tracing}).
12030 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
12031 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
12032 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
12033 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
12034 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
12035 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
12036 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
12037 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
12038 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
12039 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
12040 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
12041 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
12042
12043 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
12044
12045 @smallexample
12046 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
12047
12048 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
12049
12050 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
12051
12052 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
12053
12054 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
12055 @end smallexample
12056
12057 @noindent
12058 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
12059
12060 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
12061 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
12062 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
12063 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
12064 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
12065 information on tracepoint conditions.
12066
12067 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12068 @cindex set fast tracepoint
12069 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
12070 @kindex ftrace
12071 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
12072 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
12073 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
12074 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
12075 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
12076 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
12077 message.
12078
12079 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
12080 @code{trace}.
12081
12082 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
12083 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
12084 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
12085 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
12086 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
12087 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
12088 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
12089 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
12090
12091 @example
12092 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
12093 @end example
12094
12095 @noindent
12096 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
12097 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
12098
12099 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
12100 @cindex set static tracepoint
12101 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
12102 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
12103 @kindex strace
12104 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
12105 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
12106 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
12107 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
12108 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
12109
12110 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
12111 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
12112 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
12113 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
12114 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
12115 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
12116 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
12117 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
12118 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
12119 tracing engine:
12120
12121 @smallexample
12122 main ()
12123 @{
12124 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
12125 @}
12126 @end smallexample
12127
12128 @noindent
12129 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
12130 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
12131
12132 @smallexample
12133 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12134 Cnt Enb ID Address What
12135 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
12136 Data: "str %s"
12137 [etc...]
12138 @end smallexample
12139
12140 @noindent
12141 so you may probe the marker above with:
12142
12143 @smallexample
12144 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
12145 @end smallexample
12146
12147 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
12148 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
12149 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
12150 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
12151 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
12152 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
12153 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
12154 the @samp{Data:} field.
12155
12156 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
12157 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
12158 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
12159
12160 @vindex $tpnum
12161 @cindex last tracepoint number
12162 @cindex recent tracepoint number
12163 @cindex tracepoint number
12164 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
12165 of the most recently set tracepoint.
12166
12167 @kindex delete tracepoint
12168 @cindex tracepoint deletion
12169 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12170 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
12171 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
12172 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
12173
12174 Examples:
12175
12176 @smallexample
12177 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
12178
12179 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
12180 @end smallexample
12181
12182 @noindent
12183 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
12184 @end table
12185
12186 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12187 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
12188
12189 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
12190
12191 @table @code
12192 @kindex disable tracepoint
12193 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12194 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
12195 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
12196 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
12197 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
12198 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
12199 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
12200 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
12201 next trace experiment.
12202
12203 @kindex enable tracepoint
12204 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12205 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
12206 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
12207 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
12208 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
12209 next time a trace experiment is run.
12210 @end table
12211
12212 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
12213 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
12214
12215 @table @code
12216 @kindex passcount
12217 @cindex tracepoint pass count
12218 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
12219 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
12220 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
12221 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
12222 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
12223 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
12224 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
12225 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
12226 user.
12227
12228 Examples:
12229
12230 @smallexample
12231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
12232 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
12233
12234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
12235 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
12236 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
12238 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
12239 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
12240 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
12241 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
12242 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
12243 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
12244 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
12245 @end smallexample
12246 @end table
12247
12248 @node Tracepoint Conditions
12249 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
12250 @cindex conditional tracepoints
12251 @cindex tracepoint conditions
12252
12253 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
12254 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
12255 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
12256 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
12257 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
12258 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
12259 is true.
12260
12261 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
12262 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
12263 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
12264 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
12265 just as with breakpoints.
12266
12267 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
12268 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
12269 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
12270 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
12271 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
12272 accesses, and so forth.
12273
12274 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
12275 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
12276 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
12277 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
12278 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
12279 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
12280 search through.
12281
12282 @smallexample
12283 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
12284 @end smallexample
12285
12286 @node Trace State Variables
12287 @subsection Trace State Variables
12288 @cindex trace state variables
12289
12290 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
12291 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
12292 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
12293 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
12294 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
12295 integers.
12296
12297 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
12298 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
12299 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
12300 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
12301
12302 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
12303 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
12304 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
12305 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
12306 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
12307 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
12308 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
12309 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
12310 variable with the same name.
12311
12312 @table @code
12313
12314 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
12315 @kindex tvariable
12316 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
12317 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
12318 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
12319 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
12320 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
12321 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
12322 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
12323 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
12324 value. The default initial value is 0.
12325
12326 @item info tvariables
12327 @kindex info tvariables
12328 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
12329 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
12330 currently running.
12331
12332 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
12333 @kindex delete tvariable
12334 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
12335 are specified.
12336
12337 @end table
12338
12339 @node Tracepoint Actions
12340 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
12341
12342 @table @code
12343 @kindex actions
12344 @cindex tracepoint actions
12345 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
12346 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
12347 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
12348 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
12349 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
12350 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
12351 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
12352 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
12353 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
12354 @code{while-stepping}.
12355
12356 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
12357 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
12358 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
12359
12360 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
12361 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
12362 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
12363
12364 @smallexample
12365 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
12366
12367 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
12368
12369 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
12370 @end smallexample
12371
12372 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
12373 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
12374 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
12375 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
12376 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
12377 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
12378 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
12379 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
12380
12381 @smallexample
12382 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
12383 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12384 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
12385 > collect bar,baz
12386 > collect $regs
12387 > while-stepping 12
12388 > collect $pc, arr[i]
12389 > end
12390 end
12391 @end smallexample
12392
12393 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
12394 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12395 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
12396 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
12397 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
12398 special arguments are supported:
12399
12400 @table @code
12401 @item $regs
12402 Collect all registers.
12403
12404 @item $args
12405 Collect all function arguments.
12406
12407 @item $locals
12408 Collect all local variables.
12409
12410 @item $_ret
12411 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
12412 of a backtrace.
12413
12414 @item $_probe_argc
12415 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
12416 tracepoint is located.
12417 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12418
12419 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
12420 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
12421 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
12422 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
12423
12424 @item $_sdata
12425 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
12426 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
12427 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
12428 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
12429 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
12430 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
12431 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
12432 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
12433 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
12434
12435 @smallexample
12436 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
12437 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
12438 @end smallexample
12439
12440 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
12441 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
12442 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
12443 @value{GDBN}.
12444 @end table
12445
12446 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
12447 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
12448 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
12449
12450 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
12451 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
12452 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
12453 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
12454 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
12455 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
12456 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
12457 @samp{mystr}.
12458
12459 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
12460 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
12461
12462 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
12463 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12464 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
12465 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
12466 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
12467 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
12468 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
12469 action were used.
12470
12471 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
12472 @item while-stepping @var{n}
12473 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
12474 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
12475 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
12476 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
12477
12478 @smallexample
12479 > while-stepping 12
12480 > collect $regs, myglobal
12481 > end
12482 >
12483 @end smallexample
12484
12485 @noindent
12486 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
12487 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
12488 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
12489 @code{stepping}.
12490
12491 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
12492 @kindex set default-collect
12493 @cindex default collection action
12494 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
12495 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
12496 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
12497 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
12498 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
12499 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
12500
12501 @item show default-collect
12502 @kindex show default-collect
12503 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
12504 tracepoint hit.
12505
12506 @end table
12507
12508 @node Listing Tracepoints
12509 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
12510
12511 @table @code
12512 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12513 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
12514 @cindex information about tracepoints
12515 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
12516 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
12517 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
12518 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
12519 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
12520 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
12521
12522 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
12523 tracing:
12524
12525 @itemize @bullet
12526 @item
12527 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
12528
12529 @item
12530 the state about installed on target of each location
12531 @end itemize
12532
12533 @smallexample
12534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
12535 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
12536 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
12537 while-stepping 20
12538 collect globfoo, $regs
12539 end
12540 collect globfoo2
12541 end
12542 pass count 1200
12543 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
12544 collect $eip
12545 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12546 installed on target
12547 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
12548 installed on target
12549 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
12550 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
12551 not installed on target
12552 (@value{GDBP})
12553 @end smallexample
12554
12555 @noindent
12556 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
12557 @end table
12558
12559 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12560 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
12561
12562 @table @code
12563 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
12564 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
12565 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
12566 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
12567 program.
12568
12569 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
12570
12571 @table @emph
12572 @item Count
12573 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
12574 stable identifier.
12575 @item ID
12576 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
12577 @item Enabled or Disabled
12578 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
12579 that are not enabled.
12580 @item Address
12581 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
12582 @item What
12583 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
12584 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
12585 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
12586 will be left blank.
12587 @end table
12588
12589 @noindent
12590 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
12591
12592 @table @emph
12593 @item Data
12594 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
12595 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
12596 marker call.
12597 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
12598 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
12599 @end table
12600
12601 @smallexample
12602 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
12603 Cnt ID Enb Address What
12604 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
12605 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
12606 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
12607 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
12608 Data: str %s
12609 (@value{GDBP})
12610 @end smallexample
12611 @end table
12612
12613 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12614 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
12615
12616 @table @code
12617 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
12618 @cindex start a new trace experiment
12619 @cindex collected data discarded
12620 @item tstart
12621 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
12622 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
12623 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
12624 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
12625 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
12626 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
12627 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
12628 information, and so forth.
12629
12630 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
12631 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
12632 @item tstop
12633 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
12634 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
12635 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
12636 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
12637 needs to be stopped quickly.
12638
12639 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
12640 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
12641 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
12642
12643 @kindex tstatus
12644 @cindex status of trace data collection
12645 @cindex trace experiment, status of
12646 @item tstatus
12647 This command displays the status of the current trace data
12648 collection.
12649 @end table
12650
12651 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
12652
12653 @smallexample
12654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
12655 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
12656 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
12657 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
12658 > while-stepping 11
12659 > collect $regs
12660 > end
12661 > end
12662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
12663 [time passes @dots{}]
12664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
12665 @end smallexample
12666
12667 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
12668 @cindex disconnected tracing
12669 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
12670 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
12671 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
12672 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
12673 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
12674 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
12675 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
12676 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
12677
12678 @table @code
12679 @item set disconnected-tracing on
12680 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
12681 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
12682 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
12683 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
12684 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
12685 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
12686 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
12687
12688 @item show disconnected-tracing
12689 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
12690 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
12691
12692 @end table
12693
12694 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
12695 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
12696 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
12697 it will continue after reconnection.
12698
12699 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
12700 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
12701 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
12702 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
12703 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
12704 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
12705 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
12706 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
12707 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
12708 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
12709
12710 @cindex circular trace buffer
12711 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
12712 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
12713 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
12714 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
12715 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
12716 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
12717 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
12718 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
12719 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
12720 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
12721 the next run.
12722
12723 @table @code
12724 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
12725 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
12726 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
12727 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
12728 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
12729 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
12730 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
12731
12732 @item show circular-trace-buffer
12733 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
12734 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
12735 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
12736 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
12737 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
12738
12739 @end table
12740
12741 @table @code
12742 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
12743 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
12744 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
12745 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
12746 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
12747 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
12748 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
12749 likes. This is also the default.
12750
12751 @item show trace-buffer-size
12752 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
12753 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
12754 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
12755 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
12756 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
12757 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
12758 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
12759 @end table
12760
12761 @table @code
12762 @item set trace-user @var{text}
12763 @kindex set trace-user
12764
12765 @item show trace-user
12766 @kindex show trace-user
12767
12768 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
12769 @kindex set trace-notes
12770 Set the trace run's notes.
12771
12772 @item show trace-notes
12773 @kindex show trace-notes
12774 Show the trace run's notes.
12775
12776 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
12777 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
12778 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
12779 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
12780 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
12781
12782 @item show trace-stop-notes
12783 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
12784 Show the trace run's stop notes.
12785
12786 @end table
12787
12788 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
12789 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
12790
12791 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
12792 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
12793 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
12794 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
12795 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
12796 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
12797 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
12798 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
12799 mentioned here.
12800
12801 @itemize @bullet
12802
12803 @item
12804 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
12805 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
12806 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
12807 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
12808 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
12809 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
12810 cannot be collected either.
12811
12812 @item
12813 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
12814 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
12815 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
12816 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
12817 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
12818 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
12819 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
12820 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
12821 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
12822 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
12823
12824 @item
12825 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
12826 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
12827 in a misleading way.
12828
12829 @item
12830 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
12831 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
12832 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
12833 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
12834 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
12835 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
12836 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
12837 by @code{ptr}.
12838
12839 @item
12840 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
12841 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
12842 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
12843 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
12844 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
12845 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
12846 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
12847 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
12848 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
12849 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
12850 invalid address.
12851
12852 @item
12853 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
12854 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
12855 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
12856 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
12857 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
12858 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
12859 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
12860 it to zero.
12861
12862 @end itemize
12863
12864 @node Analyze Collected Data
12865 @section Using the Collected Data
12866
12867 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
12868 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
12869 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
12870 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
12871 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
12872 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
12873 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
12874 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
12875 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
12876 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
12877 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
12878 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
12879 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
12880 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
12881 the buffer will fail.
12882
12883 @menu
12884 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
12885 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
12886 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
12887 @end menu
12888
12889 @node tfind
12890 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
12891
12892 @kindex tfind
12893 @cindex select trace snapshot
12894 @cindex find trace snapshot
12895 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
12896 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
12897 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
12898 snapshot is selected.
12899
12900 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
12901
12902 @table @code
12903 @item tfind start
12904 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
12905 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
12906
12907 @item tfind none
12908 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
12909
12910 @item tfind end
12911 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
12912
12913 @item tfind
12914 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
12915
12916 @item tfind -
12917 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
12918 retracing earlier steps.
12919
12920 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
12921 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
12922 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
12923 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
12924 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
12925
12926 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
12927 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
12928 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
12929 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
12930 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
12931
12932 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12933 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
12934 addresses (exclusive).
12935
12936 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
12937 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
12938 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
12939
12940 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
12941 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
12942 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
12943 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
12944 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
12945 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
12946 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
12947 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
12948 @end table
12949
12950 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
12951 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
12952 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
12953 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
12954 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
12955 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
12956 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
12957 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
12958 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
12959 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
12960 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
12961 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
12962 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
12963 tracepoint as the current one.
12964
12965 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
12966 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
12967 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
12968 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
12969 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
12970
12971 @smallexample
12972 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12973 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12974 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
12975 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
12976 > tfind
12977 > end
12978
12979 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
12980 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
12981 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
12982 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
12983 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
12984 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
12985 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
12986 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
12987 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
12988 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
12989 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
12990 @end smallexample
12991
12992 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
12993 the buffer:
12994
12995 @smallexample
12996 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
12997 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
12998 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
12999 > tfind line
13000 > end
13001
13002 Frame 0, X = 1
13003 Frame 7, X = 2
13004 Frame 13, X = 255
13005 @end smallexample
13006
13007 @node tdump
13008 @subsection @code{tdump}
13009 @kindex tdump
13010 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
13011 @cindex tracepoint data, display
13012
13013 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
13014 the current trace snapshot.
13015
13016 @smallexample
13017 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
13018 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13019 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
13020 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
13021 > end
13022
13023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13024
13025 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
13026 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
13027 at gdb_test.c:444
13028 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
13029
13030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
13031 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
13032 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
13033 d1 0x18 24
13034 d2 0x80 128
13035 d3 0x33 51
13036 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
13037 d5 0x22 34
13038 d6 0xe0 224
13039 d7 0x380035 3670069
13040 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
13041 a1 0x3000668 50333288
13042 a2 0x100 256
13043 a3 0x322000 3284992
13044 a4 0x3000698 50333336
13045 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
13046 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
13047 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
13048 ps 0x0 0
13049 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
13050 fpcontrol 0x0 0
13051 fpstatus 0x0 0
13052 fpiaddr 0x0 0
13053 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
13054 p1 = (void *) 0x11
13055 p2 = (void *) 0x22
13056 p3 = (void *) 0x33
13057 p4 = (void *) 0x44
13058 p5 = (void *) 0x55
13059 p6 = (void *) 0x66
13060 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
13061
13062 (@value{GDBP})
13063 @end smallexample
13064
13065 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
13066 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
13067 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
13068 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
13069
13070 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
13071 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
13072 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
13073 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
13074 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
13075 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
13076 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
13077 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
13078 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
13079 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
13080
13081 @node save tracepoints
13082 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
13083 @kindex save tracepoints
13084 @kindex save-tracepoints
13085 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
13086
13087 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
13088 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
13089 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
13090 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
13091 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
13092 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
13093
13094 @node Tracepoint Variables
13095 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
13096 @cindex tracepoint variables
13097 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
13098
13099 @table @code
13100 @vindex $trace_frame
13101 @item (int) $trace_frame
13102 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
13103 snapshot is selected.
13104
13105 @vindex $tracepoint
13106 @item (int) $tracepoint
13107 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
13108
13109 @vindex $trace_line
13110 @item (int) $trace_line
13111 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
13112
13113 @vindex $trace_file
13114 @item (char []) $trace_file
13115 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
13116
13117 @vindex $trace_func
13118 @item (char []) $trace_func
13119 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
13120 @end table
13121
13122 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
13123 use @code{output} instead.
13124
13125 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
13126 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
13127 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
13128 which are managed by the target.
13129
13130 @smallexample
13131 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13132
13133 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
13134 > output $trace_file
13135 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
13136 > tfind
13137 > end
13138 @end smallexample
13139
13140 @node Trace Files
13141 @section Using Trace Files
13142 @cindex trace files
13143
13144 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
13145 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
13146 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
13147 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
13148 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
13149
13150 @table @code
13151
13152 @kindex tsave
13153 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
13154 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
13155 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
13156 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
13157 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
13158 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
13159 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
13160 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
13161 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
13162 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
13163 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
13164 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save date in CTF
13165 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
13166 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
13167 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
13168
13169 @kindex target tfile
13170 @kindex tfile
13171 @kindex target ctf
13172 @kindex ctf
13173 @item target tfile @var{filename}
13174 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
13175 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
13176 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
13177 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
13178 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
13179 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
13180 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
13181 the host.
13182
13183 @smallexample
13184 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
13185 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
13186 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
13187 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
13188 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
13189 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
13190 i = 0
13191 a = 0
13192 b = 1 '\001'
13193 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
13194 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
13195 (@value{GDBP}) p b
13196 $1 = 1
13197 @end smallexample
13198
13199 @end table
13200
13201 @node Overlays
13202 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
13203 @cindex overlays
13204
13205 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
13206 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
13207 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
13208 use overlays.
13209
13210 @menu
13211 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
13212 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
13213 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
13214 mapped by asking the inferior.
13215 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
13216 @end menu
13217
13218 @node How Overlays Work
13219 @section How Overlays Work
13220 @cindex mapped overlays
13221 @cindex unmapped overlays
13222 @cindex load address, overlay's
13223 @cindex mapped address
13224 @cindex overlay area
13225
13226 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
13227 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
13228 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
13229 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
13230 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
13231
13232 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
13233 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
13234 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
13235 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
13236 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
13237 largest overlay as well.
13238
13239 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
13240 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
13241 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
13242 there.
13243
13244 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
13245 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
13246 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
13247
13248 @smallexample
13249 @group
13250 Data Instruction Larger
13251 Address Space Address Space Address Space
13252 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
13253 | | | | | |
13254 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
13255 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
13256 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
13257 | and heap | | | | | |
13258 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
13259 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
13260 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
13261 | | | | | |
13262 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
13263 address | | | | | |
13264 | overlay | <-' | | |
13265 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
13266 | | <---. | | load address
13267 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
13268 | | | |
13269 +-----------+ | |
13270 +-----------+
13271 | |
13272 +-----------+
13273
13274 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
13275 @end group
13276 @end smallexample
13277
13278 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
13279 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
13280 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
13281 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
13282 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
13283 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
13284 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
13285 program and the overlay area.
13286
13287 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
13288 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
13289 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
13290 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
13291 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
13292 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
13293 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
13294
13295 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
13296 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
13297 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
13298
13299 @itemize @bullet
13300
13301 @item
13302 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
13303 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
13304 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
13305 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
13306
13307 @item
13308 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
13309 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
13310 your program's performance.
13311
13312 @item
13313 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
13314 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
13315 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
13316 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
13317 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
13318 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
13319 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
13320
13321 @item
13322 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
13323 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
13324 instruction and data spaces.
13325
13326 @end itemize
13327
13328 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
13329 improved in many ways:
13330
13331 @itemize @bullet
13332
13333 @item
13334 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
13335 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
13336 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
13337 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
13338 area in the usual way.
13339
13340 @item
13341 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
13342 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
13343
13344 @item
13345 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
13346 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
13347 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
13348 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
13349 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
13350 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
13351 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
13352
13353 @end itemize
13354
13355
13356 @node Overlay Commands
13357 @section Overlay Commands
13358
13359 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
13360 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
13361 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
13362 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
13363 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
13364 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
13365
13366 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
13367 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
13368
13369 @table @code
13370 @item overlay off
13371 @kindex overlay
13372 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
13373 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
13374 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
13375 overlay support is disabled.
13376
13377 @item overlay manual
13378 @cindex manual overlay debugging
13379 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13380 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
13381 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
13382 commands described below.
13383
13384 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
13385 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
13386 @cindex map an overlay
13387 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
13388 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
13389 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
13390 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
13391 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
13392 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
13393
13394 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
13395 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
13396 @cindex unmap an overlay
13397 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
13398 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
13399 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
13400 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
13401
13402 @item overlay auto
13403 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
13404 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
13405 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
13406 Overlay Debugging}.
13407
13408 @item overlay load-target
13409 @itemx overlay load
13410 @cindex reloading the overlay table
13411 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
13412 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
13413 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
13414 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
13415 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
13416
13417 @item overlay list-overlays
13418 @itemx overlay list
13419 @cindex listing mapped overlays
13420 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
13421 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
13422
13423 @end table
13424
13425 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
13426 of the function the address falls in:
13427
13428 @smallexample
13429 (@value{GDBP}) print main
13430 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
13431 @end smallexample
13432 @noindent
13433 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
13434 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
13435 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
13436 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
13437
13438 @smallexample
13439 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13440 No sections are mapped.
13441 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13442 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
13443 @end smallexample
13444 @noindent
13445 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
13446 name normally:
13447
13448 @smallexample
13449 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
13450 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
13451 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
13452 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
13453 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
13454 @end smallexample
13455
13456 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
13457 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
13458 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
13459 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
13460 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
13461
13462 @itemize @bullet
13463 @item
13464 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
13465 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
13466 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
13467 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
13468 @item
13469 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
13470 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
13471 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
13472 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
13473 breakpoints properly.
13474 @end itemize
13475
13476
13477 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
13478 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
13479 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
13480
13481 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
13482 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
13483 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
13484 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
13485 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
13486 current state of the overlays.
13487
13488 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
13489 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
13490
13491 @table @asis
13492
13493 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
13494 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
13495
13496 @smallexample
13497 struct
13498 @{
13499 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
13500 unsigned long vma;
13501
13502 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
13503 unsigned long size;
13504
13505 /* The overlay's load address. */
13506 unsigned long lma;
13507
13508 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
13509 zero otherwise. */
13510 unsigned long mapped;
13511 @}
13512 @end smallexample
13513
13514 @item @code{_novlys}:
13515 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
13516 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
13517
13518 @end table
13519
13520 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
13521 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
13522 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
13523 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
13524 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
13525 currently mapped.
13526
13527 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
13528 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
13529 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
13530 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
13531 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
13532 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
13533 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
13534 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
13535 are not being executed.
13536
13537 @node Overlay Sample Program
13538 @section Overlay Sample Program
13539 @cindex overlay example program
13540
13541 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
13542 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
13543 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
13544 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
13545 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
13546 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
13547 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
13548
13549 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
13550 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
13551 suite. The program consists of the following files from
13552 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
13553
13554 @table @file
13555 @item overlays.c
13556 The main program file.
13557 @item ovlymgr.c
13558 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
13559 @item foo.c
13560 @itemx bar.c
13561 @itemx baz.c
13562 @itemx grbx.c
13563 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
13564 @item d10v.ld
13565 @itemx m32r.ld
13566 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
13567 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
13568 @end table
13569
13570 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
13571 cross-compiler like this:
13572
13573 @smallexample
13574 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
13575 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
13576 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
13577 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
13578 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
13579 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
13580 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
13581 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
13582 @end smallexample
13583
13584 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
13585 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
13586 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
13587
13588
13589 @node Languages
13590 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
13591 @cindex languages
13592
13593 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
13594 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
13595 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
13596 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
13597 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
13598 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
13599
13600 @cindex working language
13601 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
13602 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
13603 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
13604 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
13605 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
13606 language}.
13607
13608 @menu
13609 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
13610 * Show:: Displaying the language
13611 * Checks:: Type and range checks
13612 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
13613 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
13614 @end menu
13615
13616 @node Setting
13617 @section Switching Between Source Languages
13618
13619 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
13620 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
13621 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
13622 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
13623 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
13624 are printed, etc.
13625
13626 In addition to the working language, every source file that
13627 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
13628 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
13629 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
13630 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
13631 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
13632 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
13633 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
13634 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
13635 Displaying the Language}.
13636
13637 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
13638 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
13639 another language. In that case, make the
13640 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
13641 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
13642 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
13643
13644 @menu
13645 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
13646 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
13647 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
13648 @end menu
13649
13650 @node Filenames
13651 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
13652
13653 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
13654 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
13655
13656 @table @file
13657 @item .ada
13658 @itemx .ads
13659 @itemx .adb
13660 @itemx .a
13661 Ada source file.
13662
13663 @item .c
13664 C source file
13665
13666 @item .C
13667 @itemx .cc
13668 @itemx .cp
13669 @itemx .cpp
13670 @itemx .cxx
13671 @itemx .c++
13672 C@t{++} source file
13673
13674 @item .d
13675 D source file
13676
13677 @item .m
13678 Objective-C source file
13679
13680 @item .f
13681 @itemx .F
13682 Fortran source file
13683
13684 @item .mod
13685 Modula-2 source file
13686
13687 @item .s
13688 @itemx .S
13689 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
13690 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
13691 @end table
13692
13693 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
13694 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
13695
13696 @node Manually
13697 @subsection Setting the Working Language
13698
13699 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
13700 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
13701 your program.
13702
13703 @kindex set language
13704 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
13705 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
13706 a language, such as
13707 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
13708 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
13709
13710 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
13711 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
13712 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
13713 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
13714 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
13715 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
13716 command such as:
13717
13718 @smallexample
13719 print a = b + c
13720 @end smallexample
13721
13722 @noindent
13723 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
13724 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
13725 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
13726 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
13727
13728 @node Automatically
13729 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
13730
13731 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
13732 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
13733 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
13734 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
13735 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
13736 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
13737 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
13738 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
13739 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
13740
13741 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
13742 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
13743 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
13744 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
13745 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
13746
13747 @node Show
13748 @section Displaying the Language
13749
13750 The following commands help you find out which language is the
13751 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
13752
13753 @table @code
13754 @item show language
13755 @anchor{show language}
13756 @kindex show language
13757 Display the current working language. This is the
13758 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
13759 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
13760
13761 @item info frame
13762 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
13763 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
13764 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
13765 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
13766 information listed here.
13767
13768 @item info source
13769 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
13770 Display the source language of this source file.
13771 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
13772 information listed here.
13773 @end table
13774
13775 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
13776 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
13777 with a language explicitly:
13778
13779 @table @code
13780 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
13781 @kindex set extension-language
13782 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
13783 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
13784
13785 @item info extensions
13786 @kindex info extensions
13787 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
13788 @end table
13789
13790 @node Checks
13791 @section Type and Range Checking
13792
13793 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
13794 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
13795 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
13796 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
13797 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
13798 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
13799 errors when your program is running.
13800
13801 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
13802 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
13803 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
13804 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
13805
13806 @menu
13807 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
13808 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
13809 @end menu
13810
13811 @cindex type checking
13812 @cindex checks, type
13813 @node Type Checking
13814 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
13815
13816 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
13817 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
13818 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
13819 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
13820
13821 @smallexample
13822 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
13823
13824 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
13825 $1 = 2
13826 @exdent but
13827 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
13828 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
13829 @end smallexample
13830
13831 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
13832 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
13833
13834 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13835 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
13836 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
13837 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
13838 expressions like the second example above.
13839
13840 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
13841 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
13842 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
13843 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
13844 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
13845 little sense to evaluate anyway.
13846
13847 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
13848
13849 @kindex set check type
13850 @kindex show check type
13851 @table @code
13852 @item set check type on
13853 @itemx set check type off
13854 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
13855 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
13856 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
13857
13858 @item show check type
13859 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
13860 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
13861 @end table
13862
13863 @cindex range checking
13864 @cindex checks, range
13865 @node Range Checking
13866 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
13867
13868 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
13869 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
13870 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
13871 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
13872 not exceed the bounds of the array.
13873
13874 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
13875 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
13876 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
13877 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
13878
13879 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
13880 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
13881 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
13882 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
13883 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
13884 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
13885
13886 @smallexample
13887 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
13888 @end smallexample
13889
13890 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
13891 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
13892 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
13893
13894 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
13895
13896 @kindex set check range
13897 @kindex show check range
13898 @table @code
13899 @item set check range auto
13900 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
13901 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
13902 each language.
13903
13904 @item set check range on
13905 @itemx set check range off
13906 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
13907 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
13908 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
13909 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
13910
13911 @item set check range warn
13912 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
13913 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
13914 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
13915 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
13916 systems).
13917
13918 @item show range
13919 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
13920 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
13921 @end table
13922
13923 @node Supported Languages
13924 @section Supported Languages
13925
13926 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran, Java,
13927 OpenCL C, Pascal, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
13928 @c This is false ...
13929 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
13930 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
13931 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
13932 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
13933 language.
13934
13935 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
13936 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
13937 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
13938 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
13939 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
13940 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
13941 language reference or tutorial.
13942
13943 @menu
13944 * C:: C and C@t{++}
13945 * D:: D
13946 * Go:: Go
13947 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
13948 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
13949 * Fortran:: Fortran
13950 * Pascal:: Pascal
13951 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
13952 * Ada:: Ada
13953 @end menu
13954
13955 @node C
13956 @subsection C and C@t{++}
13957
13958 @cindex C and C@t{++}
13959 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
13960
13961 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
13962 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
13963 together.
13964
13965 @cindex C@t{++}
13966 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
13967 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
13968 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
13969 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
13970 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
13971 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
13972 compiler (@code{aCC}).
13973
13974 @menu
13975 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
13976 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
13977 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
13978 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
13979 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
13980 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
13981 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
13982 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
13983 @end menu
13984
13985 @node C Operators
13986 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
13987
13988 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
13989
13990 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
13991 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
13992 often defined on groups of types.
13993
13994 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
13995
13996 @itemize @bullet
13997
13998 @item
13999 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14000 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14001
14002 @item
14003 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
14004 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
14005
14006 @item
14007 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
14008
14009 @item
14010 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
14011
14012 @end itemize
14013
14014 @noindent
14015 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
14016 in order of increasing precedence:
14017
14018 @table @code
14019 @item ,
14020 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
14021 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
14022 expression being the last expression evaluated.
14023
14024 @item =
14025 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
14026 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
14027
14028 @item @var{op}=
14029 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
14030 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
14031 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
14032 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
14033 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
14034
14035 @item ?:
14036 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
14037 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
14038 should be of an integral type.
14039
14040 @item ||
14041 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14042
14043 @item &&
14044 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14045
14046 @item |
14047 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14048
14049 @item ^
14050 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
14051
14052 @item &
14053 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
14054
14055 @item ==@r{, }!=
14056 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
14057 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
14058
14059 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
14060 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
14061 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
14062 and non-zero for true.
14063
14064 @item <<@r{, }>>
14065 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
14066
14067 @item @@
14068 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14069
14070 @item +@r{, }-
14071 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
14072 pointer types.
14073
14074 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
14075 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
14076 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
14077 integral types.
14078
14079 @item ++@r{, }--
14080 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
14081 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
14082 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
14083 operation takes place.
14084
14085 @item *
14086 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
14087 @code{++}.
14088
14089 @item &
14090 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
14091
14092 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
14093 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
14094 to examine the address
14095 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
14096 stored.
14097
14098 @item -
14099 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
14100 precedence as @code{++}.
14101
14102 @item !
14103 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14104 @code{++}.
14105
14106 @item ~
14107 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
14108 @code{++}.
14109
14110
14111 @item .@r{, }->
14112 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
14113 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
14114 pointer based on the stored type information.
14115 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
14116
14117 @item .*@r{, }->*
14118 Dereferences of pointers to members.
14119
14120 @item []
14121 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
14122 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14123
14124 @item ()
14125 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
14126
14127 @item ::
14128 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
14129 and @code{class} types.
14130
14131 @item ::
14132 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
14133 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
14134 above.
14135 @end table
14136
14137 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
14138 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
14139 predefined meaning.
14140
14141 @node C Constants
14142 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
14143
14144 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
14145
14146 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
14147 following ways:
14148
14149 @itemize @bullet
14150 @item
14151 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
14152 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
14153 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
14154 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
14155 @code{long} value.
14156
14157 @item
14158 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
14159 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
14160 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
14161 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
14162 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
14163 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
14164 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
14165 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
14166 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
14167 constant.
14168
14169 @item
14170 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
14171 integral equivalents.
14172
14173 @item
14174 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
14175 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
14176 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
14177 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
14178 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
14179 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
14180 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
14181 @samp{\n} for newline.
14182
14183 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
14184 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
14185 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
14186 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14187
14188 @item
14189 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
14190 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
14191 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
14192 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
14193 characters.
14194
14195 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
14196 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
14197 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
14198
14199 @item
14200 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
14201 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
14202
14203 @item
14204 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
14205 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
14206 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
14207 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
14208 @end itemize
14209
14210 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
14211 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
14212
14213 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
14214 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
14215
14216 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
14217 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
14218 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
14219 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
14220 @quotation
14221 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
14222 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
14223 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
14224 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
14225 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
14226 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
14227 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
14228 code. @xref{Compilation}.
14229 @end quotation
14230
14231 @enumerate
14232
14233 @cindex member functions
14234 @item
14235 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
14236
14237 @smallexample
14238 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
14239 @end smallexample
14240
14241 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
14242 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
14243 @item
14244 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
14245 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
14246 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
14247 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
14248 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
14249
14250 @cindex call overloaded functions
14251 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
14252 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
14253 @item
14254 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
14255 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
14256 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
14257 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
14258 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
14259 default arguments.
14260
14261 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
14262 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
14263 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
14264 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
14265 number of function arguments.
14266
14267 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
14268 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
14269 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
14270
14271 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
14272 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
14273 @smallexample
14274 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
14275 @end smallexample
14276
14277 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
14278 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
14279
14280 @cindex reference declarations
14281 @item
14282 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
14283 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
14284 dereferenced.
14285
14286 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
14287 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
14288 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
14289 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
14290 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
14291
14292 @item
14293 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
14294 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
14295 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
14296 necessary, for example in an expression like
14297 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
14298 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
14299 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
14300
14301 @item
14302 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
14303 specification.
14304 @end enumerate
14305
14306 @node C Defaults
14307 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
14308
14309 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
14310
14311 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
14312 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
14313 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
14314 selects the working language.
14315
14316 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
14317 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
14318 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
14319 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
14320 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
14321 for further details.
14322
14323 @node C Checks
14324 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
14325
14326 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
14327
14328 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
14329 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
14330 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
14331 constants to pointers.
14332
14333 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
14334 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
14335 that is not itself an array.
14336
14337 @node Debugging C
14338 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
14339
14340 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
14341 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
14342 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
14343 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
14344
14345 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
14346 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
14347 ,Expressions}.
14348
14349 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
14350 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
14351
14352 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
14353
14354 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
14355 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
14356
14357 @table @code
14358 @cindex break in overloaded functions
14359 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
14360 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
14361 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
14362 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
14363 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
14364
14365 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
14366 @item rbreak @var{regex}
14367 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
14368 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
14369 classes.
14370 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
14371
14372 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
14373 @item catch throw
14374 @itemx catch rethrow
14375 @itemx catch catch
14376 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
14377 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
14378
14379 @cindex inheritance
14380 @item ptype @var{typename}
14381 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
14382 @var{typename}.
14383 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
14384
14385 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
14386 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
14387 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
14388 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
14389 multiple inheritance is in use.
14390
14391 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
14392 @item demangle @var{name}
14393 Demangle @var{name}.
14394 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
14395
14396 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
14397 @item set print demangle
14398 @itemx show print demangle
14399 @itemx set print asm-demangle
14400 @itemx show print asm-demangle
14401 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
14402 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
14403 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14404
14405 @item set print object
14406 @itemx show print object
14407 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
14408 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14409
14410 @item set print vtbl
14411 @itemx show print vtbl
14412 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
14413 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
14414 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
14415 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
14416
14417 @kindex set overload-resolution
14418 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
14419 @item set overload-resolution on
14420 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
14421 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
14422 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
14423 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
14424 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
14425 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
14426
14427 @item set overload-resolution off
14428 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
14429 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14430 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
14431 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
14432 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
14433 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
14434 argument types.
14435
14436 @kindex show overload-resolution
14437 @item show overload-resolution
14438 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
14439
14440 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
14441 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
14442 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
14443 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
14444 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
14445 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
14446 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
14447 @end table
14448
14449 @node Decimal Floating Point
14450 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
14451 @cindex decimal floating point format
14452
14453 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
14454 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
14455 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
14456 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
14457
14458 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
14459 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
14460 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
14461 configured target.
14462
14463 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
14464 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
14465 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
14466
14467 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
14468 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
14469 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
14470
14471 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
14472 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
14473 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
14474
14475 @node D
14476 @subsection D
14477
14478 @cindex D
14479 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
14480 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
14481 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
14482
14483 @node Go
14484 @subsection Go
14485
14486 @cindex Go (programming language)
14487 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
14488 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
14489
14490 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
14491
14492 @table @code
14493 @cindex current Go package
14494 @item The current Go package
14495 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
14496 specifying global variables and functions.
14497
14498 For example, given the program:
14499
14500 @example
14501 package main
14502 var myglob = "Shall we?"
14503 func main () @{
14504 // ...
14505 @}
14506 @end example
14507
14508 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
14509
14510 @example
14511 (gdb) p myglob
14512 (gdb) p main.myglob
14513 @end example
14514
14515 @cindex builtin Go types
14516 @item Builtin Go types
14517 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
14518 as a string.
14519
14520 @cindex builtin Go functions
14521 @item Builtin Go functions
14522 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
14523 function and handles it internally.
14524
14525 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
14526 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
14527 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
14528 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
14529 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
14530 @end table
14531
14532 @node Objective-C
14533 @subsection Objective-C
14534
14535 @cindex Objective-C
14536 This section provides information about some commands and command
14537 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
14538 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
14539 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
14540
14541 @menu
14542 * Method Names in Commands::
14543 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
14544 @end menu
14545
14546 @node Method Names in Commands
14547 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
14548
14549 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
14550 names as line specifications:
14551
14552 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
14553 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
14554 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
14555 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
14556 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
14557 @itemize
14558 @item @code{clear}
14559 @item @code{break}
14560 @item @code{info line}
14561 @item @code{jump}
14562 @item @code{list}
14563 @end itemize
14564
14565 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
14566
14567 @smallexample
14568 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
14569 @end smallexample
14570
14571 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
14572 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
14573 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
14574 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
14575 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
14576 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
14577 debugged, enter:
14578
14579 @smallexample
14580 break -[Fruit create]
14581 @end smallexample
14582
14583 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
14584 enter:
14585
14586 @smallexample
14587 list +[NSText initialize]
14588 @end smallexample
14589
14590 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
14591 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
14592 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
14593 is also possible to specify just a method name:
14594
14595 @smallexample
14596 break create
14597 @end smallexample
14598
14599 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
14600 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
14601 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
14602 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
14603 none apply.
14604
14605 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
14606 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
14607
14608 @smallexample
14609 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
14610 @end smallexample
14611
14612 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
14613 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
14614 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
14615 @kindex print-object
14616 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
14617
14618 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
14619
14620 @smallexample
14621 print -[@var{object} hash]
14622 @end smallexample
14623
14624 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
14625 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
14626 @noindent
14627 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
14628 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
14629 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
14630 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
14631 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
14632 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
14633
14634 @node OpenCL C
14635 @subsection OpenCL C
14636
14637 @cindex OpenCL C
14638 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
14639
14640 @menu
14641 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
14642 * OpenCL C Expressions::
14643 * OpenCL C Operators::
14644 @end menu
14645
14646 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
14647 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
14648
14649 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
14650 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
14651 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
14652 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
14653 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
14654
14655 @node OpenCL C Expressions
14656 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
14657
14658 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
14659 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
14660 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
14661 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
14662
14663 @node OpenCL C Operators
14664 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
14665
14666 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
14667 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
14668 vector data types.
14669
14670 @node Fortran
14671 @subsection Fortran
14672 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
14673
14674 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
14675 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
14676
14677 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
14678 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
14679 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
14680 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
14681 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
14682 underscore.
14683
14684 @menu
14685 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
14686 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
14687 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
14688 @end menu
14689
14690 @node Fortran Operators
14691 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
14692
14693 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
14694
14695 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14696 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
14697 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
14698
14699 @table @code
14700 @item **
14701 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
14702 of the second one.
14703
14704 @item :
14705 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
14706 represent a section of array.
14707
14708 @item %
14709 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
14710 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
14711 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
14712 union type.
14713 @end table
14714
14715 @node Fortran Defaults
14716 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
14717
14718 @cindex Fortran Defaults
14719
14720 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
14721 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
14722 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
14723 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
14724
14725 @node Special Fortran Commands
14726 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
14727
14728 @cindex Special Fortran commands
14729
14730 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
14731 such as displaying common blocks.
14732
14733 @table @code
14734 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
14735 @kindex info common
14736 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
14737 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
14738 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
14739 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
14740 printed.
14741 @end table
14742
14743 @node Pascal
14744 @subsection Pascal
14745
14746 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
14747 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
14748 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
14749 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
14750 syntax.
14751
14752 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
14753 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
14754 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
14755
14756 @node Modula-2
14757 @subsection Modula-2
14758
14759 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
14760
14761 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
14762 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
14763 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
14764 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
14765 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
14766 table.
14767
14768 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
14769 @menu
14770 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
14771 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
14772 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
14773 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
14774 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
14775 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
14776 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
14777 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
14778 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
14779 @end menu
14780
14781 @node M2 Operators
14782 @subsubsection Operators
14783 @cindex Modula-2 operators
14784
14785 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14786 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14787 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
14788 following definitions hold:
14789
14790 @itemize @bullet
14791
14792 @item
14793 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
14794 their subranges.
14795
14796 @item
14797 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
14798
14799 @item
14800 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
14801
14802 @item
14803 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
14804 @var{type}}.
14805
14806 @item
14807 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
14808
14809 @item
14810 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
14811
14812 @item
14813 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
14814 @end itemize
14815
14816 @noindent
14817 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
14818 increasing precedence:
14819
14820 @table @code
14821 @item ,
14822 Function argument or array index separator.
14823
14824 @item :=
14825 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
14826 @var{value}.
14827
14828 @item <@r{, }>
14829 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
14830 types.
14831
14832 @item <=@r{, }>=
14833 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
14834 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
14835 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
14836
14837 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
14838 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
14839 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
14840 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
14841 comment character.
14842
14843 @item IN
14844 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
14845 Same precedence as @code{<}.
14846
14847 @item OR
14848 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14849
14850 @item AND@r{, }&
14851 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
14852
14853 @item @@
14854 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
14855
14856 @item +@r{, }-
14857 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
14858 and difference on set types.
14859
14860 @item *
14861 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
14862 on set types.
14863
14864 @item /
14865 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
14866 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
14867
14868 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
14869 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
14870 precedence as @code{*}.
14871
14872 @item -
14873 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
14874
14875 @item ^
14876 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
14877
14878 @item NOT
14879 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
14880 @code{^}.
14881
14882 @item .
14883 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
14884 precedence as @code{^}.
14885
14886 @item []
14887 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
14888
14889 @item ()
14890 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
14891 as @code{^}.
14892
14893 @item ::@r{, }.
14894 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
14895 @end table
14896
14897 @quotation
14898 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
14899 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
14900 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
14901 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
14902 @end quotation
14903
14904
14905 @node Built-In Func/Proc
14906 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
14907 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
14908
14909 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
14910 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
14911
14912 @table @var
14913
14914 @item a
14915 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
14916
14917 @item c
14918 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
14919
14920 @item i
14921 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
14922
14923 @item m
14924 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
14925 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
14926 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
14927
14928 @item n
14929 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
14930
14931 @item r
14932 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
14933
14934 @item t
14935 represents a type.
14936
14937 @item v
14938 represents a variable.
14939
14940 @item x
14941 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
14942 explanation of the function for details.
14943 @end table
14944
14945 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
14946
14947 @table @code
14948 @item ABS(@var{n})
14949 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
14950
14951 @item CAP(@var{c})
14952 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
14953 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
14954
14955 @item CHR(@var{i})
14956 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
14957
14958 @item DEC(@var{v})
14959 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14960
14961 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
14962 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14963 new value.
14964
14965 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14966 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
14967 set.
14968
14969 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
14970 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
14971
14972 @item HIGH(@var{a})
14973 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
14974
14975 @item INC(@var{v})
14976 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
14977
14978 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
14979 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
14980 new value.
14981
14982 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
14983 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
14984 there. Returns the new set.
14985
14986 @item MAX(@var{t})
14987 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
14988
14989 @item MIN(@var{t})
14990 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
14991
14992 @item ODD(@var{i})
14993 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
14994
14995 @item ORD(@var{x})
14996 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
14997 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
14998 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
14999 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
15000
15001 @item SIZE(@var{x})
15002 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15003 variable or a type.
15004
15005 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
15006 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
15007
15008 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
15009 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
15010 variable or a type.
15011
15012 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
15013 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
15014 @end table
15015
15016 @quotation
15017 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
15018 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
15019 an error.
15020 @end quotation
15021
15022 @cindex Modula-2 constants
15023 @node M2 Constants
15024 @subsubsection Constants
15025
15026 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
15027 ways:
15028
15029 @itemize @bullet
15030
15031 @item
15032 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
15033 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
15034 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
15035 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
15036
15037 @item
15038 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
15039 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
15040 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
15041 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
15042 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
15043 digits.
15044
15045 @item
15046 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
15047 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
15048 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
15049 followed by a @samp{C}.
15050
15051 @item
15052 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
15053 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
15054 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
15055 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
15056 sequences.
15057
15058 @item
15059 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
15060
15061 @item
15062 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
15063 @code{FALSE}.
15064
15065 @item
15066 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
15067
15068 @item
15069 Set constants are not yet supported.
15070 @end itemize
15071
15072 @node M2 Types
15073 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
15074 @cindex Modula-2 types
15075
15076 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
15077 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
15078 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
15079 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
15080 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
15081 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
15082
15083 The first example contains the following section of code:
15084
15085 @smallexample
15086 VAR
15087 s: SET OF CHAR ;
15088 r: [20..40] ;
15089 @end smallexample
15090
15091 @noindent
15092 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
15093 @code{r} and @code{s}.
15094
15095 @smallexample
15096 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15097 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
15098 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15099 SET OF CHAR
15100 (@value{GDBP}) print r
15101 21
15102 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
15103 [20..40]
15104 @end smallexample
15105
15106 @noindent
15107 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
15108
15109 @smallexample
15110 VAR
15111 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
15112 @end smallexample
15113
15114 @noindent
15115 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
15116
15117 @smallexample
15118 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15119 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
15120 @end smallexample
15121
15122 @noindent
15123 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
15124 expressions using the debugger.
15125
15126 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
15127 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
15128
15129 @smallexample
15130 VAR
15131 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
15132 @end smallexample
15133
15134 @smallexample
15135 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15136 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
15137 @end smallexample
15138
15139 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
15140 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
15141 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
15142 above.
15143
15144 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
15145
15146 @smallexample
15147 TYPE
15148 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
15149 t = [blue..yellow] ;
15150 VAR
15151 s: t ;
15152 BEGIN
15153 s := blue ;
15154 @end smallexample
15155
15156 @noindent
15157 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
15158 and value of a variable.
15159
15160 @smallexample
15161 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15162 $1 = blue
15163 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
15164 type = [blue..yellow]
15165 @end smallexample
15166
15167 @noindent
15168 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
15169 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
15170 their @code{C} counterparts.
15171
15172 @smallexample
15173 VAR
15174 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15175 BEGIN
15176 s[1] := 1 ;
15177 @end smallexample
15178
15179 @smallexample
15180 (@value{GDBP}) print s
15181 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
15182 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15183 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15184 @end smallexample
15185
15186 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
15187 pointer types as shown in this example:
15188
15189 @smallexample
15190 VAR
15191 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
15192 BEGIN
15193 NEW(s) ;
15194 s^[1] := 1 ;
15195 @end smallexample
15196
15197 @noindent
15198 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
15199
15200 @smallexample
15201 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15202 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
15203 @end smallexample
15204
15205 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
15206 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
15207 types:
15208
15209 @smallexample
15210 TYPE
15211 foo = RECORD
15212 f1: CARDINAL ;
15213 f2: CHAR ;
15214 f3: myarray ;
15215 END ;
15216
15217 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
15218 myrange = [-2..2] ;
15219 VAR
15220 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
15221 @end smallexample
15222
15223 @noindent
15224 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
15225 below.
15226
15227 @smallexample
15228 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
15229 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
15230 f1 : CARDINAL;
15231 f2 : CHAR;
15232 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
15233 END
15234 @end smallexample
15235
15236 @node M2 Defaults
15237 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
15238 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
15239
15240 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
15241 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
15242 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15243 selected the working language.
15244
15245 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
15246 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
15247 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
15248 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
15249
15250 @node Deviations
15251 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
15252 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
15253
15254 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
15255 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
15256
15257 @itemize @bullet
15258 @item
15259 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
15260 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
15261 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
15262 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
15263 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
15264 returned a pointer.)
15265
15266 @item
15267 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
15268 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
15269 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
15270 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
15271
15272 @item
15273 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
15274 argument.
15275
15276 @item
15277 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
15278 @end itemize
15279
15280 @node M2 Checks
15281 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
15282 @cindex Modula-2 checks
15283
15284 @quotation
15285 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
15286 range checking.
15287 @end quotation
15288 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
15289
15290 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
15291
15292 @itemize @bullet
15293 @item
15294 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
15295 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
15296
15297 @item
15298 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
15299 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
15300 @end itemize
15301
15302 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
15303 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
15304
15305 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
15306 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
15307
15308 @node M2 Scope
15309 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15310 @cindex scope
15311 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
15312 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
15313 @ifinfo
15314 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
15315 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
15316 @end ifinfo
15317 @ifnotinfo
15318 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
15319 @end ifnotinfo
15320
15321 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
15322 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
15323 similar syntax:
15324
15325 @smallexample
15326
15327 @var{module} . @var{id}
15328 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
15329 @end smallexample
15330
15331 @noindent
15332 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
15333 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
15334 identifier within your program, except another module.
15335
15336 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
15337 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
15338 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
15339 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
15340
15341 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
15342 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
15343 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
15344 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
15345 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
15346 @var{module}.
15347
15348 @node GDB/M2
15349 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15350
15351 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
15352 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
15353 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
15354 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
15355 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
15356 analogue in Modula-2.
15357
15358 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
15359 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
15360 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
15361 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
15362 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
15363 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
15364
15365 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
15366 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
15367 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
15368
15369 @node Ada
15370 @subsection Ada
15371 @cindex Ada
15372
15373 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
15374 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
15375 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
15376 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15377 to be difficult.
15378
15379
15380 @cindex expressions in Ada
15381 @menu
15382 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
15383 and semantics supported by Ada mode
15384 in @value{GDBN}.
15385 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
15386 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
15387 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
15388 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
15389 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
15390 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15391 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
15392 Profile
15393 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
15394 @end menu
15395
15396 @node Ada Mode Intro
15397 @subsubsection Introduction
15398 @cindex Ada mode, general
15399
15400 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
15401 syntax, with some extensions.
15402 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
15403
15404 @itemize @bullet
15405 @item
15406 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
15407 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
15408 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
15409 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
15410
15411 @item
15412 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
15413 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15414
15415 @item
15416 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
15417 @end itemize
15418
15419 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
15420 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
15421 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
15422 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
15423 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
15424
15425 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
15426 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
15427 was translated from an Ada source file.
15428
15429 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
15430 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
15431 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
15432 middle (to allow based literals).
15433
15434 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
15435 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
15436 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
15437 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
15438 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
15439 functions to procedures elsewhere.
15440
15441 @node Omissions from Ada
15442 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
15443 @cindex Ada, omissions from
15444
15445 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
15446
15447 @itemize @bullet
15448 @item
15449 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
15450
15451 @itemize @minus
15452 @item
15453 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
15454 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
15455
15456 @item
15457 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
15458
15459 @item
15460 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
15461
15462 @item
15463 @t{'Tag}.
15464
15465 @item
15466 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
15467 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
15468
15469 @item
15470 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
15471 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
15472
15473 @item
15474 @t{'Address}.
15475 @end itemize
15476
15477 @item
15478 The names in
15479 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
15480 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
15481 not currently available.
15482
15483 @item
15484 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
15485 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
15486 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
15487 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
15488 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
15489 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
15490 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
15491 indeterminate values.
15492
15493 @item
15494 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
15495 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
15496 are not implemented.
15497
15498 @item
15499 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
15500 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
15501 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
15502 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
15503 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
15504
15505 @smallexample
15506 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
15507 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
15508 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
15509 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
15510 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
15511 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
15512 @end smallexample
15513
15514 Changing a
15515 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
15516 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
15517 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
15518 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
15519 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
15520 declared to have a type such as:
15521
15522 @smallexample
15523 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
15524 Id : Integer;
15525 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
15526 end record;
15527 @end smallexample
15528
15529 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
15530 assignments:
15531
15532 @smallexample
15533 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
15534 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
15535 @end smallexample
15536
15537 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
15538 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
15539 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
15540 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
15541 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
15542 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
15543 redundant component associations, although which component values are
15544 assigned in such cases is not defined.
15545
15546 @item
15547 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
15548
15549 @item
15550 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
15551 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
15552 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
15553 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
15554 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
15555 the proper resolution.
15556
15557 @item
15558 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
15559
15560 @item
15561 Entry calls are not implemented.
15562
15563 @item
15564 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
15565 formats are not supported.
15566
15567 @item
15568 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
15569
15570 @item
15571 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
15572 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
15573 context.
15574 Should your program
15575 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
15576 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
15577 @end itemize
15578
15579 @node Additions to Ada
15580 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
15581 @cindex Ada, deviations from
15582
15583 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
15584 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
15585
15586 @itemize @bullet
15587 @item
15588 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
15589 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
15590 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
15591 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
15592 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
15593 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
15594 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
15595 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
15596
15597 @item
15598 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
15599 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
15600 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
15601
15602 @item
15603 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
15604 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
15605
15606 @item
15607 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
15608 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
15609 @end itemize
15610
15611 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
15612 additions specific to Ada:
15613
15614 @itemize @bullet
15615 @item
15616 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
15617 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
15618
15619 @smallexample
15620 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
15621 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
15622 @end smallexample
15623
15624 @item
15625 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
15626 the value of its right-hand operand.
15627 This allows, for example,
15628 complex conditional breaks:
15629
15630 @smallexample
15631 (@value{GDBP}) break f
15632 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
15633 @end smallexample
15634
15635 @item
15636 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
15637 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
15638 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
15639 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
15640 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
15641 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
15642 in strings. For example,
15643 @smallexample
15644 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
15645 @end smallexample
15646 @noindent
15647 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
15648 after each period.
15649
15650 @item
15651 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
15652 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
15653 to write
15654
15655 @smallexample
15656 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
15657 @end smallexample
15658
15659 @item
15660 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
15661 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
15662 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
15663 of 3 might print as
15664
15665 @smallexample
15666 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
15667 @end smallexample
15668
15669 @noindent
15670 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
15671 clause.
15672
15673 @item
15674 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
15675 multi-character subsequence of
15676 their names (an exact match gets preference).
15677 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
15678 in place of @t{a'length}.
15679
15680 @item
15681 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
15682 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
15683 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
15684 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
15685 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
15686 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
15687 For example,
15688 @smallexample
15689 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
15690 @end smallexample
15691
15692 @item
15693 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
15694 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
15695 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
15696 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
15697 object.
15698
15699 @end itemize
15700
15701 @node Stopping Before Main Program
15702 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
15703
15704 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
15705 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
15706 before reaching the main procedure.
15707 As defined in the Ada Reference
15708 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
15709 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
15710 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
15711 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
15712
15713 @node Ada Exceptions
15714 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
15715
15716 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
15717
15718 @table @code
15719 @kindex info exceptions
15720 @item info exceptions
15721 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
15722 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
15723 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
15724 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
15725 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
15726 @end table
15727
15728 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
15729 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
15730 argument.
15731
15732 @smallexample
15733 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
15734 All defined Ada exceptions:
15735 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15736 program_error: 0x613d20
15737 storage_error: 0x613ce0
15738 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
15739 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15740 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
15741 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
15742 constraint_error: 0x613da0
15743 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
15744 @end smallexample
15745
15746 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
15747 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
15748
15749 @node Ada Tasks
15750 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
15751 @cindex Ada, tasking
15752
15753 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
15754 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
15755
15756 @table @code
15757 @kindex info tasks
15758 @item info tasks
15759 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
15760
15761
15762 @smallexample
15763 @iftex
15764 @leftskip=0.5cm
15765 @end iftex
15766 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15767 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15768 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15769 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
15770 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
15771 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
15772
15773 @end smallexample
15774
15775 @noindent
15776 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
15777 task currently being inspected.
15778
15779 @table @asis
15780 @item ID
15781 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
15782
15783 @item TID
15784 The Ada task ID.
15785
15786 @item P-ID
15787 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
15788
15789 @item Pri
15790 The base priority of the task.
15791
15792 @item State
15793 Current state of the task.
15794
15795 @table @code
15796 @item Unactivated
15797 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
15798 executing.
15799
15800 @item Runnable
15801 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
15802 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
15803
15804 @item Terminated
15805 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
15806 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
15807 terminated themselves.
15808
15809 @item Child Activation Wait
15810 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
15811
15812 @item Accept Statement
15813 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
15814
15815 @item Waiting on entry call
15816 The task is waiting on an entry call.
15817
15818 @item Async Select Wait
15819 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
15820 select statement.
15821
15822 @item Delay Sleep
15823 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
15824 alternative open.
15825
15826 @item Child Termination Wait
15827 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
15828 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
15829 waiting on a terminate Phase.
15830
15831 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
15832 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
15833 finish terminating.
15834
15835 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
15836 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
15837 @end table
15838
15839 @item Name
15840 Name of the task in the program.
15841
15842 @end table
15843
15844 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
15845 @item info task @var{taskno}
15846 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
15847 the following example:
15848 @smallexample
15849 @iftex
15850 @leftskip=0.5cm
15851 @end iftex
15852 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15853 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15854 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15855 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
15856 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
15857 Ada Task: 0x807c468
15858 Name: task_1
15859 Thread: 0x807f378
15860 Parent: 1 (main_task)
15861 Base Priority: 15
15862 State: Runnable
15863 @end smallexample
15864
15865 @item task
15866 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
15867 @cindex current Ada task ID
15868 This command prints the ID of the current task.
15869
15870 @smallexample
15871 @iftex
15872 @leftskip=0.5cm
15873 @end iftex
15874 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15875 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15876 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15877 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15878 (@value{GDBP}) task
15879 [Current task is 2]
15880 @end smallexample
15881
15882 @item task @var{taskno}
15883 @cindex Ada task switching
15884 This command is like the @code{thread @var{threadno}}
15885 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
15886 from the current task to the given task.
15887
15888 @smallexample
15889 @iftex
15890 @leftskip=0.5cm
15891 @end iftex
15892 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15893 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15894 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15895 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
15896 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
15897 [Switching to task 1]
15898 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15899 (@value{GDBP}) bt
15900 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
15901 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
15902 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
15903 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
15904 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
15905 @end smallexample
15906
15907 @item break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno}
15908 @itemx break @var{linespec} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
15909 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
15910 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
15911 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
15912 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
15913 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
15914 @var{linespec} argument specifies source lines, as described
15915 in @ref{Specify Location}.
15916
15917 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
15918 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
15919 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
15920 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
15921 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
15922
15923 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
15924 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
15925 program.
15926
15927 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
15928 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
15929 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
15930
15931 For example,
15932
15933 @smallexample
15934 @iftex
15935 @leftskip=0.5cm
15936 @end iftex
15937 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15938 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15939 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15940 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
15941 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15942 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
15943 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
15944 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
15945 (@value{GDBP}) cont
15946 Continuing.
15947 task # 1 running
15948 task # 2 running
15949
15950 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
15951 15 flush;
15952 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
15953 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
15954 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
15955 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
15956 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
15957 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
15958 @end smallexample
15959 @end table
15960
15961 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
15962 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
15963 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
15964
15965 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
15966 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
15967 the platform being used.
15968 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
15969 switching is not supported.
15970
15971 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
15972 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
15973 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
15974 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
15975 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
15976 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
15977
15978 @node Ravenscar Profile
15979 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
15980 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
15981
15982 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
15983 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
15984 requirements.
15985
15986 @table @code
15987 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
15988 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
15989 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
15990 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15991 Profile. This is the default.
15992
15993 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
15994 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
15995 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
15996 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
15997 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
15998 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
15999 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
16000
16001 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
16002 @item show ravenscar task-switching
16003 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
16004 using the Ravenscar Profile.
16005
16006 @end table
16007
16008 @node Ada Glitches
16009 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
16010 @cindex Ada, problems
16011
16012 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
16013 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
16014 @value{GDBN},
16015 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
16016 and the GNU Ada compiler.
16017
16018 @itemize @bullet
16019 @item
16020 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
16021 storage are invisible to the debugger.
16022
16023 @item
16024 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
16025 argument lists are treated as positional).
16026
16027 @item
16028 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
16029
16030 @item
16031 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
16032 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
16033 the host machine.
16034
16035 @item
16036 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
16037 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
16038 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
16039 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
16040 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
16041 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
16042 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
16043 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
16044 you can usually resolve the confusion
16045 by qualifying the problematic names with package
16046 @code{Standard} explicitly.
16047 @end itemize
16048
16049 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
16050 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
16051 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
16052 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
16053 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
16054 enabled.
16055
16056 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16057 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
16058 @table @code
16059
16060 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
16061 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
16062 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
16063 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
16064 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
16065 This is the default.
16066
16067 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
16068 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
16069 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
16070 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
16071 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
16072 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
16073 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
16074
16075 @end table
16076
16077 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
16078 @cindex GNAT encoding
16079 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
16080 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
16081 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
16082 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
16083 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
16084 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
16085
16086 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
16087 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
16088 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
16089 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
16090 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
16091 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
16092 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
16093 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
16094
16095 @table @code
16096
16097 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
16098 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
16099 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
16100 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
16101
16102 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16103 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
16104 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
16105
16106 @end table
16107
16108 @node Unsupported Languages
16109 @section Unsupported Languages
16110
16111 @cindex unsupported languages
16112 @cindex minimal language
16113 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
16114 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
16115 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
16116 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
16117 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
16118 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
16119
16120 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
16121 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
16122 language.
16123
16124 @node Symbols
16125 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
16126
16127 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
16128 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
16129 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
16130 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
16131 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
16132 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
16133 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
16134
16135 @cindex symbol names
16136 @cindex names of symbols
16137 @cindex quoting names
16138 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
16139 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
16140 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
16141 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
16142 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
16143 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
16144 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
16145 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
16146
16147 @smallexample
16148 p 'foo.c'::x
16149 @end smallexample
16150
16151 @noindent
16152 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
16153
16154 @table @code
16155 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
16156 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
16157 @kindex set case-sensitive
16158 @item set case-sensitive on
16159 @itemx set case-sensitive off
16160 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
16161 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
16162 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
16163 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
16164 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
16165 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
16166 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
16167 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
16168 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
16169 case-insensitive matches.
16170
16171 @kindex show case-sensitive
16172 @item show case-sensitive
16173 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
16174 lookups.
16175
16176 @kindex set print type methods
16177 @item set print type methods
16178 @itemx set print type methods on
16179 @itemx set print type methods off
16180 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
16181 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16182 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16183 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16184 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
16185 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
16186
16187 @kindex show print type methods
16188 @item show print type methods
16189 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
16190 classes.
16191
16192 @kindex set print type typedefs
16193 @item set print type typedefs
16194 @itemx set print type typedefs on
16195 @itemx set print type typedefs off
16196
16197 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
16198 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
16199 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
16200 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
16201 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
16202 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
16203 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
16204 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
16205 types.
16206
16207 @kindex show print type typedefs
16208 @item show print type typedefs
16209 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
16210 printing classes.
16211
16212 @kindex info address
16213 @cindex address of a symbol
16214 @item info address @var{symbol}
16215 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
16216 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
16217 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
16218 is always stored.
16219
16220 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
16221 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
16222 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
16223
16224 @kindex info symbol
16225 @cindex symbol from address
16226 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
16227 @item info symbol @var{addr}
16228 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
16229 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
16230 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
16231
16232 @smallexample
16233 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
16234 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
16235 @end smallexample
16236
16237 @noindent
16238 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
16239 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
16240
16241 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
16242 library containing the symbol is also printed:
16243
16244 @smallexample
16245 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
16246 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
16247 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
16248 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
16249 @end smallexample
16250
16251 @kindex demangle
16252 @cindex demangle
16253 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
16254 Demangle @var{name}.
16255 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
16256 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
16257
16258 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
16259 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
16260
16261 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
16262 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
16263
16264 @kindex whatis
16265 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16266 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
16267 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
16268 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16269
16270 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
16271 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
16272 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
16273
16274 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
16275 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
16276 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
16277 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
16278 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
16279 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
16280 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
16281 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
16282 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
16283
16284 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
16285 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
16286 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
16287 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
16288 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
16289 unroll it.
16290
16291 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
16292 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
16293 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
16294
16295 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
16296 Available flags are:
16297
16298 @table @code
16299 @item r
16300 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
16301 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
16302 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
16303
16304 @item m
16305 Do not print methods defined in the class.
16306
16307 @item M
16308 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16309 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
16310
16311 @item t
16312 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
16313 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
16314 names are substituted when printing other types.
16315
16316 @item T
16317 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
16318 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
16319 @end table
16320
16321 @kindex ptype
16322 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
16323 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
16324 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
16325 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
16326
16327 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
16328 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
16329 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
16330 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
16331 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
16332 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
16333 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
16334 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
16335
16336 For example, for this variable declaration:
16337
16338 @smallexample
16339 typedef double real_t;
16340 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
16341 typedef struct complex complex_t;
16342 complex_t var;
16343 real_t *real_pointer_var;
16344 @end smallexample
16345
16346 @noindent
16347 the two commands give this output:
16348
16349 @smallexample
16350 @group
16351 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
16352 type = complex_t
16353 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
16354 type = struct complex @{
16355 real_t real;
16356 double imag;
16357 @}
16358 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
16359 type = struct complex
16360 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
16361 type = struct complex
16362 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
16363 type = struct complex @{
16364 real_t real;
16365 double imag;
16366 @}
16367 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
16368 type = real_t *
16369 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
16370 type = double *
16371 @end group
16372 @end smallexample
16373
16374 @noindent
16375 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
16376 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
16377
16378 @cindex incomplete type
16379 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
16380 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
16381 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
16382 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
16383 given these declarations:
16384
16385 @smallexample
16386 struct foo;
16387 struct foo *fooptr;
16388 @end smallexample
16389
16390 @noindent
16391 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
16392
16393 @smallexample
16394 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
16395 $1 = <incomplete type>
16396 @end smallexample
16397
16398 @noindent
16399 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
16400 completely specified.
16401
16402 @kindex info types
16403 @item info types @var{regexp}
16404 @itemx info types
16405 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
16406 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
16407 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
16408 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
16409 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
16410 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
16411 name is @code{value}.
16412
16413 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
16414 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
16415 lists all source files where a type is defined.
16416
16417 @kindex info type-printers
16418 @item info type-printers
16419 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
16420 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
16421 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
16422 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
16423 type printers.
16424
16425 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
16426
16427 @kindex enable type-printer
16428 @kindex disable type-printer
16429 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16430 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
16431 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
16432
16433 @kindex info scope
16434 @cindex local variables
16435 @item info scope @var{location}
16436 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
16437 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
16438 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
16439 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
16440 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
16441
16442 @smallexample
16443 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
16444 Scope for command_line_handler:
16445 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
16446 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
16447 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
16448 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
16449 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
16450 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
16451 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
16452 @end smallexample
16453
16454 @noindent
16455 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
16456 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
16457 collect}.
16458
16459 @kindex info source
16460 @item info source
16461 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
16462 the function containing the current point of execution:
16463 @itemize @bullet
16464 @item
16465 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
16466 @item
16467 the directory it was compiled in,
16468 @item
16469 its length, in lines,
16470 @item
16471 which programming language it is written in,
16472 @item
16473 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
16474 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
16475 @item
16476 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
16477 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
16478 @item
16479 whether the debugging information includes information about
16480 preprocessor macros.
16481 @end itemize
16482
16483
16484 @kindex info sources
16485 @item info sources
16486 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
16487 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
16488 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
16489
16490 @kindex info functions
16491 @item info functions
16492 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
16493
16494 @item info functions @var{regexp}
16495 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
16496 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
16497 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
16498 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
16499 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
16500 that conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
16501 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
16502
16503 @kindex info variables
16504 @item info variables
16505 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
16506 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
16507
16508 @item info variables @var{regexp}
16509 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
16510 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
16511 @var{regexp}.
16512
16513 @kindex info classes
16514 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
16515 @item info classes
16516 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
16517 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
16518 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16519 expression.
16520
16521 @kindex info selectors
16522 @item info selectors
16523 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
16524 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
16525 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
16526 expression.
16527
16528 @ignore
16529 This was never implemented.
16530 @kindex info methods
16531 @item info methods
16532 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
16533 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
16534 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
16535 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
16536 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
16537 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
16538 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
16539 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
16540 @end ignore
16541
16542 @cindex opaque data types
16543 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
16544 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
16545 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
16546 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
16547 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
16548 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
16549 another source file. The default is on.
16550
16551 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
16552 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
16553
16554 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
16555 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
16556 is printed as follows:
16557 @smallexample
16558 @{<no data fields>@}
16559 @end smallexample
16560
16561 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
16562 @item show opaque-type-resolution
16563 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
16564
16565 @kindex set print symbol-loading
16566 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
16567 @item set print symbol-loading
16568 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
16569 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
16570 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
16571 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
16572 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
16573 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
16574 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
16575 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
16576 can be annoying.
16577 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
16578 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
16579 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
16580 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
16581
16582 @kindex show print symbol-loading
16583 @item show print symbol-loading
16584 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
16585 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
16586
16587 @kindex maint print symbols
16588 @cindex symbol dump
16589 @kindex maint print psymbols
16590 @cindex partial symbol dump
16591 @kindex maint print msymbols
16592 @cindex minimal symbol dump
16593 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
16594 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
16595 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
16596 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
16597 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
16598 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
16599 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
16600 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
16601 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
16602 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
16603 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
16604 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
16605 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
16606 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
16607 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
16608 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
16609 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
16610
16611 @kindex maint info symtabs
16612 @kindex maint info psymtabs
16613 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
16614 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16615 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16616 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
16617 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16618 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
16619
16620 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
16621 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
16622 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
16623 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
16624 structure in more detail. For example:
16625
16626 @smallexample
16627 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
16628 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16629 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16630 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16631 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
16632 readin no
16633 fullname (null)
16634 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
16635 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
16636 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
16637 dependencies (none)
16638 @}
16639 @}
16640 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16641 (@value{GDBP})
16642 @end smallexample
16643 @noindent
16644 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
16645 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
16646 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
16647 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
16648 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
16649
16650 @smallexample
16651 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
16652 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
16653 line 1574.
16654 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
16655 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
16656 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
16657 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
16658 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
16659 dirname (null)
16660 fullname (null)
16661 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
16662 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
16663 debugformat DWARF 2
16664 @}
16665 @}
16666 (@value{GDBP})
16667 @end smallexample
16668
16669 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
16670 @cindex symbol cache size
16671 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
16672 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
16673 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
16674 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
16675 with different sizes.
16676
16677 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
16678 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
16679 Show the size of the symbol cache.
16680
16681 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
16682 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
16683 @item maint print symbol-cache
16684 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
16685 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
16686
16687 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16688 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
16689 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
16690 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
16691 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
16692
16693 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
16694 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
16695 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
16696 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
16697 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
16698 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
16699
16700 @end table
16701
16702 @node Altering
16703 @chapter Altering Execution
16704
16705 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
16706 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
16707 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
16708 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
16709 program.
16710
16711 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
16712 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
16713 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
16714
16715 @menu
16716 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
16717 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
16718 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
16719 * Returning:: Returning from a function
16720 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
16721 * Patching:: Patching your program
16722 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
16723 @end menu
16724
16725 @node Assignment
16726 @section Assignment to Variables
16727
16728 @cindex assignment
16729 @cindex setting variables
16730 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
16731 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
16732
16733 @smallexample
16734 print x=4
16735 @end smallexample
16736
16737 @noindent
16738 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
16739 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
16740 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
16741 information on operators in supported languages.
16742
16743 @kindex set variable
16744 @cindex variables, setting
16745 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
16746 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
16747 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
16748 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
16749 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
16750
16751 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
16752 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
16753 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
16754 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
16755 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
16756 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
16757 command @code{set width}:
16758
16759 @smallexample
16760 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
16761 type = double
16762 (@value{GDBP}) p width
16763 $4 = 13
16764 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
16765 Invalid syntax in expression.
16766 @end smallexample
16767
16768 @noindent
16769 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
16770 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
16771
16772 @smallexample
16773 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
16774 @end smallexample
16775
16776 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
16777 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
16778 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
16779 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
16780 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
16781 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
16782
16783 @smallexample
16784 @group
16785 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
16786 type = double
16787 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16788 $1 = 1
16789 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
16790 (@value{GDBP}) p g
16791 $2 = 1
16792 (@value{GDBP}) r
16793 The program being debugged has been started already.
16794 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
16795 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
16796 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
16797 Invalid bfd target.
16798 (@value{GDBP}) show g
16799 The current BFD target is "=4".
16800 @end group
16801 @end smallexample
16802
16803 @noindent
16804 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
16805 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
16806 @code{g}, use
16807
16808 @smallexample
16809 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
16810 @end smallexample
16811
16812 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
16813 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
16814 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
16815 same length or shorter.
16816 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
16817 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
16818
16819 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
16820 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
16821 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
16822 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
16823 and representation in memory), and
16824
16825 @smallexample
16826 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
16827 @end smallexample
16828
16829 @noindent
16830 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
16831
16832 @node Jumping
16833 @section Continuing at a Different Address
16834
16835 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
16836 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
16837 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
16838
16839 @table @code
16840 @kindex jump
16841 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
16842 @item jump @var{linespec}
16843 @itemx j @var{linespec}
16844 @itemx jump @var{location}
16845 @itemx j @var{location}
16846 Resume execution at line @var{linespec} or at address given by
16847 @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately if there is a
16848 breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
16849 different forms of @var{linespec} and @var{location}. It is common
16850 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
16851 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16852
16853 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
16854 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
16855 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
16856 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
16857 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
16858 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
16859 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
16860 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
16861 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
16862 @end table
16863
16864 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
16865 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
16866 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
16867 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
16868 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
16869 example,
16870
16871 @smallexample
16872 set $pc = 0x485
16873 @end smallexample
16874
16875 @noindent
16876 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
16877 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
16878 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
16879
16880 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
16881 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
16882 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
16883 detail.
16884
16885 @c @group
16886 @node Signaling
16887 @section Giving your Program a Signal
16888 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
16889
16890 @table @code
16891 @kindex signal
16892 @item signal @var{signal}
16893 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
16894 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
16895 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
16896 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16897
16898 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
16899 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
16900 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16901 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
16902 signal.
16903
16904 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
16905 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
16906 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
16907 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
16908 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
16909 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
16910 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
16911 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
16912
16913 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
16914 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
16915 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
16916 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
16917 passes the signal directly to your program.
16918
16919 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
16920 after executing the command.
16921
16922 @kindex queue-signal
16923 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
16924 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
16925 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
16926 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
16927 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
16928 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
16929 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
16930 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
16931 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
16932
16933 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
16934 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
16935 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
16936 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
16937 @code{continue} command.
16938
16939 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
16940 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
16941 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
16942 (@pxref{Signals}).
16943 @end table
16944 @c @end group
16945
16946 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
16947 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
16948
16949 @node Returning
16950 @section Returning from a Function
16951
16952 @table @code
16953 @cindex returning from a function
16954 @kindex return
16955 @item return
16956 @itemx return @var{expression}
16957 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
16958 command. If you give an
16959 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
16960 value.
16961 @end table
16962
16963 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
16964 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
16965 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
16966 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
16967
16968 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
16969 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
16970 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
16971 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
16972 of functions.
16973
16974 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
16975 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
16976 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
16977 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
16978 selected stack frame returns naturally.
16979
16980 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
16981 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
16982 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
16983 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
16984 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
16985 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
16986 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
16987 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
16988 assignment into the right register(s).
16989
16990 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
16991 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
16992 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
16993 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
16994 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
16995 into a @code{long long int}:
16996
16997 @smallexample
16998 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
16999 29 return 31;
17000 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17001 Make func return now? (y or n) y
17002 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
17003 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
17004 (@value{GDBP})
17005 @end smallexample
17006
17007 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
17008 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
17009 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
17010 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
17011 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
17012 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
17013 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
17014 an appropriate cast explicitly:
17015
17016 @smallexample
17017 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
17018 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
17019 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
17020 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
17021 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
17022 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
17023 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
17024 (@value{GDBP})
17025 @end smallexample
17026
17027 @node Calling
17028 @section Calling Program Functions
17029
17030 @table @code
17031 @cindex calling functions
17032 @cindex inferior functions, calling
17033 @item print @var{expr}
17034 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
17035 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
17036 debugged.
17037
17038 @kindex call
17039 @item call @var{expr}
17040 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
17041 returned values.
17042
17043 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
17044 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
17045 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
17046 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
17047 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
17048 value history.
17049 @end table
17050
17051 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
17052 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
17053 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
17054 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
17055
17056 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
17057 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
17058 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
17059 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
17060 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
17061 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
17062 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
17063 in that case is controlled by the
17064 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
17065
17066 @table @code
17067 @item set unwindonsignal
17068 @kindex set unwindonsignal
17069 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
17070 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
17071 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
17072 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
17073 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
17074 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
17075 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
17076 received.
17077
17078 @item show unwindonsignal
17079 @kindex show unwindonsignal
17080 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17081 @value{GDBN}.
17082
17083 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17084 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
17085 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
17086 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
17087 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
17088 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
17089 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
17090 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
17091 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
17092 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
17093
17094 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17095 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
17096 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
17097 @value{GDBN}.
17098
17099 @end table
17100
17101 @cindex weak alias functions
17102 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is actually a @dfn{weak alias}
17103 for another function. In such case, @value{GDBN} might not pick up
17104 the type information, including the types of the function arguments,
17105 which causes @value{GDBN} to call the inferior function incorrectly.
17106 As a result, the called function will function erroneously and may
17107 even crash. A solution to that is to use the name of the aliased
17108 function instead.
17109
17110 @node Patching
17111 @section Patching Programs
17112
17113 @cindex patching binaries
17114 @cindex writing into executables
17115 @cindex writing into corefiles
17116
17117 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
17118 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
17119 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
17120 patching your program's binary.
17121
17122 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
17123 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
17124 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
17125 repairs.
17126
17127 @table @code
17128 @kindex set write
17129 @item set write on
17130 @itemx set write off
17131 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
17132 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
17133 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
17134
17135 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
17136 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
17137 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
17138
17139 @item show write
17140 @kindex show write
17141 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
17142 as well as reading.
17143 @end table
17144
17145 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
17146 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
17147 @cindex injecting code
17148 @cindex writing into executables
17149 @cindex compiling code
17150
17151 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
17152 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
17153 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
17154 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
17155
17156 @table @code
17157 @kindex compile code
17158 @item compile code @var{source-code}
17159 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
17160 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
17161 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
17162 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
17163 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
17164 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
17165 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
17166 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
17167 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
17168 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
17169 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
17170
17171 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
17172 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
17173 E.g.:
17174
17175 @smallexample
17176 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
17177 @end smallexample
17178
17179 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
17180 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
17181 from actual source code. E.g.:
17182
17183 @smallexample
17184 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
17185 @end smallexample
17186
17187 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
17188 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
17189 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
17190 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
17191 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
17192 editor.
17193
17194 @smallexample
17195 compile code
17196 >printf ("hello\n");
17197 >printf ("world\n");
17198 >end
17199 @end smallexample
17200
17201 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
17202 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
17203 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
17204 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
17205 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
17206 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
17207 inferior symbols otherwise.
17208
17209 @kindex compile file
17210 @item compile file @var{filename}
17211 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
17212 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
17213
17214 @smallexample
17215 compile file /home/user/example.c
17216 @end smallexample
17217 @end table
17218
17219 @noindent
17220 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
17221
17222 @table @code
17223 @anchor{set debug compile}
17224 @item set debug compile
17225 @cindex compile command debugging info
17226 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
17227 injecting the code. The default is off.
17228
17229 @item show debug compile
17230 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
17231 compiling and injecting the code.
17232 @end table
17233
17234 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
17235
17236 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
17237 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
17238 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
17239 injecting process.
17240
17241 @noindent
17242 The options used, in increasing precedence:
17243
17244 @table @asis
17245 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
17246 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
17247 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
17248 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
17249
17250 @item compilation options recorded in the target
17251 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
17252 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
17253 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
17254 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
17255 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
17256 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
17257 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
17258
17259 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
17260 @end table
17261
17262 @noindent
17263 You can override compilation options using the following command:
17264
17265 @table @code
17266 @item set compile-args
17267 @cindex compile command options override
17268 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
17269 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
17270 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
17271 compilation.
17272
17273 @item show compile-args
17274 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
17275 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
17276 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
17277 @end table
17278
17279 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
17280
17281 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
17282 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
17283 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
17284
17285 @table @asis
17286 @item C code examples and caveats
17287 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
17288 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
17289 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
17290 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
17291 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
17292
17293 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
17294 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
17295 much like any other normal debugging session.
17296
17297 @smallexample
17298 void function1 (void)
17299 @{
17300 int i = 42;
17301 printf ("function 1\n");
17302 @}
17303
17304 void function2 (void)
17305 @{
17306 int j = 12;
17307 function1 ();
17308 @}
17309
17310 int main(void)
17311 @{
17312 int k = 6;
17313 int *p;
17314 function2 ();
17315 return 0;
17316 @}
17317 @end smallexample
17318
17319 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
17320 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
17321 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
17322
17323 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
17324 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
17325 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
17326 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
17327 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
17328
17329 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
17330 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
17331 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
17332 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
17333 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
17334 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
17335 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
17336 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
17337 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
17338 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
17339
17340 @smallexample
17341 compile code k = 3;
17342 @end smallexample
17343
17344 @noindent
17345 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
17346 something else in the example program changes it, or another
17347 @code{compile} command changes it.
17348
17349 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
17350 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
17351 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
17352 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
17353 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
17354
17355 @smallexample
17356 compile code j = 3;
17357 @end smallexample
17358
17359 @noindent
17360 will result in a compilation error message.
17361
17362 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
17363 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
17364 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
17365
17366 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
17367 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
17368 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
17369 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
17370
17371 @smallexample
17372 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
17373 @end smallexample
17374
17375 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
17376 command has completed:
17377
17378 @smallexample
17379 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
17380 @end smallexample
17381
17382 @noindent
17383 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
17384 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
17385 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
17386 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
17387 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
17388
17389 @smallexample
17390 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
17391 @end smallexample
17392
17393 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
17394 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
17395 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
17396 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
17397 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
17398 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
17399 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
17400 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
17401
17402 @smallexample
17403 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
17404 @end smallexample
17405
17406 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
17407 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
17408 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
17409 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
17410 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
17411 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
17412 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
17413
17414 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
17415 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
17416 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
17417 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
17418 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
17419 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
17420
17421 @smallexample
17422 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
17423 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17424 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
17425 Compilation failed.
17426 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
17427 42
17428 @end smallexample
17429
17430 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
17431 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
17432 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
17433 will print to the console.
17434 @end table
17435
17436 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
17437
17438 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged which
17439 may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture than where
17440 @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} (@code{PATH} from
17441 shell that executed @value{GDBN}, not the one set by @value{GDBN}
17442 command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}. @code{PATH} on
17443 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
17444 target architecture and operating system.
17445
17446 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
17447 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
17448 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
17449 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
17450 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
17451 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
17452 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
17453
17454 @node GDB Files
17455 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
17456
17457 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
17458 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
17459 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
17460 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
17461
17462 @menu
17463 * Files:: Commands to specify files
17464 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
17465 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
17466 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
17467 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
17468 * Data Files:: GDB data files
17469 @end menu
17470
17471 @node Files
17472 @section Commands to Specify Files
17473
17474 @cindex symbol table
17475 @cindex core dump file
17476
17477 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
17478 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
17479 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
17480 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
17481
17482 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
17483 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
17484 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
17485 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
17486 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
17487 new files are useful.
17488
17489 @table @code
17490 @cindex executable file
17491 @kindex file
17492 @item file @var{filename}
17493 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
17494 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
17495 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
17496 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
17497 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
17498 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
17499 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
17500 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
17501
17502 @cindex unlinked object files
17503 @cindex patching object files
17504 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
17505 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
17506 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
17507 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
17508 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
17509 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
17510 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
17511 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
17512
17513 @item file
17514 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
17515 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
17516
17517 @kindex exec-file
17518 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17519 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
17520 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
17521 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
17522 discard information on the executable file.
17523
17524 @kindex symbol-file
17525 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
17526 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
17527 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
17528 table and program to run from the same file.
17529
17530 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
17531 program's symbol table.
17532
17533 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
17534 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
17535 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
17536 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
17537 @value{GDBN}.
17538
17539 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
17540 executing it once.
17541
17542 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
17543 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
17544 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
17545 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
17546 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
17547 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
17548 optimized code.
17549
17550 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
17551 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
17552 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
17553 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
17554 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
17555
17556 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
17557 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
17558 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
17559 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
17560 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
17561 Warnings and Messages}.)
17562
17563 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
17564 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
17565 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
17566 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
17567 in stabs format.
17568
17569 @kindex readnow
17570 @cindex reading symbols immediately
17571 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
17572 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17573 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
17574 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
17575 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
17576 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
17577 entire symbol table available.
17578
17579 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
17580 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
17581 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
17582 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
17583 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
17584 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
17585 @c files.
17586
17587 @kindex core-file
17588 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17589 @itemx core
17590 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
17591 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
17592 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
17593 executable file itself for other parts.
17594
17595 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
17596 to be used.
17597
17598 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
17599 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
17600 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
17601 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
17602 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
17603
17604 @kindex add-symbol-file
17605 @cindex dynamic linking
17606 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
17607 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]}
17608 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
17609 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
17610 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
17611 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
17612 into the program that is running. The @var{address} should give the memory
17613 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
17614 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
17615 of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
17616 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
17617 @var{address} as an expression.
17618
17619 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
17620 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
17621 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
17622 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
17623
17624 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
17625
17626 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
17627 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
17628 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
17629 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
17630 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
17631 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
17632 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
17633 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
17634 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
17635
17636 @itemize @bullet
17637 @item
17638 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
17639 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
17640 @item
17641 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
17642 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
17643 @item
17644 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
17645 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
17646 @end itemize
17647
17648 @noindent
17649 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
17650 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
17651 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
17652 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
17653 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
17654 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
17655 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
17656 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
17657 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
17658 way.
17659
17660 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17661
17662 @kindex remove-symbol-file
17663 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
17664 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
17665 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
17666 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
17667 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
17668
17669 @smallexample
17670 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
17671 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
17672 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
17673 (y or n) y
17674 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
17675 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
17676 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
17677 (gdb)
17678 @end smallexample
17679
17680
17681 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
17682
17683 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
17684 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
17685 @cindex load symbols from memory
17686 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
17687 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
17688 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
17689 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
17690 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
17691 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
17692 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
17693 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
17694 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
17695
17696 @kindex section
17697 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
17698 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
17699 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
17700 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
17701 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
17702 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
17703 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
17704 their addresses.
17705
17706 @kindex info files
17707 @kindex info target
17708 @item info files
17709 @itemx info target
17710 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
17711 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
17712 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
17713 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
17714 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
17715 current ones.
17716
17717 @kindex maint info sections
17718 @item maint info sections
17719 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
17720 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
17721 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
17722 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
17723 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
17724 may be arbitrarily combined):
17725
17726 @table @code
17727 @item ALLOBJ
17728 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
17729 @item @var{sections}
17730 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
17731 @item @var{section-flags}
17732 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
17733 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
17734 @table @code
17735 @item ALLOC
17736 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
17737 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
17738 @item LOAD
17739 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
17740 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
17741 @item RELOC
17742 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
17743 @item READONLY
17744 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
17745 @item CODE
17746 Section contains executable code only.
17747 @item DATA
17748 Section contains data only (no executable code).
17749 @item ROM
17750 Section will reside in ROM.
17751 @item CONSTRUCTOR
17752 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
17753 @item HAS_CONTENTS
17754 Section is not empty.
17755 @item NEVER_LOAD
17756 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
17757 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
17758 A notification to the linker that the section contains
17759 COFF shared library information.
17760 @item IS_COMMON
17761 Section contains common symbols.
17762 @end table
17763 @end table
17764 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
17765 @cindex read-only sections
17766 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
17767 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
17768 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
17769 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
17770 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
17771 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
17772 enhancement to debugging performance.
17773
17774 The default is off.
17775
17776 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
17777 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
17778 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
17779 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
17780
17781 @item show trust-readonly-sections
17782 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
17783 @end table
17784
17785 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
17786 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
17787 name and remembers it that way.
17788
17789 @cindex shared libraries
17790 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
17791 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix,
17792 and IBM RS/6000 AIX shared libraries.
17793
17794 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
17795 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
17796
17797 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
17798 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
17799 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
17800 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
17801 debugging a core file).
17802
17803 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
17804 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
17805
17806 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
17807 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
17808 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
17809
17810 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
17811 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
17812 particularly large or there are many of them.
17813
17814 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
17815 commands:
17816
17817 @table @code
17818 @kindex set auto-solib-add
17819 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
17820 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
17821 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
17822 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
17823 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
17824 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
17825 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
17826
17827 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
17828 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
17829 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
17830 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
17831 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
17832 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
17833 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
17834 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
17835 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
17836
17837 @kindex show auto-solib-add
17838 @item show auto-solib-add
17839 Display the current autoloading mode.
17840 @end table
17841
17842 @cindex load shared library
17843 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
17844 command:
17845
17846 @table @code
17847 @kindex info sharedlibrary
17848 @kindex info share
17849 @item info share @var{regex}
17850 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17851 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
17852 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
17853 all shared libraries that are loaded.
17854
17855 @kindex sharedlibrary
17856 @kindex share
17857 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
17858 @itemx share @var{regex}
17859 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
17860 Unix regular expression.
17861 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
17862 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
17863 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
17864 loaded.
17865
17866 @item nosharedlibrary
17867 @kindex nosharedlibrary
17868 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
17869 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
17870 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
17871 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
17872 discarded.
17873 @end table
17874
17875 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
17876 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
17877 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
17878 Catchpoints}).
17879
17880 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
17881 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
17882 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
17883 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
17884
17885 @table @code
17886 @item set stop-on-solib-events
17887 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
17888 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
17889 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
17890 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
17891 shared library.
17892
17893 @item show stop-on-solib-events
17894 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
17895 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
17896 library events happen.
17897 @end table
17898
17899 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
17900 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
17901 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
17902 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
17903 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
17904 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
17905 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
17906 not.
17907
17908 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
17909 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
17910 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
17911 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
17912 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
17913
17914 @table @code
17915 @cindex prefix for shared library file names
17916 @cindex system root, alternate
17917 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
17918 @kindex set sysroot
17919 @item set sysroot @var{path}
17920 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
17921 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
17922 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
17923 target program's memory. If you use @code{set sysroot} to find shared
17924 libraries, they need to be laid out in the same way that they are on
17925 the target, with e.g.@: a @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy
17926 under @var{path}.
17927
17928 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
17929 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
17930 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
17931 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
17932 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
17933 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
17934 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
17935 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
17936 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
17937 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
17938 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
17939 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
17940 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
17941 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
17942
17943 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
17944 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
17945 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
17946 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
17947 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
17948
17949 @smallexample
17950 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
17951 @end smallexample
17952
17953 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
17954 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
17955 system:
17956
17957 @smallexample
17958 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
17959 @end smallexample
17960
17961 If that does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries removing
17962 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
17963 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
17964 colons:
17965
17966 @smallexample
17967 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
17968 @end smallexample
17969
17970 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
17971 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
17972 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
17973 @samp{z}):
17974
17975 @smallexample
17976 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
17977 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17978 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
17979 @end smallexample
17980
17981 @noindent
17982 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
17983 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
17984 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
17985
17986 If that still does not find the shared library, @value{GDBN} tries
17987 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
17988
17989 @smallexample
17990 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
17991 @end smallexample
17992
17993 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
17994 if you don't want or need to.
17995
17996 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
17997 sysroot}.
17998
17999 @cindex default system root
18000 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
18001 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
18002 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
18003 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18004 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
18005 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18006 location.
18007
18008 @kindex show sysroot
18009 @item show sysroot
18010 Display the current shared library prefix.
18011
18012 @kindex set solib-search-path
18013 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
18014 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
18015 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
18016 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
18017 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
18018 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
18019 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18020 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
18021 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
18022 of shared library symbols.
18023
18024 @kindex show solib-search-path
18025 @item show solib-search-path
18026 Display the current shared library search path.
18027
18028 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
18029 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
18030 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
18031 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
18032 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
18033
18034 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
18035 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
18036 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
18037 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
18038 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
18039 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
18040 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
18041 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
18042 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
18043 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
18044 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
18045 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
18046 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
18047 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
18048 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
18049 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
18050 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
18051 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
18052 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
18053 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
18054 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
18055 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
18056
18057 @table @code
18058 @item unix
18059 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
18060 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
18061 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
18062 the forward slash.
18063
18064 @item dos-based
18065 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
18066 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
18067 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
18068 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
18069 considered directory separators.
18070
18071 @item auto
18072 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
18073 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
18074 This is the default.
18075 @end table
18076 @end table
18077
18078 @cindex file name canonicalization
18079 @cindex base name differences
18080 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
18081 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
18082 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
18083 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
18084 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
18085 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
18086 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
18087 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
18088 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
18089 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
18090 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
18091 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
18092 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
18093 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
18094 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
18095
18096 @table @code
18097 @item set basenames-may-differ
18098 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
18099 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18100
18101 @item show basenames-may-differ
18102 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
18103 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
18104 @end table
18105
18106 @node Separate Debug Files
18107 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
18108 @cindex separate debugging information files
18109 @cindex debugging information in separate files
18110 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
18111 @cindex debugging information directory, global
18112 @cindex global debugging information directories
18113 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
18114 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
18115
18116 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
18117 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
18118 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
18119 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
18120 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
18121 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
18122 install only when they need to debug a problem.
18123
18124 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
18125 file:
18126
18127 @itemize @bullet
18128 @item
18129 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
18130 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
18131 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
18132 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
18133 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
18134 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
18135 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
18136 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
18137
18138 @item
18139 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
18140 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
18141 only on some operating systems, notably those which use the ELF format
18142 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
18143 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
18144 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
18145 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
18146 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
18147 below.
18148 @end itemize
18149
18150 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
18151 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
18152
18153 @itemize @bullet
18154 @item
18155 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
18156 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
18157 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
18158 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
18159 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
18160
18161 @item
18162 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
18163 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
18164 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
18165 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
18166 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
18167 hex characters, not 10.)
18168 @end itemize
18169
18170 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
18171 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
18172 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
18173 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
18174 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
18175 debug information files, in the indicated order:
18176
18177 @itemize @minus
18178 @item
18179 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
18180 @item
18181 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
18182 @item
18183 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
18184 @item
18185 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
18186 @end itemize
18187
18188 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
18189 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
18190 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
18191 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
18192 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
18193
18194 @table @code
18195
18196 @kindex set debug-file-directory
18197 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
18198 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18199 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
18200 concatenating them by a path separator.
18201
18202 @kindex show debug-file-directory
18203 @item show debug-file-directory
18204 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
18205 information files.
18206
18207 @end table
18208
18209 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
18210 @cindex debug link sections
18211 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
18212 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
18213
18214 @itemize
18215 @item
18216 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
18217 a zero byte,
18218 @item
18219 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
18220 boundary within the section, and
18221 @item
18222 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
18223 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
18224 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
18225 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
18226 @end itemize
18227
18228 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
18229 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
18230 described above.
18231
18232 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
18233 @cindex build ID sections
18234 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
18235 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
18236 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
18237 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
18238 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
18239 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
18240 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
18241 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
18242 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
18243
18244 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
18245 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
18246 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
18247 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
18248 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
18249 in an ordinary executable.
18250
18251 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
18252 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
18253 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
18254 following commands:
18255
18256 @smallexample
18257 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
18258 @kbd{strip -g foo}
18259 @end smallexample
18260
18261 @noindent
18262 These commands remove the debugging
18263 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
18264 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
18265 two files:
18266
18267 @itemize @bullet
18268 @item
18269 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
18270 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
18271
18272 @smallexample
18273 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
18274 @end smallexample
18275
18276 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
18277 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
18278 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
18279 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
18280
18281 @item
18282 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
18283 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
18284 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
18285 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
18286 @end itemize
18287
18288 @noindent
18289
18290 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
18291 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
18292 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
18293
18294 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
18295 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
18296 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
18297 @c different ways!
18298 @ifhtml
18299 @display
18300 @html
18301 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
18302 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
18303 @end html
18304 @end display
18305 @end ifhtml
18306 @ifnothtml
18307 @display
18308 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
18309 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
18310 @end display
18311 @end ifnothtml
18312
18313 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
18314 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
18315 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
18316 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
18317 CRC.
18318
18319 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
18320 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
18321 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
18322 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
18323 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
18324
18325 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
18326 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
18327 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
18328 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
18329 @code{0xffffffff}.
18330
18331 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
18332 @smallexample
18333 unsigned long
18334 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
18335 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
18336 @{
18337 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
18338 @{
18339 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
18340 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
18341 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
18342 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
18343 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
18344 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
18345 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
18346 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
18347 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
18348 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
18349 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
18350 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
18351 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
18352 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
18353 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
18354 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
18355 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
18356 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
18357 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
18358 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
18359 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
18360 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
18361 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
18362 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
18363 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
18364 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
18365 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
18366 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
18367 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
18368 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
18369 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
18370 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
18371 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
18372 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
18373 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
18374 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
18375 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
18376 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
18377 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
18378 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
18379 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
18380 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
18381 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
18382 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
18383 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
18384 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
18385 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
18386 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
18387 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
18388 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
18389 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
18390 0x2d02ef8d
18391 @};
18392 unsigned char *end;
18393
18394 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18395 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
18396 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
18397 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
18398 @}
18399 @end smallexample
18400
18401 @noindent
18402 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
18403
18404 @node MiniDebugInfo
18405 @section Debugging information in a special section
18406 @cindex separate debug sections
18407 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
18408
18409 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
18410 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
18411 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
18412 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
18413
18414 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
18415 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
18416 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
18417 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
18418 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
18419 debugging information might be included in the section.
18420
18421 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
18422 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
18423 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
18424
18425 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
18426 standard utilities:
18427
18428 @smallexample
18429 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
18430 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
18431 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18432 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
18433
18434 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
18435 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
18436 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
18437 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
18438 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
18439 | sort > funcsyms
18440
18441 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
18442 # table.
18443 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
18444
18445 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
18446 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
18447
18448 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
18449 # removing some unnecessary sections.
18450 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
18451 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
18452
18453 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
18454 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
18455
18456 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
18457 # original binary.
18458 xz mini_debuginfo
18459 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
18460 @end smallexample
18461
18462 @node Index Files
18463 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
18464 @cindex index files
18465 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
18466
18467 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
18468 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
18469 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
18470 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
18471 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
18472 startup.
18473
18474 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
18475 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
18476 using @command{objcopy}.
18477
18478 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
18479
18480 @table @code
18481 @item save gdb-index @var{directory}
18482 @kindex save gdb-index
18483 Create an index file for each symbol file currently known by
18484 @value{GDBN}. Each file is named after its corresponding symbol file,
18485 with @samp{.gdb-index} appended, and is written into the given
18486 @var{directory}.
18487 @end table
18488
18489 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
18490 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
18491
18492 @smallexample
18493 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
18494 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
18495 @end smallexample
18496
18497 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
18498 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
18499 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
18500 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
18501 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
18502 The default is @code{off}.
18503 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
18504 @xref{Index Section Format}.
18505
18506 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
18507 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
18508
18509 @smallexample
18510 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18511 @end smallexample
18512
18513 Instead you must do, for example,
18514
18515 @smallexample
18516 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
18517 @end smallexample
18518
18519 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
18520 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
18521 currently work for programs using Ada.
18522
18523 @node Symbol Errors
18524 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
18525
18526 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
18527 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
18528 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
18529 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
18530 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
18531 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
18532 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
18533 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
18534 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
18535 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18536 Messages}).
18537
18538 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
18539
18540 @table @code
18541 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
18542
18543 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
18544 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
18545 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
18546 in its outer scope blocks.
18547
18548 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
18549 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
18550 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
18551 function.
18552
18553 @item block at @var{address} out of order
18554
18555 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
18556 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
18557 do so.
18558
18559 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
18560 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
18561 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
18562 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
18563 Messages}.)
18564
18565 @item bad block start address patched
18566
18567 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
18568 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
18569 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
18570
18571 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
18572 starting on the previous source line.
18573
18574 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
18575
18576 @cindex foo
18577 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
18578 larger than the size of the string table.
18579
18580 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
18581 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
18582 with this name.
18583
18584 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
18585
18586 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
18587 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
18588 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
18589
18590 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
18591 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
18592 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
18593 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
18594 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
18595 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
18596
18597 @item stub type has NULL name
18598
18599 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
18600
18601 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
18602 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
18603 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
18604 it.
18605
18606 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
18607
18608 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
18609
18610 @end table
18611
18612 @node Data Files
18613 @section GDB Data Files
18614
18615 @cindex prefix for data files
18616 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
18617 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
18618
18619 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
18620 is currently using.
18621
18622 @table @code
18623 @kindex set data-directory
18624 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
18625 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
18626 to @var{directory}.
18627
18628 @kindex show data-directory
18629 @item show data-directory
18630 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
18631 @end table
18632
18633 @cindex default data directory
18634 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
18635 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
18636 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
18637 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
18638 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
18639 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
18640 location.
18641
18642 The data directory may also be specified with the
18643 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
18644 @xref{Mode Options}.
18645
18646 @node Targets
18647 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
18648
18649 @cindex debugging target
18650 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
18651
18652 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
18653 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
18654 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
18655 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
18656 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
18657 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
18658 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
18659 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
18660
18661 @cindex target architecture
18662 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
18663 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
18664 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
18665 command.
18666
18667 @table @code
18668 @kindex set architecture
18669 @kindex show architecture
18670 @item set architecture @var{arch}
18671 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
18672 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
18673 supported architectures.
18674
18675 @item show architecture
18676 Show the current target architecture.
18677
18678 @item set processor
18679 @itemx processor
18680 @kindex set processor
18681 @kindex show processor
18682 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
18683 and @code{show architecture}.
18684 @end table
18685
18686 @menu
18687 * Active Targets:: Active targets
18688 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
18689 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
18690 @end menu
18691
18692 @node Active Targets
18693 @section Active Targets
18694
18695 @cindex stacking targets
18696 @cindex active targets
18697 @cindex multiple targets
18698
18699 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
18700 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
18701 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
18702 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
18703 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
18704 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
18705 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
18706 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
18707 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
18708
18709 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
18710 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
18711 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
18712 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
18713
18714 @node Target Commands
18715 @section Commands for Managing Targets
18716
18717 @table @code
18718 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
18719 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
18720 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
18721 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
18722 protocol of the target machine.
18723
18724 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
18725 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
18726 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
18727
18728 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
18729 after executing the command.
18730
18731 @kindex help target
18732 @item help target
18733 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
18734 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
18735 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18736
18737 @item help target @var{name}
18738 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
18739 select it.
18740
18741 @kindex set gnutarget
18742 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
18743 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
18744 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
18745 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
18746 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
18747 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
18748
18749 @quotation
18750 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
18751 you must know the actual BFD name.
18752 @end quotation
18753
18754 @noindent
18755 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
18756
18757 @kindex show gnutarget
18758 @item show gnutarget
18759 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
18760 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
18761 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
18762 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
18763 @end table
18764
18765 @cindex common targets
18766 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
18767 configuration):
18768
18769 @table @code
18770 @kindex target
18771 @item target exec @var{program}
18772 @cindex executable file target
18773 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
18774 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
18775
18776 @item target core @var{filename}
18777 @cindex core dump file target
18778 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
18779 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
18780
18781 @item target remote @var{medium}
18782 @cindex remote target
18783 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
18784 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
18785 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
18786
18787 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
18788 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
18789
18790 @smallexample
18791 target remote /dev/ttya
18792 @end smallexample
18793
18794 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
18795 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
18796 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
18797 clobbered by the download.
18798
18799 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
18800 @cindex built-in simulator target
18801 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
18802 In general,
18803 @smallexample
18804 target sim
18805 load
18806 run
18807 @end smallexample
18808 @noindent
18809 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
18810 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
18811 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
18812 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
18813 Processors}.
18814
18815 @item target native
18816 @cindex native target
18817 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
18818 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
18819 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
18820 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
18821
18822 @end table
18823
18824 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
18825 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
18826
18827 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
18828 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
18829 various aspects of this process.
18830
18831 @table @code
18832
18833 @item set hash
18834 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18835 @cindex hash mark while downloading
18836 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
18837 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
18838 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
18839 monitor.
18840
18841 @item show hash
18842 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
18843 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
18844
18845 @item set debug monitor
18846 @kindex set debug monitor
18847 @cindex display remote monitor communications
18848 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
18849 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18850
18851 @item show debug monitor
18852 @kindex show debug monitor
18853 Show the current status of displaying communications between
18854 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
18855 @end table
18856
18857 @table @code
18858
18859 @kindex load @var{filename}
18860 @item load @var{filename}
18861 @anchor{load}
18862 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
18863 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
18864 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
18865 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
18866 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
18867 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
18868
18869 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
18870 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
18871 target is @dots{}}''
18872
18873 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
18874 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
18875 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
18876 specifies a fixed address.
18877 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
18878
18879 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
18880 load programs into flash memory.
18881
18882 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
18883 @end table
18884
18885 @node Byte Order
18886 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
18887
18888 @cindex choosing target byte order
18889 @cindex target byte order
18890
18891 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
18892 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
18893 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
18894 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
18895 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
18896 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
18897
18898 @table @code
18899 @kindex set endian
18900 @item set endian big
18901 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
18902
18903 @item set endian little
18904 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
18905
18906 @item set endian auto
18907 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
18908 executable.
18909
18910 @item show endian
18911 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
18912
18913 @end table
18914
18915 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
18916 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
18917 target system.
18918
18919
18920 @node Remote Debugging
18921 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
18922 @cindex remote debugging
18923
18924 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
18925 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
18926 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
18927 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
18928 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
18929
18930 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
18931 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
18932 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
18933 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
18934 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
18935 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
18936
18937 Other remote targets may be available in your
18938 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
18939
18940 @menu
18941 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
18942 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
18943 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
18944 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
18945 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
18946 @end menu
18947
18948 @node Connecting
18949 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
18950
18951 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
18952 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symbol and debugging information.
18953 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
18954 program as the first argument.
18955
18956 @cindex @code{target remote}
18957 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
18958 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
18959 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
18960 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
18961 @code{target remote} command establishes a connection to the target.
18962 Its arguments indicate which medium to use:
18963
18964 @table @code
18965
18966 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
18967 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
18968 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
18969 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
18970
18971 @smallexample
18972 target remote /dev/ttyb
18973 @end smallexample
18974
18975 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
18976 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
18977 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
18978 @code{target} command.
18979
18980 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
18981 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
18982 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
18983 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
18984 The @var{host} may be either a host name or a numeric @acronym{IP}
18985 address; @var{port} must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be
18986 the target machine itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or
18987 it might be a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
18988 target.
18989
18990 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
18991 @code{manyfarms}:
18992
18993 @smallexample
18994 target remote manyfarms:2828
18995 @end smallexample
18996
18997 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
18998 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
18999 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
19000 port 1234 on your local machine:
19001
19002 @smallexample
19003 target remote :1234
19004 @end smallexample
19005 @noindent
19006
19007 Note that the colon is still required here.
19008
19009 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
19010 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
19011 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
19012 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
19013
19014 @smallexample
19015 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
19016 @end smallexample
19017
19018 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
19019 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
19020 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
19021 cause havoc with your debugging session.
19022
19023 @item target remote | @var{command}
19024 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
19025 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
19026 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
19027 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
19028 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
19029 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
19030 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
19031 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
19032
19033 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
19034 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
19035 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
19036
19037 @end table
19038
19039 Once the connection has been established, you can use all the usual
19040 commands to examine and change data. The remote program is already
19041 running; you can use @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}, and you do not
19042 need to use @kbd{run}.
19043
19044 @cindex interrupting remote programs
19045 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
19046 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
19047 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
19048 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
19049 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
19050 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
19051
19052 @smallexample
19053 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
19054 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
19055 @end smallexample
19056
19057 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
19058 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
19059 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
19060 goes back to waiting.
19061
19062 @table @code
19063 @kindex detach (remote)
19064 @item detach
19065 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
19066 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
19067 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
19068 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
19069 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
19070
19071 @kindex disconnect
19072 @item disconnect
19073 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
19074 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
19075 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
19076 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
19077 another target.
19078
19079 @cindex send command to remote monitor
19080 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
19081 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
19082 @kindex monitor
19083 @item monitor @var{cmd}
19084 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
19085 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
19086 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
19087 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
19088 and implement.
19089 @end table
19090
19091 @node File Transfer
19092 @section Sending files to a remote system
19093 @cindex remote target, file transfer
19094 @cindex file transfer
19095 @cindex sending files to remote systems
19096
19097 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
19098 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
19099 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
19100 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
19101 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
19102 the only way to upload or download files.
19103
19104 Not all remote targets support these commands.
19105
19106 @table @code
19107 @kindex remote put
19108 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
19109 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
19110 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
19111
19112 @kindex remote get
19113 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
19114 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
19115 on the host system.
19116
19117 @kindex remote delete
19118 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
19119 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
19120
19121 @end table
19122
19123 @node Server
19124 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
19125
19126 @kindex gdbserver
19127 @cindex remote connection without stubs
19128 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
19129 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
19130 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
19131
19132 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
19133 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
19134 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
19135 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
19136 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
19137 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
19138 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
19139 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
19140 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
19141 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
19142 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
19143 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
19144 choice for debugging.
19145
19146 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
19147 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
19148 protocol.
19149
19150 @quotation
19151 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
19152 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
19153 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
19154 target system with the same privileges as the user running
19155 @code{gdbserver}.
19156 @end quotation
19157
19158 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
19159 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
19160 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
19161
19162 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
19163 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
19164 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
19165 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
19166 system does all the symbol handling.
19167
19168 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
19169 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
19170 syntax is:
19171
19172 @smallexample
19173 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
19174 @end smallexample
19175
19176 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
19177 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
19178 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
19179 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
19180 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
19181 @file{/dev/com1}:
19182
19183 @smallexample
19184 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
19185 @end smallexample
19186
19187 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
19188 with it.
19189
19190 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
19191
19192 @smallexample
19193 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
19194 @end smallexample
19195
19196 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
19197 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
19198 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
19199 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
19200 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
19201 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
19202 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
19203 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
19204 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
19205 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
19206 @code{target remote} command.
19207
19208 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
19209 with ssh:
19210
19211 @smallexample
19212 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
19213 @end smallexample
19214
19215 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
19216 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
19217 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
19218 You could elide it if you want to.
19219
19220 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
19221 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
19222 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
19223 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
19224
19225 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
19226 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
19227 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
19228
19229 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
19230 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
19231
19232 @smallexample
19233 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
19234 @end smallexample
19235
19236 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
19237 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
19238
19239 @pindex pidof
19240 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
19241 @code{pidof} utility:
19242
19243 @smallexample
19244 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
19245 @end smallexample
19246
19247 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
19248 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
19249 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
19250
19251 @subsubsection Multi-Process Mode for @code{gdbserver}
19252 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, multiple processes
19253 @cindex multiple processes with @code{gdbserver}
19254
19255 When you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target remote},
19256 @code{gdbserver} debugs the specified program only once. When the
19257 program exits, or you detach from it, @value{GDBN} closes the connection
19258 and @code{gdbserver} exits.
19259
19260 If you connect using @kbd{target extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver}
19261 enters multi-process mode. When the debugged program exits, or you
19262 detach from it, @value{GDBN} stays connected to @code{gdbserver} even
19263 though no program is running. The @code{run} and @code{attach}
19264 commands instruct @code{gdbserver} to run or attach to a new program.
19265 The @code{run} command uses @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set
19266 remote exec-file}) to select the program to run. Command line
19267 arguments are supported, except for wildcard expansion and I/O
19268 redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
19269
19270 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
19271 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
19272 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
19273 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
19274 the program you want to debug.
19275
19276 In multi-process mode @code{gdbserver} does not automatically exit unless you
19277 use the option @option{--once}. You can terminate it by using
19278 @code{monitor exit} (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}). Note that the
19279 conditions under which @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN}
19280 connects to it (@kbd{target remote} or @kbd{target extended-remote}). The
19281 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
19282
19283 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
19284
19285 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP port.
19286
19287 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
19288 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
19289 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
19290 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
19291 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
19292 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
19293 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
19294 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
19295
19296 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
19297 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
19298 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
19299
19300 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
19301 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
19302 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
19303 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
19304 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
19305 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
19306 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
19307 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
19308 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
19309 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
19310 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
19311 instance closes its port after the first connection.
19312
19313 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
19314 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
19315
19316 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19317 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
19318 status information about the debugging process.
19319 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
19320 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
19321 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
19322 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
19323
19324 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
19325 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
19326 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
19327 Possible options are:
19328
19329 @table @code
19330 @item none
19331 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19332 @item all
19333 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19334 @item timestamps
19335 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19336 @end table
19337
19338 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19339 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19340
19341 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
19342 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
19343 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
19344 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
19345 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
19346
19347 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
19348 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
19349 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
19350 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
19351
19352 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
19353 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
19354 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
19355 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
19356
19357 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
19358 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
19359 environment:
19360
19361 @smallexample
19362 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
19363 @end smallexample
19364
19365 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
19366
19367 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
19368
19369 First make sure you have the necessary symbol files. Load symbols for
19370 your application using the @code{file} command before you connect. Use
19371 @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN}
19372 was compiled with the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}).
19373
19374 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
19375 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
19376 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
19377 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
19378 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
19379 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
19380 programs.
19381
19382 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
19383 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
19384 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
19385 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
19386 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
19387 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{gdbserver}, since the program is
19388 already on the target.
19389
19390 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
19391 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
19392 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
19393
19394 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
19395 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
19396 Here are the available commands.
19397
19398 @table @code
19399 @item monitor help
19400 List the available monitor commands.
19401
19402 @item monitor set debug 0
19403 @itemx monitor set debug 1
19404 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
19405
19406 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
19407 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
19408 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
19409 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
19410
19411 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
19412 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
19413 Possible options are:
19414
19415 @table @code
19416 @item none
19417 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
19418 @item all
19419 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
19420 @item timestamps
19421 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
19422 @end table
19423
19424 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
19425 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
19426
19427 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
19428 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
19429 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19430 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
19431 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
19432 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
19433
19434 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
19435 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
19436
19437 @item monitor exit
19438 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
19439 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
19440 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
19441 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
19442 of a multi-process mode debug session.
19443
19444 @end table
19445
19446 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19447 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
19448
19449 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
19450 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
19451
19452 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
19453 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
19454 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
19455 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
19456 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
19457 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
19458 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
19459 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
19460 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
19461 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
19462 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
19463 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
19464
19465 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
19466
19467 @table @code
19468 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
19469
19470 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
19471 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
19472 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
19473
19474 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
19475
19476 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
19477 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
19478 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
19479 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
19480 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
19481 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
19482
19483 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
19484
19485 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
19486 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
19487 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
19488 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
19489 command for that. For example:
19490
19491 @smallexample
19492 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
19493 @end smallexample
19494
19495 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
19496 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
19497 @end table
19498
19499 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
19500 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
19501 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
19502 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
19503 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
19504 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
19505 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
19506 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
19507 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
19508 @code{gdbserver} like so:
19509
19510 @smallexample
19511 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
19512 @end smallexample
19513
19514 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
19515
19516 @smallexample
19517 $ gdb myprogram
19518 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
19519 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
19520 (@value{GDBP}) b main
19521 (@value{GDBP}) continue
19522 @end smallexample
19523
19524 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
19525 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
19526 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
19527 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
19528 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
19529 tracing.
19530
19531 @node Remote Configuration
19532 @section Remote Configuration
19533
19534 @kindex set remote
19535 @kindex show remote
19536 This section documents the configuration options available when
19537 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
19538 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
19539 system-call-allowed}.
19540
19541 @table @code
19542 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
19543 @cindex address size for remote targets
19544 @cindex bits in remote address
19545 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
19546 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
19547 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
19548 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
19549
19550 @item show remoteaddresssize
19551 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
19552
19553 @item set serial baud @var{n}
19554 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
19555 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
19556 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
19557 remote targets.
19558
19559 @item show serial baud
19560 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
19561
19562 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
19563 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
19564 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
19565
19566 @item show serial parity
19567 Show the current parity of the serial port.
19568
19569 @item set remotebreak
19570 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19571 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
19572 @anchor{set remotebreak}
19573 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
19574 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
19575 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
19576 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
19577 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
19578
19579 @item show remotebreak
19580 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
19581 interrupt the remote program.
19582
19583 @item set remoteflow on
19584 @itemx set remoteflow off
19585 @kindex set remoteflow
19586 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
19587 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
19588
19589 @item show remoteflow
19590 @kindex show remoteflow
19591 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
19592
19593 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
19594 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
19595 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
19596 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
19597 @code{ascii}.
19598
19599 @item show remotelogbase
19600 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
19601 protocol.
19602
19603 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
19604 @cindex record serial communications on file
19605 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
19606 default is not to record at all.
19607
19608 @item show remotelogfile.
19609 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
19610 serial communications.
19611
19612 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
19613 @cindex timeout for serial communications
19614 @cindex remote timeout
19615 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
19616 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
19617
19618 @item show remotetimeout
19619 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
19620 responses.
19621
19622 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
19623 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
19624 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
19625 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
19626 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
19627 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
19628 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
19629 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
19630
19631 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
19632 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
19633 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
19634 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
19635 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum length of
19636 a remote hardware watchpoint. A limit of -1, the default, is treated
19637 as unlimited.
19638
19639 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
19640 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
19641 a remote hardware watchpoint.
19642
19643 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
19644 @itemx show remote exec-file
19645 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
19646 @cindex executable file, for remote target
19647 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
19648 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
19649 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
19650 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
19651
19652 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
19653 @cindex interrupt remote programs
19654 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
19655 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
19656 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
19657 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
19658 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
19659 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
19660 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
19661 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
19662
19663 @item show interrupt-sequence
19664 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
19665 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
19666 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
19667 also known as Magic SysRq g.
19668
19669 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
19670 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
19671 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
19672 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
19673 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
19674 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
19675
19676 @item show interrupt-on-connect
19677 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
19678 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
19679
19680 @kindex set tcp
19681 @kindex show tcp
19682 @item set tcp auto-retry on
19683 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
19684 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
19685 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
19686 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
19687 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
19688 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
19689 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
19690 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
19691
19692 @item set tcp auto-retry off
19693 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
19694
19695 @item show tcp auto-retry
19696 Show the current auto-retry setting.
19697
19698 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
19699 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
19700 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
19701 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
19702 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
19703 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
19704 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
19705 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
19706 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
19707 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
19708 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
19709
19710 @item show tcp connect-timeout
19711 Show the current connection timeout setting.
19712 @end table
19713
19714 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
19715 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
19716 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
19717 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
19718 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
19719 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
19720 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
19721 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
19722 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
19723
19724 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
19725 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
19726 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
19727 @value{GDBN} developers.
19728
19729 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
19730 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
19731 are:
19732
19733 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
19734 @item Command Name
19735 @tab Remote Packet
19736 @tab Related Features
19737
19738 @item @code{fetch-register}
19739 @tab @code{p}
19740 @tab @code{info registers}
19741
19742 @item @code{set-register}
19743 @tab @code{P}
19744 @tab @code{set}
19745
19746 @item @code{binary-download}
19747 @tab @code{X}
19748 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
19749
19750 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
19751 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
19752 @tab @code{info auxv}
19753
19754 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
19755 @tab @code{qSymbol}
19756 @tab Detecting multiple threads
19757
19758 @item @code{attach}
19759 @tab @code{vAttach}
19760 @tab @code{attach}
19761
19762 @item @code{verbose-resume}
19763 @tab @code{vCont}
19764 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
19765
19766 @item @code{run}
19767 @tab @code{vRun}
19768 @tab @code{run}
19769
19770 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
19771 @tab @code{Z0}
19772 @tab @code{break}
19773
19774 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
19775 @tab @code{Z1}
19776 @tab @code{hbreak}
19777
19778 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
19779 @tab @code{Z2}
19780 @tab @code{watch}
19781
19782 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
19783 @tab @code{Z3}
19784 @tab @code{rwatch}
19785
19786 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
19787 @tab @code{Z4}
19788 @tab @code{awatch}
19789
19790 @item @code{target-features}
19791 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
19792 @tab @code{set architecture}
19793
19794 @item @code{library-info}
19795 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
19796 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
19797
19798 @item @code{memory-map}
19799 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
19800 @tab @code{info mem}
19801
19802 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
19803 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
19804 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
19805
19806 @item @code{read-spu-object}
19807 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
19808 @tab @code{info spu}
19809
19810 @item @code{write-spu-object}
19811 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
19812 @tab @code{info spu}
19813
19814 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
19815 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
19816 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
19817
19818 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
19819 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
19820 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
19821
19822 @item @code{threads}
19823 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
19824 @tab @code{info threads}
19825
19826 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
19827 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
19828 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
19829
19830 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
19831 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
19832 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
19833
19834 @item @code{search-memory}
19835 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
19836 @tab @code{find}
19837
19838 @item @code{supported-packets}
19839 @tab @code{qSupported}
19840 @tab Remote communications parameters
19841
19842 @item @code{pass-signals}
19843 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
19844 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19845
19846 @item @code{program-signals}
19847 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
19848 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
19849
19850 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
19851 @tab @code{vFile:close}
19852 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19853
19854 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
19855 @tab @code{vFile:open}
19856 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19857
19858 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
19859 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
19860 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19861
19862 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
19863 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
19864 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
19865
19866 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
19867 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
19868 @tab @code{remote delete}
19869
19870 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
19871 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
19872 @tab Host I/O
19873
19874 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
19875 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
19876 @tab Host I/O
19877
19878 @item @code{noack-packet}
19879 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
19880 @tab Packet acknowledgment
19881
19882 @item @code{osdata}
19883 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
19884 @tab @code{info os}
19885
19886 @item @code{query-attached}
19887 @tab @code{qAttached}
19888 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
19889
19890 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
19891 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
19892 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
19893
19894 @item @code{trace-status}
19895 @tab @code{qTStatus}
19896 @tab @code{tstatus}
19897
19898 @item @code{traceframe-info}
19899 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
19900 @tab Traceframe info
19901
19902 @item @code{install-in-trace}
19903 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
19904 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
19905
19906 @item @code{disable-randomization}
19907 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
19908 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
19909
19910 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
19911 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
19912 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
19913
19914 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
19915 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
19916 @tab @code{break}
19917
19918 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
19919 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
19920 @tab @code{hbreak}
19921
19922 @end multitable
19923
19924 @node Remote Stub
19925 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
19926
19927 @cindex debugging stub, example
19928 @cindex remote stub, example
19929 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
19930 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
19931 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
19932 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
19933 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
19934 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
19935 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
19936 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
19937
19938 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
19939 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
19940 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
19941 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
19942 program, you need:
19943
19944 @enumerate
19945 @item
19946 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
19947 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
19948 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
19949
19950 @item
19951 A C subroutine library to support your program's
19952 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
19953
19954 @item
19955 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
19956 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
19957 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
19958 documentation.
19959 @end enumerate
19960
19961 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
19962 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
19963 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
19964
19965 @table @emph
19966 @item On the host,
19967 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
19968 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
19969 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
19970
19971 @item On the target,
19972 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
19973 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
19974 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
19975
19976 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
19977 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
19978 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
19979 @end table
19980
19981 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
19982 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
19983 @sc{sparc} boards.
19984
19985 @cindex remote serial stub list
19986 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
19987
19988 @table @code
19989
19990 @item i386-stub.c
19991 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
19992 @cindex Intel
19993 @cindex i386
19994 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
19995
19996 @item m68k-stub.c
19997 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
19998 @cindex Motorola 680x0
19999 @cindex m680x0
20000 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
20001
20002 @item sh-stub.c
20003 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
20004 @cindex Renesas
20005 @cindex SH
20006 For Renesas SH architectures.
20007
20008 @item sparc-stub.c
20009 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
20010 @cindex Sparc
20011 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
20012
20013 @item sparcl-stub.c
20014 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
20015 @cindex Fujitsu
20016 @cindex SparcLite
20017 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
20018
20019 @end table
20020
20021 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
20022 recently added stubs.
20023
20024 @menu
20025 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
20026 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
20027 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
20028 @end menu
20029
20030 @node Stub Contents
20031 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
20032
20033 @cindex remote serial stub
20034 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
20035 subroutines:
20036
20037 @table @code
20038 @item set_debug_traps
20039 @findex set_debug_traps
20040 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
20041 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
20042 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
20043 program's startup code.
20044
20045 @item handle_exception
20046 @findex handle_exception
20047 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
20048 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
20049 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
20050 run when a trap is triggered.
20051
20052 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
20053 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
20054 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
20055 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
20056 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
20057 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
20058 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
20059 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
20060 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
20061 machine.
20062
20063 @item breakpoint
20064 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
20065 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
20066 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
20067 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
20068 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
20069 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
20070 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
20071 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
20072 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
20073 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
20074 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
20075
20076 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
20077 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
20078 start of your debugging session.
20079 @end table
20080
20081 @node Bootstrapping
20082 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
20083
20084 @cindex remote stub, support routines
20085 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
20086 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
20087 debugging target machine.
20088
20089 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
20090 serial port.
20091
20092 @table @code
20093 @item int getDebugChar()
20094 @findex getDebugChar
20095 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
20096 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
20097 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20098
20099 @item void putDebugChar(int)
20100 @findex putDebugChar
20101 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
20102 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
20103 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
20104 @end table
20105
20106 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
20107 @cindex interrupting remote targets
20108 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
20109 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
20110 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
20111 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
20112 remote system to stop.
20113
20114 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
20115 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
20116 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
20117 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
20118
20119 Other routines you need to supply are:
20120
20121 @table @code
20122 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
20123 @findex exceptionHandler
20124 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
20125 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
20126 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
20127 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
20128 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
20129 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
20130 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
20131 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
20132 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
20133 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
20134 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
20135 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
20136 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
20137
20138 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
20139 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
20140 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
20141 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
20142 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
20143
20144 @item void flush_i_cache()
20145 @findex flush_i_cache
20146 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
20147 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
20148 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
20149
20150 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
20151 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
20152 @end table
20153
20154 @noindent
20155 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
20156
20157 @table @code
20158 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
20159 @findex memset
20160 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
20161 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
20162 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
20163 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
20164 @end table
20165
20166 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
20167 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
20168 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
20169 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
20170
20171
20172 @node Debug Session
20173 @subsection Putting it All Together
20174
20175 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
20176 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
20177 steps.
20178
20179 @enumerate
20180 @item
20181 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
20182 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
20183 @display
20184 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
20185 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
20186 @end display
20187
20188 @item
20189 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
20190 procedure is called:
20191
20192 @smallexample
20193 set_debug_traps();
20194 breakpoint();
20195 @end smallexample
20196
20197 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
20198 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
20199 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
20200 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
20201 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
20202 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
20203 progress.
20204
20205 @item
20206 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
20207 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
20208
20209 @smallexample
20210 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
20211 @end smallexample
20212
20213 @noindent
20214 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
20215 function in your program, that function is called when
20216 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
20217 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
20218 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
20219
20220 @item
20221 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
20222 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
20223
20224 @item
20225 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
20226 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
20227
20228 @item
20229 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
20230 @c document that. FIXME.
20231 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
20232 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
20233
20234 @item
20235 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
20236 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
20237
20238 @end enumerate
20239
20240 @node Configurations
20241 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
20242
20243 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
20244 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
20245 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
20246
20247 There are three major categories of configurations: native
20248 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
20249 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
20250 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
20251 are quite different from each other.
20252
20253 @menu
20254 * Native::
20255 * Embedded OS::
20256 * Embedded Processors::
20257 * Architectures::
20258 @end menu
20259
20260 @node Native
20261 @section Native
20262
20263 This section describes details specific to particular native
20264 configurations.
20265
20266 @menu
20267 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
20268 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
20269 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
20270 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
20271 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
20272 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
20273 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
20274 @end menu
20275
20276 @node HP-UX
20277 @subsection HP-UX
20278
20279 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
20280 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
20281 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
20282
20283
20284 @node BSD libkvm Interface
20285 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
20286
20287 @cindex libkvm
20288 @cindex kernel memory image
20289 @cindex kernel crash dump
20290
20291 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
20292 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
20293 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
20294 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
20295 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
20296 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
20297 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
20298 @code{kvm} target:
20299
20300 @smallexample
20301 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
20302 @end smallexample
20303
20304 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
20305 argument:
20306
20307 @smallexample
20308 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
20309 @end smallexample
20310
20311 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
20312 available:
20313
20314 @table @code
20315 @kindex kvm
20316 @item kvm pcb
20317 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
20318
20319 @item kvm proc
20320 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
20321 modern FreeBSD systems.
20322 @end table
20323
20324 @node SVR4 Process Information
20325 @subsection SVR4 Process Information
20326 @cindex /proc
20327 @cindex examine process image
20328 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
20329
20330 Many versions of SVR4 and compatible systems provide a facility called
20331 @samp{/proc} that can be used to examine the image of a running
20332 process using file-system subroutines.
20333
20334 If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with this
20335 facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report
20336 information about the process running your program, or about any
20337 process running on your system. This includes, as of this writing,
20338 @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris, but not HP-UX, for example.
20339
20340 This command may also work on core files that were created on a system
20341 that has the @samp{/proc} facility.
20342
20343 @table @code
20344 @kindex info proc
20345 @cindex process ID
20346 @item info proc
20347 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
20348 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
20349 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
20350 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
20351 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
20352 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
20353 executable file's absolute file name.
20354
20355 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
20356 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
20357 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
20358 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
20359 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
20360 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
20361
20362 @item info proc cmdline
20363 @cindex info proc cmdline
20364 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
20365 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20366
20367 @item info proc cwd
20368 @cindex info proc cwd
20369 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
20370 specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20371
20372 @item info proc exe
20373 @cindex info proc exe
20374 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is specific
20375 to @sc{gnu}/Linux.
20376
20377 @item info proc mappings
20378 @cindex memory address space mappings
20379 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program, with
20380 information on whether the process has read, write, or execute access
20381 rights to each range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, each memory range
20382 includes the object file which is mapped to that range, instead of the
20383 memory access rights to that range.
20384
20385 @item info proc stat
20386 @itemx info proc status
20387 @cindex process detailed status information
20388 These subcommands are specific to @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. They show
20389 the process-related information, including the user ID and group ID;
20390 how many threads are there in the process; its virtual memory usage;
20391 the signals that are pending, blocked, and ignored; its TTY; its
20392 consumption of system and user time; its stack size; its @samp{nice}
20393 value; etc. For more information, see the @samp{proc} man page
20394 (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
20395
20396 @item info proc all
20397 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
20398 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
20399
20400 @ignore
20401 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
20402 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
20403 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
20404 @kindex info proc times
20405 @item info proc times
20406 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
20407 its children.
20408
20409 @kindex info proc id
20410 @item info proc id
20411 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
20412 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
20413 @end ignore
20414
20415 @item set procfs-trace
20416 @kindex set procfs-trace
20417 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
20418 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
20419
20420 @item show procfs-trace
20421 @kindex show procfs-trace
20422 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
20423
20424 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
20425 @kindex set procfs-file
20426 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
20427 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
20428 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
20429 standard output.
20430
20431 @item show procfs-file
20432 @kindex show procfs-file
20433 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
20434
20435 @item proc-trace-entry
20436 @itemx proc-trace-exit
20437 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
20438 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
20439 @kindex proc-trace-entry
20440 @kindex proc-trace-exit
20441 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
20442 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
20443 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
20444 from the @code{syscall} interface.
20445
20446 @item info pidlist
20447 @kindex info pidlist
20448 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
20449 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
20450 processes and all the threads within each process.
20451
20452 @item info meminfo
20453 @kindex info meminfo
20454 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
20455 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
20456 @end table
20457
20458 @node DJGPP Native
20459 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
20460 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
20461 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
20462 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
20463
20464 @cindex DPMI
20465 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
20466 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
20467 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
20468 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
20469
20470 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
20471 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
20472 subsection describes those commands.
20473
20474 @table @code
20475 @kindex info dos
20476 @item info dos
20477 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
20478 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20479
20480 @kindex sysinfo
20481 @cindex MS-DOS system info
20482 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
20483 @item info dos sysinfo
20484 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
20485 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
20486 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
20487
20488 @cindex GDT
20489 @cindex LDT
20490 @cindex IDT
20491 @cindex segment descriptor tables
20492 @cindex descriptor tables display
20493 @item info dos gdt
20494 @itemx info dos ldt
20495 @itemx info dos idt
20496 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
20497 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
20498 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
20499 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
20500 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
20501 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
20502 rights.
20503
20504 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
20505 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
20506 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
20507 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
20508 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
20509
20510 @cindex garbled pointers
20511 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
20512 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
20513 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
20514 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
20515 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
20516 debugged program's data segment:
20517
20518 @smallexample
20519 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
20520 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
20521 @end smallexample
20522
20523 @noindent
20524 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
20525 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
20526
20527 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
20528 @item info dos pde
20529 @itemx info dos pte
20530 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
20531 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
20532 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
20533 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
20534 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
20535 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
20536 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
20537 that is currently in use.
20538
20539 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
20540 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
20541 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
20542 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
20543 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
20544 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
20545 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
20546
20547 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
20548 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
20549 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
20550 controller.
20551
20552 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
20553
20554 @cindex physical address from linear address
20555 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
20556 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
20557 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
20558 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
20559 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
20560 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
20561 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
20562
20563 @smallexample
20564 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
20565 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
20566 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
20567 @end smallexample
20568
20569 @noindent
20570 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
20571 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
20572 attributes of that page.
20573
20574 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
20575 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
20576 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
20577 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
20578 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
20579 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
20580
20581 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
20582 transfer buffer:
20583
20584 @smallexample
20585 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
20586 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
20587 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
20588 @end smallexample
20589
20590 @noindent
20591 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
20592 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
20593 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
20594 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
20595 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
20596
20597 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
20598 @end table
20599
20600 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
20601 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
20602 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
20603 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
20604
20605 @table @code
20606 @kindex set com1base
20607 @kindex set com1irq
20608 @kindex set com2base
20609 @kindex set com2irq
20610 @kindex set com3base
20611 @kindex set com3irq
20612 @kindex set com4base
20613 @kindex set com4irq
20614 @item set com1base @var{addr}
20615 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
20616 port.
20617
20618 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
20619 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
20620 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
20621
20622 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
20623 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
20624 other 3 COM ports.
20625
20626 @kindex show com1base
20627 @kindex show com1irq
20628 @kindex show com2base
20629 @kindex show com2irq
20630 @kindex show com3base
20631 @kindex show com3irq
20632 @kindex show com4base
20633 @kindex show com4irq
20634 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
20635 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
20636 lines used by the COM ports.
20637
20638 @item info serial
20639 @kindex info serial
20640 @cindex DOS serial port status
20641 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
20642 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
20643 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
20644 counts of various errors encountered so far.
20645 @end table
20646
20647
20648 @node Cygwin Native
20649 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
20650 @cindex MS Windows debugging
20651 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
20652 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
20653
20654 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
20655 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
20656
20657 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
20658 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
20659 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
20660 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
20661 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
20662 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
20663 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
20664 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
20665
20666 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
20667 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
20668 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
20669
20670 @table @code
20671 @kindex info w32
20672 @item info w32
20673 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
20674 information about the target system and important OS structures.
20675
20676 @item info w32 selector
20677 This command displays information returned by
20678 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
20679 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
20680 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
20681 Without argument, this command displays information
20682 about the six segment registers.
20683
20684 @item info w32 thread-information-block
20685 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
20686 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
20687 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
20688
20689 @kindex info dll
20690 @item info dll
20691 This is a Cygwin-specific alias of @code{info shared}.
20692
20693 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
20694 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
20695 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
20696 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
20697 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
20698 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
20699 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
20700 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
20701 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
20702 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
20703 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
20704
20705 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
20706 @item show cygwin-exceptions
20707 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
20708 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
20709
20710 @kindex set new-console
20711 @item set new-console @var{mode}
20712 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
20713 be started in a new console on next start.
20714 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
20715 be started in the same console as the debugger.
20716
20717 @kindex show new-console
20718 @item show new-console
20719 Displays whether a new console is used
20720 when the debuggee is started.
20721
20722 @kindex set new-group
20723 @item set new-group @var{mode}
20724 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
20725 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
20726 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
20727 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
20728
20729 @kindex show new-group
20730 @item show new-group
20731 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
20732
20733 @kindex set debugevents
20734 @item set debugevents
20735 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
20736 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
20737 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
20738 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
20739 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
20740
20741 @kindex set debugexec
20742 @item set debugexec
20743 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
20744 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
20745
20746 @kindex set debugexceptions
20747 @item set debugexceptions
20748 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
20749 debuggee seen by the debugger.
20750
20751 @kindex set debugmemory
20752 @item set debugmemory
20753 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
20754 and writes by the debugger.
20755
20756 @kindex set shell
20757 @item set shell
20758 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
20759 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
20760
20761 @kindex show shell
20762 @item show shell
20763 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
20764
20765 @end table
20766
20767 @menu
20768 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
20769 @end menu
20770
20771 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
20772 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
20773 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
20774 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
20775
20776 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
20777 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
20778 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
20779 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
20780 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
20781 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
20782 ``minimal symbols''.
20783
20784 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
20785 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
20786 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
20787 program run once to completion.
20788
20789 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
20790
20791 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
20792 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
20793 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
20794 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
20795 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
20796 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
20797 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
20798 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
20799 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
20800
20801 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
20802 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
20803 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
20804 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
20805 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
20806 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
20807
20808 @smallexample
20809 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
20810 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
20811
20812 Non-debugging symbols:
20813 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
20814 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
20815 @end smallexample
20816
20817 @smallexample
20818 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
20819 All functions matching regular expression "!":
20820
20821 Non-debugging symbols:
20822 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
20823 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
20824 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
20825 [etc...]
20826 @end smallexample
20827
20828 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
20829
20830 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
20831 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
20832 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
20833 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
20834 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
20835 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
20836 a function within a DLL without a running program.
20837
20838 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
20839 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
20840 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
20841 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
20842 problem:
20843
20844 @smallexample
20845 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
20846 $1 = 268572168
20847 @end smallexample
20848
20849 @smallexample
20850 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
20851 0x10021610: "\230y\""
20852 @end smallexample
20853
20854 And two possible solutions:
20855
20856 @smallexample
20857 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
20858 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20859 @end smallexample
20860
20861 @smallexample
20862 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
20863 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
20864 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
20865 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
20866 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
20867 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
20868 @end smallexample
20869
20870 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
20871 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
20872 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
20873 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
20874 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
20875
20876 @smallexample
20877 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
20878 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
20879 @end smallexample
20880
20881 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
20882 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
20883 safe.
20884
20885 @node Hurd Native
20886 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
20887 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
20888
20889 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
20890 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
20891
20892 @table @code
20893 @item set signals
20894 @itemx set sigs
20895 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
20896 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20897 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
20898 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
20899 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
20900 @code{signals}.
20901
20902 @item show signals
20903 @itemx show sigs
20904 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
20905 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
20906 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
20907
20908 @item set signal-thread
20909 @itemx set sigthread
20910 @kindex set signal-thread
20911 @kindex set sigthread
20912 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
20913 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
20914 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
20915 signal-thread}.
20916
20917 @item show signal-thread
20918 @itemx show sigthread
20919 @kindex show signal-thread
20920 @kindex show sigthread
20921 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
20922 delivered a signal.
20923
20924 @item set stopped
20925 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20926 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
20927 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
20928 continued by delivering a signal to it.
20929
20930 @item show stopped
20931 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
20932 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
20933 stopped.
20934
20935 @item set exceptions
20936 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20937 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
20938 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
20939 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
20940 trapping on.
20941
20942 @item show exceptions
20943 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
20944 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
20945
20946 @item set task pause
20947 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
20948 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20949 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
20950 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
20951 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
20952 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
20953 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
20954 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
20955 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
20956
20957 @item show task pause
20958 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
20959 Show the current state of task suspension.
20960
20961 @item set task detach-suspend-count
20962 @cindex task suspend count
20963 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20964 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
20965 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
20966
20967 @item show task detach-suspend-count
20968 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
20969
20970 @item set task exception-port
20971 @itemx set task excp
20972 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20973 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
20974 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
20975 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
20976
20977 @item set noninvasive
20978 @cindex noninvasive task options
20979 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
20980 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
20981 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
20982 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
20983
20984 @item info send-rights
20985 @itemx info receive-rights
20986 @itemx info port-rights
20987 @itemx info port-sets
20988 @itemx info dead-names
20989 @itemx info ports
20990 @itemx info psets
20991 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20992 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20993 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20994 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20995 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
20996 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
20997 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
20998 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
20999 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
21000
21001 @item set thread pause
21002 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
21003 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21004 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
21005 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
21006 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
21007 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
21008 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
21009 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
21010 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
21011 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
21012 only the current thread.
21013
21014 @item show thread pause
21015 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
21016 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
21017
21018 @item set thread run
21019 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21020
21021 @item show thread run
21022 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
21023
21024 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
21025 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21026 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21027 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
21028 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
21029 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
21030 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
21031
21032 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
21033 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
21034 detaching.
21035
21036 @item set thread exception-port
21037 @itemx set thread excp
21038 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
21039 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
21040 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
21041
21042 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
21043 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
21044 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
21045 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
21046
21047 @item set thread default
21048 @itemx show thread default
21049 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
21050 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
21051 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
21052 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
21053 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
21054 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
21055 the non-default commands.
21056 @end table
21057
21058 @node Darwin
21059 @subsection Darwin
21060 @cindex Darwin
21061
21062 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
21063
21064 @table @code
21065 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
21066 @kindex set debug darwin
21067 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
21068 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
21069
21070 @item show debug darwin
21071 @kindex show debug darwin
21072 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
21073
21074 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
21075 @kindex set debug mach-o
21076 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
21077 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
21078 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
21079 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
21080 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
21081 usage.
21082
21083 @item show debug mach-o
21084 @kindex show debug mach-o
21085 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
21086
21087 @item set mach-exceptions on
21088 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
21089 @kindex set mach-exceptions
21090 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
21091 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
21092 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
21093 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
21094
21095 @item show mach-exceptions
21096 @kindex show mach-exceptions
21097 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
21098 @end table
21099
21100
21101 @node Embedded OS
21102 @section Embedded Operating Systems
21103
21104 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
21105 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
21106 architectures.
21107
21108 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
21109 various real-time operating systems.
21110
21111 @node Embedded Processors
21112 @section Embedded Processors
21113
21114 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
21115 configurations.
21116
21117 @cindex send command to simulator
21118 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
21119 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
21120
21121 @table @code
21122 @item sim @var{command}
21123 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
21124 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
21125 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
21126 acceptable commands.
21127 @end table
21128
21129
21130 @menu
21131 * ARM:: ARM RDI
21132 * M32R/D:: Renesas M32R/D
21133 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
21134 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
21135 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
21136 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
21137 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
21138 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
21139 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
21140 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
21141 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
21142 * CRIS:: CRIS
21143 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
21144 @end menu
21145
21146 @node ARM
21147 @subsection ARM
21148 @cindex ARM RDI
21149
21150 @table @code
21151 @kindex target rdi
21152 @item target rdi @var{dev}
21153 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
21154 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
21155 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
21156
21157 @kindex target rdp
21158 @item target rdp @var{dev}
21159 ARM Demon monitor.
21160
21161 @end table
21162
21163 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
21164
21165 @table @code
21166 @item set arm disassembler
21167 @kindex set arm
21168 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
21169 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
21170
21171 @item show arm disassembler
21172 @kindex show arm
21173 Show the current disassembly style.
21174
21175 @item set arm apcs32
21176 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
21177 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
21178
21179 @item show arm apcs32
21180 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
21181
21182 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
21183 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
21184 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
21185
21186 @table @code
21187 @item auto
21188 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
21189 @item softfpa
21190 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
21191 processors.
21192 @item fpa
21193 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
21194 @item softvfp
21195 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
21196 @item vfp
21197 VFP co-processor.
21198 @end table
21199
21200 @item show arm fpu
21201 Show the current type of the FPU.
21202
21203 @item set arm abi
21204 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
21205
21206 @item show arm abi
21207 Show the currently used ABI.
21208
21209 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21210 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
21211 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
21212 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
21213 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
21214 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
21215 register).
21216
21217 @item show arm fallback-mode
21218 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
21219
21220 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
21221 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
21222 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
21223 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
21224 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
21225
21226 @item show arm force-mode
21227 Show the current forced instruction mode.
21228
21229 @item set debug arm
21230 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
21231 target support subsystem.
21232
21233 @item show debug arm
21234 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
21235 @end table
21236
21237 The following commands are available when an ARM target is debugged
21238 using the RDI interface:
21239
21240 @table @code
21241 @item rdilogfile @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21242 @kindex rdilogfile
21243 @cindex ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) logging
21244 Set the filename for the ADP (Angel Debugger Protocol) packet log.
21245 With an argument, sets the log file to the specified @var{file}. With
21246 no argument, show the current log file name. The default log file is
21247 @file{rdi.log}.
21248
21249 @item rdilogenable @r{[}@var{arg}@r{]}
21250 @kindex rdilogenable
21251 Control logging of ADP packets. With an argument of 1 or @code{"yes"}
21252 enables logging, with an argument 0 or @code{"no"} disables it. With
21253 no arguments displays the current setting. When logging is enabled,
21254 ADP packets exchanged between @value{GDBN} and the RDI target device
21255 are logged to a file.
21256
21257 @item set rdiromatzero
21258 @kindex set rdiromatzero
21259 @cindex ROM at zero address, RDI
21260 Tell @value{GDBN} whether the target has ROM at address 0. If on,
21261 vector catching is disabled, so that zero address can be used. If off
21262 (the default), vector catching is enabled. For this command to take
21263 effect, it needs to be invoked prior to the @code{target rdi} command.
21264
21265 @item show rdiromatzero
21266 @kindex show rdiromatzero
21267 Show the current setting of ROM at zero address.
21268
21269 @item set rdiheartbeat
21270 @kindex set rdiheartbeat
21271 @cindex RDI heartbeat
21272 Enable or disable RDI heartbeat packets. It is not recommended to
21273 turn on this option, since it confuses ARM and EPI JTAG interface, as
21274 well as the Angel monitor.
21275
21276 @item show rdiheartbeat
21277 @kindex show rdiheartbeat
21278 Show the setting of RDI heartbeat packets.
21279 @end table
21280
21281 @table @code
21282 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21283 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
21284
21285 @table @code
21286 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
21287 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
21288 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
21289 The default value is @code{all}.
21290
21291 @table @code
21292 @item none
21293 @item demon
21294 @item angel
21295 @item redboot
21296 @item all
21297 @end table
21298 @end table
21299 @end table
21300
21301 @node M32R/D
21302 @subsection Renesas M32R/D and M32R/SDI
21303
21304 @table @code
21305 @kindex target m32r
21306 @item target m32r @var{dev}
21307 Renesas M32R/D ROM monitor.
21308
21309 @kindex target m32rsdi
21310 @item target m32rsdi @var{dev}
21311 Renesas M32R SDI server, connected via parallel port to the board.
21312 @end table
21313
21314 The following @value{GDBN} commands are specific to the M32R monitor:
21315
21316 @table @code
21317 @item set download-path @var{path}
21318 @kindex set download-path
21319 @cindex find downloadable @sc{srec} files (M32R)
21320 Set the default path for finding downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21321
21322 @item show download-path
21323 @kindex show download-path
21324 Show the default path for downloadable @sc{srec} files.
21325
21326 @item set board-address @var{addr}
21327 @kindex set board-address
21328 @cindex M32-EVA target board address
21329 Set the IP address for the M32R-EVA target board.
21330
21331 @item show board-address
21332 @kindex show board-address
21333 Show the current IP address of the target board.
21334
21335 @item set server-address @var{addr}
21336 @kindex set server-address
21337 @cindex download server address (M32R)
21338 Set the IP address for the download server, which is the @value{GDBN}'s
21339 host machine.
21340
21341 @item show server-address
21342 @kindex show server-address
21343 Display the IP address of the download server.
21344
21345 @item upload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21346 @kindex upload@r{, M32R}
21347 Upload the specified @sc{srec} @var{file} via the monitor's Ethernet
21348 upload capability. If no @var{file} argument is given, the current
21349 executable file is uploaded.
21350
21351 @item tload @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
21352 @kindex tload@r{, M32R}
21353 Test the @code{upload} command.
21354 @end table
21355
21356 The following commands are available for M32R/SDI:
21357
21358 @table @code
21359 @item sdireset
21360 @kindex sdireset
21361 @cindex reset SDI connection, M32R
21362 This command resets the SDI connection.
21363
21364 @item sdistatus
21365 @kindex sdistatus
21366 This command shows the SDI connection status.
21367
21368 @item debug_chaos
21369 @kindex debug_chaos
21370 @cindex M32R/Chaos debugging
21371 Instructs the remote that M32R/Chaos debugging is to be used.
21372
21373 @item use_debug_dma
21374 @kindex use_debug_dma
21375 Instructs the remote to use the DEBUG_DMA method of accessing memory.
21376
21377 @item use_mon_code
21378 @kindex use_mon_code
21379 Instructs the remote to use the MON_CODE method of accessing memory.
21380
21381 @item use_ib_break
21382 @kindex use_ib_break
21383 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by IB break.
21384
21385 @item use_dbt_break
21386 @kindex use_dbt_break
21387 Instructs the remote to set breakpoints by DBT.
21388 @end table
21389
21390 @node M68K
21391 @subsection M68k
21392
21393 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and a
21394 target command for the following ROM monitor.
21395
21396 @table @code
21397
21398 @kindex target dbug
21399 @item target dbug @var{dev}
21400 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
21401
21402 @end table
21403
21404 @node MicroBlaze
21405 @subsection MicroBlaze
21406 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
21407 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
21408
21409 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
21410 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
21411 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
21412 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
21413 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
21414 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
21415 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
21416 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
21417 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
21418 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
21419 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
21420
21421 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
21422
21423 @table @code
21424 @item target remote :1234
21425 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
21426 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
21427
21428 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
21429 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
21430 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
21431
21432 @item load
21433 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
21434
21435 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
21436 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
21437
21438 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
21439 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
21440 @end table
21441
21442 @node MIPS Embedded
21443 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
21444
21445 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} boards
21446 @value{GDBN} can use the @acronym{MIPS} remote debugging protocol to talk to a
21447 @acronym{MIPS} board attached to a serial line. This is available when
21448 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-elf}.
21449
21450 @need 1000
21451 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
21452
21453 @table @code
21454 @item target mips @var{port}
21455 @kindex target mips @var{port}
21456 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
21457 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
21458 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
21459 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
21460 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
21461 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
21462
21463 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
21464 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
21465 debugger:
21466
21467 @smallexample
21468 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
21469 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
21470 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
21471 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
21472 (@value{GDBP}) run
21473 @end smallexample
21474
21475 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
21476 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
21477 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
21478 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
21479 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
21480
21481 @item target pmon @var{port}
21482 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
21483 PMON ROM monitor.
21484
21485 @item target ddb @var{port}
21486 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
21487 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
21488
21489 @item target lsi @var{port}
21490 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
21491 LSI variant of PMON.
21492
21493 @kindex target r3900
21494 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
21495 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
21496
21497 @kindex target array
21498 @item target array @var{dev}
21499 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
21500
21501 @end table
21502
21503
21504 @noindent
21505 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
21506
21507 @table @code
21508 @item set mipsfpu double
21509 @itemx set mipsfpu single
21510 @itemx set mipsfpu none
21511 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
21512 @itemx show mipsfpu
21513 @kindex set mipsfpu
21514 @kindex show mipsfpu
21515 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
21516 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
21517 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
21518 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
21519 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
21520 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
21521 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
21522 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
21523 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
21524 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
21525 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
21526 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
21527 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
21528
21529 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
21530 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
21531 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
21532
21533 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
21534 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
21535
21536 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
21537 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
21538 @itemx show timeout
21539 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
21540 @cindex @code{timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21541 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, @acronym{MIPS} protocol
21542 @kindex set timeout
21543 @kindex show timeout
21544 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
21545 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
21546 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the @acronym{MIPS}
21547 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
21548 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
21549 waiting for an acknowledgment of a packet with the @code{set
21550 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
21551 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
21552 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
21553 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-elf}.)
21554
21555 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
21556 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
21557 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
21558 to run before stopping.
21559
21560 @item set syn-garbage-limit @var{num}
21561 @kindex set syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21562 @cindex synchronize with remote @acronym{MIPS} target
21563 Limit the maximum number of characters @value{GDBN} should ignore when
21564 it tries to synchronize with the remote target. The default is 10
21565 characters. Setting the limit to -1 means there's no limit.
21566
21567 @item show syn-garbage-limit
21568 @kindex show syn-garbage-limit@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21569 Show the current limit on the number of characters to ignore when
21570 trying to synchronize with the remote system.
21571
21572 @item set monitor-prompt @var{prompt}
21573 @kindex set monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21574 @cindex remote monitor prompt
21575 Tell @value{GDBN} to expect the specified @var{prompt} string from the
21576 remote monitor. The default depends on the target:
21577 @table @asis
21578 @item pmon target
21579 @samp{PMON}
21580 @item ddb target
21581 @samp{NEC010}
21582 @item lsi target
21583 @samp{PMON>}
21584 @end table
21585
21586 @item show monitor-prompt
21587 @kindex show monitor-prompt@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21588 Show the current strings @value{GDBN} expects as the prompt from the
21589 remote monitor.
21590
21591 @item set monitor-warnings
21592 @kindex set monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21593 Enable or disable monitor warnings about hardware breakpoints. This
21594 has effect only for the @code{lsi} target. When on, @value{GDBN} will
21595 display warning messages whose codes are returned by the @code{lsi}
21596 PMON monitor for breakpoint commands.
21597
21598 @item show monitor-warnings
21599 @kindex show monitor-warnings@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21600 Show the current setting of printing monitor warnings.
21601
21602 @item pmon @var{command}
21603 @kindex pmon@r{, @acronym{MIPS} remote}
21604 @cindex send PMON command
21605 This command allows sending an arbitrary @var{command} string to the
21606 monitor. The monitor must be in debug mode for this to work.
21607 @end table
21608
21609 @node PowerPC Embedded
21610 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
21611
21612 @cindex DVC register
21613 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
21614 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
21615
21616 @smallexample
21617 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
21618 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
21619 @end smallexample
21620
21621 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
21622 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
21623 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
21624 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
21625 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
21626 or newer.
21627
21628 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
21629 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
21630 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
21631 watching variables of scalar types.
21632
21633 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
21634 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
21635
21636 @smallexample
21637 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
21638 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
21639 @end smallexample
21640
21641 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
21642 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
21643
21644 @cindex ranged breakpoint
21645 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
21646 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
21647 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
21648 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
21649 use the @code{break-range} command.
21650
21651 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
21652
21653 @table @code
21654 @kindex break-range
21655 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
21656 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
21657 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
21658 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
21659 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
21660 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
21661 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
21662 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
21663 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
21664
21665 @kindex set powerpc
21666 @item set powerpc soft-float
21667 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
21668 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
21669 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
21670 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21671
21672 @item set powerpc vector-abi
21673 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
21674 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
21675 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
21676 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
21677 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
21678 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
21679 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
21680
21681 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
21682 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
21683 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
21684 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
21685 address of its first byte.
21686
21687 @kindex target dink32
21688 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
21689 DINK32 ROM monitor.
21690
21691 @kindex target ppcbug
21692 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
21693 @kindex target ppcbug1
21694 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
21695 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
21696
21697 @kindex target sds
21698 @item target sds @var{dev}
21699 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
21700 @end table
21701
21702 @cindex SDS protocol
21703 The following commands specific to the SDS protocol are supported
21704 by @value{GDBN}:
21705
21706 @table @code
21707 @item set sdstimeout @var{nsec}
21708 @kindex set sdstimeout
21709 Set the timeout for SDS protocol reads to be @var{nsec} seconds. The
21710 default is 2 seconds.
21711
21712 @item show sdstimeout
21713 @kindex show sdstimeout
21714 Show the current value of the SDS timeout.
21715
21716 @item sds @var{command}
21717 @kindex sds@r{, a command}
21718 Send the specified @var{command} string to the SDS monitor.
21719 @end table
21720
21721
21722 @node PA
21723 @subsection HP PA Embedded
21724
21725 @table @code
21726
21727 @kindex target op50n
21728 @item target op50n @var{dev}
21729 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
21730
21731 @kindex target w89k
21732 @item target w89k @var{dev}
21733 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
21734
21735 @end table
21736
21737 @node Sparclet
21738 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
21739
21740 @cindex Sparclet
21741
21742 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
21743 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
21744 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
21745 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
21746 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
21747
21748 @table @code
21749 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
21750 @kindex remotetimeout
21751 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
21752 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
21753 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
21754 @end table
21755
21756 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
21757 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
21758 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
21759 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
21760 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
21761
21762 @smallexample
21763 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
21764 @end smallexample
21765
21766 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
21767
21768 @smallexample
21769 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
21770 @end smallexample
21771
21772 @cindex running, on Sparclet
21773 Once you have set
21774 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
21775 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
21776 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
21777
21778 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
21779
21780 @smallexample
21781 (gdbslet)
21782 @end smallexample
21783
21784 @menu
21785 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
21786 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
21787 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
21788 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
21789 @end menu
21790
21791 @node Sparclet File
21792 @subsubsection Setting File to Debug
21793
21794 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
21795
21796 @smallexample
21797 (gdbslet) file prog
21798 @end smallexample
21799
21800 @need 1000
21801 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
21802 @value{GDBN} locates
21803 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
21804 path.
21805 If the file was compiled with debug information (option @samp{-g}), source
21806 files will be searched as well.
21807 @value{GDBN} locates
21808 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
21809 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}).
21810 If it fails
21811 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
21812
21813 @smallexample
21814 prog: No such file or directory.
21815 @end smallexample
21816
21817 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
21818 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
21819 @code{target} command again.
21820
21821 @node Sparclet Connection
21822 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
21823
21824 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
21825 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
21826
21827 @smallexample
21828 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
21829 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
21830 main () at ../prog.c:3
21831 @end smallexample
21832
21833 @need 750
21834 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
21835
21836 @smallexample
21837 Connected to ttya.
21838 @end smallexample
21839
21840 @node Sparclet Download
21841 @subsubsection Sparclet Download
21842
21843 @cindex download to Sparclet
21844 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
21845 you can use the @value{GDBN}
21846 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
21847 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
21848 command.
21849 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
21850 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
21851 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
21852 of each of the file's sections.
21853 For instance, if the program
21854 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
21855 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
21856
21857 @smallexample
21858 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
21859 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
21860 @end smallexample
21861
21862 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
21863 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
21864 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
21865
21866 @node Sparclet Execution
21867 @subsubsection Running and Debugging
21868
21869 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
21870 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
21871 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
21872 manual for the list of commands.
21873
21874 @smallexample
21875 (gdbslet) b main
21876 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
21877 (gdbslet) run
21878 Starting program: prog
21879 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
21880 3 char *symarg = 0;
21881 (gdbslet) step
21882 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
21883 (gdbslet)
21884 @end smallexample
21885
21886 @node Sparclite
21887 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
21888
21889 @table @code
21890
21891 @kindex target sparclite
21892 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
21893 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
21894 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
21895 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
21896 remote protocol.
21897
21898 @end table
21899
21900 @node Z8000
21901 @subsection Zilog Z8000
21902
21903 @cindex Z8000
21904 @cindex simulator, Z8000
21905 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
21906
21907 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
21908 a Z8000 simulator.
21909
21910 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
21911 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
21912 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
21913 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
21914
21915 @table @code
21916 @item target sim @var{args}
21917 @kindex sim
21918 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
21919 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
21920 options, specify them via @var{args}.
21921 @end table
21922
21923 @noindent
21924 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
21925 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
21926 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
21927 to run your program, and so on.
21928
21929 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
21930 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
21931 additional items of information as specially named registers:
21932
21933 @table @code
21934
21935 @item cycles
21936 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
21937
21938 @item insts
21939 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
21940
21941 @item time
21942 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
21943
21944 @end table
21945
21946 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
21947 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
21948 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
21949 simulated clock ticks.
21950
21951 @node AVR
21952 @subsection Atmel AVR
21953 @cindex AVR
21954
21955 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
21956 following AVR-specific commands:
21957
21958 @table @code
21959 @item info io_registers
21960 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
21961 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
21962 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
21963 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
21964 @end table
21965
21966 @node CRIS
21967 @subsection CRIS
21968 @cindex CRIS
21969
21970 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
21971 following CRIS-specific commands:
21972
21973 @table @code
21974 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
21975 @cindex CRIS version
21976 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
21977 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
21978 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
21979
21980 @item show cris-version
21981 Show the current CRIS version.
21982
21983 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
21984 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
21985 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
21986 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
21987 @code{R59}.
21988
21989 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
21990 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
21991
21992 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
21993 @cindex CRIS mode
21994 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
21995 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
21996 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
21997
21998 @item show cris-mode
21999 Show the current CRIS mode.
22000 @end table
22001
22002 @node Super-H
22003 @subsection Renesas Super-H
22004 @cindex Super-H
22005
22006 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
22007 commands:
22008
22009 @table @code
22010 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
22011 @kindex set sh calling-convention
22012 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
22013 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
22014 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
22015 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
22016 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
22017 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
22018 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
22019 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
22020 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
22021 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
22022
22023 @item show sh calling-convention
22024 @kindex show sh calling-convention
22025 Show the current calling convention setting.
22026
22027 @end table
22028
22029
22030 @node Architectures
22031 @section Architectures
22032
22033 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
22034 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
22035
22036 @menu
22037 * AArch64::
22038 * i386::
22039 * Alpha::
22040 * MIPS::
22041 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
22042 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22043 * PowerPC::
22044 * Nios II::
22045 @end menu
22046
22047 @node AArch64
22048 @subsection AArch64
22049 @cindex AArch64 support
22050
22051 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
22052 following special commands:
22053
22054 @table @code
22055 @item set debug aarch64
22056 @kindex set debug aarch64
22057 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
22058 messages are to be displayed.
22059
22060 @item show debug aarch64
22061 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
22062
22063 @end table
22064
22065 @node i386
22066 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
22067
22068 @table @code
22069 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
22070 @kindex set struct-convention
22071 @cindex struct return convention
22072 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
22073 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
22074 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
22075 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
22076 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
22077 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
22078 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
22079 be returned in a register.
22080
22081 @item show struct-convention
22082 @kindex show struct-convention
22083 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
22084 from functions.
22085 @end table
22086
22087 @subsubsection Intel(R) @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
22088 @cindex Intel(R) Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
22089
22090 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
22091 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
22092 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
22093 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
22094 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
22095 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
22096 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
22097
22098 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
22099 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
22100 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
22101 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
22102 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
22103 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
22104
22105 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
22106 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
22107 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
22108
22109 @smallexample
22110 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
22111 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
22112 @end smallexample
22113
22114 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
22115 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
22116 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
22117 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
22118 the pointer.
22119
22120 @node Alpha
22121 @subsection Alpha
22122
22123 See the following section.
22124
22125 @node MIPS
22126 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
22127
22128 @cindex stack on Alpha
22129 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
22130 @cindex Alpha stack
22131 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
22132 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
22133 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
22134 find the beginning of a function.
22135
22136 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
22137 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
22138 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
22139 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
22140 commands:
22141
22142 @table @code
22143 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
22144 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
22145 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
22146 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
22147 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
22148 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
22149 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
22150 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
22151
22152 @item show heuristic-fence-post
22153 Display the current limit.
22154 @end table
22155
22156 @noindent
22157 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
22158 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
22159
22160 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
22161 programs:
22162
22163 @table @code
22164 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
22165 @kindex set mips abi
22166 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
22167 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
22168 values of @var{arg} are:
22169
22170 @table @samp
22171 @item auto
22172 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
22173 default).
22174 @item o32
22175 @item o64
22176 @item n32
22177 @item n64
22178 @item eabi32
22179 @item eabi64
22180 @end table
22181
22182 @item show mips abi
22183 @kindex show mips abi
22184 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22185
22186 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
22187 @kindex set mips compression
22188 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
22189 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
22190 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
22191 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
22192 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
22193 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
22194 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
22195 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
22196 provided by the executable.
22197
22198 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
22199 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
22200 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
22201 identified as such.
22202
22203 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
22204 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
22205 implicitly from an executable.
22206
22207 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
22208 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
22209 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
22210 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
22211 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
22212
22213 @item show mips compression
22214 @kindex show mips compression
22215 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
22216 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
22217
22218 @item set mipsfpu
22219 @itemx show mipsfpu
22220 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
22221
22222 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
22223 @kindex set mips mask-address
22224 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
22225 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
22226 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
22227 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
22228 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
22229
22230 @item show mips mask-address
22231 @kindex show mips mask-address
22232 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
22233 not.
22234
22235 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22236 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22237 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
22238 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
22239 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
22240 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
22241
22242 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22243 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
22244 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
22245
22246 @item set debug mips
22247 @kindex set debug mips
22248 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
22249 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22250
22251 @item show debug mips
22252 @kindex show debug mips
22253 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
22254 @end table
22255
22256
22257 @node HPPA
22258 @subsection HPPA
22259 @cindex HPPA support
22260
22261 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
22262 following special commands:
22263
22264 @table @code
22265 @item set debug hppa
22266 @kindex set debug hppa
22267 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
22268 messages are to be displayed.
22269
22270 @item show debug hppa
22271 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
22272
22273 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
22274 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
22275 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
22276 given @var{address}.
22277
22278 @end table
22279
22280
22281 @node SPU
22282 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
22283 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
22284 @cindex SPU
22285
22286 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
22287 it provides the following special commands:
22288
22289 @table @code
22290 @item info spu event
22291 @kindex info spu
22292 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
22293 and pending event status.
22294
22295 @item info spu signal
22296 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
22297 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
22298 notification channels.
22299
22300 @item info spu mailbox
22301 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
22302 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
22303 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
22304
22305 @item info spu dma
22306 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22307 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22308 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22309
22310 @item info spu proxydma
22311 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
22312 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
22313 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
22314
22315 @end table
22316
22317 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
22318 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
22319 special commands:
22320
22321 @table @code
22322 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
22323 @kindex set spu
22324 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
22325 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
22326 function. The default is @code{off}.
22327
22328 @item show spu stop-on-load
22329 @kindex show spu
22330 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
22331
22332 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
22333 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
22334 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
22335 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
22336 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
22337 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
22338
22339 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
22340 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
22341
22342 @end table
22343
22344 @node PowerPC
22345 @subsection PowerPC
22346 @cindex PowerPC architecture
22347
22348 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
22349 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
22350 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
22351 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
22352 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
22353
22354 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
22355 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
22356 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
22357
22358 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
22359 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
22360
22361 @node Nios II
22362 @subsection Nios II
22363 @cindex Nios II architecture
22364
22365 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
22366 it provides the following special commands:
22367
22368 @table @code
22369
22370 @item set debug nios2
22371 @kindex set debug nios2
22372 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
22373 target code in @value{GDBN}.
22374
22375 @item show debug nios2
22376 @kindex show debug nios2
22377 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
22378 @end table
22379
22380 @node Controlling GDB
22381 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
22382
22383 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
22384 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
22385 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
22386 described here.
22387
22388 @menu
22389 * Prompt:: Prompt
22390 * Editing:: Command editing
22391 * Command History:: Command history
22392 * Screen Size:: Screen size
22393 * Numbers:: Numbers
22394 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
22395 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
22396 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
22397 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
22398 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
22399 @end menu
22400
22401 @node Prompt
22402 @section Prompt
22403
22404 @cindex prompt
22405
22406 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
22407 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
22408 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
22409 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
22410 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
22411 which one you are talking to.
22412
22413 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
22414 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
22415 or a prompt that does not.
22416
22417 @table @code
22418 @kindex set prompt
22419 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
22420 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
22421
22422 @kindex show prompt
22423 @item show prompt
22424 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
22425 @end table
22426
22427 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
22428 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
22429 are:
22430
22431 @table @code
22432 @kindex set extended-prompt
22433 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
22434 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
22435 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
22436 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
22437 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
22438 is displayed.
22439
22440 For example:
22441
22442 @smallexample
22443 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
22444 @end smallexample
22445
22446 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
22447 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
22448
22449 @kindex show extended-prompt
22450 @item show extended-prompt
22451 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
22452 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
22453 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
22454 @end table
22455
22456 @node Editing
22457 @section Command Editing
22458 @cindex readline
22459 @cindex command line editing
22460
22461 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
22462 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
22463 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
22464 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
22465 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
22466 debugging sessions.
22467
22468 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
22469 command @code{set}.
22470
22471 @table @code
22472 @kindex set editing
22473 @cindex editing
22474 @item set editing
22475 @itemx set editing on
22476 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
22477
22478 @item set editing off
22479 Disable command line editing.
22480
22481 @kindex show editing
22482 @item show editing
22483 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
22484 @end table
22485
22486 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22487 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
22488 @end ifset
22489 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22490 @xref{Command Line Editing},
22491 @end ifclear
22492 for more details about the Readline
22493 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
22494 encouraged to read that chapter.
22495
22496 @node Command History
22497 @section Command History
22498 @cindex command history
22499
22500 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
22501 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
22502 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
22503 history facility.
22504
22505 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
22506 package, to provide the history facility.
22507 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22508 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
22509 @end ifset
22510 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22511 @xref{Using History Interactively},
22512 @end ifclear
22513 for the detailed description of the History library.
22514
22515 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
22516 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
22517 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
22518 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
22519 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
22520 pressed on a line by itself.
22521
22522 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
22523 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
22524 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
22525 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
22526
22527 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
22528 history.
22529
22530 @table @code
22531 @cindex history substitution
22532 @cindex history file
22533 @kindex set history filename
22534 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
22535 @item set history filename @var{fname}
22536 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
22537 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
22538 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
22539 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
22540 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
22541 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
22542 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
22543 is not set.
22544
22545 @cindex save command history
22546 @kindex set history save
22547 @item set history save
22548 @itemx set history save on
22549 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
22550 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
22551
22552 @item set history save off
22553 Stop recording command history in a file.
22554
22555 @cindex history size
22556 @kindex set history size
22557 @cindex @env{HISTSIZE}, environment variable
22558 @item set history size @var{size}
22559 @itemx set history size unlimited
22560 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
22561 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
22562 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set. If @var{size}
22563 is @code{unlimited}, the number of commands @value{GDBN} keeps in the
22564 history list is unlimited.
22565 @end table
22566
22567 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
22568 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
22569 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
22570 @end ifset
22571 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
22572 @xref{Event Designators},
22573 @end ifclear
22574 for more details.
22575
22576 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
22577 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
22578 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
22579 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
22580 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
22581 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
22582 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
22583 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
22584
22585 The commands to control history expansion are:
22586
22587 @table @code
22588 @item set history expansion on
22589 @itemx set history expansion
22590 @kindex set history expansion
22591 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
22592
22593 @item set history expansion off
22594 Disable history expansion.
22595
22596 @c @group
22597 @kindex show history
22598 @item show history
22599 @itemx show history filename
22600 @itemx show history save
22601 @itemx show history size
22602 @itemx show history expansion
22603 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
22604 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
22605 @c @end group
22606 @end table
22607
22608 @table @code
22609 @kindex show commands
22610 @cindex show last commands
22611 @cindex display command history
22612 @item show commands
22613 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
22614
22615 @item show commands @var{n}
22616 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
22617
22618 @item show commands +
22619 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
22620 @end table
22621
22622 @node Screen Size
22623 @section Screen Size
22624 @cindex size of screen
22625 @cindex screen size
22626 @cindex pagination
22627 @cindex page size
22628 @cindex pauses in output
22629
22630 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
22631 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
22632 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
22633 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
22634 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
22635 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
22636 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
22637 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
22638
22639 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
22640 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
22641 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
22642 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
22643 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
22644 width} commands:
22645
22646 @table @code
22647 @kindex set height
22648 @kindex set width
22649 @kindex show width
22650 @kindex show height
22651 @item set height @var{lpp}
22652 @itemx set height unlimited
22653 @itemx show height
22654 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
22655 @itemx set width unlimited
22656 @itemx show width
22657 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
22658 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
22659 commands display the current settings.
22660
22661 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
22662 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
22663 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
22664 buffer.
22665
22666 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
22667 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
22668
22669 @item set pagination on
22670 @itemx set pagination off
22671 @kindex set pagination
22672 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
22673 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
22674 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
22675 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
22676
22677 @item show pagination
22678 @kindex show pagination
22679 Show the current pagination mode.
22680 @end table
22681
22682 @node Numbers
22683 @section Numbers
22684 @cindex number representation
22685 @cindex entering numbers
22686
22687 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
22688 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
22689 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
22690 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
22691 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
22692 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
22693 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
22694 both input and output with the commands described below.
22695
22696 @table @code
22697 @kindex set input-radix
22698 @item set input-radix @var{base}
22699 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
22700 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22701 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
22702 example, any of
22703
22704 @smallexample
22705 set input-radix 012
22706 set input-radix 10.
22707 set input-radix 0xa
22708 @end smallexample
22709
22710 @noindent
22711 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
22712 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
22713 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
22714 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
22715 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
22716 change the radix.
22717
22718 @kindex set output-radix
22719 @item set output-radix @var{base}
22720 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
22721 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
22722 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
22723
22724 @kindex show input-radix
22725 @item show input-radix
22726 Display the current default base for numeric input.
22727
22728 @kindex show output-radix
22729 @item show output-radix
22730 Display the current default base for numeric display.
22731
22732 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
22733 @itemx show radix
22734 @kindex set radix
22735 @kindex show radix
22736 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
22737 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
22738 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
22739 default value of 10.
22740
22741 @end table
22742
22743 @node ABI
22744 @section Configuring the Current ABI
22745
22746 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
22747 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
22748 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
22749 current ABI.
22750
22751 @cindex OS ABI
22752 @kindex set osabi
22753 @kindex show osabi
22754 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
22755
22756 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
22757 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
22758 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
22759 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
22760 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
22761 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
22762 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
22763 platform provides.
22764
22765 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
22766 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
22767 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
22768 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
22769
22770 @table @code
22771 @item show osabi
22772 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
22773
22774 @item set osabi
22775 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
22776
22777 @item set osabi @var{abi}
22778 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
22779 @end table
22780
22781 @cindex float promotion
22782
22783 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
22784 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
22785 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
22786 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
22787 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
22788 @code{double} and then passed.
22789
22790 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
22791 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
22792 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
22793
22794 @table @code
22795 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
22796 @item set coerce-float-to-double
22797 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
22798 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
22799 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
22800
22801 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
22802 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
22803 functions.
22804
22805 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
22806 @item show coerce-float-to-double
22807 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
22808 @end table
22809
22810 @kindex set cp-abi
22811 @kindex show cp-abi
22812 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
22813 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
22814 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
22815 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
22816 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
22817 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
22818 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
22819 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
22820 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
22821 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
22822 ``auto''.
22823
22824 @table @code
22825 @item show cp-abi
22826 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
22827
22828 @item set cp-abi
22829 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
22830
22831 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
22832 @itemx set cp-abi auto
22833 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
22834 @end table
22835
22836 @node Auto-loading
22837 @section Automatically loading associated files
22838 @cindex auto-loading
22839
22840 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
22841 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
22842 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
22843 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
22844 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
22845 sources).
22846
22847 @menu
22848 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
22849 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
22850
22851 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
22852 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
22853 @end menu
22854
22855 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
22856 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
22857 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
22858
22859 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
22860 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
22861 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22862
22863 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
22864 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
22865
22866 @table @code
22867 @anchor{set auto-load off}
22868 @kindex set auto-load off
22869 @item set auto-load off
22870 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
22871 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
22872 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
22873 @smallexample
22874 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
22875 @end smallexample
22876
22877 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
22878 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
22879 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
22880 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
22881 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
22882 @code{set auto-load no}.
22883
22884 @anchor{show auto-load}
22885 @kindex show auto-load
22886 @item show auto-load
22887 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
22888 or disabled.
22889
22890 @smallexample
22891 (gdb) show auto-load
22892 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
22893 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
22894 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
22895 is on.
22896 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
22897 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
22898 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22899 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
22900 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
22901 @end smallexample
22902
22903 @anchor{info auto-load}
22904 @kindex info auto-load
22905 @item info auto-load
22906 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
22907 not.
22908
22909 @smallexample
22910 (gdb) info auto-load
22911 gdb-scripts:
22912 Loaded Script
22913 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
22914 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
22915 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
22916 loaded.
22917 python-scripts:
22918 Loaded Script
22919 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
22920 @end smallexample
22921 @end table
22922
22923 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
22924
22925 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
22926 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
22927 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
22928 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
22929 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
22930 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
22931 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
22932 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22933 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22934 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22935 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22936 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
22937 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
22938 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
22939 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22940 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
22941 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22942 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
22943 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
22944 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
22945 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22946 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
22947 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22948 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
22949 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
22950 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
22951 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22952 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
22953 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
22954 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
22955 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
22956 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22957 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
22958 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22959 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
22960 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
22961 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
22962 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
22963 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
22964 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
22965 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
22966 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
22967 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
22968 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
22969 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
22970 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
22971 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
22972 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
22973 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
22974 @end multitable
22975
22976 @node Init File in the Current Directory
22977 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
22978 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
22979
22980 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
22981 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
22982 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
22983
22984 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
22985 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
22986
22987 @table @code
22988 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
22989 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
22990 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
22991 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
22992 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
22993
22994 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
22995 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
22996 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
22997 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
22998 current directory is enabled or disabled.
22999
23000 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
23001 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
23002 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
23003 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
23004 current directory have been auto-loaded.
23005 @end table
23006
23007 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
23008 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
23009 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
23010
23011 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
23012
23013 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
23014 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
23015
23016 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
23017 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
23018 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
23019 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
23020 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
23021 library.
23022
23023 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
23024 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
23025
23026 @table @code
23027 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
23028 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
23029 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
23030 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
23031
23032 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
23033 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
23034 @item show auto-load libthread-db
23035 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
23036 enabled or disabled.
23037
23038 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
23039 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
23040 @item info auto-load libthread-db
23041 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
23042 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
23043 @end table
23044
23045 @node Auto-loading safe path
23046 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
23047 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
23048
23049 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
23050 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
23051 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
23052 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
23053 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
23054
23055 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
23056 get loaded:
23057
23058 @smallexample
23059 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
23060 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
23061 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
23062 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23063 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23064 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
23065 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
23066 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
23067 @end smallexample
23068
23069 @noindent
23070 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
23071 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
23072
23073 @smallexample
23074 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
23075 @end smallexample
23076
23077 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
23078
23079 @table @code
23080 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
23081 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
23082 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
23083 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
23084 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
23085 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
23086 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
23087 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
23088 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
23089 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
23090
23091 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
23092 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
23093 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
23094
23095 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
23096 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
23097 @item show auto-load safe-path
23098 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
23099 scripts.
23100
23101 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
23102 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
23103 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
23104 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
23105 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
23106 by the host platform path separator in use.
23107 @end table
23108
23109 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
23110 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
23111 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
23112 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
23113 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
23114
23115 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
23116 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
23117 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
23118 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
23119 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
23120 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
23121 init file in the current directory
23122 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
23123
23124 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
23125 example, you could use one of the following ways:
23126
23127 @table @asis
23128 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
23129 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
23130 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
23131 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
23132
23133 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
23134 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
23135 @value{GDBN} session.
23136
23137 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
23138 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23139 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
23140 from trusted sources.
23141
23142 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
23143 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
23144 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
23145 trusted sources.
23146 @end table
23147
23148 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
23149 also suppresses any such warning messages:
23150
23151 @table @asis
23152 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
23153 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
23154
23155 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
23156 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
23157 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
23158 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
23159 @end table
23160
23161 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
23162 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
23163 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
23164 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
23165 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
23166 recommended to be entered.
23167
23168 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
23169 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
23170 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
23171
23172 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
23173 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
23174 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
23175 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
23176 be printed.
23177
23178 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
23179 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
23180 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
23181
23182 @smallexample
23183 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
23184 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
23185 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
23186 for objfile "/tmp/true".
23187 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
23188 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
23189 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
23190 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
23191 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
23192 @end smallexample
23193
23194 @table @code
23195 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
23196 @kindex set debug auto-load
23197 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
23198 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
23199
23200 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
23201 @kindex show debug auto-load
23202 @item show debug auto-load
23203 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
23204 on or off.
23205 @end table
23206
23207 @node Messages/Warnings
23208 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
23209
23210 @cindex verbose operation
23211 @cindex optional warnings
23212 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
23213 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
23214 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
23215 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
23216
23217 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
23218 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
23219 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
23220
23221 @table @code
23222 @kindex set verbose
23223 @item set verbose on
23224 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23225
23226 @item set verbose off
23227 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
23228
23229 @kindex show verbose
23230 @item show verbose
23231 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
23232 @end table
23233
23234 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
23235 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
23236 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
23237 Symbol Files}).
23238
23239 @table @code
23240
23241 @kindex set complaints
23242 @item set complaints @var{limit}
23243 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
23244 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
23245 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
23246 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
23247
23248 @kindex show complaints
23249 @item show complaints
23250 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
23251
23252 @end table
23253
23254 @anchor{confirmation requests}
23255 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
23256 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
23257 you try to run a program which is already running:
23258
23259 @smallexample
23260 (@value{GDBP}) run
23261 The program being debugged has been started already.
23262 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
23263 @end smallexample
23264
23265 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
23266 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
23267
23268 @table @code
23269
23270 @kindex set confirm
23271 @cindex flinching
23272 @cindex confirmation
23273 @cindex stupid questions
23274 @item set confirm off
23275 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
23276 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
23277 automatically disables confirmation requests.
23278
23279 @item set confirm on
23280 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
23281
23282 @kindex show confirm
23283 @item show confirm
23284 Displays state of confirmation requests.
23285
23286 @end table
23287
23288 @cindex command tracing
23289 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
23290 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
23291 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
23292 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
23293
23294 @table @code
23295 @kindex set trace-commands
23296 @cindex command scripts, debugging
23297 @item set trace-commands on
23298 Enable command tracing.
23299 @item set trace-commands off
23300 Disable command tracing.
23301 @item show trace-commands
23302 Display the current state of command tracing.
23303 @end table
23304
23305 @node Debugging Output
23306 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
23307 @cindex optional debugging messages
23308
23309 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
23310 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
23311 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
23312 section documents those commands.
23313
23314 @table @code
23315 @kindex set exec-done-display
23316 @item set exec-done-display
23317 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
23318 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
23319 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
23320 @kindex show exec-done-display
23321 @item show exec-done-display
23322 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
23323 notification.
23324 @kindex set debug
23325 @cindex ARM AArch64
23326 @item set debug aarch64
23327 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
23328 The default is off.
23329 @kindex show debug
23330 @item show debug aarch64
23331 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23332 ARM AArch64.
23333 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
23334 @cindex architecture debugging info
23335 @item set debug arch
23336 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
23337 @item show debug arch
23338 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
23339 @item set debug aix-solib
23340 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
23341 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
23342 support module. The default is off.
23343 @item show debug aix-thread
23344 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
23345 @item set debug aix-thread
23346 @cindex AIX threads
23347 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
23348 module.
23349 @item show debug aix-thread
23350 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
23351 @item set debug check-physname
23352 @cindex physname
23353 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
23354 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
23355 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
23356 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
23357 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
23358 both ways and display any discrepancies.
23359 @item show debug check-physname
23360 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
23361 @item set debug coff-pe-read
23362 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
23363 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
23364 exported symbols. The default is off.
23365 @item show debug coff-pe-read
23366 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23367 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23368 @item set debug dwarf2-die
23369 @cindex DWARF2 DIEs
23370 Dump DWARF2 DIEs after they are read in.
23371 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
23372 A value of zero turns off the display.
23373 @item show debug dwarf2-die
23374 Show the current state of DWARF2 DIE debugging.
23375 @item set debug dwarf2-read
23376 @cindex DWARF2 Reading
23377 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
23378 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
23379 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23380 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23381 @item show debug dwarf2-read
23382 Show the current state of DWARF2 reader debugging.
23383 @item set debug displaced
23384 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
23385 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
23386 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
23387 @item show debug displaced
23388 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
23389 related to displaced stepping.
23390 @item set debug event
23391 @cindex event debugging info
23392 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
23393 default is off.
23394 @item show debug event
23395 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
23396 info.
23397 @item set debug expression
23398 @cindex expression debugging info
23399 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
23400 expression parsing. The default is off.
23401 @item show debug expression
23402 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
23403 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
23404 @item set debug frame
23405 @cindex frame debugging info
23406 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
23407 default is off.
23408 @item show debug frame
23409 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
23410 info.
23411 @item set debug gnu-nat
23412 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
23413 Turns on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
23414 @item show debug gnu-nat
23415 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
23416 @item set debug infrun
23417 @cindex inferior debugging info
23418 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
23419 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
23420 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
23421 @item show debug infrun
23422 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
23423 @item set debug jit
23424 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
23425 Turns on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
23426 @item show debug jit
23427 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
23428 @item set debug lin-lwp
23429 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
23430 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
23431 Turns on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
23432 @item show debug lin-lwp
23433 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
23434 @item set debug mach-o
23435 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
23436 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
23437 processing. The default is off.
23438 @item show debug mach-o
23439 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
23440 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
23441 @item set debug notification
23442 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
23443 Turns on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
23444 The default is off.
23445 @item show debug notification
23446 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
23447 @item set debug observer
23448 @cindex observer debugging info
23449 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
23450 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
23451 @item show debug observer
23452 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
23453 @item set debug overload
23454 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
23455 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
23456 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
23457 is off.
23458 @item show debug overload
23459 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
23460 debugging info.
23461 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
23462 @cindex debug expression parser
23463 @item set debug parser
23464 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
23465 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
23466 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
23467 details. The default is off.
23468 @item show debug parser
23469 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
23470 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
23471 @cindex serial connections, debugging
23472 @cindex debug remote protocol
23473 @cindex remote protocol debugging
23474 @cindex display remote packets
23475 @item set debug remote
23476 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
23477 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
23478 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
23479 @item show debug remote
23480 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
23481 @item set debug serial
23482 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
23483 default is off.
23484 @item show debug serial
23485 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
23486 info.
23487 @item set debug solib-frv
23488 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
23489 Turns on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
23490 @item show debug solib-frv
23491 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
23492 messages.
23493 @item set debug symbol-lookup
23494 @cindex symbol lookup
23495 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
23496 The default is 0 (off).
23497 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23498 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23499 @item show debug symbol-lookup
23500 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
23501 @item set debug symfile
23502 @cindex symbol file functions
23503 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
23504 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
23505 @item show debug symfile
23506 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
23507 @item set debug symtab-create
23508 @cindex symbol table creation
23509 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
23510 The default is 0 (off).
23511 A value of 1 provides basic information.
23512 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
23513 @item show debug symtab-create
23514 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
23515 @item set debug target
23516 @cindex target debugging info
23517 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
23518 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
23519 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
23520 value of large memory transfers.
23521 @item show debug target
23522 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
23523 info.
23524 @item set debug timestamp
23525 @cindex timestampping debugging info
23526 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
23527 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
23528 message.
23529 @item show debug timestamp
23530 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
23531 debugging info.
23532 @item set debug varobj
23533 @cindex variable object debugging info
23534 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
23535 info. The default is off.
23536 @item show debug varobj
23537 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
23538 debugging info.
23539 @item set debug xml
23540 @cindex XML parser debugging
23541 Turns on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
23542 @item show debug xml
23543 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
23544 @end table
23545
23546 @node Other Misc Settings
23547 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
23548 @cindex miscellaneous settings
23549
23550 @table @code
23551 @kindex set interactive-mode
23552 @item set interactive-mode
23553 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
23554 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
23555 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
23556 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
23557 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
23558 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
23559 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
23560 is, non-interactively otherwise.
23561
23562 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
23563 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
23564 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
23565 inside a cygwin window.
23566
23567 @kindex show interactive-mode
23568 @item show interactive-mode
23569 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
23570 @end table
23571
23572 @node Extending GDB
23573 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
23574 @cindex extending GDB
23575
23576 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
23577 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
23578 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
23579 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
23580 being debugged.
23581
23582 @menu
23583 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
23584 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
23585 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
23586 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
23587 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
23588 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
23589 @end menu
23590
23591 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
23592 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
23593 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
23594 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
23595 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23596 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
23597
23598 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
23599 setting:
23600
23601 @table @code
23602 @kindex set script-extension
23603 @kindex show script-extension
23604 @item set script-extension off
23605 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
23606
23607 @item set script-extension soft
23608 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23609 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
23610 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
23611 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
23612
23613 @item set script-extension strict
23614 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
23615 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
23616 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
23617
23618 @item show script-extension
23619 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
23620
23621 @end table
23622
23623 @node Sequences
23624 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
23625
23626 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
23627 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
23628 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
23629 files.
23630
23631 @menu
23632 * Define:: How to define your own commands
23633 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
23634 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
23635 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
23636 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
23637 @end menu
23638
23639 @node Define
23640 @subsection User-defined Commands
23641
23642 @cindex user-defined command
23643 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
23644 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
23645 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
23646 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
23647 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
23648 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
23649
23650 @smallexample
23651 define adder
23652 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23653 end
23654 @end smallexample
23655
23656 @noindent
23657 To execute the command use:
23658
23659 @smallexample
23660 adder 1 2 3
23661 @end smallexample
23662
23663 @noindent
23664 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
23665 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
23666 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
23667 functions calls.
23668
23669 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
23670 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
23671 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
23672 been passed. This expands to a number in the range 0@dots{}10.
23673
23674 @smallexample
23675 define adder
23676 if $argc == 2
23677 print $arg0 + $arg1
23678 end
23679 if $argc == 3
23680 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
23681 end
23682 end
23683 @end smallexample
23684
23685 @table @code
23686
23687 @kindex define
23688 @item define @var{commandname}
23689 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
23690 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
23691 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
23692 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
23693 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
23694 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
23695
23696 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
23697 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
23698 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23699
23700 @kindex document
23701 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
23702 @item document @var{commandname}
23703 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
23704 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
23705 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
23706 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
23707 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
23708 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
23709
23710 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
23711 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
23712 does not change the documentation.
23713
23714 @kindex dont-repeat
23715 @cindex don't repeat command
23716 @item dont-repeat
23717 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
23718 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
23719 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
23720
23721 @kindex help user-defined
23722 @item help user-defined
23723 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
23724 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
23725 included (if any).
23726
23727 @kindex show user
23728 @item show user
23729 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
23730 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
23731 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
23732 definitions for all user-defined commands.
23733 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
23734
23735 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
23736 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
23737 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
23738 @item show max-user-call-depth
23739 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
23740 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
23741 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
23742 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
23743 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
23744 @end table
23745
23746 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
23747 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
23748
23749 When user-defined commands are executed, the
23750 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
23751 stops execution of the user-defined command.
23752
23753 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
23754 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
23755 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
23756 messages when used in a user-defined command.
23757
23758 @node Hooks
23759 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
23760 @cindex command hooks
23761 @cindex hooks, for commands
23762 @cindex hooks, pre-command
23763
23764 @kindex hook
23765 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
23766 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
23767 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
23768 before that command.
23769
23770 @cindex hooks, post-command
23771 @kindex hookpost
23772 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
23773 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
23774 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
23775 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
23776 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
23777
23778 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
23779 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
23780
23781 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
23782 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
23783
23784 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
23785 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
23786 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
23787 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
23788 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
23789
23790 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
23791 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
23792 you could define:
23793
23794 @smallexample
23795 define hook-stop
23796 handle SIGALRM nopass
23797 end
23798
23799 define hook-run
23800 handle SIGALRM pass
23801 end
23802
23803 define hook-continue
23804 handle SIGALRM pass
23805 end
23806 @end smallexample
23807
23808 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
23809 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
23810 you could define:
23811
23812 @smallexample
23813 define hook-echo
23814 echo <<<---
23815 end
23816
23817 define hookpost-echo
23818 echo --->>>\n
23819 end
23820
23821 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
23822 <<<---Hello World--->>>
23823 (@value{GDBP})
23824
23825 @end smallexample
23826
23827 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
23828 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
23829 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
23830 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
23831 @c or not?
23832 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
23833 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
23834 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
23835
23836 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
23837 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
23838 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
23839
23840 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
23841 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
23842
23843 @node Command Files
23844 @subsection Command Files
23845
23846 @cindex command files
23847 @cindex scripting commands
23848 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
23849 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
23850 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
23851 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
23852 terminal.
23853
23854 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
23855 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
23856 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
23857 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
23858 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
23859
23860 @table @code
23861 @kindex source
23862 @cindex execute commands from a file
23863 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
23864 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
23865 @end table
23866
23867 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
23868 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
23869 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
23870 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
23871 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
23872
23873 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
23874 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
23875 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
23876 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
23877 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
23878 is not relevant to scripts.
23879
23880 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
23881 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
23882 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
23883 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
23884 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23885 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
23886 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
23887 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
23888 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
23889 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
23890 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
23891 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
23892 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
23893 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
23894
23895 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
23896 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
23897 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
23898
23899 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
23900 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
23901 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
23902 when called from command files.
23903
23904 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
23905 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
23906 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
23907 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
23908 the next command.
23909
23910 @smallexample
23911 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
23912 @end smallexample
23913
23914 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
23915 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
23916 would be directed to @file{log}.
23917
23918 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
23919 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
23920 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
23921 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
23922 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
23923 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
23924 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
23925 conditionally, etc.
23926
23927 @table @code
23928 @kindex if
23929 @kindex else
23930 @item if
23931 @itemx else
23932 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
23933 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
23934 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
23935 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
23936 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
23937 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
23938 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
23939
23940 @kindex while
23941 @item while
23942 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
23943 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
23944 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
23945 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
23946 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
23947 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
23948
23949 @kindex loop_break
23950 @item loop_break
23951 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
23952 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
23953 line.
23954
23955 @kindex loop_continue
23956 @item loop_continue
23957 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
23958 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
23959 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
23960 the controlling expression.
23961
23962 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
23963 @item end
23964 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
23965 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
23966 @end table
23967
23968
23969 @node Output
23970 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
23971
23972 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
23973 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
23974 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
23975 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
23976 want.
23977
23978 @table @code
23979 @kindex echo
23980 @item echo @var{text}
23981 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
23982 @c because it is not in ANSI.
23983 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
23984 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
23985 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
23986 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
23987 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
23988 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
23989 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
23990 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
23991 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
23992
23993 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
23994 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
23995
23996 @smallexample
23997 echo This is some text\n\
23998 which is continued\n\
23999 onto several lines.\n
24000 @end smallexample
24001
24002 produces the same output as
24003
24004 @smallexample
24005 echo This is some text\n
24006 echo which is continued\n
24007 echo onto several lines.\n
24008 @end smallexample
24009
24010 @kindex output
24011 @item output @var{expression}
24012 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
24013 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
24014 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
24015 on expressions.
24016
24017 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
24018 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
24019 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
24020 Formats}, for more information.
24021
24022 @kindex printf
24023 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24024 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24025 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
24026 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
24027 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
24028 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
24029 executing the code below:
24030
24031 @smallexample
24032 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
24033 @end smallexample
24034
24035 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
24036 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
24037 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
24038 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
24039 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
24040 printed.
24041
24042 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
24043
24044 @smallexample
24045 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
24046 @end smallexample
24047
24048 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
24049 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
24050 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
24051
24052 @itemize @bullet
24053 @item
24054 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
24055
24056 @item
24057 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
24058 width.
24059
24060 @item
24061 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
24062 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
24063
24064 @item
24065 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
24066 supported.
24067
24068 @item
24069 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
24070
24071 @item
24072 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
24073 @end itemize
24074
24075 @noindent
24076 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
24077 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
24078 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
24079 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
24080
24081 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
24082 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
24083 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
24084 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
24085 supported.
24086
24087 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
24088 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
24089 together with a floating point specifier.
24090 letters:
24091
24092 @itemize @bullet
24093 @item
24094 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
24095
24096 @item
24097 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
24098
24099 @item
24100 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
24101 @end itemize
24102
24103 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
24104 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
24105 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
24106
24107 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
24108 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
24109
24110 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
24111 @smallexample
24112 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
24113 @end smallexample
24114
24115 @kindex eval
24116 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
24117 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
24118 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
24119
24120 @end table
24121
24122 @node Auto-loading sequences
24123 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
24124 @cindex native script auto-loading
24125
24126 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24127 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
24128 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
24129 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24130
24131 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24132 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24133
24134 @table @code
24135 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
24136 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
24137 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
24138 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
24139
24140 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
24141 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
24142 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
24143 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
24144 disabled.
24145
24146 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
24147 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
24148 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
24149 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
24150 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
24151 auto-loaded.
24152 @end table
24153
24154 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
24155 matching names are printed.
24156
24157 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
24158 @include python.texi
24159
24160 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
24161 @include guile.texi
24162
24163 @node Auto-loading extensions
24164 @section Auto-loading extensions
24165 @cindex auto-loading extensions
24166
24167 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
24168 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
24169 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
24170 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
24171 section of modern file formats like ELF.
24172
24173 @menu
24174 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24175 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24176 * Which flavor to choose?::
24177 @end menu
24178
24179 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
24180 debugging commands and features.
24181
24182 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
24183 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
24184 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
24185 for more information.
24186 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
24187 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
24188
24189 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24190 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24191
24192 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
24193 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
24194 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24195 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24196 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24197
24198 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
24199 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
24200 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
24201 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
24202
24203 @table @code
24204 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
24205 GDB's own command language
24206 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
24207 Python
24208 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
24209 Guile
24210 @end table
24211
24212 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
24213 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
24214 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
24215 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
24216 script in the specified extension language.
24217
24218 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
24219 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
24220
24221 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
24222 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24223
24224 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
24225 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
24226 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
24227 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
24228 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
24229 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
24230
24231 @table @code
24232 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
24233 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
24234 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24235 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
24236 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
24237 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
24238
24239 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
24240 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
24241
24242 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
24243 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
24244 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
24245 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
24246
24247 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
24248 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
24249 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
24250 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
24251 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
24252 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
24253 platform.
24254
24255 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24256 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24257 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24258
24259 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
24260 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
24261 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
24262 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24263
24264 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
24265 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
24266 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
24267 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
24268 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
24269 @end table
24270
24271 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
24272 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
24273 @var{objfile} is opened.
24274 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
24275 is evaluated more than once.
24276
24277 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
24278 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24279 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
24280
24281 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
24282 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
24283 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24284 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
24285 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
24286 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
24287 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
24288
24289 The following entries are supported:
24290
24291 @table @code
24292 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
24293 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
24294 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
24295 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
24296 @end table
24297
24298 @subsubsection Script File Entries
24299
24300 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
24301 in the current directory and then along the source search path
24302 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
24303 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
24304 directory is not relevant to scripts.
24305
24306 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
24307 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
24308
24309 @example
24310 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
24311 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
24312 asm("\
24313 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
24314 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
24315 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
24316 .popsection \n\
24317 ");
24318 @end example
24319
24320 @noindent
24321 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
24322 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
24323
24324 @example
24325 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
24326 @end example
24327
24328 The script name may include directories if desired.
24329
24330 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
24331 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24332
24333 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
24334 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
24335 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
24336 will remove duplicates.
24337
24338 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
24339
24340 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
24341 itself instead of loading it from a file.
24342 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
24343 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
24344 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
24345 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
24346 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
24347 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
24348 on its name.
24349
24350 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
24351 testsuite.
24352
24353 @example
24354 #include "symcat.h"
24355 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
24356 asm(
24357 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
24358 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
24359 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
24360 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
24361 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
24362 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
24363 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
24364 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
24365 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
24366 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
24367 ".byte 0\n"
24368 ".popsection\n"
24369 );
24370 @end example
24371
24372 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
24373 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24374 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
24375 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
24376
24377 @node Which flavor to choose?
24378 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
24379
24380 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
24381 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
24382
24383 @noindent
24384 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
24385
24386 @itemize @bullet
24387 @item
24388 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
24389
24390 @item
24391 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
24392
24393 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
24394 in the source search path.
24395 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
24396 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
24397
24398 @item
24399 Doesn't require source code additions.
24400 @end itemize
24401
24402 @noindent
24403 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
24404
24405 @itemize @bullet
24406 @item
24407 Works with static linking.
24408
24409 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
24410 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
24411 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
24412 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
24413 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
24414
24415 @item
24416 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
24417
24418 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
24419 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
24420
24421 @item
24422 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
24423
24424 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
24425 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
24426 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
24427 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
24428 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
24429 top of the source tree to the source search path.
24430 @end itemize
24431
24432 @node Multiple Extension Languages
24433 @section Multiple Extension Languages
24434
24435 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
24436 and generally do not interfere with each other.
24437 There are some things to be aware of, however.
24438
24439 @subsection Python comes first
24440
24441 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
24442 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
24443 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
24444 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
24445 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
24446 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
24447 pretty-printed form of a value).
24448 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
24449 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
24450 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
24451
24452 @node Aliases
24453 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
24454 @cindex aliases for commands
24455
24456 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
24457 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
24458 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
24459 that involves less typing.
24460
24461 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
24462 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
24463 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
24464
24465 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
24466 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
24467 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
24468
24469 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
24470
24471 @table @code
24472
24473 @kindex alias
24474 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
24475
24476 @end table
24477
24478 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
24479 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
24480 underscores.
24481
24482 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
24483 that is being aliased.
24484
24485 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
24486 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
24487 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
24488
24489 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
24490 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
24491
24492 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
24493 of a command so that there is less to type.
24494 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
24495 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
24496 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
24497 The following will accomplish this.
24498
24499 @smallexample
24500 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
24501 @end smallexample
24502
24503 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
24504 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
24505 for it with the @samp{document} command.
24506 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
24507
24508 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
24509 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
24510 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
24511 of a command.
24512
24513 @smallexample
24514 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
24515 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
24516 (gdb) set p elms 20
24517 (gdb) show p elms
24518 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
24519 @end smallexample
24520
24521 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
24522 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
24523 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
24524
24525 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
24526 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
24527
24528 @smallexample
24529 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
24530 @end smallexample
24531
24532 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
24533 alias for a more complex command.
24534 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
24535
24536 @smallexample
24537 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
24538 (gdb) spe 20
24539 @end smallexample
24540
24541 @node Interpreters
24542 @chapter Command Interpreters
24543 @cindex command interpreters
24544
24545 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
24546 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
24547 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
24548
24549 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
24550 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
24551 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
24552 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
24553
24554 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
24555 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
24556 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
24557 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
24558
24559 @table @code
24560 @item console
24561 @cindex console interpreter
24562 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
24563 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
24564 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
24565
24566 @item mi
24567 @cindex mi interpreter
24568 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
24569 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
24570 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
24571 Interface}.
24572
24573 @item mi2
24574 @cindex mi2 interpreter
24575 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
24576
24577 @item mi1
24578 @cindex mi1 interpreter
24579 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
24580
24581 @end table
24582
24583 @cindex invoke another interpreter
24584 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
24585 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
24586 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
24587 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
24588 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
24589 the IDE inoperable!
24590
24591 @kindex interpreter-exec
24592 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
24593 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
24594 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
24595 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
24596
24597 @smallexample
24598 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
24599 @end smallexample
24600
24601 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
24602 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
24603
24604 @node TUI
24605 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
24606 @cindex TUI
24607 @cindex Text User Interface
24608
24609 @menu
24610 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
24611 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
24612 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
24613 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
24614 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
24615 @end menu
24616
24617 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
24618 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
24619 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
24620 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
24621 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
24622 is available.
24623
24624 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
24625 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
24626 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
24627 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @kbd{C-x C-a}.
24628 @xref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
24629
24630 @node TUI Overview
24631 @section TUI Overview
24632
24633 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
24634
24635 @table @emph
24636 @item command
24637 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
24638 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
24639 managed using readline.
24640
24641 @item source
24642 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
24643 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
24644
24645 @item assembly
24646 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
24647
24648 @item register
24649 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
24650 when their values change.
24651 @end table
24652
24653 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
24654 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
24655 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
24656 indicates the breakpoint type:
24657
24658 @table @code
24659 @item B
24660 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24661
24662 @item b
24663 Breakpoint which was never hit.
24664
24665 @item H
24666 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
24667
24668 @item h
24669 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
24670 @end table
24671
24672 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
24673
24674 @table @code
24675 @item +
24676 Breakpoint is enabled.
24677
24678 @item -
24679 Breakpoint is disabled.
24680 @end table
24681
24682 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
24683 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
24684 changes.
24685
24686 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
24687 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
24688 layouts:
24689
24690 @itemize @bullet
24691 @item
24692 source only,
24693
24694 @item
24695 assembly only,
24696
24697 @item
24698 source and assembly,
24699
24700 @item
24701 source and registers, or
24702
24703 @item
24704 assembly and registers.
24705 @end itemize
24706
24707 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
24708
24709 @table @emph
24710 @item target
24711 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
24712 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
24713
24714 @item process
24715 Gives the current process or thread number.
24716 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
24717
24718 @item function
24719 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
24720 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
24721 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
24722 the string @code{??} is displayed.
24723
24724 @item line
24725 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
24726 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
24727
24728 @item pc
24729 Indicates the current program counter address.
24730 @end table
24731
24732 @node TUI Keys
24733 @section TUI Key Bindings
24734 @cindex TUI key bindings
24735
24736 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
24737 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24738 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
24739 @end ifset
24740 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24741 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
24742 @end ifclear
24743 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
24744 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
24745
24746 @table @kbd
24747 @kindex C-x C-a
24748 @item C-x C-a
24749 @kindex C-x a
24750 @itemx C-x a
24751 @kindex C-x A
24752 @itemx C-x A
24753 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
24754 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
24755 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
24756 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
24757 The screen is then refreshed.
24758
24759 @kindex C-x 1
24760 @item C-x 1
24761 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
24762 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
24763 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
24764
24765 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
24766
24767 @kindex C-x 2
24768 @item C-x 2
24769 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
24770 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
24771 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
24772 previous layout and the new one.
24773
24774 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
24775
24776 @kindex C-x o
24777 @item C-x o
24778 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
24779 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
24780 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
24781
24782 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
24783
24784 @kindex C-x s
24785 @item C-x s
24786 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
24787 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
24788 @end table
24789
24790 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
24791
24792 @table @asis
24793 @kindex PgUp
24794 @item @key{PgUp}
24795 Scroll the active window one page up.
24796
24797 @kindex PgDn
24798 @item @key{PgDn}
24799 Scroll the active window one page down.
24800
24801 @kindex Up
24802 @item @key{Up}
24803 Scroll the active window one line up.
24804
24805 @kindex Down
24806 @item @key{Down}
24807 Scroll the active window one line down.
24808
24809 @kindex Left
24810 @item @key{Left}
24811 Scroll the active window one column left.
24812
24813 @kindex Right
24814 @item @key{Right}
24815 Scroll the active window one column right.
24816
24817 @kindex C-L
24818 @item @kbd{C-L}
24819 Refresh the screen.
24820 @end table
24821
24822 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
24823 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
24824 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
24825 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
24826 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
24827
24828 @node TUI Single Key Mode
24829 @section TUI Single Key Mode
24830 @cindex TUI single key mode
24831
24832 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
24833 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
24834 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
24835
24836 @table @kbd
24837 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24838 @item c
24839 continue
24840
24841 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24842 @item d
24843 down
24844
24845 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24846 @item f
24847 finish
24848
24849 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24850 @item n
24851 next
24852
24853 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24854 @item q
24855 exit the SingleKey mode.
24856
24857 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24858 @item r
24859 run
24860
24861 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24862 @item s
24863 step
24864
24865 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24866 @item u
24867 up
24868
24869 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24870 @item v
24871 info locals
24872
24873 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
24874 @item w
24875 where
24876 @end table
24877
24878 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
24879 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
24880 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
24881 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
24882 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
24883 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
24884
24885
24886 @node TUI Commands
24887 @section TUI-specific Commands
24888 @cindex TUI commands
24889
24890 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
24891 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
24892 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
24893 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
24894
24895 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
24896 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
24897 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
24898 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
24899 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
24900
24901 @table @code
24902 @item info win
24903 @kindex info win
24904 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
24905
24906 @item layout next
24907 @kindex layout
24908 Display the next layout.
24909
24910 @item layout prev
24911 Display the previous layout.
24912
24913 @item layout src
24914 Display the source window only.
24915
24916 @item layout asm
24917 Display the assembly window only.
24918
24919 @item layout split
24920 Display the source and assembly window.
24921
24922 @item layout regs
24923 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
24924
24925 @item focus next
24926 @kindex focus
24927 Make the next window active for scrolling.
24928
24929 @item focus prev
24930 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
24931
24932 @item focus src
24933 Make the source window active for scrolling.
24934
24935 @item focus asm
24936 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
24937
24938 @item focus regs
24939 Make the register window active for scrolling.
24940
24941 @item focus cmd
24942 Make the command window active for scrolling.
24943
24944 @item refresh
24945 @kindex refresh
24946 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
24947
24948 @item tui reg float
24949 @kindex tui reg
24950 Show the floating point registers in the register window.
24951
24952 @item tui reg general
24953 Show the general registers in the register window.
24954
24955 @item tui reg next
24956 Show the next register group. The list of register groups as well as
24957 their order is target specific. The predefined register groups are the
24958 following: @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{system}, @code{vector},
24959 @code{all}, @code{save}, @code{restore}.
24960
24961 @item tui reg system
24962 Show the system registers in the register window.
24963
24964 @item update
24965 @kindex update
24966 Update the source window and the current execution point.
24967
24968 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
24969 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
24970 @kindex winheight
24971 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
24972 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
24973 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
24974 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
24975 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
24976
24977 @item tabset @var{nchars}
24978 @kindex tabset
24979 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
24980 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
24981 assembly windows.
24982 @end table
24983
24984 @node TUI Configuration
24985 @section TUI Configuration Variables
24986 @cindex TUI configuration variables
24987
24988 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
24989
24990 @table @code
24991 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
24992 @kindex set tui border-kind
24993 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
24994 The possible values are the following:
24995 @table @code
24996 @item space
24997 Use a space character to draw the border.
24998
24999 @item ascii
25000 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
25001
25002 @item acs
25003 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
25004 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
25005 @end table
25006
25007 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
25008 @kindex set tui border-mode
25009 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
25010 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
25011 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
25012 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
25013 @table @code
25014 @item normal
25015 Use normal attributes to display the border.
25016
25017 @item standout
25018 Use standout mode.
25019
25020 @item reverse
25021 Use reverse video mode.
25022
25023 @item half
25024 Use half bright mode.
25025
25026 @item half-standout
25027 Use half bright and standout mode.
25028
25029 @item bold
25030 Use extra bright or bold mode.
25031
25032 @item bold-standout
25033 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
25034 @end table
25035 @end table
25036
25037 @node Emacs
25038 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
25039
25040 @cindex Emacs
25041 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
25042 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
25043 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
25044 @value{GDBN}.
25045
25046 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
25047 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
25048 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
25049 created Emacs buffer.
25050 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
25051
25052 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
25053 things:
25054
25055 @itemize @bullet
25056 @item
25057 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
25058 the GUD buffer.
25059
25060 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
25061 and output done by the program you are debugging.
25062
25063 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
25064 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
25065 in this way.
25066
25067 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
25068 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
25069 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
25070 stop.
25071
25072 @item
25073 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
25074
25075 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
25076 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
25077 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
25078 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
25079 and the source.
25080
25081 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
25082 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
25083 @end itemize
25084
25085 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
25086 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
25087 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
25088 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
25089
25090 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
25091 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
25092 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
25093 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
25094 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
25095 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
25096 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
25097 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
25098 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
25099
25100 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
25101 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
25102 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
25103 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25104
25105 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
25106 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
25107 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
25108 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
25109 one you want.
25110
25111 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
25112 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
25113
25114 @table @kbd
25115 @item C-h m
25116 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
25117
25118 @item C-c C-s
25119 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
25120 update the display window to show the current file and location.
25121
25122 @item C-c C-n
25123 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
25124 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
25125 to show the current file and location.
25126
25127 @item C-c C-i
25128 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
25129 display window accordingly.
25130
25131 @item C-c C-f
25132 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
25133 @code{finish} command.
25134
25135 @item C-c C-r
25136 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
25137 command.
25138
25139 @item C-c <
25140 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
25141 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
25142 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
25143
25144 @item C-c >
25145 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
25146 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
25147 @end table
25148
25149 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
25150 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
25151
25152 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
25153 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
25154 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
25155 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
25156 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
25157 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
25158 speedbar displays watch expressions.
25159
25160 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
25161 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
25162 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
25163 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
25164 frame.
25165
25166 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
25167 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
25168 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
25169 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
25170 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
25171 to correspond properly with the code.
25172
25173 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
25174 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
25175 Emacs Manual}).
25176
25177 @node GDB/MI
25178 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
25179
25180 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
25181
25182 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
25183 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
25184 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
25185 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
25186 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
25187 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
25188
25189 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
25190 in the form of a reference manual.
25191
25192 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
25193 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
25194 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
25195
25196 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
25197
25198 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
25199 This chapter uses the following notation:
25200
25201 @itemize @bullet
25202 @item
25203 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
25204
25205 @item
25206 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
25207 it may or may not be given.
25208
25209 @item
25210 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25211 may repeat zero or more times.
25212
25213 @item
25214 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
25215 may repeat one or more times.
25216
25217 @item
25218 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
25219 @end itemize
25220
25221 @ignore
25222 @heading Dependencies
25223 @end ignore
25224
25225 @menu
25226 * GDB/MI General Design::
25227 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
25228 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
25229 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
25230 * GDB/MI Output Records::
25231 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
25232 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
25233 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
25234 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
25235 * GDB/MI Program Context::
25236 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
25237 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
25238 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
25239 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
25240 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
25241 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
25242 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
25243 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
25244 * GDB/MI File Commands::
25245 @ignore
25246 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
25247 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
25248 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
25249 @end ignore
25250 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
25251 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
25252 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
25253 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
25254 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
25255 @end menu
25256
25257 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25258 @node GDB/MI General Design
25259 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
25260 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
25261
25262 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
25263 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
25264 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
25265 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
25266 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
25267 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
25268 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
25269 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
25270 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
25271 a command and reported as part of that command response.
25272
25273 The important examples of notifications are:
25274 @itemize @bullet
25275
25276 @item
25277 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
25278 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
25279 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
25280 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
25281 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
25282 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
25283 command itself was successfully executed.
25284
25285 @item
25286 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
25287 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
25288 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
25289 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
25290 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
25291 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
25292
25293 @item
25294 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
25295 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
25296 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
25297 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
25298 orthogonal frontend design.
25299
25300 @end itemize
25301
25302 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
25303 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
25304 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
25305 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
25306 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
25307 the user interface.
25308
25309
25310 @menu
25311 * Context management::
25312 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
25313 * Thread groups::
25314 @end menu
25315
25316 @node Context management
25317 @subsection Context management
25318
25319 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
25320
25321 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
25322 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
25323 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
25324 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
25325 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
25326 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
25327 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
25328 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
25329 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
25330
25331 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
25332 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
25333 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
25334 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
25335 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
25336 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
25337 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
25338 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
25339 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
25340 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} identifier
25341 for thread and frame to operate on.
25342
25343 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
25344 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
25345 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
25346 current thread be changed. For example, when stopping on a breakpoint
25347 it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is hit. For
25348 another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} command via
25349 the frontend, it is desirable to change the frontend's selected thread to the
25350 one specified by user. @value{GDBN} communicates the suggestion to
25351 change current thread using the @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
25352 No such notification is available for the selected frame at the moment.
25353
25354 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
25355 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
25356 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
25357 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
25358 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
25359 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
25360 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
25361 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
25362 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
25363 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
25364 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
25365 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
25366 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
25367 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
25368 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
25369 @samp{--frame} options.
25370
25371 @subsubsection Language
25372
25373 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
25374 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
25375 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
25376 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
25377 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
25378 For instance:
25379
25380 @smallexample
25381 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
25382 ^done,value="4"
25383 (gdb)
25384 @end smallexample
25385
25386 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
25387 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
25388 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
25389
25390 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
25391 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
25392
25393 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
25394 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
25395 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
25396 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
25397 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
25398 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
25399 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
25400 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
25401 @code{-list-target-features} command.
25402
25403 @table @code
25404 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
25405 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
25406 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
25407
25408 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
25409 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
25410 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
25411
25412 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
25413 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
25414 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
25415 MI commands even while the target is running.
25416
25417 @item -gdb-show mi-async
25418 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
25419 @end table
25420
25421 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
25422 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
25423 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
25424 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
25425 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
25426 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
25427
25428 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
25429 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
25430 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
25431 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
25432 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
25433 are running.
25434
25435 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
25436 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
25437 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
25438 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
25439 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
25440 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
25441 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
25442 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
25443 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
25444 @samp{--thread} option).
25445
25446 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
25447 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
25448 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
25449 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
25450
25451 @node Thread groups
25452 @subsection Thread groups
25453 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
25454 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
25455 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
25456 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
25457 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
25458
25459 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
25460 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
25461 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
25462 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
25463 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
25464 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
25465 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
25466 into processes.
25467
25468 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
25469 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
25470 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
25471 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
25472 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
25473 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
25474 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
25475 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
25476 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
25477 the members of specific thread group.
25478
25479 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
25480 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
25481 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
25482 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
25483 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
25484 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
25485 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
25486 after attaching to that thread group.
25487
25488 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
25489 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
25490 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
25491 such thread groups.
25492
25493 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25494 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
25495 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
25496
25497 @menu
25498 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
25499 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
25500 @end menu
25501
25502 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
25503 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
25504
25505 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
25506 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
25507 @table @code
25508 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
25509 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
25510
25511 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
25512 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
25513 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
25514
25515 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
25516 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
25517 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
25518
25519 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25520 "any sequence of digits"
25521
25522 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
25523 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
25524
25525 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
25526 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
25527
25528 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
25529 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
25530
25531 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
25532 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
25533 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
25534
25535 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
25536 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
25537
25538 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25539 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25540 @end table
25541
25542 @noindent
25543 Notes:
25544
25545 @itemize @bullet
25546 @item
25547 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
25548 output is described below.
25549
25550 @item
25551 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
25552 finishes.
25553
25554 @item
25555 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
25556 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
25557 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
25558 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
25559 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
25560 @end itemize
25561
25562 Pragmatics:
25563
25564 @itemize @bullet
25565 @item
25566 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
25567
25568 @item
25569 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
25570 @end itemize
25571
25572 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
25573 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
25574
25575 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
25576 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
25577 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
25578 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
25579 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
25580 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
25581
25582 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
25583 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
25584 @var{token}.
25585
25586 @table @code
25587 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
25588 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
25589
25590 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
25591 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
25592
25593 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
25594 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
25595
25596 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
25597 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
25598
25599 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
25600 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
25601
25602 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
25603 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
25604
25605 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
25606 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
25607
25608 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
25609 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
25610
25611 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
25612 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
25613
25614 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
25615 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
25616 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
25617
25618 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
25619 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
25620
25621 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
25622 @code{ @var{string} }
25623
25624 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
25625 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
25626
25627 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
25628 @code{@var{c-string}}
25629
25630 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
25631 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
25632
25633 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
25634 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
25635 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
25636
25637 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
25638 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
25639
25640 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
25641 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
25642
25643 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
25644 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
25645
25646 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
25647 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
25648
25649 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
25650 @code{CR | CR-LF}
25651
25652 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
25653 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
25654 @end table
25655
25656 @noindent
25657 Notes:
25658
25659 @itemize @bullet
25660 @item
25661 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
25662
25663 @item
25664 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
25665 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
25666 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
25667 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
25668 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
25669 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
25670 prior command.
25671
25672 @item
25673 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25674 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
25675 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
25676 prefixed by @samp{+}.
25677
25678 @item
25679 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25680 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
25681 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
25682 @samp{*}.
25683
25684 @item
25685 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25686 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
25687 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
25688 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
25689
25690 @item
25691 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25692 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
25693 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
25694 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
25695
25696 @item
25697 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25698 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
25699 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
25700
25701 @item
25702 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25703 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
25704 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
25705 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
25706
25707 @item
25708 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
25709 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
25710 @var{values}.
25711
25712
25713 @end itemize
25714
25715 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
25716 details about the various output records.
25717
25718 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25719 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
25720 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
25721
25722 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
25723 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
25724
25725 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
25726 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
25727 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
25728 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
25729 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
25730 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
25731
25732 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
25733 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
25734 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
25735
25736 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25737 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
25738 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
25739 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
25740
25741 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
25742 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
25743
25744 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
25745 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
25746 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
25747 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
25748 might change.
25749
25750 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
25751 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
25752 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
25753 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
25754
25755 @itemize @bullet
25756 @item
25757 New MI commands may be added.
25758
25759 @item
25760 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
25761
25762 @item
25763 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
25764 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
25765
25766 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
25767 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
25768
25769 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
25770 @c resolve inconsistencies.
25771 @end itemize
25772
25773 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
25774 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
25775 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
25776 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
25777 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
25778
25779 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
25780 @c version?
25781
25782 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
25783 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
25784 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
25785 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
25786 @cindex mailing lists
25787
25788 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
25789 @node GDB/MI Output Records
25790 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
25791
25792 @menu
25793 * GDB/MI Result Records::
25794 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
25795 * GDB/MI Async Records::
25796 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
25797 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
25798 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
25799 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
25800 @end menu
25801
25802 @node GDB/MI Result Records
25803 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
25804
25805 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25806 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
25807 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
25808 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
25809
25810 @table @code
25811 @findex ^done
25812 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
25813 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
25814 values.
25815
25816 @item "^running"
25817 @findex ^running
25818 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
25819 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
25820 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
25821 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
25822 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
25823 which threads are resumed.
25824
25825 @item "^connected"
25826 @findex ^connected
25827 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
25828
25829 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
25830 @findex ^error
25831 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
25832 the corresponding error message.
25833
25834 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
25835 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
25836 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
25837
25838 @table @samp
25839 @item "undefined-command"
25840 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
25841 @end table
25842
25843 @item "^exit"
25844 @findex ^exit
25845 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
25846
25847 @end table
25848
25849 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
25850 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
25851
25852 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
25853 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25854 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
25855 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
25856 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
25857
25858 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
25859 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
25860 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
25861 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
25862 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
25863
25864 @table @code
25865 @item "~" @var{string-output}
25866 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
25867 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
25868
25869 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
25870 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
25871 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
25872 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
25873
25874 @item "&" @var{string-output}
25875 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
25876 internals.
25877 @end table
25878
25879 @node GDB/MI Async Records
25880 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
25881
25882 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
25883 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
25884 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
25885 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
25886 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
25887 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
25888
25889 The following is the list of possible async records:
25890
25891 @table @code
25892
25893 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
25894 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field tells which
25895 specific thread is now running, and can be @samp{all} if all threads
25896 are running. The frontend should assume that no interaction with a
25897 running thread is possible after this notification is produced.
25898 The frontend should not assume that this notification is output
25899 only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may emit this notification
25900 several times, either for different threads, because it cannot resume
25901 all threads together, or even for a single thread, if the thread must
25902 be stepped though some code before letting it run freely.
25903
25904 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
25905 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
25906 following values:
25907
25908 @table @code
25909 @item breakpoint-hit
25910 A breakpoint was reached.
25911 @item watchpoint-trigger
25912 A watchpoint was triggered.
25913 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
25914 A read watchpoint was triggered.
25915 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
25916 An access watchpoint was triggered.
25917 @item function-finished
25918 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25919 @item location-reached
25920 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
25921 @item watchpoint-scope
25922 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
25923 @item end-stepping-range
25924 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
25925 similar CLI command was accomplished.
25926 @item exited-signalled
25927 The inferior exited because of a signal.
25928 @item exited
25929 The inferior exited.
25930 @item exited-normally
25931 The inferior exited normally.
25932 @item signal-received
25933 A signal was received by the inferior.
25934 @item solib-event
25935 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
25936 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
25937 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
25938 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
25939 @item fork
25940 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
25941 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25942 @item vfork
25943 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
25944 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25945 @item syscall-entry
25946 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
25947 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25948 @item syscall-return
25949 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
25950 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25951 @item exec
25952 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
25953 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
25954 @end table
25955
25956 The @var{id} field identifies the thread that directly caused the stop
25957 -- for example by hitting a breakpoint. Depending on whether all-stop
25958 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
25959 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
25960 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
25961 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
25962 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
25963 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
25964 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
25965 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
25966 if such information is not available.
25967
25968 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
25969 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
25970 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
25971 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
25972 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
25973 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
25974 cannot be used in any way.
25975
25976 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
25977 A thread group became associated with a running program,
25978 either because the program was just started or the thread group
25979 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
25980 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
25981 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
25982
25983 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
25984 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
25985 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
25986 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
25987 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
25988 only when the inferior exited with some code.
25989
25990 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25991 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
25992 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
25993 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
25994 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
25995
25996 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"
25997 Informs that the selected thread was changed as result of the last
25998 command. This notification is not emitted as result of @code{-thread-select}
25999 command but is emitted whenever an MI command that is not documented
26000 to change the selected thread actually changes it. In particular,
26001 invoking, directly or indirectly (via user-defined command), the CLI
26002 @code{thread} command, will generate this notification.
26003
26004 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
26005 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
26006 that thread.
26007
26008 @item =library-loaded,...
26009 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
26010 notification has 4 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
26011 @var{host-name}, and @var{symbols-loaded}. The @var{id} field is an
26012 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
26013 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
26014 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
26015 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
26016 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
26017 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
26018 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
26019 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
26020 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
26021 thread groups.
26022
26023 @item =library-unloaded,...
26024 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
26025 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
26026 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
26027 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
26028 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
26029 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
26030 thread groups.
26031
26032 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
26033 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
26034 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
26035 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
26036 frame is @var{tpnum}.
26037
26038 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
26039 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
26040 initial value @var{initial}.
26041
26042 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
26043 @itemx =tsv-deleted
26044 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
26045 trace state variables are deleted.
26046
26047 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
26048 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
26049 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
26050 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
26051 value of trace state variable is known.
26052
26053 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
26054 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
26055 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
26056 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
26057 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
26058 user.
26059
26060 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
26061 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
26062 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
26063
26064 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
26065 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
26066
26067 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}"
26068 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
26069 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
26070 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
26071 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
26072
26073 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
26074 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
26075 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
26076 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
26077 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
26078 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
26079
26080 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
26081 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
26082 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
26083 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
26084 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
26085 executable code.
26086 @end table
26087
26088 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
26089 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
26090
26091 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
26092 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
26093 following fields:
26094
26095 @table @code
26096 @item number
26097 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
26098 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
26099 @samp{1.2}.
26100
26101 @item type
26102 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
26103 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
26104
26105 @item catch-type
26106 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
26107 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
26108
26109 @item disp
26110 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
26111 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
26112 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
26113
26114 @item enabled
26115 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
26116 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
26117 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
26118
26119 @item addr
26120 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
26121 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
26122 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
26123 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
26124 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
26125
26126 @item func
26127 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
26128 If not known, this field is not present.
26129
26130 @item filename
26131 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
26132 If not known, this field is not present.
26133
26134 @item fullname
26135 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
26136 known. If not known, this field is not present.
26137
26138 @item line
26139 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
26140 If not known, this field is not present.
26141
26142 @item at
26143 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
26144 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
26145 by a symbol name.
26146
26147 @item pending
26148 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
26149 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
26150
26151 @item evaluated-by
26152 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
26153 @samp{target}.
26154
26155 @item thread
26156 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
26157 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
26158
26159 @item task
26160 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
26161 field will hold the task identifier.
26162
26163 @item cond
26164 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
26165
26166 @item ignore
26167 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
26168
26169 @item enable
26170 The enable count of the breakpoint.
26171
26172 @item traceframe-usage
26173 FIXME.
26174
26175 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
26176 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
26177
26178 @item mask
26179 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
26180
26181 @item pass
26182 A tracepoint's pass count.
26183
26184 @item original-location
26185 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
26186 This field is optional.
26187
26188 @item times
26189 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
26190
26191 @item installed
26192 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
26193 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
26194 is not.
26195
26196 @item what
26197 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
26198
26199 @end table
26200
26201 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
26202 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
26203
26204 @smallexample
26205 -> -break-insert main
26206 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26207 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26208 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26209 times="0"@}
26210 <- (gdb)
26211 @end smallexample
26212
26213 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
26214 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
26215
26216 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
26217 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
26218 fields:
26219
26220 @table @code
26221 @item level
26222 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
26223 zero. This field is always present.
26224
26225 @item func
26226 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
26227 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
26228
26229 @item addr
26230 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
26231
26232 @item file
26233 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
26234 address. This field may be absent.
26235
26236 @item line
26237 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
26238 may be absent.
26239
26240 @item from
26241 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
26242 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
26243
26244 @end table
26245
26246 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
26247 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
26248
26249 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
26250 uses a tuple with the following fields:
26251
26252 @table @code
26253 @item id
26254 The numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}. This field is
26255 always present.
26256
26257 @item target-id
26258 Target-specific string identifying the thread. This field is always present.
26259
26260 @item details
26261 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
26262 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
26263 frontend. This field is optional.
26264
26265 @item state
26266 Either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running}, depending on whether the
26267 thread is presently running. This field is always present.
26268
26269 @item core
26270 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
26271 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
26272 @end table
26273
26274 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
26275 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
26276
26277 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
26278 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
26279 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
26280 the @code{exception-name} field.
26281
26282 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26283 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
26284 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
26285 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
26286
26287 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
26288 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
26289 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
26290 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
26291
26292 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
26293 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
26294
26295 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
26296
26297 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
26298 information of the breakpoint.
26299
26300 @smallexample
26301 -> -break-insert main
26302 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26303 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
26304 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
26305 times="0"@}
26306 <- (gdb)
26307 @end smallexample
26308
26309 @subheading Program Execution
26310
26311 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
26312 reason that execution stopped.
26313
26314 @smallexample
26315 -> -exec-run
26316 <- ^running
26317 <- (gdb)
26318 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
26319 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
26320 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
26321 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
26322 <- (gdb)
26323 -> -exec-continue
26324 <- ^running
26325 <- (gdb)
26326 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
26327 <- (gdb)
26328 @end smallexample
26329
26330 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
26331
26332 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
26333
26334 @smallexample
26335 -> (gdb)
26336 <- -gdb-exit
26337 <- ^exit
26338 @end smallexample
26339
26340 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
26341 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
26342 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
26343 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
26344 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
26345 fails to exit in reasonable time.
26346
26347 @subheading A Bad Command
26348
26349 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
26350
26351 @smallexample
26352 -> -rubbish
26353 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
26354 <- (gdb)
26355 @end smallexample
26356
26357
26358 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26359 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
26360 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
26361
26362 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
26363 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
26364
26365 @subheading Motivation
26366
26367 The motivation for this collection of commands.
26368
26369 @subheading Introduction
26370
26371 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
26372
26373 @subheading Commands
26374
26375 For each command in the block, the following is described:
26376
26377 @subsubheading Synopsis
26378
26379 @smallexample
26380 -command @var{args}@dots{}
26381 @end smallexample
26382
26383 @subsubheading Result
26384
26385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26386
26387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
26388
26389 @subsubheading Example
26390
26391 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
26392 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
26393
26394
26395 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26396 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
26397 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
26398
26399 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
26400 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
26401 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
26402 breakpoints.
26403
26404 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
26405 @findex -break-after
26406
26407 @subsubheading Synopsis
26408
26409 @smallexample
26410 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
26411 @end smallexample
26412
26413 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
26414 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
26415 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
26416 @samp{-break-list} command below.
26417
26418 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26419
26420 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
26421
26422 @subsubheading Example
26423
26424 @smallexample
26425 (gdb)
26426 -break-insert main
26427 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26428 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26429 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26430 times="0"@}
26431 (gdb)
26432 -break-after 1 3
26433 ~
26434 ^done
26435 (gdb)
26436 -break-list
26437 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26438 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26439 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26440 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26441 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26442 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26443 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26444 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26445 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26446 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26447 (gdb)
26448 @end smallexample
26449
26450 @ignore
26451 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
26452 @findex -break-catch
26453 @end ignore
26454
26455 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
26456 @findex -break-commands
26457
26458 @subsubheading Synopsis
26459
26460 @smallexample
26461 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
26462 @end smallexample
26463
26464 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
26465 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
26466 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
26467 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
26468 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
26469 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
26470
26471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26472
26473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
26474
26475 @subsubheading Example
26476
26477 @smallexample
26478 (gdb)
26479 -break-insert main
26480 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
26481 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
26482 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26483 times="0"@}
26484 (gdb)
26485 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
26486 ^done
26487 (gdb)
26488 @end smallexample
26489
26490 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
26491 @findex -break-condition
26492
26493 @subsubheading Synopsis
26494
26495 @smallexample
26496 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
26497 @end smallexample
26498
26499 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
26500 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
26501 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
26502 command below).
26503
26504 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26505
26506 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
26507
26508 @subsubheading Example
26509
26510 @smallexample
26511 (gdb)
26512 -break-condition 1 1
26513 ^done
26514 (gdb)
26515 -break-list
26516 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26517 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26518 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26519 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26520 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26521 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26522 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26523 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26524 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26525 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
26526 (gdb)
26527 @end smallexample
26528
26529 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
26530 @findex -break-delete
26531
26532 @subsubheading Synopsis
26533
26534 @smallexample
26535 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26536 @end smallexample
26537
26538 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
26539 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
26540
26541 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26542
26543 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
26544
26545 @subsubheading Example
26546
26547 @smallexample
26548 (gdb)
26549 -break-delete 1
26550 ^done
26551 (gdb)
26552 -break-list
26553 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26554 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26555 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26556 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26557 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26558 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26559 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26560 body=[]@}
26561 (gdb)
26562 @end smallexample
26563
26564 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
26565 @findex -break-disable
26566
26567 @subsubheading Synopsis
26568
26569 @smallexample
26570 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26571 @end smallexample
26572
26573 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
26574 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
26575
26576 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26577
26578 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
26579
26580 @subsubheading Example
26581
26582 @smallexample
26583 (gdb)
26584 -break-disable 2
26585 ^done
26586 (gdb)
26587 -break-list
26588 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26589 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26590 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26591 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26592 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26593 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26594 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26595 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
26596 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26597 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26598 (gdb)
26599 @end smallexample
26600
26601 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
26602 @findex -break-enable
26603
26604 @subsubheading Synopsis
26605
26606 @smallexample
26607 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
26608 @end smallexample
26609
26610 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
26611
26612 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26613
26614 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
26615
26616 @subsubheading Example
26617
26618 @smallexample
26619 (gdb)
26620 -break-enable 2
26621 ^done
26622 (gdb)
26623 -break-list
26624 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
26625 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26626 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26627 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26628 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26629 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26630 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26631 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26632 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26633 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26634 (gdb)
26635 @end smallexample
26636
26637 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
26638 @findex -break-info
26639
26640 @subsubheading Synopsis
26641
26642 @smallexample
26643 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
26644 @end smallexample
26645
26646 @c REDUNDANT???
26647 Get information about a single breakpoint.
26648
26649 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
26650 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
26651 table.
26652
26653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26654
26655 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
26656
26657 @subsubheading Example
26658 N.A.
26659
26660 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
26661 @findex -break-insert
26662
26663 @subsubheading Synopsis
26664
26665 @smallexample
26666 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
26667 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26668 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
26669 @end smallexample
26670
26671 @noindent
26672 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26673
26674 @itemize @bullet
26675 @item function
26676 @c @item +offset
26677 @c @item -offset
26678 @c @item linenum
26679 @item filename:linenum
26680 @item filename:function
26681 @item *address
26682 @end itemize
26683
26684 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26685
26686 @table @samp
26687 @item -t
26688 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26689 @item -h
26690 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
26691 @item -f
26692 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
26693 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26694 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26695 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26696 cannot be parsed.
26697 @item -d
26698 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26699 @item -a
26700 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
26701 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
26702 @item -c @var{condition}
26703 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26704 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26705 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
26706 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26707 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26708 @end table
26709
26710 @subsubheading Result
26711
26712 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26713 resulting breakpoint.
26714
26715 Note: this format is open to change.
26716 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26717
26718 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26719
26720 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
26721 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
26722
26723 @subsubheading Example
26724
26725 @smallexample
26726 (gdb)
26727 -break-insert main
26728 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
26729 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26730 times="0"@}
26731 (gdb)
26732 -break-insert -t foo
26733 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
26734 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26735 times="0"@}
26736 (gdb)
26737 -break-list
26738 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26739 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26740 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26741 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26742 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26743 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26744 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26745 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26746 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
26747 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
26748 times="0"@},
26749 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
26750 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
26751 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26752 times="0"@}]@}
26753 (gdb)
26754 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
26755 @c ~int foo(int, int);
26756 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
26757 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
26758 @c times="0"@}
26759 @c (gdb)
26760 @end smallexample
26761
26762 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
26763 @findex -dprintf-insert
26764
26765 @subsubheading Synopsis
26766
26767 @smallexample
26768 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
26769 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
26770 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
26771 [ @var{argument} ]
26772 @end smallexample
26773
26774 @noindent
26775 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
26776
26777 @itemize @bullet
26778 @item @var{function}
26779 @c @item +offset
26780 @c @item -offset
26781 @c @item @var{linenum}
26782 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
26783 @item @var{filename}:function
26784 @item *@var{address}
26785 @end itemize
26786
26787 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
26788
26789 @table @samp
26790 @item -t
26791 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
26792 @item -f
26793 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
26794 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
26795 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
26796 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
26797 cannot be parsed.
26798 @item -d
26799 Create a disabled breakpoint.
26800 @item -c @var{condition}
26801 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
26802 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
26803 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
26804 to @var{ignore-count}.
26805 @item -p @var{thread-id}
26806 Restrict the breakpoint to the specified @var{thread-id}.
26807 @end table
26808
26809 @subsubheading Result
26810
26811 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
26812 resulting breakpoint.
26813
26814 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
26815
26816 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26817
26818 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
26819
26820 @subsubheading Example
26821
26822 @smallexample
26823 (gdb)
26824 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
26825 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26826 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26827 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
26828 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
26829 original-location="foo"@}
26830 (gdb)
26831 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
26832 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26833 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
26834 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
26835 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
26836 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
26837 (gdb)
26838 @end smallexample
26839
26840 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
26841 @findex -break-list
26842
26843 @subsubheading Synopsis
26844
26845 @smallexample
26846 -break-list
26847 @end smallexample
26848
26849 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
26850
26851 @table @samp
26852 @item Number
26853 number of the breakpoint
26854 @item Type
26855 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
26856 @item Disposition
26857 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
26858 or @samp{nokeep}
26859 @item Enabled
26860 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
26861 @item Address
26862 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
26863 @item What
26864 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
26865 name, line number
26866 @item Thread-groups
26867 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
26868 @item Times
26869 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
26870 @end table
26871
26872 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
26873 @code{body} field is an empty list.
26874
26875 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26876
26877 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
26878
26879 @subsubheading Example
26880
26881 @smallexample
26882 (gdb)
26883 -break-list
26884 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
26885 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26886 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26887 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26888 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26889 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26890 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26891 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26892 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
26893 times="0"@},
26894 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
26895 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
26896 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
26897 (gdb)
26898 @end smallexample
26899
26900 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
26901
26902 @smallexample
26903 (gdb)
26904 -break-list
26905 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
26906 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
26907 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
26908 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
26909 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
26910 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
26911 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
26912 body=[]@}
26913 (gdb)
26914 @end smallexample
26915
26916 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
26917 @findex -break-passcount
26918
26919 @subsubheading Synopsis
26920
26921 @smallexample
26922 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
26923 @end smallexample
26924
26925 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
26926 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
26927 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
26928 command @samp{passcount}.
26929
26930 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
26931 @findex -break-watch
26932
26933 @subsubheading Synopsis
26934
26935 @smallexample
26936 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
26937 @end smallexample
26938
26939 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
26940 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
26941 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
26942 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
26943 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
26944 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
26945 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
26946 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
26947
26948 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
26949 breakpoints inserted.
26950
26951 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
26952
26953 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
26954 @samp{rwatch}.
26955
26956 @subsubheading Example
26957
26958 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
26959
26960 @smallexample
26961 (gdb)
26962 -break-watch x
26963 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
26964 (gdb)
26965 -exec-continue
26966 ^running
26967 (gdb)
26968 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
26969 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
26970 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
26971 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
26972 (gdb)
26973 @end smallexample
26974
26975 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
26976 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
26977 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
26978
26979 @smallexample
26980 (gdb)
26981 -break-watch C
26982 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
26983 (gdb)
26984 -exec-continue
26985 ^running
26986 (gdb)
26987 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
26988 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
26989 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
26990 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
26991 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
26992 (gdb)
26993 -exec-continue
26994 ^running
26995 (gdb)
26996 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
26997 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
26998 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
26999 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27000 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27001 (gdb)
27002 @end smallexample
27003
27004 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
27005 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
27006 deleted.
27007
27008 @smallexample
27009 (gdb)
27010 -break-watch C
27011 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
27012 (gdb)
27013 -break-list
27014 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27015 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27016 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27017 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27018 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27019 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27020 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27021 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27022 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27023 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27024 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27025 times="1"@},
27026 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27027 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
27028 (gdb)
27029 -exec-continue
27030 ^running
27031 (gdb)
27032 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
27033 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
27034 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27035 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27036 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
27037 (gdb)
27038 -break-list
27039 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
27040 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27041 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27042 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27043 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27044 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27045 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27046 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27047 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27048 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27049 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
27050 times="1"@},
27051 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
27052 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
27053 (gdb)
27054 -exec-continue
27055 ^running
27056 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
27057 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
27058 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27059 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27060 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27061 (gdb)
27062 -break-list
27063 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
27064 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
27065 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
27066 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
27067 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
27068 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
27069 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
27070 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
27071 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
27072 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27073 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
27074 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
27075 (gdb)
27076 @end smallexample
27077
27078
27079 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27080 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27081 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
27082
27083 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
27084 catchpoints.
27085
27086 @menu
27087 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27088 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
27089 @end menu
27090
27091 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27092 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27093
27094 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
27095 @findex -catch-load
27096
27097 @subsubheading Synopsis
27098
27099 @smallexample
27100 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27101 @end smallexample
27102
27103 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
27104 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27105 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
27106 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27107 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
27108
27109
27110 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27111
27112 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
27113
27114 @subsubheading Example
27115
27116 @smallexample
27117 -catch-load -t foo.so
27118 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
27119 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
27120 (gdb)
27121 @end smallexample
27122
27123
27124 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
27125 @findex -catch-unload
27126
27127 @subsubheading Synopsis
27128
27129 @smallexample
27130 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
27131 @end smallexample
27132
27133 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
27134 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
27135 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
27136 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
27137 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
27138
27139 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27140
27141 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
27142
27143 @subsubheading Example
27144
27145 @smallexample
27146 -catch-unload -d bar.so
27147 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
27148 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
27149 (gdb)
27150 @end smallexample
27151
27152 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
27153 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
27154
27155 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
27156 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
27157
27158 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
27159 @findex -catch-assert
27160
27161 @subsubheading Synopsis
27162
27163 @smallexample
27164 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
27165 @end smallexample
27166
27167 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
27168
27169 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27170
27171 @table @samp
27172 @item -c @var{condition}
27173 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27174 @item -d
27175 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27176 @item -t
27177 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27178 @end table
27179
27180 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27181
27182 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
27183
27184 @subsubheading Example
27185
27186 @smallexample
27187 -catch-assert
27188 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27189 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
27190 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
27191 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
27192 (gdb)
27193 @end smallexample
27194
27195 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
27196 @findex -catch-exception
27197
27198 @subsubheading Synopsis
27199
27200 @smallexample
27201 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
27202 [ -t ] [ -u ]
27203 @end smallexample
27204
27205 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
27206 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
27207 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
27208 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
27209 catchpoints.
27210
27211 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
27212
27213 @table @samp
27214 @item -c @var{condition}
27215 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
27216 @item -d
27217 Create a disabled catchpoint.
27218 @item -e @var{exception-name}
27219 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
27220 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
27221 @item -t
27222 Create a temporary catchpoint.
27223 @item -u
27224 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
27225 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
27226 @end table
27227
27228 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27229
27230 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
27231 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
27232
27233 @subsubheading Example
27234
27235 @smallexample
27236 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
27237 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27238 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
27239 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
27240 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
27241 (gdb)
27242 @end smallexample
27243
27244 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27245 @node GDB/MI Program Context
27246 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
27247
27248 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
27249 @findex -exec-arguments
27250
27251
27252 @subsubheading Synopsis
27253
27254 @smallexample
27255 -exec-arguments @var{args}
27256 @end smallexample
27257
27258 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
27259 @samp{-exec-run}.
27260
27261 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27262
27263 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
27264
27265 @subsubheading Example
27266
27267 @smallexample
27268 (gdb)
27269 -exec-arguments -v word
27270 ^done
27271 (gdb)
27272 @end smallexample
27273
27274
27275 @ignore
27276 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
27277 @findex -exec-show-arguments
27278
27279 @subsubheading Synopsis
27280
27281 @smallexample
27282 -exec-show-arguments
27283 @end smallexample
27284
27285 Print the arguments of the program.
27286
27287 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27288
27289 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
27290
27291 @subsubheading Example
27292 N.A.
27293 @end ignore
27294
27295
27296 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
27297 @findex -environment-cd
27298
27299 @subsubheading Synopsis
27300
27301 @smallexample
27302 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
27303 @end smallexample
27304
27305 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
27306
27307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27308
27309 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
27310
27311 @subsubheading Example
27312
27313 @smallexample
27314 (gdb)
27315 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27316 ^done
27317 (gdb)
27318 @end smallexample
27319
27320
27321 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
27322 @findex -environment-directory
27323
27324 @subsubheading Synopsis
27325
27326 @smallexample
27327 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27328 @end smallexample
27329
27330 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
27331 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
27332 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
27333 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27334 occurs as normal.
27335 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27336 multiple directories in a single command
27337 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27338 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27339 If blanks are needed as
27340 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27341 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27342 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27343 character must not be used
27344 in any directory name.
27345 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
27346
27347 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27348
27349 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
27350
27351 @subsubheading Example
27352
27353 @smallexample
27354 (gdb)
27355 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
27356 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27357 (gdb)
27358 -environment-directory ""
27359 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
27360 (gdb)
27361 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
27362 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
27363 (gdb)
27364 -environment-directory -r
27365 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
27366 (gdb)
27367 @end smallexample
27368
27369
27370 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
27371 @findex -environment-path
27372
27373 @subsubheading Synopsis
27374
27375 @smallexample
27376 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
27377 @end smallexample
27378
27379 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
27380 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
27381 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
27382 supplied in addition to the
27383 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
27384 occurs as normal.
27385 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
27386 multiple directories in a single command
27387 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
27388 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
27389 If blanks are needed as
27390 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
27391 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
27392 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
27393 character must not be used
27394 in any directory name.
27395 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
27396
27397
27398 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27399
27400 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
27401
27402 @subsubheading Example
27403
27404 @smallexample
27405 (gdb)
27406 -environment-path
27407 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
27408 (gdb)
27409 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
27410 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
27411 (gdb)
27412 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
27413 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
27414 (gdb)
27415 @end smallexample
27416
27417
27418 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
27419 @findex -environment-pwd
27420
27421 @subsubheading Synopsis
27422
27423 @smallexample
27424 -environment-pwd
27425 @end smallexample
27426
27427 Show the current working directory.
27428
27429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27430
27431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
27432
27433 @subsubheading Example
27434
27435 @smallexample
27436 (gdb)
27437 -environment-pwd
27438 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
27439 (gdb)
27440 @end smallexample
27441
27442 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27443 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
27444 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
27445
27446
27447 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
27448 @findex -thread-info
27449
27450 @subsubheading Synopsis
27451
27452 @smallexample
27453 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
27454 @end smallexample
27455
27456 Reports information about either a specific thread, if
27457 the @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all
27458 threads. When printing information about all threads,
27459 also reports the current thread.
27460
27461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27462
27463 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
27464 about all threads.
27465
27466 @subsubheading Result
27467
27468 The result is a list of threads. The following attributes are
27469 defined for a given thread:
27470
27471 @table @samp
27472 @item current
27473 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27474
27475 @item id
27476 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the thread.
27477
27478 @item target-id
27479 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the thread.
27480
27481 @item details
27482 Extra information about the thread, in a target-specific format. This
27483 field is optional.
27484
27485 @item name
27486 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27487 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27488 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27489 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27490 field is omitted.
27491
27492 @item frame
27493 The stack frame currently executing in the thread.
27494
27495 @item state
27496 The thread's state. The @samp{state} field may have the following
27497 values:
27498
27499 @table @code
27500 @item stopped
27501 The thread is stopped. Frame information is available for stopped
27502 threads.
27503
27504 @item running
27505 The thread is running. There's no frame information for running
27506 threads.
27507
27508 @end table
27509
27510 @item core
27511 If @value{GDBN} can find the CPU core on which this thread is running,
27512 then this field is the core identifier. This field is optional.
27513
27514 @end table
27515
27516 @subsubheading Example
27517
27518 @smallexample
27519 -thread-info
27520 ^done,threads=[
27521 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
27522 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
27523 args=[]@},state="running"@},
27524 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
27525 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
27526 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
27527 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
27528 state="running"@}],
27529 current-thread-id="1"
27530 (gdb)
27531 @end smallexample
27532
27533 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
27534 @findex -thread-list-ids
27535
27536 @subsubheading Synopsis
27537
27538 @smallexample
27539 -thread-list-ids
27540 @end smallexample
27541
27542 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
27543 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
27544
27545 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
27546 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
27547
27548 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27549
27550 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
27551
27552 @subsubheading Example
27553
27554 @smallexample
27555 (gdb)
27556 -thread-list-ids
27557 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27558 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
27559 (gdb)
27560 @end smallexample
27561
27562
27563 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
27564 @findex -thread-select
27565
27566 @subsubheading Synopsis
27567
27568 @smallexample
27569 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
27570 @end smallexample
27571
27572 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
27573 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
27574
27575 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
27576 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
27577
27578 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27579
27580 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
27581
27582 @subsubheading Example
27583
27584 @smallexample
27585 (gdb)
27586 -exec-next
27587 ^running
27588 (gdb)
27589 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
27590 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
27591 (gdb)
27592 -thread-list-ids
27593 ^done,
27594 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
27595 number-of-threads="3"
27596 (gdb)
27597 -thread-select 3
27598 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
27599 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
27600 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
27601 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
27602 (gdb)
27603 @end smallexample
27604
27605 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27606 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
27607 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
27608
27609 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
27610 @findex -ada-task-info
27611
27612 @subsubheading Synopsis
27613
27614 @smallexample
27615 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
27616 @end smallexample
27617
27618 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
27619 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
27620
27621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27622
27623 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
27624 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
27625
27626 @subsubheading Result
27627
27628 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
27629 defined for each Ada task:
27630
27631 @table @samp
27632 @item current
27633 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
27634
27635 @item id
27636 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
27637
27638 @item task-id
27639 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
27640
27641 @item thread-id
27642 The identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada task.
27643
27644 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
27645 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
27646 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
27647
27648 @item parent-id
27649 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
27650 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
27651
27652 @item priority
27653 The base priority of the task.
27654
27655 @item state
27656 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
27657 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
27658
27659 @item name
27660 The name of the task.
27661
27662 @end table
27663
27664 @subsubheading Example
27665
27666 @smallexample
27667 -ada-task-info
27668 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
27669 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
27670 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
27671 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
27672 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
27673 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
27674 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
27675 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
27676 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
27677 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
27678 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
27679 (gdb)
27680 @end smallexample
27681
27682 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27683 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
27684 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
27685
27686 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
27687 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
27688 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
27689 other cases.
27690
27691 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
27692 @findex -exec-continue
27693
27694 @subsubheading Synopsis
27695
27696 @smallexample
27697 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
27698 @end smallexample
27699
27700 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
27701 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
27702 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
27703 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
27704 @itemize @bullet
27705 @item
27706 breakpoints or watchpoints
27707 @item
27708 signals or exceptions
27709 @item
27710 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
27711 @item
27712 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
27713 @end itemize
27714 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
27715 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
27716 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
27717 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
27718 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
27719 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
27720
27721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27722
27723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
27724
27725 @subsubheading Example
27726
27727 @smallexample
27728 -exec-continue
27729 ^running
27730 (gdb)
27731 @@Hello world
27732 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
27733 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
27734 line="13"@}
27735 (gdb)
27736 @end smallexample
27737
27738
27739 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
27740 @findex -exec-finish
27741
27742 @subsubheading Synopsis
27743
27744 @smallexample
27745 -exec-finish [--reverse]
27746 @end smallexample
27747
27748 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
27749 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
27750 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
27751 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
27752 function was called.
27753
27754 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27755
27756 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
27757
27758 @subsubheading Example
27759
27760 Function returning @code{void}.
27761
27762 @smallexample
27763 -exec-finish
27764 ^running
27765 (gdb)
27766 @@hello from foo
27767 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
27768 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
27769 (gdb)
27770 @end smallexample
27771
27772 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
27773 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
27774 value itself.
27775
27776 @smallexample
27777 -exec-finish
27778 ^running
27779 (gdb)
27780 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
27781 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
27782 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
27783 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
27784 (gdb)
27785 @end smallexample
27786
27787
27788 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
27789 @findex -exec-interrupt
27790
27791 @subsubheading Synopsis
27792
27793 @smallexample
27794 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
27795 @end smallexample
27796
27797 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
27798 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
27799 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
27800 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
27801 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
27802
27803 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
27804 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
27805 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
27806 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
27807
27808 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
27809 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
27810 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
27811 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
27812
27813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27814
27815 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
27816
27817 @subsubheading Example
27818
27819 @smallexample
27820 (gdb)
27821 111-exec-continue
27822 111^running
27823
27824 (gdb)
27825 222-exec-interrupt
27826 222^done
27827 (gdb)
27828 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
27829 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
27830 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
27831 (gdb)
27832
27833 (gdb)
27834 -exec-interrupt
27835 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
27836 (gdb)
27837 @end smallexample
27838
27839 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
27840 @findex -exec-jump
27841
27842 @subsubheading Synopsis
27843
27844 @smallexample
27845 -exec-jump @var{location}
27846 @end smallexample
27847
27848 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
27849 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
27850 different forms of @var{location}.
27851
27852 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27853
27854 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
27855
27856 @subsubheading Example
27857
27858 @smallexample
27859 -exec-jump foo.c:10
27860 *running,thread-id="all"
27861 ^running
27862 @end smallexample
27863
27864
27865 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
27866 @findex -exec-next
27867
27868 @subsubheading Synopsis
27869
27870 @smallexample
27871 -exec-next [--reverse]
27872 @end smallexample
27873
27874 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
27875 of the next source line is reached.
27876
27877 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27878 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
27879 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
27880 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
27881 source line where the function was called.
27882
27883
27884 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27885
27886 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
27887
27888 @subsubheading Example
27889
27890 @smallexample
27891 -exec-next
27892 ^running
27893 (gdb)
27894 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
27895 (gdb)
27896 @end smallexample
27897
27898
27899 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
27900 @findex -exec-next-instruction
27901
27902 @subsubheading Synopsis
27903
27904 @smallexample
27905 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
27906 @end smallexample
27907
27908 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
27909 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
27910 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
27911 printed as well.
27912
27913 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
27914 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
27915 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
27916 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
27917 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
27918
27919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27920
27921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
27922
27923 @subsubheading Example
27924
27925 @smallexample
27926 (gdb)
27927 -exec-next-instruction
27928 ^running
27929
27930 (gdb)
27931 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
27932 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
27933 (gdb)
27934 @end smallexample
27935
27936
27937 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
27938 @findex -exec-return
27939
27940 @subsubheading Synopsis
27941
27942 @smallexample
27943 -exec-return
27944 @end smallexample
27945
27946 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
27947 Displays the new current frame.
27948
27949 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
27950
27951 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
27952
27953 @subsubheading Example
27954
27955 @smallexample
27956 (gdb)
27957 200-break-insert callee4
27958 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
27959 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27960 (gdb)
27961 000-exec-run
27962 000^running
27963 (gdb)
27964 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
27965 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
27966 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27967 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
27968 (gdb)
27969 205-break-delete
27970 205^done
27971 (gdb)
27972 111-exec-return
27973 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
27974 args=[@{name="strarg",
27975 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
27976 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
27977 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
27978 (gdb)
27979 @end smallexample
27980
27981
27982 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
27983 @findex -exec-run
27984
27985 @subsubheading Synopsis
27986
27987 @smallexample
27988 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
27989 @end smallexample
27990
27991 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
27992 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
27993 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
27994 the program has exited exceptionally.
27995
27996 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
27997 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
27998 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
27999 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
28000 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
28001
28002 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
28003 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
28004 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
28005 (@pxref{Starting}).
28006
28007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28008
28009 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
28010
28011 @subsubheading Examples
28012
28013 @smallexample
28014 (gdb)
28015 -break-insert main
28016 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28017 (gdb)
28018 -exec-run
28019 ^running
28020 (gdb)
28021 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
28022 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28023 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
28024 (gdb)
28025 @end smallexample
28026
28027 @noindent
28028 Program exited normally:
28029
28030 @smallexample
28031 (gdb)
28032 -exec-run
28033 ^running
28034 (gdb)
28035 x = 55
28036 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28037 (gdb)
28038 @end smallexample
28039
28040 @noindent
28041 Program exited exceptionally:
28042
28043 @smallexample
28044 (gdb)
28045 -exec-run
28046 ^running
28047 (gdb)
28048 x = 55
28049 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
28050 (gdb)
28051 @end smallexample
28052
28053 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
28054 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
28055
28056 @smallexample
28057 (gdb)
28058 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
28059 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
28060 @end smallexample
28061
28062
28063 @c @subheading -exec-signal
28064
28065
28066 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
28067 @findex -exec-step
28068
28069 @subsubheading Synopsis
28070
28071 @smallexample
28072 -exec-step [--reverse]
28073 @end smallexample
28074
28075 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
28076 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
28077 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
28078 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
28079 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
28080 previously executed source line.
28081
28082 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28083
28084 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
28085
28086 @subsubheading Example
28087
28088 Stepping into a function:
28089
28090 @smallexample
28091 -exec-step
28092 ^running
28093 (gdb)
28094 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28095 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
28096 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
28097 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
28098 (gdb)
28099 @end smallexample
28100
28101 Regular stepping:
28102
28103 @smallexample
28104 -exec-step
28105 ^running
28106 (gdb)
28107 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
28108 (gdb)
28109 @end smallexample
28110
28111
28112 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
28113 @findex -exec-step-instruction
28114
28115 @subsubheading Synopsis
28116
28117 @smallexample
28118 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
28119 @end smallexample
28120
28121 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
28122 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
28123 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
28124 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
28125 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
28126 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
28127 as well.
28128
28129 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28130
28131 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
28132
28133 @subsubheading Example
28134
28135 @smallexample
28136 (gdb)
28137 -exec-step-instruction
28138 ^running
28139
28140 (gdb)
28141 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28142 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28143 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28144 (gdb)
28145 -exec-step-instruction
28146 ^running
28147
28148 (gdb)
28149 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
28150 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
28151 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
28152 (gdb)
28153 @end smallexample
28154
28155
28156 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
28157 @findex -exec-until
28158
28159 @subsubheading Synopsis
28160
28161 @smallexample
28162 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
28163 @end smallexample
28164
28165 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
28166 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
28167 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
28168 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
28169
28170 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28171
28172 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
28173
28174 @subsubheading Example
28175
28176 @smallexample
28177 (gdb)
28178 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
28179 ^running
28180 (gdb)
28181 x = 55
28182 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
28183 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
28184 (gdb)
28185 @end smallexample
28186
28187 @ignore
28188 @subheading -file-clear
28189 Is this going away????
28190 @end ignore
28191
28192 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28193 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
28194 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
28195
28196 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
28197 @findex -enable-frame-filters
28198
28199 @smallexample
28200 -enable-frame-filters
28201 @end smallexample
28202
28203 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
28204 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
28205 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28206 request that this functionality be enabled.
28207
28208 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28209
28210 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28211 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28212
28213 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
28214 @findex -stack-info-frame
28215
28216 @subsubheading Synopsis
28217
28218 @smallexample
28219 -stack-info-frame
28220 @end smallexample
28221
28222 Get info on the selected frame.
28223
28224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28225
28226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
28227 (without arguments).
28228
28229 @subsubheading Example
28230
28231 @smallexample
28232 (gdb)
28233 -stack-info-frame
28234 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28235 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28236 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
28237 (gdb)
28238 @end smallexample
28239
28240 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
28241 @findex -stack-info-depth
28242
28243 @subsubheading Synopsis
28244
28245 @smallexample
28246 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
28247 @end smallexample
28248
28249 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
28250 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
28251
28252 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28253
28254 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
28255
28256 @subsubheading Example
28257
28258 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
28259
28260 @smallexample
28261 (gdb)
28262 -stack-info-depth
28263 ^done,depth="12"
28264 (gdb)
28265 -stack-info-depth 4
28266 ^done,depth="4"
28267 (gdb)
28268 -stack-info-depth 12
28269 ^done,depth="12"
28270 (gdb)
28271 -stack-info-depth 11
28272 ^done,depth="11"
28273 (gdb)
28274 -stack-info-depth 13
28275 ^done,depth="12"
28276 (gdb)
28277 @end smallexample
28278
28279 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
28280 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
28281 @findex -stack-list-arguments
28282
28283 @subsubheading Synopsis
28284
28285 @smallexample
28286 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28287 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28288 @end smallexample
28289
28290 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
28291 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
28292 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
28293 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
28294 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
28295 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
28296 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
28297 which case only existing frames will be returned.
28298
28299 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28300 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28301 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28302 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28303 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28304 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28305
28306 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
28307 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
28308 are still displayed, however.
28309
28310 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
28311 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28312
28313 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28314
28315 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
28316 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
28317 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
28318
28319 @subsubheading Example
28320
28321 @smallexample
28322 (gdb)
28323 -stack-list-frames
28324 ^done,
28325 stack=[
28326 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28327 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28328 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
28329 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
28330 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28331 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
28332 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
28333 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28334 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
28335 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
28336 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28337 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
28338 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
28339 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28340 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
28341 (gdb)
28342 -stack-list-arguments 0
28343 ^done,
28344 stack-args=[
28345 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28346 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
28347 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
28348 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
28349 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28350 (gdb)
28351 -stack-list-arguments 1
28352 ^done,
28353 stack-args=[
28354 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
28355 frame=@{level="1",
28356 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28357 frame=@{level="2",args=[
28358 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28359 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
28360 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
28361 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28362 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
28363 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
28364 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
28365 (gdb)
28366 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
28367 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
28368 (gdb)
28369 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
28370 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
28371 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
28372 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
28373 (gdb)
28374 @end smallexample
28375
28376 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
28377
28378
28379 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
28380 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
28381 @findex -stack-list-frames
28382
28383 @subsubheading Synopsis
28384
28385 @smallexample
28386 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
28387 @end smallexample
28388
28389 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
28390 following info:
28391
28392 @table @samp
28393 @item @var{level}
28394 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
28395 @item @var{addr}
28396 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
28397 @item @var{func}
28398 Function name.
28399 @item @var{file}
28400 File name of the source file where the function lives.
28401 @item @var{fullname}
28402 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
28403 @item @var{line}
28404 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
28405 @item @var{from}
28406 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
28407 if the frame's function is not known.
28408 @end table
28409
28410 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
28411 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
28412 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
28413 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
28414 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
28415 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
28416 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
28417 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28418 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28419
28420 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28421
28422 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
28423
28424 @subsubheading Example
28425
28426 Full stack backtrace:
28427
28428 @smallexample
28429 (gdb)
28430 -stack-list-frames
28431 ^done,stack=
28432 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
28433 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
28434 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28435 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28436 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28437 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28438 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28439 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28440 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28441 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28442 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28443 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28444 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28445 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28446 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28447 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28448 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28449 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28450 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28451 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28452 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28453 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28454 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
28455 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
28456 (gdb)
28457 @end smallexample
28458
28459 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
28460
28461 @smallexample
28462 (gdb)
28463 -stack-list-frames 3 5
28464 ^done,stack=
28465 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28466 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28467 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28468 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
28469 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28470 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28471 (gdb)
28472 @end smallexample
28473
28474 Show a single frame:
28475
28476 @smallexample
28477 (gdb)
28478 -stack-list-frames 3 3
28479 ^done,stack=
28480 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
28481 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
28482 (gdb)
28483 @end smallexample
28484
28485
28486 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
28487 @findex -stack-list-locals
28488 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
28489
28490 @subsubheading Synopsis
28491
28492 @smallexample
28493 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28494 @end smallexample
28495
28496 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
28497 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28498 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28499 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28500 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28501 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
28502 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
28503 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
28504 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
28505 Python frame filters will not be executed.
28506
28507 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28508 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
28509 variables are still displayed, however.
28510
28511 This command is deprecated in favor of the
28512 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
28513
28514 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28515
28516 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
28517
28518 @subsubheading Example
28519
28520 @smallexample
28521 (gdb)
28522 -stack-list-locals 0
28523 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
28524 (gdb)
28525 -stack-list-locals --all-values
28526 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
28527 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
28528 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
28529 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
28530 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
28531 (gdb)
28532 @end smallexample
28533
28534 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
28535 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
28536 @findex -stack-list-variables
28537
28538 @subsubheading Synopsis
28539
28540 @smallexample
28541 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
28542 @end smallexample
28543
28544 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
28545 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
28546 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
28547 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
28548 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
28549 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
28550 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
28551
28552 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
28553 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
28554 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
28555
28556 @subsubheading Example
28557
28558 @smallexample
28559 (gdb)
28560 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
28561 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
28562 (gdb)
28563 @end smallexample
28564
28565
28566 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
28567 @findex -stack-select-frame
28568
28569 @subsubheading Synopsis
28570
28571 @smallexample
28572 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
28573 @end smallexample
28574
28575 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
28576 the stack.
28577
28578 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
28579 option to every command.
28580
28581 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28582
28583 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
28584 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
28585
28586 @subsubheading Example
28587
28588 @smallexample
28589 (gdb)
28590 -stack-select-frame 2
28591 ^done
28592 (gdb)
28593 @end smallexample
28594
28595 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28596 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
28597 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
28598
28599 @ignore
28600
28601 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28602
28603 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
28604 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
28605 used by @code{Insight}.
28606
28607 The two main reasons for that are:
28608
28609 @enumerate 1
28610 @item
28611 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
28612
28613 @item
28614 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
28615 now).
28616 @end enumerate
28617
28618 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
28619 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
28620 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
28621 hints about their use.
28622
28623 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
28624 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
28625 least, the following operations:
28626
28627 @itemize @bullet
28628 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
28629 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
28630 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
28631 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
28632 @end itemize
28633
28634 @end ignore
28635
28636 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
28637
28638 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
28639
28640 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
28641 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
28642 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
28643 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
28644 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
28645 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
28646 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
28647 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
28648 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
28649 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
28650 object, or to change display format.
28651
28652 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
28653 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
28654 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
28655 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
28656 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
28657 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
28658 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
28659 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
28660 child will be created.
28661
28662 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
28663 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
28664 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
28665 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
28666 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
28667
28668 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
28669 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
28670 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
28671 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
28672 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
28673 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
28674 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
28675 variables that frontend has created.
28676
28677 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
28678 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
28679 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
28680 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
28681 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
28682 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
28683 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
28684 implicitly updated.
28685
28686 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
28687 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
28688 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
28689 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
28690 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
28691 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
28692 frame. Consider this example:
28693
28694 @smallexample
28695 void do_work(...)
28696 @{
28697 struct work_state state;
28698
28699 if (...)
28700 do_work(...);
28701 @}
28702 @end smallexample
28703
28704 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
28705 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
28706 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
28707 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
28708 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
28709
28710 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
28711 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
28712 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
28713 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
28714 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
28715 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
28716
28717 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
28718 access this functionality:
28719
28720 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
28721 @item @strong{Operation}
28722 @tab @strong{Description}
28723
28724 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
28725 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
28726 @item @code{-var-create}
28727 @tab create a variable object
28728 @item @code{-var-delete}
28729 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
28730 @item @code{-var-set-format}
28731 @tab set the display format of this variable
28732 @item @code{-var-show-format}
28733 @tab show the display format of this variable
28734 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
28735 @tab tells how many children this object has
28736 @item @code{-var-list-children}
28737 @tab return a list of the object's children
28738 @item @code{-var-info-type}
28739 @tab show the type of this variable object
28740 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
28741 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
28742 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
28743 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
28744 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
28745 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
28746 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
28747 @tab get the value of this variable
28748 @item @code{-var-assign}
28749 @tab set the value of this variable
28750 @item @code{-var-update}
28751 @tab update the variable and its children
28752 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
28753 @tab set frozeness attribute
28754 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
28755 @tab set range of children to display on update
28756 @end multitable
28757
28758 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
28759 how it can be used.
28760
28761 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
28762
28763 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
28764 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
28765
28766 @smallexample
28767 -enable-pretty-printing
28768 @end smallexample
28769
28770 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
28771 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
28772 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
28773 request that this functionality be enabled.
28774
28775 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
28776
28777 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
28778 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
28779
28780 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
28781 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
28782
28783 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
28784 @findex -var-create
28785
28786 @subsubheading Synopsis
28787
28788 @smallexample
28789 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
28790 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
28791 @end smallexample
28792
28793 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
28794 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
28795 register.
28796
28797 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
28798 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
28799 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
28800 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
28801 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
28802
28803 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
28804 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
28805 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
28806 object must be created.
28807
28808 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
28809 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
28810
28811 @itemize @bullet
28812 @item
28813 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
28814
28815 @item
28816 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
28817
28818 @item
28819 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
28820 @end itemize
28821
28822 @cindex dynamic varobj
28823 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
28824 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
28825 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
28826 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
28827 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
28828 compatibility for existing clients.
28829
28830 @subsubheading Result
28831
28832 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
28833 are:
28834
28835 @table @samp
28836 @item name
28837 The name of the varobj.
28838
28839 @item numchild
28840 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
28841 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
28842 @samp{has_more} attribute.
28843
28844 @item value
28845 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
28846 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
28847 will not be interesting.
28848
28849 @item type
28850 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
28851 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
28852 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
28853 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
28854 @emph{declared} one.
28855
28856 @item thread-id
28857 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
28858 thread's identifier.
28859
28860 @item has_more
28861 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
28862 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
28863
28864 @item dynamic
28865 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
28866 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
28867 then this attribute will not be present.
28868
28869 @item displayhint
28870 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
28871 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
28872 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
28873 @end table
28874
28875 Typical output will look like this:
28876
28877 @smallexample
28878 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
28879 has_more="@var{has_more}"
28880 @end smallexample
28881
28882
28883 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
28884 @findex -var-delete
28885
28886 @subsubheading Synopsis
28887
28888 @smallexample
28889 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
28890 @end smallexample
28891
28892 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
28893 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
28894
28895 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
28896
28897
28898 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
28899 @findex -var-set-format
28900
28901 @subsubheading Synopsis
28902
28903 @smallexample
28904 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
28905 @end smallexample
28906
28907 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
28908 @var{format-spec}.
28909
28910 @anchor{-var-set-format}
28911 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
28912
28913 @smallexample
28914 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
28915 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
28916 @end smallexample
28917
28918 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
28919 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
28920 for pointers, etc.).
28921
28922 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
28923 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
28924
28925 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
28926 @findex -var-show-format
28927
28928 @subsubheading Synopsis
28929
28930 @smallexample
28931 -var-show-format @var{name}
28932 @end smallexample
28933
28934 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
28935
28936 @smallexample
28937 @var{format} @expansion{}
28938 @var{format-spec}
28939 @end smallexample
28940
28941
28942 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
28943 @findex -var-info-num-children
28944
28945 @subsubheading Synopsis
28946
28947 @smallexample
28948 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
28949 @end smallexample
28950
28951 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
28952
28953 @smallexample
28954 numchild=@var{n}
28955 @end smallexample
28956
28957 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
28958 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
28959 be available.
28960
28961
28962 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
28963 @findex -var-list-children
28964
28965 @subsubheading Synopsis
28966
28967 @smallexample
28968 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
28969 @end smallexample
28970 @anchor{-var-list-children}
28971
28972 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
28973 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
28974 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
28975 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
28976 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
28977 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
28978 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
28979 and unions.
28980
28981 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
28982 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
28983 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
28984 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
28985 reported.
28986
28987 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
28988 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
28989 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
28990 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
28991 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
28992 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
28993 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
28994 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
28995 the visible items.
28996
28997 For each child the following results are returned:
28998
28999 @table @var
29000
29001 @item name
29002 Name of the variable object created for this child.
29003
29004 @item exp
29005 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
29006 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
29007
29008 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
29009 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
29010
29011 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
29012 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
29013 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
29014 type and value are not present.
29015
29016 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
29017 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
29018 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
29019
29020 @item numchild
29021 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
29022 0.
29023
29024 @item type
29025 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
29026 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
29027 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
29028 @emph{declared} one.
29029
29030 @item value
29031 If values were requested, this is the value.
29032
29033 @item thread-id
29034 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the thread id.
29035 Otherwise this result is not present.
29036
29037 @item frozen
29038 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
29039
29040 @item displayhint
29041 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29042 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29043 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29044
29045 @item dynamic
29046 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29047 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29048 then this attribute will not be present.
29049
29050 @end table
29051
29052 The result may have its own attributes:
29053
29054 @table @samp
29055 @item displayhint
29056 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
29057 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
29058 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
29059
29060 @item has_more
29061 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
29062 remaining after the end of the selected range.
29063 @end table
29064
29065 @subsubheading Example
29066
29067 @smallexample
29068 (gdb)
29069 -var-list-children n
29070 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29071 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29072 (gdb)
29073 -var-list-children --all-values n
29074 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
29075 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
29076 @end smallexample
29077
29078
29079 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
29080 @findex -var-info-type
29081
29082 @subsubheading Synopsis
29083
29084 @smallexample
29085 -var-info-type @var{name}
29086 @end smallexample
29087
29088 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
29089 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
29090 @value{GDBN} CLI:
29091
29092 @smallexample
29093 type=@var{typename}
29094 @end smallexample
29095
29096
29097 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
29098 @findex -var-info-expression
29099
29100 @subsubheading Synopsis
29101
29102 @smallexample
29103 -var-info-expression @var{name}
29104 @end smallexample
29105
29106 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
29107 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
29108 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
29109
29110 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
29111 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
29112
29113 @smallexample
29114 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
29115 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
29116 @end smallexample
29117
29118 @noindent
29119 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
29120 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
29121
29122 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
29123 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
29124 is of limited use.
29125
29126 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
29127 @findex -var-info-path-expression
29128
29129 @subsubheading Synopsis
29130
29131 @smallexample
29132 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
29133 @end smallexample
29134
29135 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
29136 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
29137 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
29138 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
29139 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
29140 watchpoint from a variable object.
29141
29142 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
29143 and will give an error when invoked on one.
29144
29145 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
29146 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
29147 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
29148 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
29149 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
29150 @smallexample
29151 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
29152 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
29153 @end smallexample
29154
29155 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
29156 @findex -var-show-attributes
29157
29158 @subsubheading Synopsis
29159
29160 @smallexample
29161 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
29162 @end smallexample
29163
29164 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
29165
29166 @smallexample
29167 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
29168 @end smallexample
29169
29170 @noindent
29171 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
29172
29173 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
29174 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
29175
29176 @subsubheading Synopsis
29177
29178 @smallexample
29179 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
29180 @end smallexample
29181
29182 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
29183 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
29184 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
29185 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
29186 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
29187 the current display format will be used. The current display format
29188 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
29189
29190 @smallexample
29191 value=@var{value}
29192 @end smallexample
29193
29194 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
29195 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
29196
29197 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
29198 @findex -var-assign
29199
29200 @subsubheading Synopsis
29201
29202 @smallexample
29203 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
29204 @end smallexample
29205
29206 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
29207 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
29208 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
29209 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
29210
29211 @subsubheading Example
29212
29213 @smallexample
29214 (gdb)
29215 -var-assign var1 3
29216 ^done,value="3"
29217 (gdb)
29218 -var-update *
29219 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
29220 (gdb)
29221 @end smallexample
29222
29223 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
29224 @findex -var-update
29225
29226 @subsubheading Synopsis
29227
29228 @smallexample
29229 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
29230 @end smallexample
29231
29232 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
29233 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
29234 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
29235 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
29236 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
29237 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
29238 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
29239 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
29240 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
29241 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
29242 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
29243 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
29244 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
29245
29246 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
29247 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
29248 diagnostic.
29249
29250 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
29251 only the selected range of children will be reported.
29252
29253 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
29254 @samp{changelist}.
29255
29256 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
29257
29258 @table @samp
29259 @item name
29260 The name of the varobj.
29261
29262 @item value
29263 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
29264 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
29265
29266 @item in_scope
29267 @anchor{-var-update}
29268 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
29269
29270 @table @code
29271 @item "true"
29272 The variable object's current value is valid.
29273
29274 @item "false"
29275 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
29276 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
29277 scope.
29278
29279 @item "invalid"
29280 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
29281 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
29282 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
29283 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
29284 objects.
29285 @end table
29286
29287 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
29288 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
29289
29290 @item type_changed
29291 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
29292 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
29293 be @samp{false}.
29294
29295 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
29296 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
29297 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
29298 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
29299 unset.
29300
29301 @item new_type
29302 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
29303 hold the new type.
29304
29305 @item new_num_children
29306 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
29307 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
29308
29309 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
29310 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
29311 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
29312 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
29313 children which may be available.
29314
29315 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
29316 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
29317 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
29318 only happen at the end of the update range).
29319
29320 @item displayhint
29321 The display hint, if any.
29322
29323 @item has_more
29324 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
29325 available outside the varobj's update range.
29326
29327 @item dynamic
29328 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
29329 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
29330 then this attribute will not be present.
29331
29332 @item new_children
29333 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
29334 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
29335 be listed in this attribute.
29336 @end table
29337
29338 @subsubheading Example
29339
29340 @smallexample
29341 (gdb)
29342 -var-assign var1 3
29343 ^done,value="3"
29344 (gdb)
29345 -var-update --all-values var1
29346 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
29347 type_changed="false"@}]
29348 (gdb)
29349 @end smallexample
29350
29351 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
29352 @findex -var-set-frozen
29353 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
29354
29355 @subsubheading Synopsis
29356
29357 @smallexample
29358 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
29359 @end smallexample
29360
29361 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
29362 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
29363 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
29364 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
29365 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
29366 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
29367 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
29368 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
29369 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
29370 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
29371 @code{-var-update} does.
29372
29373 @subsubheading Example
29374
29375 @smallexample
29376 (gdb)
29377 -var-set-frozen V 1
29378 ^done
29379 (gdb)
29380 @end smallexample
29381
29382 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
29383 @findex -var-set-update-range
29384 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
29385
29386 @subsubheading Synopsis
29387
29388 @smallexample
29389 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
29390 @end smallexample
29391
29392 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
29393 @code{-var-update}.
29394
29395 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
29396 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
29397 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
29398 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
29399
29400 @subsubheading Example
29401
29402 @smallexample
29403 (gdb)
29404 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
29405 ^done
29406 @end smallexample
29407
29408 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
29409 @findex -var-set-visualizer
29410 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
29411
29412 @subsubheading Synopsis
29413
29414 @smallexample
29415 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
29416 @end smallexample
29417
29418 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
29419
29420 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
29421 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
29422
29423 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
29424 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
29425 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
29426 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
29427 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
29428 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
29429 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
29430
29431 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
29432 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
29433 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
29434 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
29435
29436 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
29437 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
29438 can be used to check this.
29439
29440 @subsubheading Example
29441
29442 Resetting the visualizer:
29443
29444 @smallexample
29445 (gdb)
29446 -var-set-visualizer V None
29447 ^done
29448 @end smallexample
29449
29450 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
29451
29452 @smallexample
29453 (gdb)
29454 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
29455 ^done
29456 @end smallexample
29457
29458 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
29459 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
29460
29461 @smallexample
29462 (gdb)
29463 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
29464 ^done
29465 @end smallexample
29466
29467 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29468 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
29469 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
29470
29471 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
29472 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
29473 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
29474 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
29475
29476 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
29477 @c @subheading -data-assign
29478 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
29479 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
29480 @c set variable
29481 @c @subsubheading Example
29482 @c N.A.
29483
29484 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
29485 @findex -data-disassemble
29486
29487 @subsubheading Synopsis
29488
29489 @smallexample
29490 -data-disassemble
29491 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
29492 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
29493 -- @var{mode}
29494 @end smallexample
29495
29496 @noindent
29497 Where:
29498
29499 @table @samp
29500 @item @var{start-addr}
29501 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
29502 @item @var{end-addr}
29503 is the end address
29504 @item @var{filename}
29505 is the name of the file to disassemble
29506 @item @var{linenum}
29507 is the line number to disassemble around
29508 @item @var{lines}
29509 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
29510 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
29511 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
29512 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
29513 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
29514 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
29515 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
29516 are displayed.
29517 @item @var{mode}
29518 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly), 1 (meaning mixed source and
29519 disassembly), 2 (meaning disassembly with raw opcodes), or 3 (meaning
29520 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes).
29521 @end table
29522
29523 @subsubheading Result
29524
29525 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
29526 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
29527 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
29528
29529 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
29530 following fields:
29531
29532 @table @code
29533 @item address
29534 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
29535
29536 @item func-name
29537 The name of the function this instruction is within.
29538
29539 @item offset
29540 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
29541
29542 @item inst
29543 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
29544
29545 @item opcodes
29546 This field is only present for mode 2. This contains the raw opcode
29547 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
29548
29549 @end table
29550
29551 For modes 1 and 3 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
29552 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
29553
29554 @table @code
29555 @item line
29556 The line number within @samp{file}.
29557
29558 @item file
29559 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
29560 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
29561 used.
29562
29563 @item fullname
29564 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
29565 using the source file search path
29566 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
29567 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
29568
29569 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
29570 present in the debug information.
29571
29572 @item line_asm_insn
29573 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
29574 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
29575 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
29576 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
29577 @samp{opcodes}.
29578
29579 @end table
29580
29581 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
29582 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
29583 adjust its format.
29584
29585 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29586
29587 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
29588
29589 @subsubheading Example
29590
29591 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
29592
29593 @smallexample
29594 (gdb)
29595 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
29596 ^done,
29597 asm_insns=[
29598 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29599 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29600 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29601 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29602 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
29603 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
29604 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
29605 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29606 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
29607 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
29608 (gdb)
29609 @end smallexample
29610
29611 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
29612 @code{main}.
29613
29614 @smallexample
29615 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
29616 ^done,asm_insns=[
29617 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29618 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29619 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29620 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29621 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29622 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
29623 [@dots{}]
29624 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
29625 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
29626 (gdb)
29627 @end smallexample
29628
29629 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
29630
29631 @smallexample
29632 (gdb)
29633 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
29634 ^done,asm_insns=[
29635 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
29636 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
29637 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
29638 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29639 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29640 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
29641 (gdb)
29642 @end smallexample
29643
29644 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
29645
29646 @smallexample
29647 (gdb)
29648 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
29649 ^done,asm_insns=[
29650 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
29651 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29652 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29653 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
29654 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
29655 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
29656 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29657 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29658 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
29659 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
29660 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
29661 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
29662 (gdb)
29663 @end smallexample
29664
29665
29666 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
29667 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
29668
29669 @subsubheading Synopsis
29670
29671 @smallexample
29672 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
29673 @end smallexample
29674
29675 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
29676 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
29677 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
29678
29679 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29680
29681 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
29682 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
29683 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
29684
29685 @subsubheading Example
29686
29687 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
29688 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
29689 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
29690 output.
29691
29692 @smallexample
29693 211-data-evaluate-expression A
29694 211^done,value="1"
29695 (gdb)
29696 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
29697 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
29698 (gdb)
29699 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
29700 411^done,value="4"
29701 (gdb)
29702 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
29703 511^done,value="4"
29704 (gdb)
29705 @end smallexample
29706
29707
29708 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
29709 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
29710
29711 @subsubheading Synopsis
29712
29713 @smallexample
29714 -data-list-changed-registers
29715 @end smallexample
29716
29717 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
29718
29719 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29720
29721 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
29722 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
29723
29724 @subsubheading Example
29725
29726 On a PPC MBX board:
29727
29728 @smallexample
29729 (gdb)
29730 -exec-continue
29731 ^running
29732
29733 (gdb)
29734 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
29735 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
29736 line="5"@}
29737 (gdb)
29738 -data-list-changed-registers
29739 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
29740 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
29741 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
29742 (gdb)
29743 @end smallexample
29744
29745
29746 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
29747 @findex -data-list-register-names
29748
29749 @subsubheading Synopsis
29750
29751 @smallexample
29752 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
29753 @end smallexample
29754
29755 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
29756 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
29757 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
29758 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
29759 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
29760 include empty register names.
29761
29762 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29763
29764 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
29765 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
29766 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
29767
29768 @subsubheading Example
29769
29770 For the PPC MBX board:
29771 @smallexample
29772 (gdb)
29773 -data-list-register-names
29774 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
29775 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
29776 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
29777 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
29778 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
29779 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
29780 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
29781 (gdb)
29782 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
29783 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
29784 (gdb)
29785 @end smallexample
29786
29787 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
29788 @findex -data-list-register-values
29789
29790 @subsubheading Synopsis
29791
29792 @smallexample
29793 -data-list-register-values
29794 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
29795 @end smallexample
29796
29797 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
29798 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
29799 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
29800 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
29801 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
29802 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
29803
29804 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
29805
29806 @table @code
29807 @item x
29808 Hexadecimal
29809 @item o
29810 Octal
29811 @item t
29812 Binary
29813 @item d
29814 Decimal
29815 @item r
29816 Raw
29817 @item N
29818 Natural
29819 @end table
29820
29821 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29822
29823 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
29824 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
29825
29826 @subsubheading Example
29827
29828 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
29829 don't appear in the actual output):
29830
29831 @smallexample
29832 (gdb)
29833 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
29834 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29835 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
29836 (gdb)
29837 -data-list-register-values x
29838 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
29839 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29840 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
29841 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
29842 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
29843 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
29844 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
29845 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
29846 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
29847 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
29848 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
29849 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
29850 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
29851 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
29852 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
29853 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
29854 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
29855 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
29856 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
29857 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
29858 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
29859 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
29860 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
29861 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
29862 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
29863 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
29864 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
29865 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
29866 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
29867 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
29868 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
29869 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
29870 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
29871 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
29872 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
29873 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
29874 (gdb)
29875 @end smallexample
29876
29877
29878 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
29879 @findex -data-read-memory
29880
29881 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
29882
29883 @subsubheading Synopsis
29884
29885 @smallexample
29886 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
29887 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
29888 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
29889 @end smallexample
29890
29891 @noindent
29892 where:
29893
29894 @table @samp
29895 @item @var{address}
29896 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
29897 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
29898 quoted using the C convention.
29899
29900 @item @var{word-format}
29901 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
29902 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
29903 ,Output Formats}).
29904
29905 @item @var{word-size}
29906 The size of each memory word in bytes.
29907
29908 @item @var{nr-rows}
29909 The number of rows in the output table.
29910
29911 @item @var{nr-cols}
29912 The number of columns in the output table.
29913
29914 @item @var{aschar}
29915 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
29916 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
29917 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
29918 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
29919
29920 @item @var{byte-offset}
29921 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
29922 @end table
29923
29924 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
29925 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
29926 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
29927 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
29928 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
29929 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
29930 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
29931 @samp{addr}.
29932
29933 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
29934 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
29935 @samp{prev-page}.
29936
29937 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29938
29939 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
29940 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
29941
29942 @subsubheading Example
29943
29944 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
29945 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
29946 word. Display each word in hex.
29947
29948 @smallexample
29949 (gdb)
29950 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
29951 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
29952 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
29953 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
29954 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
29955 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
29956 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
29957 (gdb)
29958 @end smallexample
29959
29960 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
29961 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
29962
29963 @smallexample
29964 (gdb)
29965 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
29966 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
29967 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
29968 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
29969 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
29970 (gdb)
29971 @end smallexample
29972
29973 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
29974 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
29975 used as the non-printable character.
29976
29977 @smallexample
29978 (gdb)
29979 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
29980 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
29981 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
29982 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
29983 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29984 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29985 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29986 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
29987 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
29988 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
29989 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
29990 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
29991 (gdb)
29992 @end smallexample
29993
29994 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
29995 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
29996
29997 @subsubheading Synopsis
29998
29999 @smallexample
30000 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
30001 @var{address} @var{count}
30002 @end smallexample
30003
30004 @noindent
30005 where:
30006
30007 @table @samp
30008 @item @var{address}
30009 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30010 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30011 quoted using the C convention.
30012
30013 @item @var{count}
30014 The number of bytes to read. This should be an integer literal.
30015
30016 @item @var{byte-offset}
30017 The offsets in bytes relative to @var{address} at which to start
30018 reading. This should be an integer literal. This option is provided
30019 so that a frontend is not required to first evaluate address and then
30020 perform address arithmetics itself.
30021
30022 @end table
30023
30024 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
30025 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
30026 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
30027 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
30028 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
30029 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
30030
30031 In general, every single byte in the region may be readable or not,
30032 and the only way to read every readable byte is to try a read at
30033 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
30034 attempt to read all accessible bytes at either beginning or the end
30035 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
30036 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
30037 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
30038 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
30039
30040 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
30041 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
30042 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
30043 and has the following fields:
30044
30045 @table @code
30046 @item begin
30047 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30048
30049 @item end
30050 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
30051
30052 @item offset
30053 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
30054 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
30055
30056 @item contents
30057 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
30058
30059 @end table
30060
30061
30062
30063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30064
30065 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
30066
30067 @subsubheading Example
30068
30069 @smallexample
30070 (gdb)
30071 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
30072 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
30073 end="0xbffff15e",
30074 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
30075 (gdb)
30076 @end smallexample
30077
30078
30079 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
30080 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
30081
30082 @subsubheading Synopsis
30083
30084 @smallexample
30085 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
30086 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
30087 @end smallexample
30088
30089 @noindent
30090 where:
30091
30092 @table @samp
30093 @item @var{address}
30094 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
30095 written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
30096 quoted using the C convention.
30097
30098 @item @var{contents}
30099 The hex-encoded bytes to write.
30100
30101 @item @var{count}
30102 Optional argument indicating the number of bytes to be written. If @var{count}
30103 is greater than @var{contents}' length, @value{GDBN} will repeatedly
30104 write @var{contents} until it fills @var{count} bytes.
30105
30106 @end table
30107
30108 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30109
30110 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30111
30112 @subsubheading Example
30113
30114 @smallexample
30115 (gdb)
30116 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
30117 ^done
30118 (gdb)
30119 @end smallexample
30120
30121 @smallexample
30122 (gdb)
30123 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
30124 ^done
30125 (gdb)
30126 @end smallexample
30127
30128 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30129 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
30130 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
30131
30132 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
30133 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
30134
30135 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
30136 @findex -trace-find
30137
30138 @subsubheading Synopsis
30139
30140 @smallexample
30141 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
30142 @end smallexample
30143
30144 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
30145 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
30146 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
30147
30148 @table @samp
30149
30150 @item none
30151 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
30152
30153 @item frame-number
30154 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
30155 that index.
30156
30157 @item tracepoint-number
30158 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
30159 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
30160
30161 @item pc
30162 An address is required as parameter. Finds
30163 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
30164 address.
30165
30166 @item pc-inside-range
30167 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
30168 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
30169 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30170
30171 @item pc-outside-range
30172 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
30173 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
30174 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
30175
30176 @item line
30177 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
30178 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
30179 the specified location.
30180
30181 @end table
30182
30183 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
30184 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
30185
30186 @table @samp
30187 @item found
30188 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
30189 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
30190
30191 @item traceframe
30192 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
30193 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30194
30195 @item tracepoint
30196 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
30197 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
30198
30199 @item frame
30200 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
30201 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
30202 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
30203
30204 @end table
30205
30206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30207
30208 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
30209
30210 @subheading -trace-define-variable
30211 @findex -trace-define-variable
30212
30213 @subsubheading Synopsis
30214
30215 @smallexample
30216 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
30217 @end smallexample
30218
30219 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
30220 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
30221 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
30222 with the @samp{$} character.
30223
30224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30225
30226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
30227
30228 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
30229 @findex -trace-frame-collected
30230
30231 @subsubheading Synopsis
30232
30233 @smallexample
30234 -trace-frame-collected
30235 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
30236 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
30237 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
30238 [--memory-contents]
30239 @end smallexample
30240
30241 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
30242 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
30243 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
30244 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
30245 See the output description table below for more details.
30246
30247 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
30248 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
30249 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
30250 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
30251 memory range and which is a computed expression.
30252
30253 For instance, if the actions were
30254 @smallexample
30255 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
30256 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
30257 @end smallexample
30258
30259 @noindent
30260 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
30261 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
30262 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
30263 objects would be computed expressions.
30264
30265 An example output would be:
30266
30267 @smallexample
30268 (gdb)
30269 -trace-frame-collected
30270 ^done,
30271 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
30272 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
30273 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
30274 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
30275 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
30276 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
30277 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
30278 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
30279 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
30280 ...
30281 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
30282 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
30283 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
30284 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
30285 (gdb)
30286 @end smallexample
30287
30288 Where:
30289
30290 @table @code
30291 @item explicit-variables
30292 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
30293 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
30294 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
30295 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
30296 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
30297 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
30298 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
30299 arrays, structures and unions.
30300
30301 @item computed-expressions
30302 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
30303 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
30304 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
30305 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
30306
30307 @item registers
30308 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
30309 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
30310 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
30311 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
30312 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
30313
30314 @item tvars
30315 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
30316 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
30317 current value are returned.
30318
30319 @item memory
30320 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
30321 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
30322 collected memory range and has the following fields:
30323
30324 @table @code
30325 @item address
30326 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
30327
30328 @item length
30329 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
30330
30331 @item contents
30332 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
30333 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
30334
30335 @end table
30336
30337 @end table
30338
30339 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30340
30341 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30342
30343 @subsubheading Example
30344
30345 @subheading -trace-list-variables
30346 @findex -trace-list-variables
30347
30348 @subsubheading Synopsis
30349
30350 @smallexample
30351 -trace-list-variables
30352 @end smallexample
30353
30354 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
30355 table has the following fields:
30356
30357 @table @samp
30358 @item name
30359 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
30360
30361 @item initial
30362 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
30363 field is always present.
30364
30365 @item current
30366 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
30367 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
30368 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
30369 presently running.
30370
30371 @end table
30372
30373 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30374
30375 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
30376
30377 @subsubheading Example
30378
30379 @smallexample
30380 (gdb)
30381 -trace-list-variables
30382 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
30383 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
30384 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
30385 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
30386 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
30387 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
30388 (gdb)
30389 @end smallexample
30390
30391 @subheading -trace-save
30392 @findex -trace-save
30393
30394 @subsubheading Synopsis
30395
30396 @smallexample
30397 -trace-save [-r ] @var{filename}
30398 @end smallexample
30399
30400 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
30401 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
30402 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
30403 to perform the save.
30404
30405 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30406
30407 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
30408
30409
30410 @subheading -trace-start
30411 @findex -trace-start
30412
30413 @subsubheading Synopsis
30414
30415 @smallexample
30416 -trace-start
30417 @end smallexample
30418
30419 Starts a tracing experiments. The result of this command does not
30420 have any fields.
30421
30422 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30423
30424 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
30425
30426 @subheading -trace-status
30427 @findex -trace-status
30428
30429 @subsubheading Synopsis
30430
30431 @smallexample
30432 -trace-status
30433 @end smallexample
30434
30435 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
30436 the following fields:
30437
30438 @table @samp
30439
30440 @item supported
30441 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
30442 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
30443 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
30444 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
30445 started. This field is always present.
30446
30447 @item running
30448 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
30449 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
30450 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30451
30452 @item stop-reason
30453 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
30454 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
30455 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
30456 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
30457 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
30458 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
30459 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
30460 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
30461 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
30462
30463 @item stopping-tracepoint
30464 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
30465 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
30466 @samp{passcount}.
30467
30468 @item frames
30469 @itemx frames-created
30470 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
30471 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
30472 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
30473 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
30474
30475 @item buffer-size
30476 @itemx buffer-free
30477 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
30478 remaining space. These fields are optional.
30479
30480 @item circular
30481 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
30482 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
30483 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
30484 and may fill up.
30485
30486 @item disconnected
30487 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
30488 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
30489 that the trace run will stop.
30490
30491 @item trace-file
30492 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
30493 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
30494
30495 @end table
30496
30497 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30498
30499 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
30500
30501 @subheading -trace-stop
30502 @findex -trace-stop
30503
30504 @subsubheading Synopsis
30505
30506 @smallexample
30507 -trace-stop
30508 @end smallexample
30509
30510 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
30511 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
30512 @samp{running} fields are not output.
30513
30514 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30515
30516 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
30517
30518
30519 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30520 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
30521 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
30522
30523
30524 @ignore
30525 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
30526 @findex -symbol-info-address
30527
30528 @subsubheading Synopsis
30529
30530 @smallexample
30531 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
30532 @end smallexample
30533
30534 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
30535
30536 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30537
30538 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
30539
30540 @subsubheading Example
30541 N.A.
30542
30543
30544 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
30545 @findex -symbol-info-file
30546
30547 @subsubheading Synopsis
30548
30549 @smallexample
30550 -symbol-info-file
30551 @end smallexample
30552
30553 Show the file for the symbol.
30554
30555 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30556
30557 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
30558 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
30559
30560 @subsubheading Example
30561 N.A.
30562
30563
30564 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
30565 @findex -symbol-info-function
30566
30567 @subsubheading Synopsis
30568
30569 @smallexample
30570 -symbol-info-function
30571 @end smallexample
30572
30573 Show which function the symbol lives in.
30574
30575 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30576
30577 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
30578
30579 @subsubheading Example
30580 N.A.
30581
30582
30583 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
30584 @findex -symbol-info-line
30585
30586 @subsubheading Synopsis
30587
30588 @smallexample
30589 -symbol-info-line
30590 @end smallexample
30591
30592 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
30593
30594 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30595
30596 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
30597 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
30598
30599 @subsubheading Example
30600 N.A.
30601
30602
30603 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
30604 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
30605
30606 @subsubheading Synopsis
30607
30608 @smallexample
30609 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
30610 @end smallexample
30611
30612 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
30613
30614 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30615
30616 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
30617
30618 @subsubheading Example
30619 N.A.
30620
30621
30622 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
30623 @findex -symbol-list-functions
30624
30625 @subsubheading Synopsis
30626
30627 @smallexample
30628 -symbol-list-functions
30629 @end smallexample
30630
30631 List the functions in the executable.
30632
30633 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30634
30635 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
30636 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30637
30638 @subsubheading Example
30639 N.A.
30640 @end ignore
30641
30642
30643 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
30644 @findex -symbol-list-lines
30645
30646 @subsubheading Synopsis
30647
30648 @smallexample
30649 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
30650 @end smallexample
30651
30652 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
30653 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
30654 ascending PC order.
30655
30656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30657
30658 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
30659
30660 @subsubheading Example
30661 @smallexample
30662 (gdb)
30663 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
30664 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
30665 (gdb)
30666 @end smallexample
30667
30668
30669 @ignore
30670 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
30671 @findex -symbol-list-types
30672
30673 @subsubheading Synopsis
30674
30675 @smallexample
30676 -symbol-list-types
30677 @end smallexample
30678
30679 List all the type names.
30680
30681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30682
30683 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
30684 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30685
30686 @subsubheading Example
30687 N.A.
30688
30689
30690 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
30691 @findex -symbol-list-variables
30692
30693 @subsubheading Synopsis
30694
30695 @smallexample
30696 -symbol-list-variables
30697 @end smallexample
30698
30699 List all the global and static variable names.
30700
30701 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30702
30703 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
30704
30705 @subsubheading Example
30706 N.A.
30707
30708
30709 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
30710 @findex -symbol-locate
30711
30712 @subsubheading Synopsis
30713
30714 @smallexample
30715 -symbol-locate
30716 @end smallexample
30717
30718 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30719
30720 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
30721
30722 @subsubheading Example
30723 N.A.
30724
30725
30726 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
30727 @findex -symbol-type
30728
30729 @subsubheading Synopsis
30730
30731 @smallexample
30732 -symbol-type @var{variable}
30733 @end smallexample
30734
30735 Show type of @var{variable}.
30736
30737 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30738
30739 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
30740 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
30741
30742 @subsubheading Example
30743 N.A.
30744 @end ignore
30745
30746
30747 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30748 @node GDB/MI File Commands
30749 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
30750
30751 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
30752 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
30753
30754 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
30755 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
30756
30757 @subsubheading Synopsis
30758
30759 @smallexample
30760 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
30761 @end smallexample
30762
30763 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
30764 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
30765 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
30766 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
30767 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
30768 notification.
30769
30770 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30771
30772 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
30773
30774 @subsubheading Example
30775
30776 @smallexample
30777 (gdb)
30778 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30779 ^done
30780 (gdb)
30781 @end smallexample
30782
30783
30784 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
30785 @findex -file-exec-file
30786
30787 @subsubheading Synopsis
30788
30789 @smallexample
30790 -file-exec-file @var{file}
30791 @end smallexample
30792
30793 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
30794 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
30795 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
30796 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
30797 notification.
30798
30799 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30800
30801 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
30802
30803 @subsubheading Example
30804
30805 @smallexample
30806 (gdb)
30807 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30808 ^done
30809 (gdb)
30810 @end smallexample
30811
30812
30813 @ignore
30814 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
30815 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
30816
30817 @subsubheading Synopsis
30818
30819 @smallexample
30820 -file-list-exec-sections
30821 @end smallexample
30822
30823 List the sections of the current executable file.
30824
30825 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30826
30827 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
30828 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
30829 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
30830
30831 @subsubheading Example
30832 N.A.
30833 @end ignore
30834
30835
30836 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
30837 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
30838
30839 @subsubheading Synopsis
30840
30841 @smallexample
30842 -file-list-exec-source-file
30843 @end smallexample
30844
30845 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
30846 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
30847 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
30848 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
30849
30850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30851
30852 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
30853
30854 @subsubheading Example
30855
30856 @smallexample
30857 (gdb)
30858 123-file-list-exec-source-file
30859 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
30860 (gdb)
30861 @end smallexample
30862
30863
30864 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
30865 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
30866
30867 @subsubheading Synopsis
30868
30869 @smallexample
30870 -file-list-exec-source-files
30871 @end smallexample
30872
30873 List the source files for the current executable.
30874
30875 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
30876 name) of a source file.
30877
30878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30879
30880 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
30881 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
30882
30883 @subsubheading Example
30884 @smallexample
30885 (gdb)
30886 -file-list-exec-source-files
30887 ^done,files=[
30888 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
30889 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
30890 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
30891 (gdb)
30892 @end smallexample
30893
30894 @ignore
30895 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
30896 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
30897
30898 @subsubheading Synopsis
30899
30900 @smallexample
30901 -file-list-shared-libraries
30902 @end smallexample
30903
30904 List the shared libraries in the program.
30905
30906 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30907
30908 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
30909
30910 @subsubheading Example
30911 N.A.
30912
30913
30914 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
30915 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
30916
30917 @subsubheading Synopsis
30918
30919 @smallexample
30920 -file-list-symbol-files
30921 @end smallexample
30922
30923 List symbol files.
30924
30925 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30926
30927 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
30928
30929 @subsubheading Example
30930 N.A.
30931 @end ignore
30932
30933
30934 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
30935 @findex -file-symbol-file
30936
30937 @subsubheading Synopsis
30938
30939 @smallexample
30940 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
30941 @end smallexample
30942
30943 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
30944 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
30945 produced, except for a completion notification.
30946
30947 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30948
30949 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
30950
30951 @subsubheading Example
30952
30953 @smallexample
30954 (gdb)
30955 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
30956 ^done
30957 (gdb)
30958 @end smallexample
30959
30960 @ignore
30961 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30962 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
30963 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
30964
30965 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
30966
30967 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
30968
30969 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
30970
30971 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
30972
30973 @c @subheading -overlay-map
30974
30975 @c @subheading -overlay-off
30976
30977 @c @subheading -overlay-on
30978
30979 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
30980
30981 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30982 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
30983 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
30984
30985 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
30986
30987 @c @subheading -signal-handle
30988
30989 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
30990
30991 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
30992 @end ignore
30993
30994
30995 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30996 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
30997 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
30998
30999
31000 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
31001 @findex -target-attach
31002
31003 @subsubheading Synopsis
31004
31005 @smallexample
31006 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
31007 @end smallexample
31008
31009 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
31010 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
31011 group, the id previously returned by
31012 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
31013
31014 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31015
31016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
31017
31018 @subsubheading Example
31019 @smallexample
31020 (gdb)
31021 -target-attach 34
31022 =thread-created,id="1"
31023 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
31024 ^done
31025 (gdb)
31026 @end smallexample
31027
31028 @ignore
31029 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
31030 @findex -target-compare-sections
31031
31032 @subsubheading Synopsis
31033
31034 @smallexample
31035 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
31036 @end smallexample
31037
31038 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
31039 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
31040
31041 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31042
31043 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
31044
31045 @subsubheading Example
31046 N.A.
31047 @end ignore
31048
31049
31050 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
31051 @findex -target-detach
31052
31053 @subsubheading Synopsis
31054
31055 @smallexample
31056 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
31057 @end smallexample
31058
31059 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
31060 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
31061 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
31062
31063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31064
31065 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
31066
31067 @subsubheading Example
31068
31069 @smallexample
31070 (gdb)
31071 -target-detach
31072 ^done
31073 (gdb)
31074 @end smallexample
31075
31076
31077 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
31078 @findex -target-disconnect
31079
31080 @subsubheading Synopsis
31081
31082 @smallexample
31083 -target-disconnect
31084 @end smallexample
31085
31086 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
31087 generally not resumed.
31088
31089 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31090
31091 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
31092
31093 @subsubheading Example
31094
31095 @smallexample
31096 (gdb)
31097 -target-disconnect
31098 ^done
31099 (gdb)
31100 @end smallexample
31101
31102
31103 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
31104 @findex -target-download
31105
31106 @subsubheading Synopsis
31107
31108 @smallexample
31109 -target-download
31110 @end smallexample
31111
31112 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
31113 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
31114
31115 @table @samp
31116 @item section
31117 The name of the section.
31118 @item section-sent
31119 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
31120 @item section-size
31121 The size of the section.
31122 @item total-sent
31123 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
31124 @item total-size
31125 The size of the overall executable to download.
31126 @end table
31127
31128 @noindent
31129 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
31130 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
31131
31132 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
31133 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
31134
31135 @table @samp
31136 @item section
31137 The name of the section.
31138 @item section-size
31139 The size of the section.
31140 @item total-size
31141 The size of the overall executable to download.
31142 @end table
31143
31144 @noindent
31145 At the end, a summary is printed.
31146
31147 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31148
31149 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
31150
31151 @subsubheading Example
31152
31153 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
31154 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
31155
31156 @smallexample
31157 (gdb)
31158 -target-download
31159 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
31160 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
31161 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
31162 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
31163 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
31164 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
31165 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
31166 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
31167 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
31168 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
31169 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
31170 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
31171 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
31172 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
31173 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
31174 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
31175 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
31176 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
31177 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
31178 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
31179 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
31180 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
31181 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
31182 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
31183 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
31184 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
31185 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
31186 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31187 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
31188 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
31189 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
31190 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
31191 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
31192 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
31193 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
31194 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
31195 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
31196 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
31197 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
31198 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
31199 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
31200 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
31201 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
31202 write-rate="429"
31203 (gdb)
31204 @end smallexample
31205
31206
31207 @ignore
31208 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
31209 @findex -target-exec-status
31210
31211 @subsubheading Synopsis
31212
31213 @smallexample
31214 -target-exec-status
31215 @end smallexample
31216
31217 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
31218 not, for instance).
31219
31220 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31221
31222 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31223
31224 @subsubheading Example
31225 N.A.
31226
31227
31228 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
31229 @findex -target-list-available-targets
31230
31231 @subsubheading Synopsis
31232
31233 @smallexample
31234 -target-list-available-targets
31235 @end smallexample
31236
31237 List the possible targets to connect to.
31238
31239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31240
31241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
31242
31243 @subsubheading Example
31244 N.A.
31245
31246
31247 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
31248 @findex -target-list-current-targets
31249
31250 @subsubheading Synopsis
31251
31252 @smallexample
31253 -target-list-current-targets
31254 @end smallexample
31255
31256 Describe the current target.
31257
31258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31259
31260 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
31261 other things).
31262
31263 @subsubheading Example
31264 N.A.
31265
31266
31267 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
31268 @findex -target-list-parameters
31269
31270 @subsubheading Synopsis
31271
31272 @smallexample
31273 -target-list-parameters
31274 @end smallexample
31275
31276 @c ????
31277 @end ignore
31278
31279 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31280
31281 No equivalent.
31282
31283 @subsubheading Example
31284 N.A.
31285
31286
31287 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
31288 @findex -target-select
31289
31290 @subsubheading Synopsis
31291
31292 @smallexample
31293 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
31294 @end smallexample
31295
31296 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
31297
31298 @table @samp
31299 @item @var{type}
31300 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
31301 @item @var{parameters}
31302 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
31303 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
31304 @end table
31305
31306 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
31307 which the target program is, in the following form:
31308
31309 @smallexample
31310 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
31311 args=[@var{arg list}]
31312 @end smallexample
31313
31314 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31315
31316 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
31317
31318 @subsubheading Example
31319
31320 @smallexample
31321 (gdb)
31322 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
31323 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
31324 (gdb)
31325 @end smallexample
31326
31327 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31328 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
31329 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
31330
31331
31332 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
31333 @findex -target-file-put
31334
31335 @subsubheading Synopsis
31336
31337 @smallexample
31338 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
31339 @end smallexample
31340
31341 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
31342 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
31343
31344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31345
31346 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
31347
31348 @subsubheading Example
31349
31350 @smallexample
31351 (gdb)
31352 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
31353 ^done
31354 (gdb)
31355 @end smallexample
31356
31357
31358 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
31359 @findex -target-file-get
31360
31361 @subsubheading Synopsis
31362
31363 @smallexample
31364 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
31365 @end smallexample
31366
31367 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
31368 on the host system.
31369
31370 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31371
31372 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
31373
31374 @subsubheading Example
31375
31376 @smallexample
31377 (gdb)
31378 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
31379 ^done
31380 (gdb)
31381 @end smallexample
31382
31383
31384 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
31385 @findex -target-file-delete
31386
31387 @subsubheading Synopsis
31388
31389 @smallexample
31390 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
31391 @end smallexample
31392
31393 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
31394
31395 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31396
31397 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
31398
31399 @subsubheading Example
31400
31401 @smallexample
31402 (gdb)
31403 -target-file-delete remotefile
31404 ^done
31405 (gdb)
31406 @end smallexample
31407
31408
31409 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31410 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
31411 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31412
31413 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
31414 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
31415
31416 @subsubheading Synopsis
31417
31418 @smallexample
31419 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
31420 @end smallexample
31421
31422 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
31423 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
31424 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
31425
31426 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31427
31428 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
31429
31430 @subsubheading Result
31431
31432 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
31433 defined for each exception:
31434
31435 @table @samp
31436 @item name
31437 The name of the exception.
31438
31439 @item address
31440 The address of the exception.
31441
31442 @end table
31443
31444 @subsubheading Example
31445
31446 @smallexample
31447 -info-ada-exceptions aint
31448 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
31449 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
31450 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
31451 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
31452 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
31453 @end smallexample
31454
31455 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
31456
31457 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
31458 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
31459 Catchpoint Commands}.
31460
31461
31462 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31463 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
31464 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
31465
31466 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
31467 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
31468 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
31469 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
31470
31471 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
31472 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
31473 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
31474
31475 @subsubheading Synopsis
31476
31477 @smallexample
31478 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
31479 @end smallexample
31480
31481 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
31482
31483 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
31484 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
31485 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
31486 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
31487 dash.
31488
31489 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31490
31491 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31492
31493 @subsubheading Result
31494
31495 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
31496
31497 @table @samp
31498 @item exists
31499 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
31500 @code{"false"} otherwise.
31501
31502 @end table
31503
31504 @subsubheading Example
31505
31506 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
31507
31508 @smallexample
31509 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
31510 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
31511 @end smallexample
31512
31513 @noindent
31514 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
31515 to the debugger:
31516
31517 @smallexample
31518 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
31519 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
31520 @end smallexample
31521
31522 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
31523 @findex -list-features
31524 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
31525
31526 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
31527 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
31528 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
31529 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
31530 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
31531 startup.
31532
31533 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
31534 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
31535 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
31536 is given below.
31537
31538 Example output:
31539
31540 @smallexample
31541 (gdb) -list-features
31542 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
31543 @end smallexample
31544
31545 The current list of features is:
31546
31547 @ftable @samp
31548 @item frozen-varobjs
31549 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
31550 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
31551 of @code{-varobj-create}.
31552 @item pending-breakpoints
31553 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
31554 command.
31555 @item python
31556 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
31557 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
31558 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
31559 @item thread-info
31560 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
31561 @item data-read-memory-bytes
31562 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
31563 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
31564 @item breakpoint-notifications
31565 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
31566 CLI will be announced via async records.
31567 @item ada-task-info
31568 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
31569 @item language-option
31570 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
31571 option (@pxref{Context management}).
31572 @item info-gdb-mi-command
31573 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
31574 @item undefined-command-error-code
31575 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
31576 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
31577 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
31578 @item exec-run-start-option
31579 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
31580 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
31581 @end ftable
31582
31583 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
31584 @findex -list-target-features
31585
31586 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
31587 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
31588 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
31589 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
31590 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
31591 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
31592 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
31593 Example output:
31594
31595 @smallexample
31596 (gdb) -list-target-features
31597 ^done,result=["async"]
31598 @end smallexample
31599
31600 The current list of features is:
31601
31602 @table @samp
31603 @item async
31604 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
31605 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
31606 while the target is running.
31607
31608 @item reverse
31609 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
31610 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
31611
31612 @end table
31613
31614 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31615 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
31616 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
31617
31618 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
31619
31620 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
31621 @findex -gdb-exit
31622
31623 @subsubheading Synopsis
31624
31625 @smallexample
31626 -gdb-exit
31627 @end smallexample
31628
31629 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
31630
31631 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31632
31633 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
31634
31635 @subsubheading Example
31636
31637 @smallexample
31638 (gdb)
31639 -gdb-exit
31640 ^exit
31641 @end smallexample
31642
31643
31644 @ignore
31645 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
31646 @findex -exec-abort
31647
31648 @subsubheading Synopsis
31649
31650 @smallexample
31651 -exec-abort
31652 @end smallexample
31653
31654 Kill the inferior running program.
31655
31656 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31657
31658 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
31659
31660 @subsubheading Example
31661 N.A.
31662 @end ignore
31663
31664
31665 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
31666 @findex -gdb-set
31667
31668 @subsubheading Synopsis
31669
31670 @smallexample
31671 -gdb-set
31672 @end smallexample
31673
31674 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
31675 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
31676
31677 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31678
31679 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
31680
31681 @subsubheading Example
31682
31683 @smallexample
31684 (gdb)
31685 -gdb-set $foo=3
31686 ^done
31687 (gdb)
31688 @end smallexample
31689
31690
31691 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
31692 @findex -gdb-show
31693
31694 @subsubheading Synopsis
31695
31696 @smallexample
31697 -gdb-show
31698 @end smallexample
31699
31700 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
31701
31702 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31703
31704 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
31705
31706 @subsubheading Example
31707
31708 @smallexample
31709 (gdb)
31710 -gdb-show annotate
31711 ^done,value="0"
31712 (gdb)
31713 @end smallexample
31714
31715 @c @subheading -gdb-source
31716
31717
31718 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
31719 @findex -gdb-version
31720
31721 @subsubheading Synopsis
31722
31723 @smallexample
31724 -gdb-version
31725 @end smallexample
31726
31727 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
31728
31729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31730
31731 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
31732 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
31733
31734 @subsubheading Example
31735
31736 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
31737 @c box in TeX.
31738 @smallexample
31739 (gdb)
31740 -gdb-version
31741 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
31742 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
31743 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
31744 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
31745 ~ certain conditions.
31746 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
31747 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
31748 ~ details.
31749 ~This GDB was configured as
31750 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
31751 ^done
31752 (gdb)
31753 @end smallexample
31754
31755 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
31756 @findex -list-thread-groups
31757
31758 @subheading Synopsis
31759
31760 @smallexample
31761 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
31762 @end smallexample
31763
31764 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
31765 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
31766 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
31767 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
31768 top-level thread groups.
31769
31770 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
31771 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
31772 available on the target.
31773
31774 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
31775 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
31776 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
31777 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
31778 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
31779 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
31780 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
31781 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
31782
31783 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
31784 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
31785 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
31786 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
31787 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
31788 @samp{threads} field.
31789
31790 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
31791 the following caveats:
31792
31793 @itemize @bullet
31794 @item
31795 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
31796 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
31797 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
31798
31799 @item
31800 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
31801 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
31802 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
31803 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
31804 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
31805 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
31806
31807 @end itemize
31808
31809 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
31810 have the following fields:
31811
31812 @table @code
31813 @item id
31814 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
31815 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
31816 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
31817
31818 @item type
31819 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
31820 valid type.
31821
31822 @item pid
31823 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
31824 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
31825
31826 @item exit-code
31827 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
31828 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
31829 only if the process is not running.
31830
31831 @item num_children
31832 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
31833 absent for an available thread group.
31834
31835 @item threads
31836 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
31837 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
31838 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
31839
31840 @item cores
31841 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
31842 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
31843 such information is not available.
31844
31845 @item executable
31846 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
31847 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
31848 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
31849
31850 @end table
31851
31852 @subheading Example
31853
31854 @smallexample
31855 @value{GDBP}
31856 -list-thread-groups
31857 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
31858 -list-thread-groups 17
31859 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
31860 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
31861 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
31862 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
31863 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
31864 -list-thread-groups --available
31865 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
31866 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
31867 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31868 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31869 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
31870 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
31871 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
31872 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
31873 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
31874 @end smallexample
31875
31876 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
31877 @findex -info-os
31878
31879 @subsubheading Synopsis
31880
31881 @smallexample
31882 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
31883 @end smallexample
31884
31885 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
31886 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
31887 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
31888 of data of that type.
31889
31890 The types of information available depend on the target operating
31891 system.
31892
31893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31894
31895 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
31896
31897 @subsubheading Example
31898
31899 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
31900 like this:
31901
31902 @smallexample
31903 @value{GDBP}
31904 -info-os
31905 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
31906 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
31907 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
31908 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
31909 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
31910 col2="CPUs"@},
31911 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
31912 col2="File descriptors"@},
31913 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
31914 col2="Kernel modules"@},
31915 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
31916 col2="Message queues"@},
31917 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
31918 col2="Processes"@},
31919 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
31920 col2="Process groups"@},
31921 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
31922 col2="Semaphores"@},
31923 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
31924 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
31925 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
31926 col2="Sockets"@},
31927 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
31928 col2="Threads"@}]
31929 @value{GDBP}
31930 -info-os processes
31931 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
31932 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
31933 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
31934 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
31935 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
31936 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
31937 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
31938 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
31939 ...
31940 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
31941 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
31942 (gdb)
31943 @end smallexample
31944
31945 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
31946 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
31947 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
31948 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
31949 @code{info os} omits it.)
31950
31951 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
31952 @findex -add-inferior
31953
31954 @subheading Synopsis
31955
31956 @smallexample
31957 -add-inferior
31958 @end smallexample
31959
31960 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
31961 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
31962 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
31963 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
31964 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
31965 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
31966
31967 @subheading Example
31968
31969 @smallexample
31970 @value{GDBP}
31971 -add-inferior
31972 ^done,inferior="i3"
31973 @end smallexample
31974
31975 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
31976 @findex -interpreter-exec
31977
31978 @subheading Synopsis
31979
31980 @smallexample
31981 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
31982 @end smallexample
31983 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
31984
31985 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
31986
31987 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
31988
31989 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
31990
31991 @subheading Example
31992
31993 @smallexample
31994 (gdb)
31995 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
31996 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
31997 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
31998 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
31999 ^done
32000 (gdb)
32001 @end smallexample
32002
32003 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
32004 @findex -inferior-tty-set
32005
32006 @subheading Synopsis
32007
32008 @smallexample
32009 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32010 @end smallexample
32011
32012 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
32013
32014 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32015
32016 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
32017
32018 @subheading Example
32019
32020 @smallexample
32021 (gdb)
32022 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32023 ^done
32024 (gdb)
32025 @end smallexample
32026
32027 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
32028 @findex -inferior-tty-show
32029
32030 @subheading Synopsis
32031
32032 @smallexample
32033 -inferior-tty-show
32034 @end smallexample
32035
32036 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
32037
32038 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32039
32040 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
32041
32042 @subheading Example
32043
32044 @smallexample
32045 (gdb)
32046 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
32047 ^done
32048 (gdb)
32049 -inferior-tty-show
32050 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
32051 (gdb)
32052 @end smallexample
32053
32054 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
32055 @findex -enable-timings
32056
32057 @subheading Synopsis
32058
32059 @smallexample
32060 -enable-timings [yes | no]
32061 @end smallexample
32062
32063 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
32064 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
32065 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
32066 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
32067
32068 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
32069
32070 No equivalent.
32071
32072 @subheading Example
32073
32074 @smallexample
32075 (gdb)
32076 -enable-timings
32077 ^done
32078 (gdb)
32079 -break-insert main
32080 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
32081 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
32082 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
32083 times="0"@},
32084 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
32085 (gdb)
32086 -enable-timings no
32087 ^done
32088 (gdb)
32089 -exec-run
32090 ^running
32091 (gdb)
32092 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
32093 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
32094 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
32095 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
32096 (gdb)
32097 @end smallexample
32098
32099 @node Annotations
32100 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
32101
32102 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
32103 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
32104 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
32105 relatively high level.
32106
32107 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
32108 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
32109
32110 @ignore
32111 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
32112 @end ignore
32113
32114 @menu
32115 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
32116 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
32117 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
32118 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
32119 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
32120 * Annotations for Running::
32121 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
32122 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
32123 @end menu
32124
32125 @node Annotations Overview
32126 @section What is an Annotation?
32127 @cindex annotations
32128
32129 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
32130 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
32131 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
32132 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
32133 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
32134 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
32135 cannot contain newline characters.
32136
32137 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
32138 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
32139 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
32140 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
32141 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
32142 means those three characters as output.
32143
32144 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
32145 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
32146 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
32147 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
32148 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
32149 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
32150 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
32151 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
32152 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
32153
32154 @table @code
32155 @kindex set annotate
32156 @item set annotate @var{level}
32157 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
32158 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
32159
32160 @item show annotate
32161 @kindex show annotate
32162 Show the current annotation level.
32163 @end table
32164
32165 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
32166
32167 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
32168
32169 @smallexample
32170 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
32171 GNU gdb 6.0
32172 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
32173 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
32174 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
32175 under certain conditions.
32176 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
32177 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
32178 for details.
32179 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
32180
32181 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32182 (@value{GDBP})
32183 ^Z^Zprompt
32184 @kbd{quit}
32185
32186 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32187 $
32188 @end smallexample
32189
32190 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
32191 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
32192 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
32193 output from @value{GDBN}.
32194
32195 @node Server Prefix
32196 @section The Server Prefix
32197 @cindex server prefix
32198
32199 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
32200 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
32201 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
32202 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
32203 a transparent manner.
32204
32205 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
32206 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
32207 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
32208 @code{print} command.
32209
32210 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
32211 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
32212
32213 @node Prompting
32214 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
32215
32216 @cindex annotations for prompts
32217 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
32218 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
32219 over, etc.
32220
32221 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
32222 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
32223 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
32224 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
32225 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
32226 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
32227 features the following annotations:
32228
32229 @smallexample
32230 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
32231 ^Z^Zprompt
32232 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
32233 @end smallexample
32234
32235 The input types are
32236
32237 @table @code
32238 @findex pre-prompt annotation
32239 @findex prompt annotation
32240 @findex post-prompt annotation
32241 @item prompt
32242 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
32243
32244 @findex pre-commands annotation
32245 @findex commands annotation
32246 @findex post-commands annotation
32247 @item commands
32248 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
32249 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
32250
32251 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
32252 @findex overload-choice annotation
32253 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
32254 @item overload-choice
32255 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
32256
32257 @findex pre-query annotation
32258 @findex query annotation
32259 @findex post-query annotation
32260 @item query
32261 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
32262
32263 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
32264 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
32265 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
32266 @item prompt-for-continue
32267 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
32268 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
32269 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
32270 presence of annotations.
32271 @end table
32272
32273 @node Errors
32274 @section Errors
32275 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
32276
32277 @findex quit annotation
32278 @smallexample
32279 ^Z^Zquit
32280 @end smallexample
32281
32282 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
32283
32284 @findex error annotation
32285 @smallexample
32286 ^Z^Zerror
32287 @end smallexample
32288
32289 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
32290
32291 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
32292 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
32293 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
32294 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
32295 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
32296 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
32297 to the top level.
32298
32299 @findex error-begin annotation
32300 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
32301
32302 @smallexample
32303 ^Z^Zerror-begin
32304 @end smallexample
32305
32306 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
32307 message.
32308
32309 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
32310 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
32311 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
32312
32313 @node Invalidation
32314 @section Invalidation Notices
32315
32316 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
32317 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
32318 changed.
32319
32320 @table @code
32321 @findex frames-invalid annotation
32322 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
32323
32324 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
32325 have changed.
32326
32327 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
32328 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
32329
32330 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
32331 deleted a breakpoint.
32332 @end table
32333
32334 @node Annotations for Running
32335 @section Running the Program
32336 @cindex annotations for running programs
32337
32338 @findex starting annotation
32339 @findex stopping annotation
32340 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
32341 @code{step} or @code{continue},
32342
32343 @smallexample
32344 ^Z^Zstarting
32345 @end smallexample
32346
32347 is output. When the program stops,
32348
32349 @smallexample
32350 ^Z^Zstopped
32351 @end smallexample
32352
32353 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
32354 annotations describe how the program stopped.
32355
32356 @table @code
32357 @findex exited annotation
32358 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
32359 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
32360 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
32361
32362 @findex signalled annotation
32363 @findex signal-name annotation
32364 @findex signal-name-end annotation
32365 @findex signal-string annotation
32366 @findex signal-string-end annotation
32367 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
32368 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
32369 annotation continues:
32370
32371 @smallexample
32372 @var{intro-text}
32373 ^Z^Zsignal-name
32374 @var{name}
32375 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
32376 @var{middle-text}
32377 ^Z^Zsignal-string
32378 @var{string}
32379 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
32380 @var{end-text}
32381 @end smallexample
32382
32383 @noindent
32384 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
32385 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
32386 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
32387 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
32388 user's benefit and have no particular format.
32389
32390 @findex signal annotation
32391 @item ^Z^Zsignal
32392 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
32393 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
32394 terminated with it.
32395
32396 @findex breakpoint annotation
32397 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
32398 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
32399
32400 @findex watchpoint annotation
32401 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
32402 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
32403 @end table
32404
32405 @node Source Annotations
32406 @section Displaying Source
32407 @cindex annotations for source display
32408
32409 @findex source annotation
32410 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
32411
32412 @smallexample
32413 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
32414 @end smallexample
32415
32416 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
32417 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
32418 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
32419 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
32420 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
32421 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
32422 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
32423 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
32424 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
32425 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
32426 depend on the language).
32427
32428 @node JIT Interface
32429 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
32430 @cindex just-in-time compilation
32431 @cindex JIT compilation interface
32432
32433 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
32434 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
32435 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
32436 performance while maintaining platform independence.
32437
32438 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
32439 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
32440 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
32441 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
32442 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
32443 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
32444
32445 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
32446 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
32447 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
32448 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
32449 LLVM JIT.
32450
32451 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
32452 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
32453 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
32454 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
32455 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
32456 out about additional code.
32457
32458 @menu
32459 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
32460 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
32461 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
32462 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
32463 @end menu
32464
32465 @node Declarations
32466 @section JIT Declarations
32467
32468 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
32469 implement the interface:
32470
32471 @smallexample
32472 typedef enum
32473 @{
32474 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
32475 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
32476 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
32477 @} jit_actions_t;
32478
32479 struct jit_code_entry
32480 @{
32481 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
32482 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
32483 const char *symfile_addr;
32484 uint64_t symfile_size;
32485 @};
32486
32487 struct jit_descriptor
32488 @{
32489 uint32_t version;
32490 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
32491 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
32492 uint32_t action_flag;
32493 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
32494 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
32495 @};
32496
32497 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
32498 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
32499
32500 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
32501 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
32502 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
32503 @end smallexample
32504
32505 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
32506 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
32507 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
32508
32509 @node Registering Code
32510 @section Registering Code
32511
32512 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
32513
32514 @itemize @bullet
32515 @item
32516 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
32517 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
32518
32519 @item
32520 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
32521 file.
32522
32523 @item
32524 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
32525
32526 @item
32527 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
32528
32529 @item
32530 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
32531 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32532 @end itemize
32533
32534 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
32535 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
32536 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
32537 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
32538
32539 @node Unregistering Code
32540 @section Unregistering Code
32541
32542 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
32543
32544 @itemize @bullet
32545 @item
32546 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
32547
32548 @item
32549 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
32550
32551 @item
32552 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
32553 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
32554 @end itemize
32555
32556 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
32557 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
32558
32559 @node Custom Debug Info
32560 @section Custom Debug Info
32561 @cindex custom JIT debug info
32562 @cindex JIT debug info reader
32563
32564 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
32565 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
32566 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
32567 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
32568 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
32569 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
32570 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
32571 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
32572 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
32573
32574 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
32575 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
32576 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
32577 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
32578 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
32579 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
32580 compiler.
32581
32582 @menu
32583 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
32584 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
32585 @end menu
32586
32587 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32588 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
32589 @kindex jit-reader-load
32590 @kindex jit-reader-unload
32591
32592 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
32593 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
32594
32595 @table @code
32596 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
32597 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
32598 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
32599 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
32600 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
32601 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
32602 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
32603
32604 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
32605 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
32606 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
32607 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
32608 @code{jit-reader-load}.
32609
32610 @item jit-reader-unload
32611 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
32612
32613 @end table
32614
32615 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32616 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
32617 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
32618
32619 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
32620 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
32621
32622 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
32623 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
32624 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
32625 the system include directory.
32626
32627 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
32628 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
32629 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
32630
32631 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
32632 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
32633
32634 @findex gdb_init_reader
32635 @smallexample
32636 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
32637 @end smallexample
32638
32639 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
32640
32641 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
32642 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
32643 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
32644 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
32645 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
32646 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
32647
32648 @smallexample
32649 struct gdb_reader_funcs
32650 @{
32651 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
32652 int reader_version;
32653
32654 /* For use by the reader. */
32655 void *priv_data;
32656
32657 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
32658 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
32659 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
32660 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
32661 @};
32662 @end smallexample
32663
32664 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
32665 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
32666
32667 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
32668 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
32669 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
32670 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
32671 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
32672 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
32673 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
32674 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
32675 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
32676 target's address space.
32677
32678 @node In-Process Agent
32679 @chapter In-Process Agent
32680 @cindex debugging agent
32681 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
32682 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
32683 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
32684 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
32685 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
32686 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
32687 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
32688 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
32689 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
32690 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
32691 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
32692 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
32693 behavior without interrupting it.
32694
32695 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
32696 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
32697 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
32698 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
32699 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
32700 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
32701 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
32702 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
32703 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
32704
32705 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
32706 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
32707 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
32708 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
32709
32710 @anchor{Control Agent}
32711 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
32712 debugging with the following commands:
32713
32714 @table @code
32715 @kindex set agent on
32716 @item set agent on
32717 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
32718 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
32719 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
32720 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
32721 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
32722 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
32723
32724 @kindex set agent off
32725 @item set agent off
32726 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
32727 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
32728
32729 @kindex show agent
32730 @item show agent
32731 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
32732 the in-process agent.
32733 @end table
32734
32735 @menu
32736 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
32737 @end menu
32738
32739 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
32740 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
32741 @cindex in-process agent protocol
32742
32743 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
32744 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
32745 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
32746 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
32747 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
32748 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
32749 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
32750 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
32751 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
32752
32753 @menu
32754 * IPA Protocol Objects::
32755 * IPA Protocol Commands::
32756 @end menu
32757
32758 @node IPA Protocol Objects
32759 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
32760 @cindex ipa protocol objects
32761
32762 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
32763 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
32764
32765 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
32766 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
32767 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
32768 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
32769
32770 @enumerate
32771 @item
32772 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
32773 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
32774 @item
32775 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
32776 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
32777 the other one.
32778 @end enumerate
32779
32780 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
32781
32782 @enumerate
32783 @item
32784 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
32785 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
32786 @anchor{agent expression object}
32787 @item
32788 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
32789 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
32790 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
32791 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
32792 @item
32793 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
32794 @anchor{tracepoint object}
32795
32796 @end enumerate
32797
32798 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
32799 object:
32800
32801 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
32802 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
32803 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
32804 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
32805 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
32806 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
32807 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32808 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
32809 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
32810 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
32811 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
32812 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
32813 memory address for collecting.
32814 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
32815 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32816 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
32817 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32818 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
32819 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
32820 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
32821 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
32822 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
32823 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
32824 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
32825 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
32826 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
32827 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
32828 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
32829 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
32830 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
32831 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
32832 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
32833 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
32834 @ref{agent expression object}
32835 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
32836 @ref{agent expression object}
32837 @item actions @tab variable
32838 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
32839 @end multitable
32840
32841 @node IPA Protocol Commands
32842 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
32843 @cindex ipa protocol commands
32844
32845 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
32846 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
32847
32848 @table @samp
32849
32850 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
32851 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
32852 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
32853 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
32854 in IPA finally.
32855
32856 Replies:
32857 @table @samp
32858 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
32859 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
32860 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
32861 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
32862 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
32863 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
32864 @item E @var{NN}
32865 for an error
32866
32867 @end table
32868
32869 @item close
32870 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
32871 is about to kill inferiors.
32872
32873 @item qTfSTM
32874 @xref{qTfSTM}.
32875 @item qTsSTM
32876 @xref{qTsSTM}.
32877 @item qTSTMat
32878 @xref{qTSTMat}.
32879 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
32880 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
32881
32882 Replies:
32883 @table @samp
32884 @item E @var{NN}
32885 for an error
32886 @end table
32887 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
32888 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
32889 @end table
32890
32891 @node GDB Bugs
32892 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
32893 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
32894 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
32895
32896 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
32897
32898 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
32899 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
32900 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
32901 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
32902
32903 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
32904 information that enables us to fix the bug.
32905
32906 @menu
32907 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
32908 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
32909 @end menu
32910
32911 @node Bug Criteria
32912 @section Have You Found a Bug?
32913 @cindex bug criteria
32914
32915 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
32916
32917 @itemize @bullet
32918 @cindex fatal signal
32919 @cindex debugger crash
32920 @cindex crash of debugger
32921 @item
32922 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
32923 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
32924
32925 @cindex error on valid input
32926 @item
32927 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
32928 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
32929 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
32930
32931 @cindex invalid input
32932 @item
32933 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
32934 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
32935 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
32936 for traditional practice''.
32937
32938 @item
32939 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
32940 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
32941 @end itemize
32942
32943 @node Bug Reporting
32944 @section How to Report Bugs
32945 @cindex bug reports
32946 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
32947
32948 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
32949 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
32950 contact that organization first.
32951
32952 You can find contact information for many support companies and
32953 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
32954 distribution.
32955 @c should add a web page ref...
32956
32957 @ifset BUGURL
32958 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
32959 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32960 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
32961 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
32962 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
32963 be used.
32964
32965 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
32966 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
32967 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
32968 @samp{bug-gdb}.
32969
32970 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
32971 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
32972 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
32973 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
32974 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
32975 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
32976 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
32977 bug reports to the mailing list.
32978 @end ifset
32979 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
32980 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
32981 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
32982 @end ifclear
32983 @end ifset
32984
32985 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
32986 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
32987 fact or leave it out, state it!
32988
32989 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
32990 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
32991 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
32992 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
32993 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
32994 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
32995 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
32996 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
32997 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
32998
32999 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
33000 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
33001 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
33002 self-contained.
33003
33004 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
33005 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
33006 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
33007 bugs properly.
33008
33009 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
33010
33011 @itemize @bullet
33012 @item
33013 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
33014 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
33015 version}.
33016
33017 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
33018 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
33019
33020 @item
33021 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
33022 version number.
33023
33024 @item
33025 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
33026 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
33027 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
33028 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
33029
33030 @item
33031 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
33032 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
33033
33034 @item
33035 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
33036 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
33037 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
33038 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
33039 those compilers.
33040
33041 @item
33042 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
33043 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
33044 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
33045 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
33046
33047 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
33048 and then we might not encounter the bug.
33049
33050 @item
33051 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
33052 reproduce the bug.
33053
33054 @item
33055 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
33056 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
33057
33058 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
33059 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
33060 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
33061 a chance to make a mistake.
33062
33063 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
33064 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
33065 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
33066 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
33067 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
33068 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
33069 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
33070 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
33071
33072 @pindex script
33073 @cindex recording a session script
33074 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
33075 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
33076 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
33077 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
33078
33079 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
33080 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
33081
33082 @item
33083 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
33084 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
33085 it by context, not by line number.
33086
33087 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
33088 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
33089
33090 @end itemize
33091
33092 Here are some things that are not necessary:
33093
33094 @itemize @bullet
33095 @item
33096 A description of the envelope of the bug.
33097
33098 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
33099 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
33100 changes will not affect it.
33101
33102 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
33103 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
33104 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
33105 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
33106
33107 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
33108 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
33109 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
33110 less time, and so on.
33111
33112 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
33113 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
33114
33115 @item
33116 A patch for the bug.
33117
33118 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
33119 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
33120 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
33121 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
33122
33123 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
33124 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
33125 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
33126 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
33127
33128 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
33129 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
33130 help us to understand.
33131
33132 @item
33133 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
33134
33135 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
33136 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
33137 @end itemize
33138
33139 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
33140 @c and consists of the two following files:
33141 @c rluser.texi
33142 @c hsuser.texi
33143 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
33144 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
33145 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
33146 @include rluser.texi
33147 @include hsuser.texi
33148 @end ifclear
33149
33150 @node In Memoriam
33151 @appendix In Memoriam
33152
33153 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
33154 contributors:
33155
33156 @table @code
33157 @item Fred Fish
33158 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
33159 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
33160 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
33161
33162 @item Michael Snyder
33163 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
33164 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
33165 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
33166 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
33167 @end table
33168
33169 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
33170 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
33171
33172 @node Formatting Documentation
33173 @appendix Formatting Documentation
33174
33175 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
33176 @cindex reference card
33177 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
33178 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
33179 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
33180 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
33181 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
33182 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
33183
33184 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
33185 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
33186
33187 @smallexample
33188 make refcard.dvi
33189 @end smallexample
33190
33191 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
33192 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
33193 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
33194 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
33195 your @sc{dvi} output program.
33196
33197 @cindex documentation
33198
33199 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
33200 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
33201 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
33202 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
33203 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
33204 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
33205
33206 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
33207 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
33208 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
33209 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
33210 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
33211 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
33212 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
33213 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
33214
33215 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
33216 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
33217 @code{makeinfo}.
33218
33219 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
33220 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
33221 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
33222
33223 @smallexample
33224 cd gdb
33225 make gdb.info
33226 @end smallexample
33227
33228 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
33229 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
33230 Texinfo definitions file.
33231
33232 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
33233 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
33234 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
33235 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
33236 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
33237 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
33238 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
33239
33240 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
33241 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
33242 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
33243 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
33244 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
33245 directory.
33246
33247 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
33248 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
33249 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
33250 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
33251
33252 @smallexample
33253 make gdb.dvi
33254 @end smallexample
33255
33256 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
33257
33258 @node Installing GDB
33259 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
33260 @cindex installation
33261
33262 @menu
33263 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
33264 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
33265 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
33266 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
33267 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
33268 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
33269 @end menu
33270
33271 @node Requirements
33272 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
33273 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
33274
33275 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
33276 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
33277
33278 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
33279 @table @asis
33280 @item ISO C90 compiler
33281 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
33282 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
33283
33284 @end table
33285
33286 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
33287 @table @asis
33288 @item Expat
33289 @anchor{Expat}
33290 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
33291 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
33292 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
33293 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
33294 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
33295 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
33296
33297 Expat is used for:
33298
33299 @itemize @bullet
33300 @item
33301 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
33302 @item
33303 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
33304 @item
33305 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
33306 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
33307 @item
33308 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
33309 @item
33310 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
33311 @item
33312 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
33313 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
33314 @end itemize
33315
33316 @item zlib
33317 @cindex compressed debug sections
33318 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
33319 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
33320 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
33321 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
33322 information in such binaries.
33323
33324 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
33325 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
33326 @url{http://zlib.net}.
33327
33328 @item iconv
33329 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
33330 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
33331 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
33332 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
33333
33334 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
33335 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
33336 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
33337 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
33338
33339 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
33340 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
33341 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
33342
33343 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
33344 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
33345 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
33346 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
33347 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
33348 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
33349 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
33350 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
33351 @end table
33352
33353 @node Running Configure
33354 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
33355 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
33356 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
33357 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
33358 build the @code{gdb} program.
33359 @iftex
33360 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
33361 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
33362 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
33363 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
33364 @end iftex
33365
33366 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
33367 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
33368 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
33369
33370 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
33371 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
33372
33373 @table @code
33374 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
33375 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
33376
33377 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
33378 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
33379
33380 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
33381 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
33382
33383 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
33384 @sc{gnu} include files
33385
33386 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
33387 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
33388
33389 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
33390 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
33391
33392 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
33393 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
33394
33395 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
33396 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
33397
33398 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
33399 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
33400 @end table
33401
33402 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
33403 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
33404 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
33405
33406 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
33407 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
33408 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
33409 argument.
33410
33411 For example:
33412
33413 @smallexample
33414 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33415 ./configure @var{host}
33416 make
33417 @end smallexample
33418
33419 @noindent
33420 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
33421 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
33422 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
33423 correct value by examining your system.)
33424
33425 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
33426 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
33427 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
33428 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
33429
33430 @need 750
33431 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
33432 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
33433 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
33434
33435 @smallexample
33436 sh configure @var{host}
33437 @end smallexample
33438
33439 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
33440 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
33441 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
33442 @file{configure}
33443 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
33444 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
33445
33446 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
33447 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
33448 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
33449 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
33450 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
33451 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
33452 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
33453 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
33454 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33455
33456 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
33457 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
33458 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
33459 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
33460 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
33461
33462 @node Separate Objdir
33463 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
33464
33465 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
33466 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
33467 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
33468 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
33469 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
33470 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
33471 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
33472 program specified there.
33473
33474 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
33475 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
33476 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
33477 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
33478 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
33479 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
33480
33481 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
33482 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
33483
33484 @smallexample
33485 @group
33486 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
33487 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
33488 cd ../gdb-sun4
33489 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
33490 make
33491 @end group
33492 @end smallexample
33493
33494 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
33495 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
33496 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
33497 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
33498 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
33499 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
33500
33501 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
33502 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
33503 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
33504 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
33505 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
33506
33507 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
33508 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
33509 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
33510 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
33511 You specify a cross-debugging target by
33512 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
33513
33514 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
33515 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
33516 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
33517
33518 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
33519 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
33520 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
33521 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
33522 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
33523
33524 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
33525 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
33526 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
33527 with each other.
33528
33529 @node Config Names
33530 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
33531
33532 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
33533 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
33534 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
33535 of information in the following pattern:
33536
33537 @smallexample
33538 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
33539 @end smallexample
33540
33541 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
33542 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
33543 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
33544
33545 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
33546 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
33547 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
33548 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
33549 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
33550 abbreviations---for example:
33551
33552 @smallexample
33553 % sh config.sub i386-linux
33554 i386-pc-linux-gnu
33555 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
33556 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
33557 % sh config.sub hp9k700
33558 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
33559 % sh config.sub sun4
33560 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
33561 % sh config.sub sun3
33562 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
33563 % sh config.sub i986v
33564 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
33565 @end smallexample
33566
33567 @noindent
33568 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
33569 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
33570
33571 @node Configure Options
33572 @section @file{configure} Options
33573
33574 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
33575 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
33576 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
33577 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
33578
33579 @smallexample
33580 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
33581 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33582 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
33583 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
33584 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
33585 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
33586 @var{host}
33587 @end smallexample
33588
33589 @noindent
33590 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
33591 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
33592 @samp{--}.
33593
33594 @table @code
33595 @item --help
33596 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
33597
33598 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
33599 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
33600 @file{@var{dir}}.
33601
33602 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
33603 Configure the source to install programs under directory
33604 @file{@var{dir}}.
33605
33606 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
33607 @need 2000
33608 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
33609 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
33610 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
33611 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
33612 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
33613 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
33614 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
33615 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
33616 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
33617 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
33618 @var{dirname}.
33619
33620 @item --norecursion
33621 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
33622 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
33623
33624 @item --target=@var{target}
33625 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
33626 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
33627 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
33628
33629 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
33630
33631 @item @var{host} @dots{}
33632 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
33633
33634 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
33635 @end table
33636
33637 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
33638 needed for special purposes only.
33639
33640 @node System-wide configuration
33641 @section System-wide configuration and settings
33642 @cindex system-wide init file
33643
33644 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
33645 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
33646 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
33647
33648 Here is the corresponding configure option:
33649
33650 @table @code
33651 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
33652 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
33653 @var{file}.
33654 @end table
33655
33656 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
33657 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
33658
33659 @itemize @bullet
33660 @item
33661 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
33662 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
33663 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
33664 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
33665 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
33666 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
33667
33668 @item
33669 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
33670 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
33671 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33672 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
33673 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
33674 @end itemize
33675
33676 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
33677 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
33678 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
33679 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
33680 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
33681 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
33682 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
33683 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
33684 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
33685 reread.
33686
33687 @menu
33688 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33689 @end menu
33690
33691 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
33692 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
33693 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
33694
33695 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
33696 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
33697 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
33698 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
33699 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
33700 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
33701
33702 The following scripts are currently available:
33703 @itemize @bullet
33704
33705 @item @file{elinos.py}
33706 @pindex elinos.py
33707 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
33708 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
33709 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
33710 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
33711 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
33712 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
33713
33714 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
33715 @pindex wrs-linux.py
33716 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
33717 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
33718 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
33719 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
33720
33721 @end itemize
33722
33723 @node Maintenance Commands
33724 @appendix Maintenance Commands
33725 @cindex maintenance commands
33726 @cindex internal commands
33727
33728 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
33729 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
33730 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
33731 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
33732 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
33733
33734 @table @code
33735 @kindex maint agent
33736 @kindex maint agent-eval
33737 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33738 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
33739 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
33740 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
33741 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
33742 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
33743 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
33744 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
33745 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
33746 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
33747 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
33748 addition and return the sum.
33749 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
33750 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
33751
33752 @kindex maint agent-printf
33753 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
33754 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
33755 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
33756 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
33757 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
33758
33759 @kindex maint info breakpoints
33760 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
33761 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
33762 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
33763 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
33764 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
33765 is shown:
33766
33767 @table @code
33768 @item breakpoint
33769 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
33770
33771 @item watchpoint
33772 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
33773
33774 @item longjmp
33775 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
33776 @code{longjmp} calls.
33777
33778 @item longjmp resume
33779 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
33780
33781 @item until
33782 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
33783
33784 @item finish
33785 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
33786
33787 @item shlib events
33788 Shared library events.
33789
33790 @end table
33791
33792 @kindex maint info bfds
33793 @item maint info bfds
33794 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
33795 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Top, , BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}.
33796
33797 @kindex set displaced-stepping
33798 @kindex show displaced-stepping
33799 @cindex displaced stepping support
33800 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
33801 @item set displaced-stepping
33802 @itemx show displaced-stepping
33803 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
33804 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
33805 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
33806 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
33807 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
33808
33809 @table @code
33810 @item set displaced-stepping on
33811 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
33812 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
33813
33814 @item set displaced-stepping off
33815 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
33816 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
33817
33818 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
33819 @item set displaced-stepping auto
33820 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
33821 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
33822 architecture supports displaced stepping.
33823 @end table
33824
33825 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
33826 @item maint check-psymtabs
33827 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
33828 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
33829
33830 @kindex maint check-symtabs
33831 @item maint check-symtabs
33832 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
33833
33834 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
33835 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
33836 Expand symbol tables.
33837 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
33838 names matching @var{regexp}.
33839
33840 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
33841 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33842 @cindex demangler crashes
33843 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
33844 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
33845 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
33846 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
33847 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
33848 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
33849 option to terminate the current session.
33850
33851 @kindex maint cplus first_component
33852 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
33853 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
33854
33855 @kindex maint cplus namespace
33856 @item maint cplus namespace
33857 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
33858
33859 @kindex maint deprecate
33860 @kindex maint undeprecate
33861 @cindex deprecated commands
33862 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
33863 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
33864 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
33865 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
33866 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
33867 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
33868 the replacement as part of the warning.
33869
33870 @kindex maint dump-me
33871 @item maint dump-me
33872 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
33873 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
33874 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
33875 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
33876
33877 @kindex maint internal-error
33878 @kindex maint internal-warning
33879 @kindex maint demangler-warning
33880 @cindex demangler crashes
33881 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33882 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33883 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
33884
33885 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
33886 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
33887 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
33888 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
33889 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
33890 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
33891 @value{GDBN} session.
33892
33893 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
33894 used as the text of the error or warning message.
33895
33896 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
33897
33898 @smallexample
33899 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
33900 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
33901 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
33902 debugging may prove unreliable.
33903 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33904 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
33905 (@value{GDBP})
33906 @end smallexample
33907
33908 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
33909 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
33910 @cindex demangler crashes
33911
33912 @kindex maint set internal-error
33913 @kindex maint show internal-error
33914 @kindex maint set internal-warning
33915 @kindex maint show internal-warning
33916 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
33917 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
33918 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33919 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
33920 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33921 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
33922 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
33923 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
33924 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
33925 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
33926 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
33927 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
33928 described in the table below.
33929
33930 @table @samp
33931 @item quit
33932 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33933 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
33934
33935 @item corefile
33936 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
33937 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
33938 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
33939 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
33940 disabled.
33941 @end table
33942
33943 @kindex maint packet
33944 @item maint packet @var{text}
33945 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
33946 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
33947 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
33948 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
33949 checksum.
33950
33951 @kindex maint print architecture
33952 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33953 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
33954 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
33955
33956 @kindex maint print c-tdesc
33957 @item maint print c-tdesc
33958 Print the current target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
33959 a C source file. The created source file can be used in @value{GDBN}
33960 when an XML parser is not available to parse the description.
33961
33962 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
33963 @item maint print dummy-frames
33964 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
33965
33966 @smallexample
33967 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
33968 @dots{}
33969 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
33970 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
33971 58 return (a + b);
33972 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
33973 @dots{}
33974 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
33975 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
33976 (@value{GDBP})
33977 @end smallexample
33978
33979 Takes an optional file parameter.
33980
33981 @kindex maint print registers
33982 @kindex maint print raw-registers
33983 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
33984 @kindex maint print register-groups
33985 @kindex maint print remote-registers
33986 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33987 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33988 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33989 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33990 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
33991 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
33992
33993 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
33994 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
33995 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
33996 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
33997 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
33998 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
33999 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
34000 and offsets in the `G' packets.
34001
34002 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
34003 write the information.
34004
34005 @kindex maint print reggroups
34006 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
34007 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
34008 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
34009 information.
34010
34011 The register groups info looks like this:
34012
34013 @smallexample
34014 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
34015 Group Type
34016 general user
34017 float user
34018 all user
34019 vector user
34020 system user
34021 save internal
34022 restore internal
34023 @end smallexample
34024
34025 @kindex flushregs
34026 @item flushregs
34027 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
34028
34029 @kindex maint print objfiles
34030 @cindex info for known object files
34031 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
34032 Print a dump of all known object files.
34033 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
34034 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
34035 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
34036
34037 @kindex maint print user-registers
34038 @cindex user registers
34039 @item maint print user-registers
34040 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
34041 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
34042 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
34043 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
34044 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
34045 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
34046 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
34047
34048 @kindex maint print section-scripts
34049 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
34050 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
34051 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
34052 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
34053 matching @var{regexp}.
34054 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
34055 and the full path if known.
34056 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
34057
34058 @kindex maint print statistics
34059 @cindex bcache statistics
34060 @item maint print statistics
34061 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
34062 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
34063 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
34064 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
34065 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
34066 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
34067 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
34068 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
34069 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
34070 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
34071 lengths.
34072
34073 @kindex maint print target-stack
34074 @cindex target stack description
34075 @item maint print target-stack
34076 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
34077 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
34078 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
34079 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
34080 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
34081 address.
34082
34083 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
34084 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
34085
34086 @kindex maint print type
34087 @cindex type chain of a data type
34088 @item maint print type @var{expr}
34089 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
34090 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
34091 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
34092 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
34093 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
34094
34095 @kindex maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
34096 @kindex maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
34097 @item maint set dwarf2 always-disassemble
34098 @item maint show dwarf2 always-disassemble
34099 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
34100 information.
34101
34102 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
34103 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
34104 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
34105 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
34106 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
34107 always see the disassembly form.
34108
34109 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
34110
34111 @smallexample
34112 (gdb) info addr argc
34113 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
34114 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
34115 @end smallexample
34116
34117 For more information on these expressions, see
34118 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
34119
34120 @kindex maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
34121 @kindex maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
34122 @item maint set dwarf2 max-cache-age
34123 @itemx maint show dwarf2 max-cache-age
34124 Control the DWARF 2 compilation unit cache.
34125
34126 @cindex DWARF 2 compilation units cache
34127 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
34128 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF 2
34129 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
34130 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
34131 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
34132 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
34133 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
34134 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
34135
34136 @kindex maint set profile
34137 @kindex maint show profile
34138 @cindex profiling GDB
34139 @item maint set profile
34140 @itemx maint show profile
34141 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
34142
34143 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
34144 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
34145 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
34146 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
34147 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
34148 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
34149 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
34150
34151 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
34152 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
34153
34154 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
34155 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
34156 @cindex hardware debug registers
34157 @item maint set show-debug-regs
34158 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
34159 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
34160 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
34161 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
34162 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
34163 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
34164
34165 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
34166 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
34167 @item maint set show-all-tib
34168 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
34169 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
34170 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
34171 command.
34172
34173 @kindex maint set target-async
34174 @kindex maint show target-async
34175 @item maint set target-async
34176 @itemx maint show target-async
34177 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
34178 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
34179 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
34180 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
34181
34182 @kindex maint set per-command
34183 @kindex maint show per-command
34184 @item maint set per-command
34185 @itemx maint show per-command
34186 @cindex resources used by commands
34187
34188 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
34189 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
34190
34191 @table @code
34192 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
34193 @itemx maint show per-command space
34194 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
34195 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
34196 took, following the command's own output.
34197 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34198 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34199
34200 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
34201 @itemx maint show per-command time
34202 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
34203 for each command.
34204 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
34205 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
34206 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
34207 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
34208 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
34209 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
34210 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
34211 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
34212 spent by the program been debugged.
34213 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
34214 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
34215
34216 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
34217 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
34218 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
34219 for each command.
34220 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
34221
34222 @enumerate a
34223 @item
34224 number of symbol tables
34225 @item
34226 number of primary symbol tables
34227 @item
34228 number of blocks in the blockvector
34229 @end enumerate
34230 @end table
34231
34232 @kindex maint space
34233 @cindex memory used by commands
34234 @item maint space @var{value}
34235 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
34236 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34237
34238 @kindex maint time
34239 @cindex time of command execution
34240 @item maint time @var{value}
34241 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
34242 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
34243
34244 @kindex maint translate-address
34245 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
34246 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
34247 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
34248 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
34249 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
34250 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
34251 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
34252
34253 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
34254 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
34255 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
34256
34257 @end table
34258
34259 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
34260 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
34261
34262 @table @code
34263 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
34264 @kindex set watchdog
34265 @cindex watchdog timer
34266 @cindex timeout for commands
34267 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
34268 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
34269 reports and error and the command is aborted.
34270
34271 @item show watchdog
34272 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
34273 @end table
34274
34275 @node Remote Protocol
34276 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
34277
34278 @menu
34279 * Overview::
34280 * Packets::
34281 * Stop Reply Packets::
34282 * General Query Packets::
34283 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
34284 * Tracepoint Packets::
34285 * Host I/O Packets::
34286 * Interrupts::
34287 * Notification Packets::
34288 * Remote Non-Stop::
34289 * Packet Acknowledgment::
34290 * Examples::
34291 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
34292 * Library List Format::
34293 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
34294 * Memory Map Format::
34295 * Thread List Format::
34296 * Traceframe Info Format::
34297 * Branch Trace Format::
34298 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
34299 @end menu
34300
34301 @node Overview
34302 @section Overview
34303
34304 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
34305 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
34306 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
34307 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
34308
34309 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
34310 transmitted and received data, respectively.
34311
34312 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
34313 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
34314 @cindex remote serial protocol
34315 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
34316 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
34317 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
34318 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
34319 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
34320
34321 @smallexample
34322 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34323 @end smallexample
34324 @noindent
34325
34326 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
34327 @noindent
34328 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
34329 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
34330 eight bit unsigned checksum).
34331
34332 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
34333 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
34334
34335 @smallexample
34336 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34337 @end smallexample
34338
34339 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
34340 @noindent
34341 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
34342 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
34343 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
34344
34345 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
34346 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
34347 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
34348 retransmission):
34349
34350 @smallexample
34351 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
34352 <- @code{+}
34353 @end smallexample
34354 @noindent
34355
34356 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
34357 once a connection is established.
34358 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
34359
34360 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
34361 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
34362 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
34363 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
34364 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
34365 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
34366 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
34367
34368 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
34369 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
34370 exceptions).
34371
34372 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
34373 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
34374 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
34375 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
34376
34377 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
34378 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
34379 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
34380
34381 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
34382 @anchor{Binary Data}
34383 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
34384 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
34385 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
34386 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
34387 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
34388 binary data.
34389
34390 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
34391 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
34392 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
34393 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
34394 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
34395 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
34396 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
34397 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
34398 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
34399 (described next).
34400
34401 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
34402 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
34403 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
34404 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
34405 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
34406 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
34407 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
34408 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
34409 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
34410 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
34411 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
34412 3}} more times.
34413
34414 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
34415 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
34416 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
34417 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
34418 @samp{0*"00}.
34419
34420 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
34421 error number. That number is not well defined.
34422
34423 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
34424 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
34425 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
34426 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
34427 on that response.
34428
34429 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
34430 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
34431 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
34432 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
34433 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
34434 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
34435
34436 @node Packets
34437 @section Packets
34438
34439 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
34440 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
34441 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
34442 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
34443
34444 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
34445 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
34446 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
34447 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
34448 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
34449 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
34450 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
34451 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
34452 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
34453 @var{baz}.
34454
34455 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
34456 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
34457 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
34458 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
34459 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
34460 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
34461 pick any thread.
34462
34463 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
34464 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
34465 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
34466 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
34467 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
34468 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
34469 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
34470 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
34471 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
34472 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
34473 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
34474 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
34475 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
34476
34477 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
34478 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
34479 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
34480 more information.
34481
34482 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
34483 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
34484
34485 Here are the packet descriptions.
34486
34487 @table @samp
34488
34489 @item !
34490 @cindex @samp{!} packet
34491 @anchor{extended mode}
34492 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
34493 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
34494 debugged.
34495
34496 Reply:
34497 @table @samp
34498 @item OK
34499 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
34500 @end table
34501
34502 @item ?
34503 @cindex @samp{?} packet
34504 @anchor{? packet}
34505 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
34506 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
34507 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
34508
34509 Reply:
34510 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34511
34512 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
34513 @cindex @samp{A} packet
34514 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
34515 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
34516 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
34517
34518 Reply:
34519 @table @samp
34520 @item OK
34521 The arguments were set.
34522 @item E @var{NN}
34523 An error occurred.
34524 @end table
34525
34526 @item b @var{baud}
34527 @cindex @samp{b} packet
34528 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
34529 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
34530
34531 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
34532 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
34533 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
34534
34535 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
34536 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
34537 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
34538 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
34539 of view, nothing actually happened.}
34540
34541 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
34542 @cindex @samp{B} packet
34543 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
34544 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
34545
34546 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
34547 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
34548
34549 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
34550 @anchor{bc}
34551 @item bc
34552 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
34553 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34554
34555 Reply:
34556 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34557
34558 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
34559 @anchor{bs}
34560 @item bs
34561 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
34562 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34563
34564 Reply:
34565 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34566
34567 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34568 @cindex @samp{c} packet
34569 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
34570 is omitted, resume at current address.
34571
34572 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34573 packet}.
34574
34575 Reply:
34576 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34577
34578 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34579 @cindex @samp{C} packet
34580 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
34581 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
34582
34583 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34584 packet}.
34585
34586 Reply:
34587 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34588
34589 @item d
34590 @cindex @samp{d} packet
34591 Toggle debug flag.
34592
34593 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
34594 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
34595
34596 @item D
34597 @itemx D;@var{pid}
34598 @cindex @samp{D} packet
34599 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
34600 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
34601 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
34602
34603 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
34604 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
34605 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
34606 big-endian hex string.
34607
34608 Reply:
34609 @table @samp
34610 @item OK
34611 for success
34612 @item E @var{NN}
34613 for an error
34614 @end table
34615
34616 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
34617 @cindex @samp{F} packet
34618 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
34619 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
34620 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
34621
34622 @item g
34623 @anchor{read registers packet}
34624 @cindex @samp{g} packet
34625 Read general registers.
34626
34627 Reply:
34628 @table @samp
34629 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34630 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
34631 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
34632 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
34633 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
34634 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}. The
34635 specification of several standard @samp{g} packets is specified below.
34636
34637 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
34638 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
34639 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
34640 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
34641 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
34642 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
34643 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
34644 have been collected, and both have zero value:
34645
34646 @smallexample
34647 -> @code{g}
34648 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
34649 @end smallexample
34650
34651 @item E @var{NN}
34652 for an error.
34653 @end table
34654
34655 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
34656 @cindex @samp{G} packet
34657 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
34658 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
34659
34660 Reply:
34661 @table @samp
34662 @item OK
34663 for success
34664 @item E @var{NN}
34665 for an error
34666 @end table
34667
34668 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
34669 @cindex @samp{H} packet
34670 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
34671 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
34672 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
34673 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
34674 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
34675 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
34676 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34677
34678 Reply:
34679 @table @samp
34680 @item OK
34681 for success
34682 @item E @var{NN}
34683 for an error
34684 @end table
34685
34686 @c FIXME: JTC:
34687 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
34688 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
34689 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
34690 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
34691 @c described. For example:
34692 @c
34693 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34694 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
34695 @c otherwise returns current registers.
34696 @c
34697 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
34698 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
34699 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
34700
34701 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
34702 @anchor{cycle step packet}
34703 @cindex @samp{i} packet
34704 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
34705 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
34706 step starting at that address.
34707
34708 @item I
34709 @cindex @samp{I} packet
34710 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
34711 step packet}.
34712
34713 @item k
34714 @cindex @samp{k} packet
34715 Kill request.
34716
34717 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
34718
34719 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
34720 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
34721
34722 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
34723
34724 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
34725 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
34726 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
34727
34728 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
34729 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
34730 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
34731
34732 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
34733 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
34734 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
34735 (@pxref{? packet}).
34736
34737 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
34738 @cindex @samp{m} packet
34739 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34740 Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to any particular boundary.
34741
34742 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
34743 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
34744 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
34745 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
34746 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
34747 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
34748 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
34749 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
34750
34751 Reply:
34752 @table @samp
34753 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34754 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal
34755 number. The reply may contain fewer bytes than requested if the
34756 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
34757 @item E @var{NN}
34758 @var{NN} is errno
34759 @end table
34760
34761 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
34762 @cindex @samp{M} packet
34763 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
34764 The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit
34765 hexadecimal number.
34766
34767 Reply:
34768 @table @samp
34769 @item OK
34770 for success
34771 @item E @var{NN}
34772 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
34773 written).
34774 @end table
34775
34776 @item p @var{n}
34777 @cindex @samp{p} packet
34778 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
34779 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
34780 register value is encoded.
34781
34782 Reply:
34783 @table @samp
34784 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
34785 the register's value
34786 @item E @var{NN}
34787 for an error
34788 @item @w{}
34789 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
34790 @end table
34791
34792 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
34793 @anchor{write register packet}
34794 @cindex @samp{P} packet
34795 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
34796 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
34797 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
34798
34799 Reply:
34800 @table @samp
34801 @item OK
34802 for success
34803 @item E @var{NN}
34804 for an error
34805 @end table
34806
34807 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34808 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
34809 @cindex @samp{q} packet
34810 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
34811 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
34812 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
34813
34814 @item r
34815 @cindex @samp{r} packet
34816 Reset the entire system.
34817
34818 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
34819
34820 @item R @var{XX}
34821 @cindex @samp{R} packet
34822 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
34823 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34824
34825 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
34826
34827 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
34828 @cindex @samp{s} packet
34829 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
34830 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
34831
34832 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34833 packet}.
34834
34835 Reply:
34836 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34837
34838 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
34839 @anchor{step with signal packet}
34840 @cindex @samp{S} packet
34841 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
34842 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
34843
34844 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
34845 packet}.
34846
34847 Reply:
34848 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34849
34850 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
34851 @cindex @samp{t} packet
34852 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
34853 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
34854 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
34855
34856 @item T @var{thread-id}
34857 @cindex @samp{T} packet
34858 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
34859
34860 Reply:
34861 @table @samp
34862 @item OK
34863 thread is still alive
34864 @item E @var{NN}
34865 thread is dead
34866 @end table
34867
34868 @item v
34869 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
34870 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
34871
34872 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
34873 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
34874 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
34875 The process ID is a
34876 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
34877 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
34878 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
34879
34880 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
34881 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
34882 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
34883 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
34884 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
34885 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
34886 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
34887 @c stopping or restarting threads.
34888
34889 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
34890
34891 Reply:
34892 @table @samp
34893 @item E @var{nn}
34894 for an error
34895 @item @r{Any stop packet}
34896 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
34897 @item OK
34898 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
34899 @end table
34900
34901 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
34902 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
34903 @anchor{vCont packet}
34904 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
34905 If an action is specified with no @var{thread-id}, then it is applied to any
34906 threads that don't have a specific action specified; if no default action is
34907 specified then other threads should remain stopped in all-stop mode and
34908 in their current state in non-stop mode.
34909 Specifying multiple
34910 default actions is an error; specifying no actions is also an error.
34911 Thread IDs are specified using the syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
34912
34913 Currently supported actions are:
34914
34915 @table @samp
34916 @item c
34917 Continue.
34918 @item C @var{sig}
34919 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34920 @item s
34921 Step.
34922 @item S @var{sig}
34923 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
34924 @item t
34925 Stop.
34926 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
34927 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
34928 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
34929 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
34930 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
34931 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
34932
34933 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
34934 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
34935 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
34936 jumps to @var{start}).
34937
34938 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
34939 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
34940 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
34941
34942 @end table
34943
34944 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
34945 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
34946 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
34947
34948 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
34949 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
34950 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
34951 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
34952 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
34953 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
34954 as an implementation detail.
34955
34956 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
34957 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}). Note that in
34958 this case @samp{vCont} actions can be specified to apply to all threads
34959 in a process by using the @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the
34960 @var{thread-id}.
34961
34962 Reply:
34963 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
34964
34965 @item vCont?
34966 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
34967 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
34968
34969 Reply:
34970 @table @samp
34971 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
34972 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
34973 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
34974 @item @w{}
34975 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
34976 @end table
34977
34978 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
34979 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
34980 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
34981 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
34982
34983 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
34984 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
34985 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
34986 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
34987 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
34988 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
34989 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
34990 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
34991 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
34992 packet is received.
34993
34994 Reply:
34995 @table @samp
34996 @item OK
34997 for success
34998 @item E @var{NN}
34999 for an error
35000 @end table
35001
35002 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35003 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
35004 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
35005 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
35006 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
35007 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
35008 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
35009 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
35010 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
35011 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
35012 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
35013 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
35014
35015
35016 Reply:
35017 @table @samp
35018 @item OK
35019 for success
35020 @item E.memtype
35021 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
35022 @item E @var{NN}
35023 for an error
35024 @end table
35025
35026 @item vFlashDone
35027 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
35028 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
35029 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
35030 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
35031 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
35032 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
35033 request is completed.
35034
35035 @item vKill;@var{pid}
35036 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
35037 @anchor{vKill packet}
35038 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
35039 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
35040 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
35041 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35042
35043 Reply:
35044 @table @samp
35045 @item E @var{nn}
35046 for an error
35047 @item OK
35048 for success
35049 @end table
35050
35051 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
35052 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
35053 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
35054 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
35055 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
35056 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
35057 state.
35058
35059 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
35060
35061 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35062
35063 Reply:
35064 @table @samp
35065 @item E @var{nn}
35066 for an error
35067 @item @r{Any stop packet}
35068 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
35069 @end table
35070
35071 @item vStopped
35072 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
35073 @xref{Notification Packets}.
35074
35075 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
35076 @anchor{X packet}
35077 @cindex @samp{X} packet
35078 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
35079 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of bytes @var{length};
35080 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
35081
35082 Reply:
35083 @table @samp
35084 @item OK
35085 for success
35086 @item E @var{NN}
35087 for an error
35088 @end table
35089
35090 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35091 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
35092 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
35093 @cindex @samp{z} packet
35094 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
35095 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
35096 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
35097
35098 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
35099 separately.
35100
35101 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
35102 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
35103 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
35104 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
35105 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
35106 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
35107
35108 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35109 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35110 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
35111 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
35112 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
35113 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
35114
35115 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
35116 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
35117 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of
35118 the breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm}
35119 and @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
35120 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind};
35121 @var{cond_list} is an optional list of conditional expressions in bytecode
35122 form that should be evaluated on the target's side. These are the
35123 conditions that should be taken into consideration when deciding if
35124 the breakpoint trigger should be reported back to @var{GDBN}.
35125
35126 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
35127 for how to best report a memory breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
35128
35129 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
35130 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
35131
35132 @table @samp
35133
35134 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35135 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35136 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35137
35138 @end table
35139
35140 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
35141 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
35142 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
35143 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
35144 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
35145 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
35146 separators. Each expression has the following form:
35147
35148 @table @samp
35149
35150 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
35151 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
35152 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
35153
35154 @end table
35155
35156 see @ref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}.
35157
35158 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
35159 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
35160 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
35161 target, is not defined.}
35162
35163 Reply:
35164 @table @samp
35165 @item OK
35166 success
35167 @item @w{}
35168 not supported
35169 @item E @var{NN}
35170 for an error
35171 @end table
35172
35173 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35174 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}
35175 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
35176 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
35177 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
35178 address @var{addr}.
35179
35180 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
35181 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory. The @var{kind}
35182 and @var{cond_list} have the same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
35183
35184 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
35185 movement.}
35186
35187 Reply:
35188 @table @samp
35189 @item OK
35190 success
35191 @item @w{}
35192 not supported
35193 @item E @var{NN}
35194 for an error
35195 @end table
35196
35197 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35198 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35199 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
35200 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
35201 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35202 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35203
35204 Reply:
35205 @table @samp
35206 @item OK
35207 success
35208 @item @w{}
35209 not supported
35210 @item E @var{NN}
35211 for an error
35212 @end table
35213
35214 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35215 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35216 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
35217 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
35218 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35219 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35220
35221 Reply:
35222 @table @samp
35223 @item OK
35224 success
35225 @item @w{}
35226 not supported
35227 @item E @var{NN}
35228 for an error
35229 @end table
35230
35231 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35232 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
35233 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
35234 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
35235 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
35236 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
35237
35238 Reply:
35239 @table @samp
35240 @item OK
35241 success
35242 @item @w{}
35243 not supported
35244 @item E @var{NN}
35245 for an error
35246 @end table
35247
35248 @end table
35249
35250 @node Stop Reply Packets
35251 @section Stop Reply Packets
35252 @cindex stop reply packets
35253
35254 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
35255 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
35256 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
35257 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
35258 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
35259 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
35260 @value{GDBN} source code.
35261
35262 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
35263 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
35264 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
35265 components.
35266
35267 @table @samp
35268
35269 @item S @var{AA}
35270 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35271 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
35272 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
35273
35274 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
35275 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
35276 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
35277 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
35278 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
35279 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
35280 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
35281 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
35282
35283 @itemize @bullet
35284 @item
35285 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
35286 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
35287 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
35288 two-digit hex number.
35289
35290 @item
35291 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
35292 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35293
35294 @item
35295 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
35296 the core on which the stop event was detected.
35297
35298 @item
35299 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
35300 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
35301 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
35302 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
35303
35304 @item
35305 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
35306 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
35307 future.
35308 @end itemize
35309
35310 The currently defined stop reasons are:
35311
35312 @table @samp
35313 @item watch
35314 @itemx rwatch
35315 @itemx awatch
35316 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
35317 hex.
35318
35319 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
35320 @item library
35321 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
35322 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
35323 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
35324
35325 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
35326 @item replaylog
35327 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
35328 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
35329 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
35330 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
35331 for more information.
35332
35333 @item swbreak
35334 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
35335 The packet indicates a memory breakpoint instruction was executed,
35336 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
35337 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
35338 part must be left empty.
35339
35340 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
35341 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
35342 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
35343 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
35344 address.
35345
35346 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
35347 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
35348 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
35349 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
35350 indicating support.
35351
35352 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
35353
35354 @item hwbreak
35355 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
35356 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
35357
35358 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
35359 apply.
35360 @end table
35361
35362 @item W @var{AA}
35363 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35364 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
35365 applicable to certain targets.
35366
35367 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the exited
35368 process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported support for
35369 multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
35370 The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35371
35372 @item X @var{AA}
35373 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
35374 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
35375
35376 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
35377 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
35378 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
35379 extensions}. The @var{pid} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
35380
35381 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
35382 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
35383 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
35384 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
35385 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
35386
35387 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
35388 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
35389 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
35390 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
35391 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
35392 system calls.
35393
35394 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
35395 this very system call.
35396
35397 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
35398 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
35399 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
35400 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
35401 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
35402 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
35403
35404 @end table
35405
35406 @node General Query Packets
35407 @section General Query Packets
35408 @cindex remote query requests
35409
35410 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
35411 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
35412 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
35413 sending information to and from the stub.
35414
35415 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
35416 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
35417 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
35418 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
35419 conventions:
35420
35421 @itemize @bullet
35422 @item
35423 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
35424 @item
35425 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
35426 letter.
35427 @item
35428 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
35429 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
35430 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
35431 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
35432 @end itemize
35433
35434 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
35435 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
35436 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
35437 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
35438 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
35439 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
35440 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
35441 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
35442 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
35443 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
35444 packet.}.
35445
35446 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
35447 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
35448 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
35449 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
35450 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
35451
35452 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
35453
35454 @table @samp
35455
35456 @item QAgent:1
35457 @itemx QAgent:0
35458 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
35459 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
35460
35461 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
35462 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
35463 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
35464 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
35465 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
35466 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
35467 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
35468 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
35469 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
35470 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
35471 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
35472
35473 @item qC
35474 @cindex current thread, remote request
35475 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
35476 Return the current thread ID.
35477
35478 Reply:
35479 @table @samp
35480 @item QC @var{thread-id}
35481 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
35482 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
35483 @item @r{(anything else)}
35484 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
35485 @end table
35486
35487 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
35488 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
35489 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
35490 @anchor{qCRC packet}
35491 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
35492 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
35493 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
35494 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
35495
35496 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
35497 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
35498 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
35499 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
35500 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
35501 detect trailing zeros.
35502
35503 Reply:
35504 @table @samp
35505 @item E @var{NN}
35506 An error (such as memory fault)
35507 @item C @var{crc32}
35508 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
35509 @end table
35510
35511 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
35512 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
35513 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
35514 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
35515 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
35516 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
35517 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
35518 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
35519 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
35520 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
35521 randomization.
35522
35523 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
35524
35525 Reply:
35526 @table @samp
35527 @item OK
35528 The request succeeded.
35529
35530 @item E @var{nn}
35531 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35532
35533 @item @w{}
35534 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
35535 by the stub.
35536 @end table
35537
35538 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35539 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35540 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
35541 address space randomization.
35542
35543 @item qfThreadInfo
35544 @itemx qsThreadInfo
35545 @cindex list active threads, remote request
35546 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
35547 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
35548 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
35549 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
35550 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
35551 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
35552 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
35553 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
35554
35555 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
35556
35557 Reply:
35558 @table @samp
35559 @item m @var{thread-id}
35560 A single thread ID
35561 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
35562 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
35563 @item l
35564 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
35565 @end table
35566
35567 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
35568 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
35569 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
35570 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
35571 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
35572 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
35573 fields.
35574
35575 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
35576 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
35577 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
35578 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
35579 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
35580
35581 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
35582 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
35583 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
35584 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
35585 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
35586
35587 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
35588 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
35589
35590 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
35591 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
35592 information associated with the variable.)
35593
35594 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
35595 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
35596 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
35597 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
35598 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
35599 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
35600
35601 Reply:
35602 @table @samp
35603 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35604 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
35605 local storage requested.
35606
35607 @item E @var{nn}
35608 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35609
35610 @item @w{}
35611 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35612 @end table
35613
35614 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
35615 @cindex get thread information block address
35616 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
35617 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
35618
35619 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
35620
35621 Reply:
35622 @table @samp
35623 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
35624 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
35625 thread information block.
35626
35627 @item E @var{nn}
35628 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
35629 address could not be retrieved.
35630
35631 @item @w{}
35632 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
35633 @end table
35634
35635 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
35636 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
35637 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
35638 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
35639 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
35640 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
35641 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
35642
35643 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
35644
35645 Reply:
35646 @table @samp
35647 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
35648 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
35649 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
35650 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
35651 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
35652 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
35653 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
35654 @end table
35655
35656 @item qOffsets
35657 @cindex section offsets, remote request
35658 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
35659 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
35660 image.
35661
35662 Reply:
35663 @table @samp
35664 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
35665 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
35666 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
35667 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
35668 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
35669 segments by the supplied offsets.
35670
35671 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
35672 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
35673 to the @code{Bss} section.}
35674
35675 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
35676 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
35677 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
35678 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
35679 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
35680 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
35681 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
35682 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
35683 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
35684 @end table
35685
35686 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
35687 @cindex thread information, remote request
35688 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
35689 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
35690 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
35691 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
35692
35693 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
35694 (see below).
35695
35696 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
35697
35698 @item QNonStop:1
35699 @itemx QNonStop:0
35700 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
35701 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
35702 @anchor{QNonStop}
35703 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
35704 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
35705
35706 Reply:
35707 @table @samp
35708 @item OK
35709 The request succeeded.
35710
35711 @item E @var{nn}
35712 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35713
35714 @item @w{}
35715 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
35716 the stub.
35717 @end table
35718
35719 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35720 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35721 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
35722 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
35723
35724 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35725 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
35726 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
35727 @anchor{QPassSignals}
35728 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
35729 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35730 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35731 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
35732 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
35733 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
35734 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
35735 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
35736 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
35737
35738 Reply:
35739 @table @samp
35740 @item OK
35741 The request succeeded.
35742
35743 @item E @var{nn}
35744 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35745
35746 @item @w{}
35747 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
35748 the stub.
35749 @end table
35750
35751 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
35752 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
35753 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35754 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35755
35756 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
35757 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
35758 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
35759 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
35760 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
35761 Others should be silently discarded.
35762
35763 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
35764 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
35765 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
35766 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
35767 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
35768 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
35769 signals.
35770
35771 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
35772 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
35773
35774 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
35775 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
35776 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
35777 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
35778 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
35779
35780 Reply:
35781 @table @samp
35782 @item OK
35783 The request succeeded.
35784
35785 @item E @var{nn}
35786 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
35787
35788 @item @w{}
35789 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
35790 by the stub.
35791 @end table
35792
35793 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
35794 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
35795 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
35796 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
35797
35798 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
35799 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
35800 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
35801 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
35802 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
35803 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
35804 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
35805 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
35806 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
35807
35808 Reply:
35809 @table @samp
35810 @item OK
35811 A command response with no output.
35812 @item @var{OUTPUT}
35813 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
35814 @item E @var{NN}
35815 Indicate a badly formed request.
35816 @item @w{}
35817 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
35818 @end table
35819
35820 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
35821 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
35822 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
35823 packets.)
35824
35825 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
35826 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
35827 @ifnotinfo
35828 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
35829 @end ifnotinfo
35830 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
35831 @anchor{qSearch memory}
35832 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
35833 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
35834 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
35835
35836 Reply:
35837 @table @samp
35838 @item 0
35839 The pattern was not found.
35840 @item 1,address
35841 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
35842 @item E @var{NN}
35843 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
35844 @item @w{}
35845 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
35846 @end table
35847
35848 @item QStartNoAckMode
35849 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
35850 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
35851 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
35852 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
35853
35854 Reply:
35855 @table @samp
35856 @item OK
35857 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
35858 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
35859 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
35860 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
35861 @item @w{}
35862 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
35863 @end table
35864
35865 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
35866 @cindex supported packets, remote query
35867 @cindex features of the remote protocol
35868 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
35869 @anchor{qSupported}
35870 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
35871 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
35872 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
35873 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
35874 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
35875 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
35876 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
35877 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
35878 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
35879 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
35880 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
35881 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
35882 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
35883 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
35884
35885 Reply:
35886 @table @samp
35887 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
35888 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
35889 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
35890 possible forms).
35891 @item @w{}
35892 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
35893 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
35894 @end table
35895
35896 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
35897 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
35898 are:
35899
35900 @table @samp
35901 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
35902 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
35903 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
35904 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
35905 @item @var{name}+
35906 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
35907 need an associated value.
35908 @item @var{name}-
35909 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
35910 @item @var{name}?
35911 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
35912 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
35913 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
35914 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
35915 @end table
35916
35917 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
35918 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
35919 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
35920 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
35921 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
35922
35923 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
35924 are defined:
35925
35926 @table @samp
35927 @item multiprocess
35928 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
35929 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
35930 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
35931 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
35932 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
35933
35934 @item xmlRegisters
35935 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
35936 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
35937 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
35938 description.
35939
35940 @item qRelocInsn
35941 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
35942 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
35943 instruction reply packet}).
35944
35945 @item swbreak
35946 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
35947 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
35948
35949 @item hwbreak
35950 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
35951 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
35952 @end table
35953
35954 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
35955 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
35956 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
35957 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
35958 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
35959 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
35960 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
35961 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
35962 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
35963 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
35964 all the features it supports.
35965
35966 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
35967 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
35968
35969 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
35970 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
35971 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
35972 form response.
35973
35974 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
35975 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
35976 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
35977 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
35978
35979 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
35980 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
35981 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
35982 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
35983 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
35984
35985 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
35986
35987 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
35988 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
35989 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
35990 @item Feature Name
35991 @tab Value Required
35992 @tab Default
35993 @tab Probe Allowed
35994
35995 @item @samp{PacketSize}
35996 @tab Yes
35997 @tab @samp{-}
35998 @tab No
35999
36000 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
36001 @tab No
36002 @tab @samp{-}
36003 @tab Yes
36004
36005 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36006 @tab No
36007 @tab @samp{-}
36008 @tab Yes
36009
36010 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36011 @tab No
36012 @tab @samp{-}
36013 @tab Yes
36014
36015 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
36016 @tab No
36017 @tab @samp{-}
36018 @tab Yes
36019
36020 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
36021 @tab No
36022 @tab @samp{-}
36023 @tab Yes
36024
36025 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
36026 @tab No
36027 @tab @samp{-}
36028 @tab Yes
36029
36030 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
36031 @tab No
36032 @tab @samp{-}
36033 @tab No
36034
36035 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
36036 @tab No
36037 @tab @samp{-}
36038 @tab Yes
36039
36040 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
36041 @tab No
36042 @tab @samp{-}
36043 @tab Yes
36044
36045 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
36046 @tab No
36047 @tab @samp{-}
36048 @tab Yes
36049
36050 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
36051 @tab No
36052 @tab @samp{-}
36053 @tab Yes
36054
36055 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
36056 @tab No
36057 @tab @samp{-}
36058 @tab Yes
36059
36060 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
36061 @tab No
36062 @tab @samp{-}
36063 @tab Yes
36064
36065 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
36066 @tab No
36067 @tab @samp{-}
36068 @tab Yes
36069
36070 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36071 @tab No
36072 @tab @samp{-}
36073 @tab Yes
36074
36075 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36076 @tab No
36077 @tab @samp{-}
36078 @tab Yes
36079
36080 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36081 @tab No
36082 @tab @samp{-}
36083 @tab Yes
36084
36085 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
36086 @tab Yes
36087 @tab @samp{-}
36088 @tab Yes
36089
36090 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
36091 @tab Yes
36092 @tab @samp{-}
36093 @tab Yes
36094
36095 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
36096 @tab Yes
36097 @tab @samp{-}
36098 @tab Yes
36099
36100 @item @samp{QNonStop}
36101 @tab No
36102 @tab @samp{-}
36103 @tab Yes
36104
36105 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
36106 @tab No
36107 @tab @samp{-}
36108 @tab Yes
36109
36110 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
36111 @tab No
36112 @tab @samp{-}
36113 @tab Yes
36114
36115 @item @samp{multiprocess}
36116 @tab No
36117 @tab @samp{-}
36118 @tab No
36119
36120 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
36121 @tab No
36122 @tab @samp{-}
36123 @tab No
36124
36125 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
36126 @tab No
36127 @tab @samp{-}
36128 @tab No
36129
36130 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
36131 @tab No
36132 @tab @samp{-}
36133 @tab No
36134
36135 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
36136 @tab No
36137 @tab @samp{-}
36138 @tab No
36139
36140 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
36141 @tab No
36142 @tab @samp{-}
36143 @tab No
36144
36145 @item @samp{QAgent}
36146 @tab No
36147 @tab @samp{-}
36148 @tab No
36149
36150 @item @samp{QAllow}
36151 @tab No
36152 @tab @samp{-}
36153 @tab No
36154
36155 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
36156 @tab No
36157 @tab @samp{-}
36158 @tab No
36159
36160 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
36161 @tab No
36162 @tab @samp{-}
36163 @tab No
36164
36165 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
36166 @tab No
36167 @tab @samp{-}
36168 @tab No
36169
36170 @item @samp{tracenz}
36171 @tab No
36172 @tab @samp{-}
36173 @tab No
36174
36175 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
36176 @tab No
36177 @tab @samp{-}
36178 @tab No
36179
36180 @item @samp{swbreak}
36181 @tab No
36182 @tab @samp{-}
36183 @tab No
36184
36185 @item @samp{hwbreak}
36186 @tab No
36187 @tab @samp{-}
36188 @tab No
36189
36190 @end multitable
36191
36192 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
36193
36194 @table @samp
36195 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
36196 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
36197 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
36198 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
36199 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
36200 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
36201 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
36202 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
36203 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
36204 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
36205
36206 @item qXfer:auxv:read
36207 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
36208 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
36209
36210 @item qXfer:btrace:read
36211 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
36212 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
36213
36214 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
36215 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
36216 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
36217
36218 @item qXfer:features:read
36219 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
36220 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
36221
36222 @item qXfer:libraries:read
36223 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
36224 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
36225
36226 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
36227 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36228 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36229
36230 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
36231 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
36232 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
36233 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
36234
36235 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
36236 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
36237 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
36238
36239 @item qXfer:sdata:read
36240 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
36241 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
36242
36243 @item qXfer:spu:read
36244 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
36245 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
36246
36247 @item qXfer:spu:write
36248 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
36249 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
36250
36251 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
36252 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
36253 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
36254
36255 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
36256 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
36257 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
36258
36259 @item qXfer:threads:read
36260 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
36261 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
36262
36263 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
36264 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
36265 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
36266
36267 @item qXfer:uib:read
36268 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
36269 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
36270
36271 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
36272 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
36273 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
36274
36275 @item QNonStop
36276 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
36277 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
36278
36279 @item QPassSignals
36280 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
36281 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
36282
36283 @item QStartNoAckMode
36284 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
36285 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
36286
36287 @item multiprocess
36288 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
36289 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
36290 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
36291 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
36292 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
36293 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
36294 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
36295 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
36296 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
36297 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
36298 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
36299
36300 @item qXfer:osdata:read
36301 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
36302 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
36303
36304 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
36305 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
36306 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
36307 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
36308
36309 @item ConditionalTracepoints
36310 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
36311 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
36312
36313 @item ReverseContinue
36314 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
36315 (@pxref{bc}).
36316
36317 @item ReverseStep
36318 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
36319 (@pxref{bs}).
36320
36321 @item TracepointSource
36322 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
36323 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
36324
36325 @item QAgent
36326 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
36327
36328 @item QAllow
36329 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
36330
36331 @item QDisableRandomization
36332 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
36333
36334 @item StaticTracepoint
36335 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
36336 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
36337
36338 @item InstallInTrace
36339 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
36340 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
36341
36342 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
36343 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
36344 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
36345 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
36346
36347 @item QTBuffer:size
36348 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
36349 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
36350
36351 @item tracenz
36352 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
36353 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
36354 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
36355
36356 @item BreakpointCommands
36357 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
36358 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
36359 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
36360
36361 @item Qbtrace:off
36362 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
36363
36364 @item Qbtrace:bts
36365 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
36366
36367 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
36368 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
36369
36370 @item swbreak
36371 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
36372 breakpoints.
36373
36374 @item hwbreak
36375 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
36376 breakpoints.
36377
36378 @end table
36379
36380 @item qSymbol::
36381 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
36382 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
36383 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
36384 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
36385
36386 Reply:
36387 @table @samp
36388 @item OK
36389 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36390 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36391 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
36392 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
36393 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
36394 below.
36395 @end table
36396
36397 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
36398 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
36399
36400 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
36401 target has previously requested.
36402
36403 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
36404 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
36405 will be empty.
36406
36407 Reply:
36408 @table @samp
36409 @item OK
36410 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
36411 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
36412 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
36413 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
36414 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
36415 @end table
36416
36417 @item qTBuffer
36418 @itemx QTBuffer
36419 @itemx QTDisconnected
36420 @itemx QTDP
36421 @itemx QTDPsrc
36422 @itemx QTDV
36423 @itemx qTfP
36424 @itemx qTfV
36425 @itemx QTFrame
36426 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
36427
36428 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36429
36430 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
36431 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
36432 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
36433 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
36434 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
36435 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
36436 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
36437 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
36438 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
36439 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
36440 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
36441
36442 Reply:
36443 @table @samp
36444 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
36445 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
36446 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
36447 the thread's attributes.
36448 @end table
36449
36450 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
36451 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
36452 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
36453 packets.)
36454
36455 @item QTNotes
36456 @itemx qTP
36457 @itemx QTSave
36458 @itemx qTsP
36459 @itemx qTsV
36460 @itemx QTStart
36461 @itemx QTStop
36462 @itemx QTEnable
36463 @itemx QTDisable
36464 @itemx QTinit
36465 @itemx QTro
36466 @itemx qTStatus
36467 @itemx qTV
36468 @itemx qTfSTM
36469 @itemx qTsSTM
36470 @itemx qTSTMat
36471 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
36472
36473 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36474 @cindex read special object, remote request
36475 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
36476 @anchor{qXfer read}
36477 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
36478 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
36479 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
36480 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
36481 additional details about what data to access.
36482
36483 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36484 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36485 formats, listed below.
36486
36487 @table @samp
36488 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36489 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
36490 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
36491 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
36492
36493 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36494 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36495
36496 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36497 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
36498
36499 Return a description of the current branch trace.
36500 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
36501 packet may have one of the following values:
36502
36503 @table @code
36504 @item all
36505 Returns all available branch trace.
36506
36507 @item new
36508 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
36509 the last read request.
36510
36511 @item delta
36512 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
36513 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
36514 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
36515 used to stitch traces together.
36516
36517 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
36518 @end table
36519
36520 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36521 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36522
36523 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36524 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
36525
36526 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
36527 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
36528
36529 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
36530 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36531
36532 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36533 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
36534 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
36535 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
36536 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
36537
36538 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36539 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36540
36541 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36542 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
36543 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
36544 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36545 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36546
36547 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
36548 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
36549 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
36550
36551 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36552 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36553
36554 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36555 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
36556 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
36557 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
36558 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
36559 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
36560 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36561 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
36562
36563 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
36564 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
36565
36566 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36567 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36568
36569 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
36570 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
36571 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
36572 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
36573
36574 @table @code
36575 @item start=@var{address}
36576 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36577 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
36578 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
36579 chosen as the starting point.
36580
36581 @item prev=@var{address}
36582 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
36583 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
36584 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
36585 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
36586 exists prior to the starting point.
36587
36588 @end table
36589
36590 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
36591 ignored.
36592
36593 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36594 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
36595 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
36596 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36597 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36598
36599 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36600 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36601
36602 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36603 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
36604
36605 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
36606 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
36607 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
36608 Action Lists}.
36609
36610 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36611 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36612 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36613
36614 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36615 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
36616 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
36617 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36618 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36619
36620 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36621 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36622 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36623
36624 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36625 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
36626 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36627 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
36628 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36629 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36630 in that context to be accessed.
36631
36632 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36633 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36634 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36635
36636 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36637 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
36638 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
36639 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
36640 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36641
36642 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36643 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36644
36645 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36646 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
36647
36648 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
36649 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
36650 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
36651
36652 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36653 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36654
36655 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36656 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
36657
36658 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
36659 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
36660
36661 This packet is not probed by default.
36662
36663 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
36664 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
36665 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
36666 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
36667 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
36668
36669 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36670 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36671
36672 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
36673 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
36674 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
36675 @xref{Operating System Information}.
36676
36677 @end table
36678
36679 Reply:
36680 @table @samp
36681 @item m @var{data}
36682 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
36683 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
36684 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
36685 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
36686 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
36687 request.
36688
36689 @item l @var{data}
36690 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
36691 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
36692 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
36693
36694 @item l
36695 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
36696 There is no more data to be read.
36697
36698 @item E00
36699 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36700
36701 @item E @var{nn}
36702 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
36703 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36704
36705 @item @w{}
36706 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
36707 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
36708 @end table
36709
36710 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36711 @cindex write data into object, remote request
36712 @anchor{qXfer write}
36713 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
36714 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
36715 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
36716 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
36717 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
36718 to access.
36719
36720 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All
36721 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
36722 formats, listed below.
36723
36724 @table @samp
36725 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36726 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
36727 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
36728 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
36729 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
36730
36731 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36732 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
36733 (@pxref{qSupported}).
36734
36735 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
36736 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
36737 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
36738 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
36739 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
36740 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
36741 in that context to be accessed.
36742
36743 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
36744 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
36745 @end table
36746
36747 Reply:
36748 @table @samp
36749 @item @var{nn}
36750 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
36751 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
36752
36753 @item E00
36754 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
36755
36756 @item E @var{nn}
36757 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
36758 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
36759
36760 @item @w{}
36761 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
36762 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
36763 @end table
36764
36765 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
36766 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
36767 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
36768 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
36769 must respond with an empty packet.
36770
36771 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
36772 @cindex query attached, remote request
36773 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
36774 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
36775 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
36776 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
36777 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
36778 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
36779 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
36780
36781 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
36782 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
36783 the @code{quit} command.
36784
36785 Reply:
36786 @table @samp
36787 @item 1
36788 The remote server attached to an existing process.
36789 @item 0
36790 The remote server created a new process.
36791 @item E @var{NN}
36792 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36793 @end table
36794
36795 @item Qbtrace:bts
36796 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using bts tracing.
36797
36798 Reply:
36799 @table @samp
36800 @item OK
36801 Branch tracing has been enabled.
36802 @item E.errtext
36803 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36804 @end table
36805
36806 @item Qbtrace:off
36807 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
36808
36809 Reply:
36810 @table @samp
36811 @item OK
36812 Branch tracing has been disabled.
36813 @item E.errtext
36814 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36815 @end table
36816
36817 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
36818 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
36819 btrace recording method in bts format.
36820
36821 Reply:
36822 @table @samp
36823 @item OK
36824 The ring buffer size has been set.
36825 @item E.errtext
36826 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
36827 @end table
36828
36829 @end table
36830
36831 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36832 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
36833
36834 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
36835 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
36836 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
36837
36838 @menu
36839 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
36840 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
36841 @end menu
36842
36843 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
36844 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
36845
36846 @menu
36847 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
36848 @end menu
36849
36850 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
36851 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
36852 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
36853
36854 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36855
36856 @table @r
36857
36858 @item 2
36859 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
36860
36861 @item 3
36862 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
36863
36864 @item 4
36865 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
36866
36867 @end table
36868
36869 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
36870 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
36871
36872 @menu
36873 * MIPS Register packet Format::
36874 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
36875 @end menu
36876
36877 @node MIPS Register packet Format
36878 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
36879 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
36880
36881 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
36882 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
36883 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
36884 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
36885 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
36886 most-significant -- least-significant.
36887
36888 @table @r
36889
36890 @item MIPS32
36891 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
36892 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
36893 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
36894
36895 @item MIPS64
36896 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
36897 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
36898 as @code{MIPS32}.
36899
36900 @end table
36901
36902 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
36903 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
36904 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
36905
36906 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
36907
36908 @table @r
36909
36910 @item 2
36911 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
36912
36913 @item 3
36914 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36915
36916 @item 4
36917 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
36918
36919 @item 5
36920 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
36921
36922 @end table
36923
36924 @node Tracepoint Packets
36925 @section Tracepoint Packets
36926 @cindex tracepoint packets
36927 @cindex packets, tracepoint
36928
36929 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
36930 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36931
36932 @table @samp
36933
36934 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
36935 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
36936 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
36937 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
36938 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
36939 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
36940 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
36941 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
36942 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
36943 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
36944 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
36945 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
36946 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
36947 actions.
36948
36949 Replies:
36950 @table @samp
36951 @item OK
36952 The packet was understood and carried out.
36953 @item qRelocInsn
36954 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
36955 @item @w{}
36956 The packet was not recognized.
36957 @end table
36958
36959 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
36960 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
36961 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
36962 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
36963 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
36964 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
36965 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
36966
36967 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
36968 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
36969 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
36970 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
36971 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
36972 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
36973 tracepoint actions.
36974
36975 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
36976 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
36977 following forms:
36978
36979 @table @samp
36980
36981 @item R @var{mask}
36982 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
36983 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
36984 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
36985 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
36986 not fit in a 32-bit word.
36987
36988 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
36989 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
36990 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
36991 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
36992 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
36993 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
36994 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
36995
36996 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
36997 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
36998 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
36999 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
37000 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
37001 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
37002 packet).
37003
37004 @end table
37005
37006 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
37007 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
37008 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
37009 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
37010 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
37011 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
37012 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
37013 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
37014
37015 Replies:
37016 @table @samp
37017 @item OK
37018 The packet was understood and carried out.
37019 @item qRelocInsn
37020 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
37021 @item @w{}
37022 The packet was not recognized.
37023 @end table
37024
37025 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
37026 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
37027 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
37028 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
37029 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
37030 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
37031 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
37032 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
37033
37034 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
37035 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
37036 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
37037 fit in a single packet.
37038 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
37039 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
37040
37041 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
37042 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
37043 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
37044 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
37045
37046 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
37047 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
37048 query packets.
37049
37050 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
37051 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
37052 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
37053 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
37054 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
37055 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
37056 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
37057 be found.
37058
37059 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
37060 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
37061 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
37062 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
37063 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
37064 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
37065 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
37066 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
37067 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
37068 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
37069 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
37070 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
37071 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
37072 variable.
37073
37074 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
37075 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
37076 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
37077 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
37078 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
37079
37080 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
37081 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
37082 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
37083 one of the following forms:
37084
37085 @table @samp
37086 @item F @var{f}
37087 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
37088 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
37089 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
37090
37091 @item T @var{t}
37092 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
37093 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
37094
37095 @end table
37096
37097 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
37098 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37099 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
37100 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
37101
37102 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
37103 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37104 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
37105 is a hexadecimal number.
37106
37107 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
37108 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
37109 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
37110 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
37111 numbers.
37112
37113 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
37114 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
37115 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
37116
37117 @item qTMinFTPILen
37118 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
37119 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
37120 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
37121 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
37122 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
37123 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
37124 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
37125 arrange for that.
37126
37127 Replies:
37128
37129 @table @samp
37130 @item 0
37131 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
37132 @item @var{length}
37133 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
37134 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
37135 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
37136 regardless of size.
37137 @item E
37138 An error has occurred.
37139 @item @w{}
37140 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
37141 @end table
37142
37143 @item QTStart
37144 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
37145 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
37146 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
37147 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
37148 instruction reply packet}).
37149
37150 @item QTStop
37151 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
37152 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
37153
37154 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37155 @anchor{QTEnable}
37156 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
37157 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37158 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
37159 of data from it will resume.
37160
37161 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
37162 @anchor{QTDisable}
37163 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
37164 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
37165 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
37166 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
37167
37168 @item QTinit
37169 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
37170 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
37171
37172 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
37173 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
37174 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
37175 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
37176 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
37177
37178 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
37179 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
37180 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
37181 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
37182
37183 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
37184 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
37185 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
37186 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
37187 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
37188 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
37189
37190 @item qTStatus
37191 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
37192 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
37193
37194 The reply has the form:
37195
37196 @table @samp
37197
37198 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
37199 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
37200 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
37201 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
37202
37203 @end table
37204
37205 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
37206 explanations as one of the optional fields:
37207
37208 @table @samp
37209
37210 @item tnotrun:0
37211 No trace has been run yet.
37212
37213 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
37214 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
37215 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
37216 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
37217 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
37218
37219 @item tfull:0
37220 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
37221
37222 @item tdisconnected:0
37223 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
37224
37225 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
37226 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
37227
37228 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
37229 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
37230 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
37231 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
37232 is hex encoded.
37233
37234 @item tunknown:0
37235 The trace stopped for some other reason.
37236
37237 @end table
37238
37239 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
37240 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
37241 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
37242 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
37243 trace.
37244
37245 @table @samp
37246
37247 @item tframes:@var{n}
37248 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
37249
37250 @item tcreated:@var{n}
37251 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
37252 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
37253
37254 @item tsize:@var{n}
37255 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
37256
37257 @item tfree:@var{n}
37258 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
37259
37260 @item circular:@var{n}
37261 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
37262 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
37263 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
37264 and may fill up.
37265
37266 @item disconn:@var{n}
37267 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
37268 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
37269 that the trace run will stop.
37270
37271 @end table
37272
37273 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
37274 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
37275 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
37276 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
37277 address @var{addr}.
37278
37279 Replies:
37280 @table @samp
37281 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
37282 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
37283 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
37284 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
37285 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
37286
37287 @end table
37288
37289 @item qTV:@var{var}
37290 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
37291 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
37292 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
37293
37294 Replies:
37295 @table @samp
37296 @item V@var{value}
37297 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
37298 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
37299 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
37300 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
37301 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
37302 program is running.
37303
37304 @item U
37305 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
37306 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
37307 was not collected.
37308 @end table
37309
37310 @item qTfP
37311 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
37312 @itemx qTsP
37313 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
37314 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
37315 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
37316 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
37317 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
37318 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
37319
37320 @item qTfV
37321 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
37322 @itemx qTsV
37323 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
37324 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
37325 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
37326 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
37327 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
37328 trace state variables.
37329
37330 @item qTfSTM
37331 @itemx qTsSTM
37332 @anchor{qTfSTM}
37333 @anchor{qTsSTM}
37334 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
37335 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
37336 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
37337 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
37338 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
37339 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
37340
37341 Reply:
37342 @table @samp
37343 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
37344 A single marker
37345 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
37346 a comma-separated list of markers
37347 @item l
37348 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37349 @item E @var{nn}
37350 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37351 @item @w{}
37352 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
37353 stub.
37354 @end table
37355
37356 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
37357 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
37358
37359 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37360 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
37361 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
37362 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
37363 @dfn{last}).
37364
37365 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
37366 @anchor{qTSTMat}
37367 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
37368 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
37369 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
37370 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
37371 tracepoint markers.
37372
37373 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
37374 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
37375 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
37376 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
37377 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
37378 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
37379
37380 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
37381 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
37382 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
37383 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
37384 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
37385 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
37386 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
37387 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
37388 available.
37389
37390 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
37391 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
37392 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
37393
37394 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
37395 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
37396 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
37397 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
37398 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
37399 use whatever size it prefers.
37400
37401 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
37402 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
37403 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
37404 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
37405 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
37406
37407 @end table
37408
37409 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
37410 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
37411 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
37412 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
37413 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
37414 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
37415 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
37416 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
37417 it had executed in the original location.
37418
37419 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
37420 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
37421 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
37422 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
37423 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
37424 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
37425 format of the request is:
37426
37427 @table @samp
37428 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
37429
37430 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
37431 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
37432 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
37433 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
37434 memory starting at @var{to}.
37435 @end table
37436
37437 Replies:
37438 @table @samp
37439 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
37440 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
37441 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
37442 @item E @var{NN}
37443 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
37444 relocating the instruction.
37445 @end table
37446
37447 @node Host I/O Packets
37448 @section Host I/O Packets
37449 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
37450 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
37451
37452 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
37453 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
37454 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
37455 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
37456 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
37457 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
37458 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
37459 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
37460 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
37461 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
37462
37463 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
37464 its arguments. They have this format:
37465
37466 @table @samp
37467
37468 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
37469 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
37470 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
37471 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
37472 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
37473 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
37474 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
37475 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
37476 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37477
37478 @end table
37479
37480 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
37481
37482 @table @samp
37483
37484 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
37485 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
37486 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
37487 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
37488 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
37489 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
37490 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
37491 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
37492 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
37493 @var{attachment}.
37494
37495 @item @w{}
37496 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
37497
37498 @end table
37499
37500 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
37501
37502 @table @samp
37503 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
37504 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
37505 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
37506 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
37507 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
37508 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
37509 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
37510
37511 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
37512 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
37513 -1 if an error occurs.
37514
37515 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
37516 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
37517 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
37518 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
37519 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
37520 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
37521 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
37522 @var{count} was zero.
37523
37524 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37525 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37526 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37527 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37528 some characters were escaped.
37529
37530 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
37531 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
37532 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
37533 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
37534 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
37535 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
37536 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
37537 error occurred.
37538
37539 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
37540 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
37541 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
37542 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
37543 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
37544 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
37545
37546 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
37547 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
37548 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
37549
37550 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
37551 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
37552 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
37553
37554 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
37555 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
37556 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
37557 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
37558 some characters were escaped.
37559
37560 @end table
37561
37562 @node Interrupts
37563 @section Interrupts
37564 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
37565
37566 When a program on the remote target is running, @value{GDBN} may
37567 attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or
37568 a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g},
37569 control of which is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
37570
37571 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
37572 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
37573 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
37574 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
37575 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
37576
37577 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
37578 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
37579 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
37580 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
37581 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
37582 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
37583 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
37584 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
37585
37586 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
37587 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
37588 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
37589
37590 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
37591 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
37592 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
37593 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
37594 currently-executing threads and processes.
37595 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
37596 running program, it should send one of the stop
37597 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
37598 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
37599 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
37600 Interrupts received while the
37601 program is stopped are discarded.
37602
37603 @node Notification Packets
37604 @section Notification Packets
37605 @cindex notification packets
37606 @cindex packets, notification
37607
37608 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
37609 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
37610 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
37611 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
37612 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
37613 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
37614 is not a problem.
37615
37616 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
37617 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
37618 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
37619 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
37620 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
37621 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
37622 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
37623
37624 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
37625 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
37626
37627 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
37628 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
37629 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
37630 not they understand it.
37631
37632 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
37633 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
37634 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
37635 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
37636 recipients.
37637
37638 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
37639 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
37640 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
37641 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
37642 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
37643
37644 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
37645 @table @samp
37646 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
37647 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
37648 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
37649 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
37650 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
37651 @item @var{ack}
37652 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
37653 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
37654 @end table
37655
37656 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
37657 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
37658
37659 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
37660 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
37661 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
37662 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
37663 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
37664 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
37665 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
37666 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
37667 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
37668 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
37669
37670 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
37671 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
37672 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
37673 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
37674 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
37675 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
37676
37677 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
37678 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
37679 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
37680 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
37681 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
37682
37683 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
37684 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
37685 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
37686 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
37687 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
37688 normally.
37689
37690 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
37691 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
37692 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
37693 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
37694 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
37695 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
37696 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
37697 the process shall be repeated.
37698
37699 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
37700 following example:
37701 @smallexample
37702 <- @code{%%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
37703 @code{...}
37704 -> @code{vStopped}
37705 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
37706 -> @code{vStopped}
37707 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
37708 -> @code{vStopped}
37709 <- @code{OK}
37710 @end smallexample
37711
37712 The following notifications are defined:
37713 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
37714
37715 @item Notification
37716 @tab Ack
37717 @tab Event
37718 @tab Description
37719
37720 @item Stop
37721 @tab vStopped
37722 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
37723 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
37724 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
37725 @value{GDBN}.
37726 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
37727
37728 @end multitable
37729
37730 @node Remote Non-Stop
37731 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
37732
37733 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
37734 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
37735 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
37736 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37737
37738 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
37739 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
37740 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
37741 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
37742 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
37743 probe the target state after a mode change.
37744
37745 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
37746 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
37747 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
37748 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
37749 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
37750 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
37751 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
37752 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
37753 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
37754 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
37755 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
37756
37757 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
37758 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
37759 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
37760 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
37761 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
37762 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
37763 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
37764 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
37765 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
37766 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
37767 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
37768 @samp{OK}.
37769
37770 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
37771 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
37772 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
37773 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
37774 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
37775 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
37776 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
37777 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
37778 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
37779 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
37780 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
37781 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
37782 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
37783
37784 @node Packet Acknowledgment
37785 @section Packet Acknowledgment
37786
37787 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37788 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
37789 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
37790 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
37791 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
37792 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
37793 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
37794
37795 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
37796 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
37797 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
37798 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
37799 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
37800
37801 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
37802 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
37803 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
37804 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
37805
37806 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
37807 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
37808 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
37809 @pxref{qSupported}.
37810 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
37811 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
37812 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
37813 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
37814 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
37815 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
37816 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
37817
37818 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
37819 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
37820 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
37821 connection.
37822 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
37823 new connection is established,
37824 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
37825 for the current connection, once disabled.
37826
37827 @node Examples
37828 @section Examples
37829
37830 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
37831 does not get any direct output:
37832
37833 @smallexample
37834 -> @code{R00}
37835 <- @code{+}
37836 @emph{target restarts}
37837 -> @code{?}
37838 <- @code{+}
37839 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37840 -> @code{+}
37841 @end smallexample
37842
37843 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
37844
37845 @smallexample
37846 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
37847 <- @code{+}
37848 -> @code{s}
37849 <- @code{+}
37850 @emph{time passes}
37851 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
37852 -> @code{+}
37853 -> @code{g}
37854 <- @code{+}
37855 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
37856 -> @code{+}
37857 @end smallexample
37858
37859 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37860 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
37861 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
37862
37863 @menu
37864 * File-I/O Overview::
37865 * Protocol Basics::
37866 * The F Request Packet::
37867 * The F Reply Packet::
37868 * The Ctrl-C Message::
37869 * Console I/O::
37870 * List of Supported Calls::
37871 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
37872 * Constants::
37873 * File-I/O Examples::
37874 @end menu
37875
37876 @node File-I/O Overview
37877 @subsection File-I/O Overview
37878 @cindex file-i/o overview
37879
37880 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
37881 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
37882 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
37883 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
37884 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
37885 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
37886
37887 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
37888 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
37889 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
37890 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
37891 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
37892
37893 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
37894 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37895 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
37896 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
37897 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
37898 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
37899 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
37900
37901 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
37902 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
37903 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
37904 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
37905 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
37906
37907 @smallexample
37908 (@value{GDBP}) continue
37909 <- target requests 'system call X'
37910 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
37911 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
37912 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
37913 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
37914 @end smallexample
37915
37916 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
37917 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
37918 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
37919 system are not supported by this protocol.
37920
37921 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
37922
37923 @node Protocol Basics
37924 @subsection Protocol Basics
37925 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
37926
37927 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
37928 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
37929 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
37930 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
37931 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
37932 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
37933 to call the appropriate host system call:
37934
37935 @itemize @bullet
37936 @item
37937 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
37938
37939 @item
37940 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
37941 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
37942 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
37943 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
37944
37945 @end itemize
37946
37947 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
37948
37949 @itemize @bullet
37950 @item
37951 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
37952 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
37953 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
37954 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
37955 packet.
37956
37957 @item
37958 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
37959 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
37960
37961 @item
37962 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
37963
37964 @item
37965 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
37966
37967 @item
37968 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
37969 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
37970 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
37971 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
37972 packet.
37973
37974 @end itemize
37975
37976 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
37977 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
37978
37979 @itemize @bullet
37980 @item
37981 Return value.
37982
37983 @item
37984 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
37985
37986 @item
37987 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
37988
37989 @end itemize
37990
37991 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
37992 the latest continue or step action.
37993
37994 @node The F Request Packet
37995 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
37996 @cindex file-i/o request packet
37997 @cindex @code{F} request packet
37998
37999 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
38000
38001 @table @samp
38002 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
38003
38004 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
38005 This is just the name of the function.
38006
38007 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
38008 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
38009 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
38010 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
38011 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
38012 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
38013 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
38014
38015 @end table
38016
38017
38018
38019 @node The F Reply Packet
38020 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
38021 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
38022 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
38023
38024 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
38025
38026 @table @samp
38027
38028 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
38029
38030 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
38031
38032 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
38033 representation.
38034 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
38035
38036 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
38037 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
38038 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
38039
38040 @smallexample
38041 F0,0,C
38042 @end smallexample
38043
38044 @noindent
38045 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
38046
38047 @smallexample
38048 F-1,4,C
38049 @end smallexample
38050
38051 @noindent
38052 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
38053
38054 @end table
38055
38056
38057 @node The Ctrl-C Message
38058 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
38059 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
38060
38061 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
38062 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
38063 the target should behave as if it had
38064 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
38065 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
38066 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
38067 packet.
38068
38069 It's important for the target to know in which
38070 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
38071
38072 @itemize @bullet
38073 @item
38074 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
38075
38076 @item
38077 The system call on the host has been finished.
38078
38079 @end itemize
38080
38081 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
38082 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
38083 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
38084 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
38085 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
38086 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
38087
38088 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
38089 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
38090 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
38091 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
38092 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
38093 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
38094 or the full action has been completed.
38095
38096 @node Console I/O
38097 @subsection Console I/O
38098 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
38099
38100 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
38101 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
38102 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
38103 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
38104 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
38105 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
38106 conditions is met:
38107
38108 @itemize @bullet
38109 @item
38110 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
38111 @code{read}
38112 system call is treated as finished.
38113
38114 @item
38115 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
38116 newline.
38117
38118 @item
38119 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
38120 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
38121
38122 @end itemize
38123
38124 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
38125 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
38126 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
38127 is stopped at the user's request.
38128
38129
38130 @node List of Supported Calls
38131 @subsection List of Supported Calls
38132 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
38133
38134 @menu
38135 * open::
38136 * close::
38137 * read::
38138 * write::
38139 * lseek::
38140 * rename::
38141 * unlink::
38142 * stat/fstat::
38143 * gettimeofday::
38144 * isatty::
38145 * system::
38146 @end menu
38147
38148 @node open
38149 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
38150 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
38151
38152 @table @asis
38153 @item Synopsis:
38154 @smallexample
38155 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
38156 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
38157 @end smallexample
38158
38159 @item Request:
38160 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
38161
38162 @noindent
38163 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38164
38165 @table @code
38166 @item O_CREAT
38167 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
38168 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
38169 are concerned.
38170
38171 @item O_EXCL
38172 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
38173 an error and open() fails.
38174
38175 @item O_TRUNC
38176 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
38177 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
38178 truncated to zero length.
38179
38180 @item O_APPEND
38181 The file is opened in append mode.
38182
38183 @item O_RDONLY
38184 The file is opened for reading only.
38185
38186 @item O_WRONLY
38187 The file is opened for writing only.
38188
38189 @item O_RDWR
38190 The file is opened for reading and writing.
38191 @end table
38192
38193 @noindent
38194 Other bits are silently ignored.
38195
38196
38197 @noindent
38198 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
38199
38200 @table @code
38201 @item S_IRUSR
38202 User has read permission.
38203
38204 @item S_IWUSR
38205 User has write permission.
38206
38207 @item S_IRGRP
38208 Group has read permission.
38209
38210 @item S_IWGRP
38211 Group has write permission.
38212
38213 @item S_IROTH
38214 Others have read permission.
38215
38216 @item S_IWOTH
38217 Others have write permission.
38218 @end table
38219
38220 @noindent
38221 Other bits are silently ignored.
38222
38223
38224 @item Return value:
38225 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
38226 occurred.
38227
38228 @item Errors:
38229
38230 @table @code
38231 @item EEXIST
38232 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
38233
38234 @item EISDIR
38235 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
38236
38237 @item EACCES
38238 The requested access is not allowed.
38239
38240 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38241 @var{pathname} was too long.
38242
38243 @item ENOENT
38244 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38245
38246 @item ENODEV
38247 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
38248
38249 @item EROFS
38250 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
38251 write access was requested.
38252
38253 @item EFAULT
38254 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
38255
38256 @item ENOSPC
38257 No space on device to create the file.
38258
38259 @item EMFILE
38260 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
38261
38262 @item ENFILE
38263 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
38264 has been reached.
38265
38266 @item EINTR
38267 The call was interrupted by the user.
38268 @end table
38269
38270 @end table
38271
38272 @node close
38273 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
38274 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
38275
38276 @table @asis
38277 @item Synopsis:
38278 @smallexample
38279 int close(int fd);
38280 @end smallexample
38281
38282 @item Request:
38283 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
38284
38285 @item Return value:
38286 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
38287
38288 @item Errors:
38289
38290 @table @code
38291 @item EBADF
38292 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
38293
38294 @item EINTR
38295 The call was interrupted by the user.
38296 @end table
38297
38298 @end table
38299
38300 @node read
38301 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
38302 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
38303
38304 @table @asis
38305 @item Synopsis:
38306 @smallexample
38307 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
38308 @end smallexample
38309
38310 @item Request:
38311 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38312
38313 @item Return value:
38314 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
38315 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
38316 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
38317
38318 @item Errors:
38319
38320 @table @code
38321 @item EBADF
38322 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38323 reading.
38324
38325 @item EFAULT
38326 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38327
38328 @item EINTR
38329 The call was interrupted by the user.
38330 @end table
38331
38332 @end table
38333
38334 @node write
38335 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
38336 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
38337
38338 @table @asis
38339 @item Synopsis:
38340 @smallexample
38341 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
38342 @end smallexample
38343
38344 @item Request:
38345 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
38346
38347 @item Return value:
38348 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
38349 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
38350 is returned.
38351
38352 @item Errors:
38353
38354 @table @code
38355 @item EBADF
38356 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
38357 writing.
38358
38359 @item EFAULT
38360 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38361
38362 @item EFBIG
38363 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
38364 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
38365
38366 @item ENOSPC
38367 No space on device to write the data.
38368
38369 @item EINTR
38370 The call was interrupted by the user.
38371 @end table
38372
38373 @end table
38374
38375 @node lseek
38376 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
38377 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
38378
38379 @table @asis
38380 @item Synopsis:
38381 @smallexample
38382 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
38383 @end smallexample
38384
38385 @item Request:
38386 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
38387
38388 @var{flag} is one of:
38389
38390 @table @code
38391 @item SEEK_SET
38392 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
38393
38394 @item SEEK_CUR
38395 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
38396 bytes.
38397
38398 @item SEEK_END
38399 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
38400 bytes.
38401 @end table
38402
38403 @item Return value:
38404 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
38405 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
38406 value of -1 is returned.
38407
38408 @item Errors:
38409
38410 @table @code
38411 @item EBADF
38412 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
38413
38414 @item ESPIPE
38415 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
38416
38417 @item EINVAL
38418 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
38419
38420 @item EINTR
38421 The call was interrupted by the user.
38422 @end table
38423
38424 @end table
38425
38426 @node rename
38427 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
38428 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
38429
38430 @table @asis
38431 @item Synopsis:
38432 @smallexample
38433 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
38434 @end smallexample
38435
38436 @item Request:
38437 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
38438
38439 @item Return value:
38440 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38441
38442 @item Errors:
38443
38444 @table @code
38445 @item EISDIR
38446 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
38447 directory.
38448
38449 @item EEXIST
38450 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
38451
38452 @item EBUSY
38453 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
38454 process.
38455
38456 @item EINVAL
38457 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
38458 of itself.
38459
38460 @item ENOTDIR
38461 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
38462 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
38463 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
38464
38465 @item EFAULT
38466 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
38467
38468 @item EACCES
38469 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38470
38471 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38472
38473 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
38474
38475 @item ENOENT
38476 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
38477
38478 @item EROFS
38479 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38480
38481 @item ENOSPC
38482 The device containing the file has no room for the new
38483 directory entry.
38484
38485 @item EINTR
38486 The call was interrupted by the user.
38487 @end table
38488
38489 @end table
38490
38491 @node unlink
38492 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
38493 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
38494
38495 @table @asis
38496 @item Synopsis:
38497 @smallexample
38498 int unlink(const char *pathname);
38499 @end smallexample
38500
38501 @item Request:
38502 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
38503
38504 @item Return value:
38505 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38506
38507 @item Errors:
38508
38509 @table @code
38510 @item EACCES
38511 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38512
38513 @item EPERM
38514 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
38515
38516 @item EBUSY
38517 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
38518 being used by another process.
38519
38520 @item EFAULT
38521 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38522
38523 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38524 @var{pathname} was too long.
38525
38526 @item ENOENT
38527 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
38528
38529 @item ENOTDIR
38530 A component of the path is not a directory.
38531
38532 @item EROFS
38533 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
38534
38535 @item EINTR
38536 The call was interrupted by the user.
38537 @end table
38538
38539 @end table
38540
38541 @node stat/fstat
38542 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
38543 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
38544 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
38545
38546 @table @asis
38547 @item Synopsis:
38548 @smallexample
38549 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
38550 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
38551 @end smallexample
38552
38553 @item Request:
38554 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
38555 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
38556
38557 @item Return value:
38558 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
38559
38560 @item Errors:
38561
38562 @table @code
38563 @item EBADF
38564 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
38565
38566 @item ENOENT
38567 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
38568 path is an empty string.
38569
38570 @item ENOTDIR
38571 A component of the path is not a directory.
38572
38573 @item EFAULT
38574 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38575
38576 @item EACCES
38577 No access to the file or the path of the file.
38578
38579 @item ENAMETOOLONG
38580 @var{pathname} was too long.
38581
38582 @item EINTR
38583 The call was interrupted by the user.
38584 @end table
38585
38586 @end table
38587
38588 @node gettimeofday
38589 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
38590 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
38591
38592 @table @asis
38593 @item Synopsis:
38594 @smallexample
38595 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
38596 @end smallexample
38597
38598 @item Request:
38599 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
38600
38601 @item Return value:
38602 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
38603
38604 @item Errors:
38605
38606 @table @code
38607 @item EINVAL
38608 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
38609
38610 @item EFAULT
38611 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
38612 @end table
38613
38614 @end table
38615
38616 @node isatty
38617 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
38618 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
38619
38620 @table @asis
38621 @item Synopsis:
38622 @smallexample
38623 int isatty(int fd);
38624 @end smallexample
38625
38626 @item Request:
38627 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
38628
38629 @item Return value:
38630 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
38631
38632 @item Errors:
38633
38634 @table @code
38635 @item EINTR
38636 The call was interrupted by the user.
38637 @end table
38638
38639 @end table
38640
38641 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
38642 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
38643 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
38644 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
38645 needed.
38646
38647
38648 @node system
38649 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
38650 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
38651
38652 @table @asis
38653 @item Synopsis:
38654 @smallexample
38655 int system(const char *command);
38656 @end smallexample
38657
38658 @item Request:
38659 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
38660
38661 @item Return value:
38662 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
38663 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
38664 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
38665 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
38666 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
38667 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
38668 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
38669
38670 @item Errors:
38671
38672 @table @code
38673 @item EINTR
38674 The call was interrupted by the user.
38675 @end table
38676
38677 @end table
38678
38679 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
38680 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
38681 the host is simplified before it's returned
38682 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
38683 is discarded, and the return value consists
38684 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
38685
38686 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
38687 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
38688 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
38689
38690 @table @code
38691 @item set remote system-call-allowed
38692 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
38693 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
38694 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
38695
38696 @item show remote system-call-allowed
38697 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
38698 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
38699 protocol.
38700 @end table
38701
38702 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38703 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
38704 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38705
38706 @menu
38707 * Integral Datatypes::
38708 * Pointer Values::
38709 * Memory Transfer::
38710 * struct stat::
38711 * struct timeval::
38712 @end menu
38713
38714 @node Integral Datatypes
38715 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
38716 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
38717
38718 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
38719 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
38720 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
38721
38722 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
38723 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
38724
38725 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
38726
38727 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
38728 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
38729
38730 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
38731
38732 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
38733 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
38734 byte order.
38735
38736 @node Pointer Values
38737 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
38738 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
38739
38740 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
38741 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
38742 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
38743 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
38744
38745 @smallexample
38746 @code{1aaf/12}
38747 @end smallexample
38748
38749 @noindent
38750 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
38751 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
38752 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
38753 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
38754
38755 @smallexample
38756 @code{123456/d}
38757 @end smallexample
38758
38759 @node Memory Transfer
38760 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
38761 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
38762
38763 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
38764 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
38765 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
38766 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
38767 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
38768 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
38769 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
38770
38771
38772 @node struct stat
38773 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
38774 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
38775
38776 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
38777 is defined as follows:
38778
38779 @smallexample
38780 struct stat @{
38781 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
38782 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
38783 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
38784 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
38785 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
38786 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
38787 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
38788 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
38789 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
38790 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
38791 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
38792 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
38793 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
38794 @};
38795 @end smallexample
38796
38797 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38798 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38799 structure is of size 64 bytes.
38800
38801 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
38802 range of values.
38803
38804 @table @code
38805
38806 @item st_dev
38807 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
38808
38809 @item st_ino
38810 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38811
38812 @item st_mode
38813 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
38814 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
38815
38816 @item st_uid
38817 @itemx st_gid
38818 @itemx st_rdev
38819 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
38820
38821 @item st_atime
38822 @itemx st_mtime
38823 @itemx st_ctime
38824 These values have a host and file system dependent
38825 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
38826 support exact timing values.
38827 @end table
38828
38829 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
38830 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
38831 continuing.
38832
38833 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
38834 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
38835 get truncated on the target.
38836
38837 @node struct timeval
38838 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
38839 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
38840
38841 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
38842 is defined as follows:
38843
38844 @smallexample
38845 struct timeval @{
38846 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
38847 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
38848 @};
38849 @end smallexample
38850
38851 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
38852 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
38853 structure is of size 8 bytes.
38854
38855 @node Constants
38856 @subsection Constants
38857 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
38858
38859 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
38860 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
38861 values before and after the call as needed.
38862
38863 @menu
38864 * Open Flags::
38865 * mode_t Values::
38866 * Errno Values::
38867 * Lseek Flags::
38868 * Limits::
38869 @end menu
38870
38871 @node Open Flags
38872 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
38873 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
38874
38875 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
38876
38877 @smallexample
38878 O_RDONLY 0x0
38879 O_WRONLY 0x1
38880 O_RDWR 0x2
38881 O_APPEND 0x8
38882 O_CREAT 0x200
38883 O_TRUNC 0x400
38884 O_EXCL 0x800
38885 @end smallexample
38886
38887 @node mode_t Values
38888 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
38889 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
38890
38891 All values are given in octal representation.
38892
38893 @smallexample
38894 S_IFREG 0100000
38895 S_IFDIR 040000
38896 S_IRUSR 0400
38897 S_IWUSR 0200
38898 S_IXUSR 0100
38899 S_IRGRP 040
38900 S_IWGRP 020
38901 S_IXGRP 010
38902 S_IROTH 04
38903 S_IWOTH 02
38904 S_IXOTH 01
38905 @end smallexample
38906
38907 @node Errno Values
38908 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
38909 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
38910
38911 All values are given in decimal representation.
38912
38913 @smallexample
38914 EPERM 1
38915 ENOENT 2
38916 EINTR 4
38917 EBADF 9
38918 EACCES 13
38919 EFAULT 14
38920 EBUSY 16
38921 EEXIST 17
38922 ENODEV 19
38923 ENOTDIR 20
38924 EISDIR 21
38925 EINVAL 22
38926 ENFILE 23
38927 EMFILE 24
38928 EFBIG 27
38929 ENOSPC 28
38930 ESPIPE 29
38931 EROFS 30
38932 ENAMETOOLONG 91
38933 EUNKNOWN 9999
38934 @end smallexample
38935
38936 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
38937 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
38938
38939 @node Lseek Flags
38940 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
38941 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
38942
38943 @smallexample
38944 SEEK_SET 0
38945 SEEK_CUR 1
38946 SEEK_END 2
38947 @end smallexample
38948
38949 @node Limits
38950 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
38951 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
38952
38953 All values are given in decimal representation.
38954
38955 @smallexample
38956 INT_MIN -2147483648
38957 INT_MAX 2147483647
38958 UINT_MAX 4294967295
38959 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
38960 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
38961 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
38962 @end smallexample
38963
38964 @node File-I/O Examples
38965 @subsection File-I/O Examples
38966 @cindex file-i/o examples
38967
38968 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38969 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
38970
38971 @smallexample
38972 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
38973 @emph{request memory read from target}
38974 -> @code{m1234,6}
38975 <- XXXXXX
38976 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
38977 -> @code{F6}
38978 @end smallexample
38979
38980 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
38981 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
38982
38983 @smallexample
38984 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38985 @emph{request memory write to target}
38986 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
38987 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
38988 -> @code{F6}
38989 @end smallexample
38990
38991 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
38992 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
38993
38994 @smallexample
38995 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
38996 -> @code{F-1,9}
38997 @end smallexample
38998
38999 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
39000 host is called:
39001
39002 @smallexample
39003 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39004 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
39005 <- @code{T02}
39006 @end smallexample
39007
39008 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
39009 host is called:
39010
39011 @smallexample
39012 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
39013 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
39014 <- @code{T02}
39015 @end smallexample
39016
39017 @node Library List Format
39018 @section Library List Format
39019 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39020
39021 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
39022 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
39023 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
39024 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
39025 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
39026 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
39027 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
39028 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
39029 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
39030 are loaded.
39031
39032 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
39033 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
39034 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
39035 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
39036
39037 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
39038 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
39039 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
39040 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
39041 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
39042 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
39043
39044 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39045 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39046
39047 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
39048 offset, looks like this:
39049
39050 @smallexample
39051 <library-list>
39052 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
39053 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
39054 </library>
39055 </library-list>
39056 @end smallexample
39057
39058 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
39059 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
39060
39061 @smallexample
39062 <library-list>
39063 <library name="sharedlib.o">
39064 <section address="0x10000000"/>
39065 <section address="0x20000000"/>
39066 <section address="0x30000000"/>
39067 </library>
39068 </library-list>
39069 @end smallexample
39070
39071 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
39072
39073 @smallexample
39074 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
39075 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
39076 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39077 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
39078 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39079 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
39080 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39081 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
39082 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
39083 @end smallexample
39084
39085 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
39086 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
39087 section for each library.
39088
39089 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39090 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
39091 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
39092
39093 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
39094 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
39095 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
39096 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
39097
39098 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
39099 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
39100 target, the following parameters are reported:
39101
39102 @itemize @minus
39103 @item
39104 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
39105 @code{struct link_map}.
39106 @item
39107 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
39108 (Thread Local Storage) access.
39109 @item
39110 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
39111 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
39112 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
39113 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
39114 @item
39115 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
39116 @end itemize
39117
39118 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
39119 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
39120 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
39121
39122 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39123 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
39124
39125 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
39126 looks like this:
39127
39128 @smallexample
39129 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
39130 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
39131 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
39132 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
39133 l_ld="0x152350"/>
39134 </library-list-svr>
39135 @end smallexample
39136
39137 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
39138
39139 @smallexample
39140 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
39141 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
39142 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39143 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
39144 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
39145 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39146 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
39147 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
39148 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
39149 @end smallexample
39150
39151 @node Memory Map Format
39152 @section Memory Map Format
39153 @cindex memory map format
39154
39155 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
39156 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
39157 memory map.
39158
39159 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
39160 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
39161 lists memory regions.
39162
39163 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39164 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
39165
39166 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39167
39168 @smallexample
39169 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39170 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
39171 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39172 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
39173 <memory-map>
39174 region...
39175 </memory-map>
39176 @end smallexample
39177
39178 Each region can be either:
39179
39180 @itemize
39181
39182 @item
39183 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
39184 bytes from there:
39185
39186 @smallexample
39187 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39188 @end smallexample
39189
39190
39191 @item
39192 A region of read-only memory:
39193
39194 @smallexample
39195 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39196 @end smallexample
39197
39198
39199 @item
39200 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
39201 bytes in length:
39202
39203 @smallexample
39204 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
39205 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
39206 </memory>
39207 @end smallexample
39208
39209 @end itemize
39210
39211 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
39212 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
39213 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
39214
39215 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
39216
39217 @smallexample
39218 <!-- ................................................... -->
39219 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
39220 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
39221 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
39222 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
39223 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
39224 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory | property)>
39225 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
39226 <!ELEMENT memory (property)>
39227 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
39228 and its type, or device. -->
39229 <!ATTLIST memory type CDATA #REQUIRED
39230 start CDATA #REQUIRED
39231 length CDATA #REQUIRED
39232 device CDATA #IMPLIED>
39233 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
39234 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
39235 <!ATTLIST property name CDATA #REQUIRED>
39236 @end smallexample
39237
39238 @node Thread List Format
39239 @section Thread List Format
39240 @cindex thread list format
39241
39242 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
39243 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
39244 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
39245 the following structure:
39246
39247 @smallexample
39248 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39249 <threads>
39250 <thread id="id" core="0">
39251 ... description ...
39252 </thread>
39253 </threads>
39254 @end smallexample
39255
39256 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
39257 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
39258 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
39259 the thread was last executing on. The content of the of @samp{thread}
39260 element is interpreted as human-readable auxilliary information.
39261
39262 @node Traceframe Info Format
39263 @section Traceframe Info Format
39264 @cindex traceframe info format
39265
39266 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
39267 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
39268 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
39269 collected in a traceframe.
39270
39271 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
39272 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
39273
39274 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39275 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39276
39277 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39278
39279 @smallexample
39280 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39281 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
39282 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
39283 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
39284 <traceframe-info>
39285 block...
39286 </traceframe-info>
39287 @end smallexample
39288
39289 Each traceframe block can be either:
39290
39291 @itemize
39292
39293 @item
39294 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
39295 @var{length} bytes from there:
39296
39297 @smallexample
39298 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
39299 @end smallexample
39300
39301 @item
39302 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
39303 collected:
39304
39305 @smallexample
39306 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
39307 @end smallexample
39308
39309 @end itemize
39310
39311 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
39312
39313 @smallexample
39314 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
39315 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39316
39317 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
39318 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
39319 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
39320 <!ELEMENT tvar>
39321 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
39322 @end smallexample
39323
39324 @node Branch Trace Format
39325 @section Branch Trace Format
39326 @cindex branch trace format
39327
39328 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
39329 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
39330 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
39331 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
39332
39333 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
39334 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
39335
39336 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39337 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39338
39339 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
39340
39341 @smallexample
39342 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39343 <!DOCTYPE btrace
39344 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
39345 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
39346 <btrace>
39347 block...
39348 </btrace>
39349 @end smallexample
39350
39351 @itemize
39352
39353 @item
39354 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
39355 and ending at @var{end}:
39356
39357 @smallexample
39358 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
39359 @end smallexample
39360
39361 @end itemize
39362
39363 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
39364
39365 @smallexample
39366 <!ELEMENT btrace (block)* >
39367 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39368
39369 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
39370 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
39371 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
39372 @end smallexample
39373
39374 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
39375 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
39376 @cindex branch trace configuration format
39377
39378 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
39379 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
39380 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
39381
39382 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
39383 settings for that format. The following information is described:
39384
39385 @table @code
39386 @item bts
39387 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
39388 @table @code
39389 @item size
39390 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
39391 @end table
39392 @end table
39393
39394 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39395 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
39396
39397 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
39398
39399 @smallexample
39400 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?)>
39401 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
39402
39403 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
39404 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
39405 @end smallexample
39406
39407 @include agentexpr.texi
39408
39409 @node Target Descriptions
39410 @appendix Target Descriptions
39411 @cindex target descriptions
39412
39413 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
39414 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
39415 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
39416 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
39417 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
39418 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
39419 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
39420
39421 @itemize @bullet
39422 @item
39423 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
39424 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
39425 @item
39426 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
39427 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
39428 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
39429 @item
39430 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
39431 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
39432 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
39433 @end itemize
39434
39435 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
39436 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
39437 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
39438 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
39439 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
39440
39441 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
39442 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
39443
39444 @menu
39445 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
39446 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
39447 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
39448 descriptions.
39449 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
39450 @end menu
39451
39452 @node Retrieving Descriptions
39453 @section Retrieving Descriptions
39454
39455 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
39456 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
39457 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
39458 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
39459 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
39460 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
39461 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
39462 Format}.
39463
39464 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
39465 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
39466 specify a file are:
39467
39468 @table @code
39469 @cindex set tdesc filename
39470 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
39471 Read the target description from @var{path}.
39472
39473 @cindex unset tdesc filename
39474 @item unset tdesc filename
39475 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
39476 will use the description supplied by the current target.
39477
39478 @cindex show tdesc filename
39479 @item show tdesc filename
39480 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
39481 @end table
39482
39483
39484 @node Target Description Format
39485 @section Target Description Format
39486 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
39487
39488 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
39489 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
39490 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
39491 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
39492 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
39493 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
39494 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
39495
39496 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
39497 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
39498 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
39499 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
39500 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
39501
39502 Here is a simple target description:
39503
39504 @smallexample
39505 <target version="1.0">
39506 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
39507 </target>
39508 @end smallexample
39509
39510 @noindent
39511 This minimal description only says that the target uses
39512 the x86-64 architecture.
39513
39514 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
39515 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
39516 are explained further below.
39517
39518 @smallexample
39519 <?xml version="1.0"?>
39520 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
39521 <target version="1.0">
39522 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
39523 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
39524 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
39525 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
39526 </target>
39527 @end smallexample
39528
39529 @noindent
39530 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
39531 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
39532 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
39533 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
39534 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
39535 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
39536 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
39537 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
39538 the version mismatch.
39539
39540 @subsection Inclusion
39541 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
39542 @cindex XInclude
39543 @ifnotinfo
39544 @cindex <xi:include>
39545 @end ifnotinfo
39546
39547 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
39548 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
39549 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
39550 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
39551 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
39552
39553 @smallexample
39554 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
39555 @end smallexample
39556
39557 @noindent
39558 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
39559 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
39560 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
39561 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
39562 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
39563 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
39564 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
39565 original description.
39566
39567 @subsection Architecture
39568 @cindex <architecture>
39569
39570 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
39571
39572 @smallexample
39573 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
39574 @end smallexample
39575
39576 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39577 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39578
39579 @subsection OS ABI
39580 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
39581
39582 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39583 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39584
39585 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
39586
39587 @smallexample
39588 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
39589 @end smallexample
39590
39591 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
39592 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
39593
39594 @subsection Compatible Architecture
39595 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
39596
39597 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
39598 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
39599
39600 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
39601
39602 @smallexample
39603 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
39604 @end smallexample
39605
39606 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
39607 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
39608
39609 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
39610 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
39611 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
39612 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
39613 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
39614 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
39615 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
39616
39617 @smallexample
39618 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
39619 <compatible>spu</compatible>
39620 @end smallexample
39621
39622 @subsection Features
39623 @cindex <feature>
39624
39625 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
39626 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
39627 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
39628 has this form:
39629
39630 @smallexample
39631 <feature name="@var{name}">
39632 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
39633 @var{reg}@dots{}
39634 </feature>
39635 @end smallexample
39636
39637 @noindent
39638 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
39639 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
39640 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
39641 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
39642
39643 @subsection Types
39644
39645 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
39646 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
39647 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
39648 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
39649 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite types.
39650
39651 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
39652 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
39653 Types must be defined before they are used.
39654
39655 @cindex <vector>
39656 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
39657 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
39658 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
39659 @var{count}:
39660
39661 @smallexample
39662 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
39663 @end smallexample
39664
39665 @cindex <union>
39666 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
39667 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
39668 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
39669 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
39670
39671 @smallexample
39672 <union id="@var{id}">
39673 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39674 @dots{}
39675 </union>
39676 @end smallexample
39677
39678 @cindex <struct>
39679 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
39680 it with a structure type. There are two forms of the @samp{<struct>}
39681 element; a @samp{<struct>} element must either contain only bitfields
39682 or contain no bitfields. If the structure contains only bitfields,
39683 its total size in bytes must be specified, each bitfield must have an
39684 explicit start and end, and bitfields are automatically assigned an
39685 integer type. The field's @var{start} should be less than or
39686 equal to its @var{end}, and zero represents the least significant bit.
39687
39688 @smallexample
39689 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39690 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39691 @dots{}
39692 </struct>
39693 @end smallexample
39694
39695 If the structure contains no bitfields, then each field has an
39696 explicit type, and no implicit padding is added.
39697
39698 @smallexample
39699 <struct id="@var{id}">
39700 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
39701 @dots{}
39702 </struct>
39703 @end smallexample
39704
39705 @cindex <flags>
39706 If a register's value is a series of single-bit flags, define it with
39707 a flags type. The @samp{<flags>} element has an explicit @var{size}
39708 and contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements. Each field has a
39709 @var{name}, a @var{start}, and an @var{end}. Only single-bit flags
39710 are supported.
39711
39712 @smallexample
39713 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
39714 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}"/>
39715 @dots{}
39716 </flags>
39717 @end smallexample
39718
39719 @subsection Registers
39720 @cindex <reg>
39721
39722 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
39723
39724 @smallexample
39725 <reg name="@var{name}"
39726 bitsize="@var{size}"
39727 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
39728 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
39729 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
39730 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
39731 @end smallexample
39732
39733 @noindent
39734 The components are as follows:
39735
39736 @table @var
39737
39738 @item name
39739 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
39740
39741 @item bitsize
39742 The register's size, in bits.
39743
39744 @item regnum
39745 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
39746 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
39747 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
39748 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
39749 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
39750 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
39751 in order of increasing register number.
39752
39753 @item save-restore
39754 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
39755 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
39756 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
39757 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
39758 ABI.
39759
39760 @item type
39761 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
39762 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
39763 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
39764 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
39765 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
39766 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
39767
39768 @item group
39769 The register group to which this register belongs. It must
39770 be either @code{general}, @code{float}, or @code{vector}. If no
39771 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register
39772 in @code{info registers}.
39773
39774 @end table
39775
39776 @node Predefined Target Types
39777 @section Predefined Target Types
39778 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
39779
39780 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
39781 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
39782 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
39783 types. The currently supported types are:
39784
39785 @table @code
39786
39787 @item int8
39788 @itemx int16
39789 @itemx int32
39790 @itemx int64
39791 @itemx int128
39792 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39793
39794 @item uint8
39795 @itemx uint16
39796 @itemx uint32
39797 @itemx uint64
39798 @itemx uint128
39799 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
39800
39801 @item code_ptr
39802 @itemx data_ptr
39803 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
39804 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
39805 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
39806 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
39807 may be marked as data pointers.
39808
39809 @item ieee_single
39810 Single precision IEEE floating point.
39811
39812 @item ieee_double
39813 Double precision IEEE floating point.
39814
39815 @item arm_fpa_ext
39816 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
39817
39818 @item i387_ext
39819 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
39820
39821 @item i386_eflags
39822 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
39823
39824 @item i386_mxcsr
39825 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
39826
39827 @end table
39828
39829 @node Standard Target Features
39830 @section Standard Target Features
39831 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
39832
39833 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
39834 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
39835 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
39836 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
39837 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
39838 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
39839 can recognize them.
39840
39841 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
39842 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
39843 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
39844 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
39845 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
39846 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
39847 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
39848 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
39849
39850 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
39851 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
39852 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
39853
39854 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
39855 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
39856 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
39857 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
39858
39859 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
39860 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
39861 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
39862
39863 @menu
39864 * AArch64 Features::
39865 * ARM Features::
39866 * i386 Features::
39867 * MicroBlaze Features::
39868 * MIPS Features::
39869 * M68K Features::
39870 * Nios II Features::
39871 * PowerPC Features::
39872 * S/390 and System z Features::
39873 * TIC6x Features::
39874 @end menu
39875
39876
39877 @node AArch64 Features
39878 @subsection AArch64 Features
39879 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
39880
39881 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
39882 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
39883 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39884
39885 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
39886 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
39887 and @samp{fpcr}.
39888
39889 @node ARM Features
39890 @subsection ARM Features
39891 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
39892
39893 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
39894 ARM targets.
39895 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
39896 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
39897
39898 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
39899 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
39900 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
39901 and @samp{xpsr}.
39902
39903 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
39904 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
39905
39906 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
39907 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
39908 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
39909 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
39910
39911 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
39912 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
39913 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
39914 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
39915 halves of the double-precision registers.
39916
39917 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
39918 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
39919 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
39920 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
39921 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
39922 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
39923
39924 @node i386 Features
39925 @subsection i386 Features
39926 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
39927
39928 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
39929 targets. It should describe the following registers:
39930
39931 @itemize @minus
39932 @item
39933 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
39934 @item
39935 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
39936 @item
39937 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
39938 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
39939 @item
39940 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
39941 @item
39942 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
39943 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
39944 @end itemize
39945
39946 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
39947
39948 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
39949 describe registers:
39950
39951 @itemize @minus
39952 @item
39953 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
39954 @item
39955 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
39956 @item
39957 @samp{mxcsr}
39958 @end itemize
39959
39960 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
39961 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
39962 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
39963
39964 @itemize @minus
39965 @item
39966 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
39967 @item
39968 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
39969 @end itemize
39970
39971 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel(R)
39972 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
39973
39974 @itemize @minus
39975 @item
39976 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
39977 @item
39978 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
39979 @end itemize
39980
39981 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
39982 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
39983
39984 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
39985 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
39986 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
39987
39988 @itemize @minus
39989 @item
39990 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39991 @end itemize
39992
39993 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
39994
39995 @itemize @minus
39996 @item
39997 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
39998 @end itemize
39999
40000 It should
40001 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
40002
40003 @itemize @minus
40004 @item
40005 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
40006 @item
40007 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
40008 @end itemize
40009
40010 It should
40011 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
40012
40013 @itemize @minus
40014 @item
40015 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
40016 @end itemize
40017
40018 @node MicroBlaze Features
40019 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
40020 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
40021
40022 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
40023 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40024 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
40025 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
40026 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
40027
40028 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
40029 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
40030
40031 @node MIPS Features
40032 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
40033 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
40034
40035 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
40036 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
40037 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
40038 on the target.
40039
40040 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
40041 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
40042 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40043
40044 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
40045 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
40046 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
40047 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40048
40049 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
40050 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
40051 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
40052 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40053
40054 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
40055 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
40056 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
40057
40058 @node M68K Features
40059 @subsection M68K Features
40060 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
40061
40062 @table @code
40063 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
40064 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
40065 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
40066 One of those features must be always present.
40067 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
40068 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
40069 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
40070 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
40071
40072 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
40073 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
40074 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
40075 @samp{fpiaddr}.
40076 @end table
40077
40078 @node Nios II Features
40079 @subsection Nios II Features
40080 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
40081
40082 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
40083 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
40084 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
40085 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
40086 @samp{mpuacc}).
40087
40088 @node PowerPC Features
40089 @subsection PowerPC Features
40090 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
40091
40092 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
40093 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
40094 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
40095 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
40096
40097 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
40098 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
40099
40100 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
40101 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
40102 and @samp{vrsave}.
40103
40104 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
40105 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
40106 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
40107 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
40108 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
40109 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
40110
40111 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
40112 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
40113 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
40114 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
40115 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
40116 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
40117 user.
40118
40119 @node S/390 and System z Features
40120 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
40121 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
40122 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
40123
40124 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
40125 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
40126 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
40127 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
40128 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
40129 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
40130 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
40131 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
40132 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
40133
40134 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
40135 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
40136 @samp{fpc}.
40137
40138 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
40139 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
40140
40141 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
40142 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
40143 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
40144 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
40145 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
40146 32-bit wide.
40147
40148 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
40149 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
40150 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
40151
40152 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
40153 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
40154 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
40155 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
40156 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
40157 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
40158 @samp{v31}.
40159
40160 @node TIC6x Features
40161 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
40162 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
40163 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
40164 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
40165 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
40166 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
40167
40168 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
40169 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
40170 through @samp{B31}.
40171
40172 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
40173 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
40174
40175 @node Operating System Information
40176 @appendix Operating System Information
40177 @cindex operating system information
40178
40179 @menu
40180 * Process list::
40181 @end menu
40182
40183 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
40184 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
40185 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
40186 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
40187 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
40188 on a different aspect of target.
40189
40190 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
40191 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
40192 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
40193 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
40194
40195 @node Process list
40196 @appendixsection Process list
40197 @cindex operating system information, process list
40198
40199 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
40200 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
40201 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
40202 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
40203
40204 An example document is:
40205
40206 @smallexample
40207 <?xml version="1.0"?>
40208 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
40209 <osdata type="processes">
40210 <item>
40211 <column name="pid">1</column>
40212 <column name="user">root</column>
40213 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
40214 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
40215 </item>
40216 </osdata>
40217 @end smallexample
40218
40219 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
40220 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
40221 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
40222 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
40223 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
40224 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
40225 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
40226
40227 @node Trace File Format
40228 @appendix Trace File Format
40229 @cindex trace file format
40230
40231 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
40232 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
40233
40234 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
40235 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
40236 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
40237 in the future.
40238
40239 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
40240 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
40241 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
40242 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
40243 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
40244 of this section.
40245
40246 @c FIXME add some specific types of data
40247
40248 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
40249 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
40250 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
40251 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
40252 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
40253 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
40254 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
40255 endianness.
40256
40257 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
40258
40259 @table @code
40260 @item R @var{bytes}
40261 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
40262 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
40263 actual bytes, in target order and @value{GDBN} register order, not a
40264 hexadecimal encoding.
40265
40266 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
40267 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
40268 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
40269 @var{length} bytes.
40270
40271 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
40272 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
40273 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
40274
40275 @end table
40276
40277 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
40278 of blocks.
40279
40280 @node Index Section Format
40281 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
40282 @cindex .gdb_index section format
40283 @cindex index section format
40284
40285 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
40286 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
40287 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
40288 description.
40289
40290 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
40291 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
40292 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
40293 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
40294 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
40295 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
40296
40297 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
40298
40299 @enumerate
40300 @item
40301 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
40302 unless otherwise noted:
40303
40304 @enumerate
40305 @item
40306 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
40307 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
40308 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
40309 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
40310 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
40311 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
40312 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
40313
40314 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
40315 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
40316 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
40317 currently not flagged as deprecated.
40318
40319 @item
40320 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
40321
40322 @item
40323 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
40324 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
40325 to the next offset.
40326
40327 @item
40328 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
40329
40330 @item
40331 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
40332
40333 @item
40334 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
40335 @end enumerate
40336
40337 @item
40338 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
40339 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
40340 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
40341 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
40342 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
40343 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
40344 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
40345 CU indices.
40346
40347 @item
40348 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
40349 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
40350 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
40351 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
40352
40353 @item
40354 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
40355 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
40356
40357 @enumerate
40358 @item
40359 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
40360
40361 @item
40362 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
40363 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
40364
40365 @item
40366 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
40367 @end enumerate
40368
40369 @item
40370 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
40371 the hash table is always a power of 2.
40372
40373 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
40374 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
40375 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
40376 constant pool.
40377
40378 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
40379 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
40380 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
40381
40382 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
40383 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
40384 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
40385 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
40386 index version:
40387
40388 @table @asis
40389 @item Version 4
40390 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
40391
40392 @item Versions 5 to 7
40393 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
40394 @end table
40395
40396 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
40397
40398 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
40399 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
40400 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
40401 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
40402 collision.
40403
40404 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
40405 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
40406 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
40407 the code.
40408
40409 @item
40410 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
40411 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
40412 strings.
40413
40414 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
40415 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
40416 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
40417 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
40418 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
40419 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
40420
40421 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
40422 @end enumerate
40423
40424 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
40425 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
40426 CU index+attributes value for each use.
40427
40428 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
40429 (bit 0 = LSB):
40430
40431 @table @asis
40432
40433 @item Bits 0-23
40434 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
40435 @item Bits 24-27
40436 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
40437 @item Bits 28-30
40438 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
40439
40440 @table @asis
40441 @item 0
40442 This value is reserved and should not be used.
40443 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
40444 with previous versions of the index.
40445 @item 1
40446 The symbol is a type.
40447 @item 2
40448 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
40449 @item 3
40450 The symbol is a function.
40451 @item 4
40452 Any other kind of symbol.
40453 @item 5,6,7
40454 These values are reserved.
40455 @end table
40456
40457 @item Bit 31
40458 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
40459
40460 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
40461 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
40462 @value{GDBN} sources.
40463
40464 @end table
40465
40466 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
40467 global/static attributes in the index.
40468
40469 @smallexample
40470 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
40471 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
40472 switch (die->tag)
40473 @{
40474 case DW_TAG_typedef:
40475 case DW_TAG_base_type:
40476 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
40477 kind = TYPE;
40478 is_static = 1;
40479 break;
40480 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
40481 kind = VARIABLE;
40482 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40483 break;
40484 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
40485 kind = FUNCTION;
40486 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
40487 break;
40488 case DW_TAG_constant:
40489 kind = VARIABLE;
40490 is_static = ! is_external;
40491 break;
40492 case DW_TAG_variable:
40493 kind = VARIABLE;
40494 is_static = ! is_external;
40495 break;
40496 case DW_TAG_namespace:
40497 kind = TYPE;
40498 is_static = 0;
40499 break;
40500 case DW_TAG_class_type:
40501 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
40502 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
40503 case DW_TAG_union_type:
40504 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
40505 kind = TYPE;
40506 is_static = (language != CPLUS && language != JAVA);
40507 break;
40508 default:
40509 assert (0);
40510 @}
40511 @end smallexample
40512
40513 @node Man Pages
40514 @appendix Manual pages
40515 @cindex Man pages
40516
40517 @menu
40518 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
40519 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
40520 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
40521 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
40522 @end menu
40523
40524 @node gdb man
40525 @heading gdb man
40526
40527 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
40528
40529 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
40530 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
40531 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
40532 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
40533 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
40534 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
40535 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
40536 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
40537 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
40538 @c man end
40539
40540 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
40541 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
40542 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
40543 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
40544
40545 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
40546 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
40547
40548 @itemize @bullet
40549 @item
40550 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
40551
40552 @item
40553 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
40554
40555 @item
40556 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
40557
40558 @item
40559 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
40560 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
40561 @end itemize
40562
40563 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
40564 Modula-2.
40565
40566 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
40567 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
40568 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
40569 by using the command @code{help}.
40570
40571 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
40572 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
40573 executable program as the argument:
40574
40575 @smallexample
40576 gdb program
40577 @end smallexample
40578
40579 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
40580
40581 @smallexample
40582 gdb program core
40583 @end smallexample
40584
40585 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
40586 to debug a running process:
40587
40588 @smallexample
40589 gdb program 1234
40590 gdb -p 1234
40591 @end smallexample
40592
40593 @noindent
40594 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
40595 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
40596 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
40597
40598 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
40599
40600 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
40601 @table @env
40602 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{functiop}
40603 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
40604
40605 @item run [@var{arglist}]
40606 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
40607
40608 @item bt
40609 Backtrace: display the program stack.
40610
40611 @item print @var{expr}
40612 Display the value of an expression.
40613
40614 @item c
40615 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
40616
40617 @item next
40618 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
40619 function calls in the line.
40620
40621 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40622 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
40623
40624 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
40625 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
40626
40627 @item step
40628 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
40629 function calls in the line.
40630
40631 @item help [@var{name}]
40632 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
40633 about using @value{GDBN}.
40634
40635 @item quit
40636 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
40637 @end table
40638
40639 @ifset man
40640 For full details on @value{GDBN},
40641 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40642 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
40643 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
40644 @end ifset
40645 @c man end
40646
40647 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
40648 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
40649 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
40650 encountered with no
40651 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
40652 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
40653 Many options have
40654 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
40655 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
40656 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
40657 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
40658 more usual convention.)
40659
40660 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
40661 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
40662 option is used.
40663
40664 @table @env
40665 @item -help
40666 @itemx -h
40667 List all options, with brief explanations.
40668
40669 @item -symbols=@var{file}
40670 @itemx -s @var{file}
40671 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
40672
40673 @item -write
40674 Enable writing into executable and core files.
40675
40676 @item -exec=@var{file}
40677 @itemx -e @var{file}
40678 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
40679 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
40680 dump.
40681
40682 @item -se=@var{file}
40683 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
40684 file.
40685
40686 @item -core=@var{file}
40687 @itemx -c @var{file}
40688 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
40689
40690 @item -command=@var{file}
40691 @itemx -x @var{file}
40692 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
40693
40694 @item -ex @var{command}
40695 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
40696
40697 @item -directory=@var{directory}
40698 @itemx -d @var{directory}
40699 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
40700
40701 @item -nh
40702 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
40703
40704 @item -nx
40705 @itemx -n
40706 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
40707
40708 @item -quiet
40709 @itemx -q
40710 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
40711 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
40712
40713 @item -batch
40714 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
40715 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
40716 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
40717 commands in the command files.
40718
40719 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
40720 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
40721 more useful, the message
40722
40723 @smallexample
40724 Program exited normally.
40725 @end smallexample
40726
40727 @noindent
40728 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
40729 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
40730
40731 @item -cd=@var{directory}
40732 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
40733 instead of the current directory.
40734
40735 @item -fullname
40736 @itemx -f
40737 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
40738 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
40739 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
40740 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
40741 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
40742 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
40743 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
40744 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
40745
40746 @item -b @var{bps}
40747 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
40748 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
40749
40750 @item -tty=@var{device}
40751 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
40752 @end table
40753 @c man end
40754
40755 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
40756 @ifset man
40757 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
40758 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
40759 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
40760
40761 @smallexample
40762 info gdb
40763 @end smallexample
40764
40765 @noindent
40766 should give you access to the complete manual.
40767
40768 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
40769 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
40770 @end ifset
40771 @c man end
40772
40773 @node gdbserver man
40774 @heading gdbserver man
40775
40776 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
40777 @format
40778 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
40779 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40780
40781 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40782
40783 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40784 @c man end
40785 @end format
40786
40787 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
40788 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
40789 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
40790
40791 @ifclear man
40792 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
40793 @end ifclear
40794 @ifset man
40795 Usage (server (target) side):
40796 @end ifset
40797
40798 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
40799 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
40800 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
40801 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
40802
40803 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
40804 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
40805 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
40806
40807 @smallexample
40808 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
40809 @end smallexample
40810
40811 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
40812
40813 @smallexample
40814 @ifset man
40815 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
40816 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
40817 @end ifset
40818 @ifclear man
40819 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
40820 @end ifclear
40821 @end smallexample
40822
40823 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
40824 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
40825 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
40826
40827 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
40828
40829 @smallexample
40830 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
40831 @end smallexample
40832
40833 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
40834 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
40835 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
40836 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
40837 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
40838 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
40839 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
40840 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
40841 print an error message and exit.
40842
40843 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
40844 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
40845
40846 @smallexample
40847 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40848 @end smallexample
40849
40850 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40851 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40852
40853 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40854 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
40855 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
40856 the program you want to debug.
40857
40858 @smallexample
40859 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40860 @end smallexample
40861
40862 @ifclear man
40863 @subheading Usage (host side)
40864 @end ifclear
40865 @ifset man
40866 Usage (host side):
40867 @end ifset
40868
40869 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
40870 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
40871 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
40872 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
40873 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
40874 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
40875 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
40876 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
40877 descriptor. For example:
40878
40879 @smallexample
40880 @ifset man
40881 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
40882 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
40883 @end ifset
40884 @ifclear man
40885 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
40886 @end ifclear
40887 @end smallexample
40888
40889 @noindent
40890 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
40891
40892 @smallexample
40893 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
40894 @end smallexample
40895
40896 @noindent
40897 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
40898 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
40899 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
40900 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
40901 `Connection refused'.
40902
40903 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
40904 described in
40905 @ifset man
40906 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
40907 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
40908 @end ifset
40909 @ifclear man
40910 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
40911 @end ifclear
40912 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
40913
40914 @smallexample
40915 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
40916 @end smallexample
40917
40918 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
40919 case.
40920 @c man end
40921
40922 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
40923 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
40924
40925 @itemize @bullet
40926
40927 @item
40928 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
40929
40930 @smallexample
40931 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
40932 @end smallexample
40933
40934 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
40935 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
40936 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
40937 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
40938 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
40939 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
40940 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40941
40942 @item
40943 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
40944 program:
40945
40946 @smallexample
40947 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40948 @end smallexample
40949
40950 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
40951 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
40952 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
40953 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
40954
40955 @item
40956 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
40957
40958 @smallexample
40959 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40960 @end smallexample
40961
40962 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
40963 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
40964 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
40965 debug several processes in the same session.
40966 @end itemize
40967
40968 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
40969
40970 @table @env
40971
40972 @item --help
40973 List all options, with brief explanations.
40974
40975 @item --version
40976 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
40977
40978 @item --attach
40979 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
40980
40981 @smallexample
40982 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
40983 @end smallexample
40984
40985 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
40986 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
40987
40988 @item --multi
40989 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
40990 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
40991 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
40992 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
40993
40994 @smallexample
40995 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
40996 @end smallexample
40997
40998 @item --debug
40999 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
41000 process.
41001 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41002 the developers.
41003
41004 @item --remote-debug
41005 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
41006 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
41007 the developers.
41008
41009 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
41010 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
41011 of debugging output.
41012 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
41013
41014 @item --wrapper
41015 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
41016 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
41017 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
41018 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
41019
41020 @item --once
41021 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
41022 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
41023 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
41024 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
41025
41026 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
41027
41028 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
41029 @c QDisableRandomization.
41030
41031 @end table
41032 @c man end
41033
41034 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
41035 @ifset man
41036 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41037 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41038 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41039
41040 @smallexample
41041 info gdb
41042 @end smallexample
41043
41044 should give you access to the complete manual.
41045
41046 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41047 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41048 @end ifset
41049 @c man end
41050
41051 @node gcore man
41052 @heading gcore
41053
41054 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
41055
41056 @format
41057 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
41058 gcore [-o @var{filename}] @var{pid}
41059 @c man end
41060 @end format
41061
41062 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
41063 Generate a core dump of a running program with process ID @var{pid}.
41064 Produced file is equivalent to a kernel produced core file as if the process
41065 crashed (and if @kbd{ulimit -c} were used to set up an appropriate core dump
41066 limit). Unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} the program remains
41067 running without any change.
41068 @c man end
41069
41070 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
41071 @table @env
41072 @item -o @var{filename}
41073 The optional argument
41074 @var{filename} specifies the file name where to put the core dump.
41075 If not specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}},
41076 where @var{pid} is the running program process ID.
41077 @end table
41078 @c man end
41079
41080 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
41081 @ifset man
41082 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41083 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41084 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41085
41086 @smallexample
41087 info gdb
41088 @end smallexample
41089
41090 @noindent
41091 should give you access to the complete manual.
41092
41093 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41094 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41095 @end ifset
41096 @c man end
41097
41098 @node gdbinit man
41099 @heading gdbinit
41100
41101 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
41102
41103 @format
41104 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
41105 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41106 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41107 @end ifset
41108
41109 ~/.gdbinit
41110
41111 ./.gdbinit
41112 @c man end
41113 @end format
41114
41115 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
41116 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
41117 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
41118 described in
41119 @ifset man
41120 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
41121 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
41122 @end ifset
41123 @ifclear man
41124 @ref{Sequences}.
41125 @end ifclear
41126
41127 Please read more in
41128 @ifset man
41129 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
41130 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
41131 @end ifset
41132 @ifclear man
41133 @ref{Startup}.
41134 @end ifclear
41135
41136 @table @env
41137 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41138 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
41139 @end ifset
41140 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
41141 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
41142 @end ifclear
41143 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41144 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
41145 See more in
41146 @ifset man
41147 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
41148 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
41149 @end ifset
41150 @ifclear man
41151 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
41152 @end ifclear
41153
41154 @item ~/.gdbinit
41155 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
41156 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
41157
41158 @item ./.gdbinit
41159 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
41160 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
41161 See more in
41162 @ifset man
41163 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
41164 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
41165 @end ifset
41166 @ifclear man
41167 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
41168 @end ifclear
41169 @end table
41170 @c man end
41171
41172 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
41173 @ifset man
41174 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
41175
41176 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
41177 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
41178 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
41179
41180 @smallexample
41181 info gdb
41182 @end smallexample
41183
41184 should give you access to the complete manual.
41185
41186 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
41187 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
41188 @end ifset
41189 @c man end
41190
41191 @include gpl.texi
41192
41193 @node GNU Free Documentation License
41194 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
41195 @include fdl.texi
41196
41197 @node Concept Index
41198 @unnumbered Concept Index
41199
41200 @printindex cp
41201
41202 @node Command and Variable Index
41203 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
41204
41205 @printindex fn
41206
41207 @tex
41208 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
41209 % meantime:
41210 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
41211 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
41212 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
41213 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
41214 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
41215 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
41216 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
41217 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
41218 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
41219 \page\colophon
41220 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
41221 @end tex
41222
41223 @bye
This page took 1.651457 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.